AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON MAY 16, 1997
    
                                              REGISTRATION NO. 333-18897     



                      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                            WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                              
                               AMENDMENT NO. 3
    
                                      TO
                                   FORM S-3
                            REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                    UNDER
                          THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
            (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

          Ohio                                        31-0412725             
(STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF           (I.R.S. EMPLOYER IDENTIFICATION NO.)
INCORPORATION OR ORGANIZATION)

                            ----------------------
                            ONE EAST FOURTH STREET
                            CINCINNATI, OHIO 45202
                                (513) 579-2000
     (ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA 
               CODE, OF REGISTRANT'S PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES)
                            ----------------------

                             MARK E. MAGEE, ESQ.
                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
                            ONE EAST FOURTH STREET
                            CINCINNATI, OHIO 45202
                                (513) 579-2000
  (NAME, ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA
                        CODE, OF AGENT FOR SERVICE)
                            ----------------------

                               WITH A COPY TO:
     JAMES R. WHITAKER, ESQ.                 MICHAEL P. BRAUN, ESQ.
     KEATING, MUETHING & KLEKAMP, P.L.L.          BROWN & WOOD LLP
     1800 PROVIDENT TOWER                         ONE WORLD TRADE CENTER
     ONE EAST FOURTH STREET                  NEW YORK, NEW YORK  10048-0557
     CINCINNATI, OHIO 45202

       APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC:
From time to time on or after the effective date of the registration 
statement, as determined by market conditions.
                                                    
                        ---------------------------
     IF THE ONLY SECURITIES BEING REGISTERED ON THIS FORM ARE BEING OFFERED
PURSUANT TO DIVIDEND OR INTEREST REINVESTMENT PLANS, PLEASE CHECK THE
FOLLOWING BOX. / /
     IF ANY OF THE SECURITIES BEING REGISTERED ON THIS FORM ARE TO BE OFFERED
ON A DELAYED OR CONTINUOUS BASIS PURSUANT TO RULE 415 UNDER THE SECURITIES
ACT OF 1933, PLEASE CHECK THE FOLLOWING BOX. /X/
     IF THIS FORM IS FILED TO REGISTER ADDITIONAL SECURITIES FOR AN OFFERING
PURSUANT TO RULE 462(B) UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, PLEASE CHECK THE FOLLOWING
BOX AND LIST THE SECURITIES ACT REGISTRATION STATEMENT NUMBER OF THE EARLIER
EFFECTIVE REGISTRATION STATEMENT FOR THE SAME OFFERING./ /____________
     IF THIS FORM IS A POST-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT FILED PURSUANT TO RULE 462(C)
UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, CHECK THE FOLLOWING BOX AND LIST THE SECURITIES ACT
REGISTRATION STATEMENT NUMBER OF THE EARLIER EFFECTIVE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
FOR THE SAME OFFERING./ /____________

     IF DELIVERY OF THE PROSPECTUS IS EXPECTED TO BE MADE PURSUANT TO RULE
434, PLEASE CHECK THE FOLLOWING BOX./ /

                       CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE




                                                 Proposed        Proposed
                                          Amount          Maximum          Maximum        Amount of
       Title of Each Class of             to be        Offering Price     Aggregate     Registration
     Securities to Be Registered        Registered     Per Unit/(1)/      Offering           Fee
                                                                          Price/(1)/
                                                                           
Asset Backed Notes and Asset Backed
Certificates/(2)/ . . . . . . . . .    $500,000,000         100%        $500,000,000    $151,515.15*




     /(1)/ Estimated for the purpose of calculating the registration fee.
     /(2)/ Not specified as to each class of Asset Backed Securities to be
           registered pursuant to General Instruction II.D of Form S-3.
     *     The Registration Fee was previously paid.

     THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT
SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS
REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH
SECTION 8(A) OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING 
PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A), MAY DETERMINE.

                  SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED MAY 15, 1997

   Information  contained herein is subject to  completion or  amendment.  A
registration  statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission. These securities may not be sold nor may
offers to buy  be accepted  prior to  the  time  the  registration statement
becomes effective.  This prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or
the solicitation of an offer to buy nor  shall  there be any  sale of  these
securities in  any State in which such offer, solicitation, or sale would be
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the securities laws of
any such State.    

PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(To Prospectus dated ______________, 199__)

                             $___________________
                                (APPROXIMATE)

          HOME EQUITY LOAN ASSET BACKED CERTIFICATES, SERIES 199_-_

                              THE PROVIDENT BANK
                        TRANSFEROR AND MASTER SERVICER

     Each  Home   Equity   Loan  Asset  Backed  Certificate,   Series  199_-_
(collectively, the "Certificates") will represent an  undivided  interest  in
the Provident Home Equity Loan Trust 199_-_   (the "Trust Fund") to be formed
pursuant to a  Pooling  and  Servicing  Agreement between The Provident  Bank
("Provident"), as Transferor and Master Servicer and (                 ),  as
Trustee.  The property of the Trust Fund will  include a  pool of (adjustable
rate) home  equity  revolving credit line loans made or to be made   in   the
future (the "Mortgage Loans") under certain home equity revolving credit line
loan agreements.  The Mortgage  Loans are secured by either first  and second
deeds of trust or  mortgages on one-  to four-family residential  properties.
See "Index of Defined Terms" on Page (S-56) of this Prospectus Supplement and
on Page (85) of the Prospectus for the location of the definitions of certain
capitalized terms.

     The aggregate undivided  interest in the Trust  Fund represented by  the
Certificates will, as of ____________,  199_ (the "Cut-Off Date"),  represent
approximately __%  of  the outstanding  principal  balances of  the  Mortgage
Loans.  The remaining undivided interest in the Trust Fund not represented by
the Certificates  (the  "Transferor Interest")  will  initially be  equal  to
$_________________, which as  of the  Cut-Off Date is  _% of the  outstanding
principal balances of the  Mortgage Loans. Only the Certificates  are offered
hereby.
     Distributions of principal and interest on the Certificates will be made
on the __________th day of each month or, if such date is not a Business Day,
then on the succeeding Business Day (each, a "Distribution Date"), commencing
___________, 199_.   On each  Distribution Date, holders of  the Certificates
will  be  entitled  to receive,  from  and  to the  limited  extent  of funds
available in  the  Collection Account  (as  defined herein  under  "Summary--
Collections"),  distributions  with   respect  to   interest  and   principal
calculated  as  set  forth  under   "Summary--Interest,"  "Summary--Principal
Payments from Principal  Collections" and "Description of  the Certificates--
Distributions  on  the  Certificates"  herein.    The  Certificates  are  not
guaranteed by Provident or any affiliate thereof.  (However, the Certificates
will be unconditionally and  irrevocably guaranteed as to the  payment of the
Guaranteed Distributions (as  defined herein under "Summary--The  Policy") on
each  Distribution  Date  pursuant  to  the terms  of  a  financial  guaranty
insurance policy (the "Policy") to be issued by

                                  (INSURER)
     There  is currently no  market for  the Certificates offered  hereby and
there  can be no  assurance that  such a  market will develop  or if  it does
develop  that  it  will continue.    See  "Risk Factors"  herein  and  in the
Prospectus.

     PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD REVIEW THE INFORMATION SET FORTH UNDER
          "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE S-16 HEREIN AND ON PAGE (12) IN THE
                           ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS.
      THE CERTIFICATES REPRESENT INTERESTS IN THE TRUST FUND ONLY AND DO
         NOT REPRESENT INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF PROVIDENT, THE 
            TRUSTEE OR ANY AFFILIATE THEREOF, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT
              PROVIDED HEREIN.  NEITHER THE CERTIFICATES NOR THE 
               MORTGAGE LOANS ARE INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY ANY 
                             GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.
        THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE
          SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
           COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
              OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
                ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS.  ANY
                 REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL
                                   OFFENSE.


                                                     Price to    Underwriting     Proceeds to
                                                             Public (1)    Discount(2)     Provident (3)
                                                                                  
Per Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               %             %              %
Total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $               $               $



(1)  Plus accrued interest, if any, from _______________, 199_.
(2)  Provident has  agreed  to  indemnify  the  Underwriter  against  certain
     liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933.
(3)  Before deducting expenses, estimated to be $_______________.
     The  Certificates are offered  subject to prior sale  and subject to the
     Underwriter's right  to reject orders  in whole or in  part.  It  is 
     expected that delivery  of  the Certificates  will  be made  in 
     book-entry form  only through the facilities of  The Depository 
     Trust Company, CEDEL  Bank, societe anonyme, and  the Euroclear  
     System  on or  about ______________,  199_  (the "Closing Date").  
     The Certificates will  be offered in Europe and the  United
     States of America.

                              ---------------------
                                (UNDERWRITER)
_____________, 199_

     IN  CONNECTION WITH  THIS OFFERING,  THE UNDERWRITER  MAY  OVER-ALLOT OR
EFFECT  TRANSACTIONS WHICH  STABILIZE OR  MAINTAIN  THE MARKET  PRICE OF  THE
CERTIFICATES  AT LEVELS ABOVE THOSE WHICH MIGHT OTHERWISE PREVAIL IN THE OPEN
MARKET.  SUCH STABILIZING, IF COMMENCED, MAY BE DISCONTINUED AT ANY TIME.

     UNTIL NINETY  DAYS AFTER  THE DATE  OF THIS  PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT,  ALL
DEALERS   EFFECTING  TRANSACTIONS  IN   THE  CERTIFICATES,   WHETHER  OR  NOT
PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY  BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A  PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT AND PROSPECTUS.  THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE  OBLIGATION OF DEALERS
ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND PROSPECTUS WITH
RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.

                              ---------------------
     The Certificates offered hereby constitute  part of a separate series of
Home Equity  Loan Asset Backed  Certificates being  offered by The  Provident
Bank  from time  to time  pursuant to  its Prospectus  dated _______________,
199__.   This  Prospectus Supplement  does  not contain  complete information
about the offering of the Certificates.   Additional information is contained
in  the Prospectus  and  investors are  urged  to read  both  this Prospectus
Supplement and the Prospectus in full.  Sales of  the Certificates may not be
consummated unless the purchaser has received both this Prospectus Supplement
and the Prospectus.

     The Trustee on behalf of  any Trust Fund will provide without  charge to
each person  to whom this Prospectus Supplement  is delivered, on the written
or  oral  request of  such person,  a copy  of  any or  all of  the documents
referred to  in the Prospectus  under "Incorporation of Certain  Documents by
Reference" that  have  been  or  may be  incorporated  by  reference  in  the
Prospectus (not including exhibits to the information that is incorporated by
reference  unless such  exhibits are  specifically incorporated  by reference
into the information that the Prospectus incorporates).  Such requests should
be directed to the  Corporate Trust Office of  the Trustee at  _____________,
telephone:_________, facsimile number:_____________, attention:__________.


                                   SUMMARY

     The following summary  of certain pertinent information is  qualified in
its entirety by reference to the detailed information appearing elsewhere  in
this  Prospectus  Supplement   and  the   accompanying  Prospectus.   Certain
capitalized terms used in the Summary are defined elsewhere in the Prospectus
Supplement or in  the Prospectus.   See "Index of Defined Terms" on Page S-56
of  this Prospectus  Supplement and  on  Page 85  of the  Prospectus  for the
location of the definitions of certain capitalized terms. 

Trust Fund               Provident Home Equity Loan  Trust 199_-_ (the "Trust
                         Fund")  will be  formed pursuant  to  a pooling  and
                         servicing agreement (the "Agreement") to be dated as
                         of ______________, 199_ (the "Cut-Off Date") between
                         The Provident Bank ("Provident"), as  transferor and
                         servicer  (together  with   any  successor  in  such
                         capacity,   the   "Transferor"   and   the   "Master
                         Servicer",   respectively)  and   (           ),  as
                         trustee (the  "Trustee").  The property of the Trust
                         Fund will include:  a pool of (adjustable rate) home
                         equity  revolving credit  line loans  made or  to be
                         made in  the future  (the  "Mortgage Loans"),  under
                         certain  home  equity  revolving  credit  line  loan
                         agreements  (the   "Credit  Line   Agreements")  and


                         secured  by  either  first  or  second mortgages  on
                         residential properties that are one-  to four-family
                         properties   (the   "Mortgaged   Properties");   the
                         collections   in  respect  of   the  Mortgage  Loans
                         received  after  the   Cut-Off  Date  (exclusive  of
                         payments in  respect of  accrued interest due  on or
                         prior to the Cut-Off  Date); property that secured a
                         Mortgage Loan which has been acquired by foreclosure
                         or deed in  lieu of foreclosure; an  irrevocable and
                         unconditional  limited financial  guaranty insurance
                         policy (the  "Policy"); rights under  certain hazard
                         insurance   policies    covering    the    Mortgaged
                         Properties; and certain other property, as described
                         more fully under "Description of  the Certificates--
                         General" herein.
                         The  Trust  Fund property  will  include the  unpaid
                         principal balance of  each Mortgage Loan  as of  the
                         Cut-Off Date (the  "Cut-Off Date Principal Balance")
                         plus  any  additions  thereto  as  a  result of  new
                         advances made pursuant to the applicable Credit Line
                         Agreement  (the  "Additional  Balances")  during the
                         life of the  Trust Fund.  With respect  to any date,
                         the "Pool Balance" will be equal to the aggregate of
                         the Principal Balances  of all Mortgage Loans  as of
                         such  date.   The aggregate  Cut-Off Date  Principal
                         Balance     of     the     Mortgage     Loans     is
                         $____________________  (the   "Cut-Off   Date   Pool
                         Balance").   The "Principal  Balance" of  a Mortgage
                         Loan (other than a  Liquidated Mortgage Loan) on any
                         day is equal to  its Cut-Off Date Principal Balance,
                         plus (i)  any Additional Balances in respect of such
                         Mortgage Loan, minus   (ii) all collections credited
                         against the Principal Balance  of such Mortgage Loan
                         in accordance with the related Credit Line Agreement
                         prior to  such  day.   The  Principal Balance  of  a
                         Liquidated  Mortgage Loan  (as defined  herein under
                         "Description of the  Certificates-- Distributions on
                         the Certificates")  after final recovery  of related
                         Liquidation  Proceeds  (as   defined  herein   under
                         "Description  of  the  Certificates--Allocations and
                         Collections") shall be zero.

Securities Offered       Each   of  the   Home   Equity  Loan   Asset  Backed
                         Certificates,  Series  199_-_  offered  hereby  (the
                         "Certificates") represents an  undivided interest in
                         the  Trust Fund.   Each  Certificate represents  the
                         right  to  receive  payments   of  interest  at  the
                         variable  rate  described  below  (the  "Certificate
                         Rate"),  payable monthly, and  payments of principal
                         at such time and to the extent provided herein under
                         "Description  of the  Certificates--Distributions on
                         the Certificates".  The aggregate undivided interest
                         in the Trust Fund represented by the Certificates as
                         of the  Closing Date will  equal $__________________
                         (the "Original  Invested Amount"),  which represents
                         __% of the Cut-Off Date Pool Balance.  The "Original
                         Certificate    Principal    Balance"   will    equal
                         $__________________.   Following  the  Closing Date,
                         the "Invested Amount" with respect to  any date will
                         be an amount  equal to the Original  Invested Amount
                         minus  (i)   the   amount  of   Investor   Principal
                         Collections  (as  defined  herein  under  "Summary--
                         Collections")     previously      distributed     to
                         Certificateholders, and  minus (ii) an  amount equal
                         to the product  of the Investor  Floating Allocation
                         Percentage and the Liquidation Loss Amounts (each as
                         defined herein  under "Summary--Collections").   The
                         Transferor will own the remaining undivided interest
                         (the  "Transferor Interest") in  the Mortgage Loans,
                         which  is  equal  to  the  Pool  Balance  minus  the
                         Invested  Amount and  will initially  equal approxi-
                         mately  __% of the  Cut-Off Date Pool  Balance.  The
                         Transferor,  as of  any  date is  the  owner of  the
                         Transferor   Interest   which  initially   will   be
                         Provident.

                         The  Certificates will  be  issued  pursuant to  the
                         Agreement.  The principal amount  of the outstanding
                         Certificates  (the "Certificate  Principal Balance")
                         on any  date is  equal to  the Original  Certificate
                         Principal Balance  minus  the aggregate  of  amounts
                         actually   distributed    as   principal    to   the
                         Certificateholders.     See   "Description  of   the
                         Certificates" herein.

Removal of Certain
Mortgage Loans;
Additional Balances      In order to permit the Transferor to remove Mortgage
                         Loans from the Trust Fund  at such times, if any, as
                         the overcollateralization exceeds the level required
                         to maintain the ratings on the  Certificates, on any
                         Distribution Date the Transferor may,  but shall not
                         be obligated to, remove  from the Trust Fund certain
                         Mortgage    Loans    without     notice    to    the
                         Certificateholders.  The Transferor is  permitted to
                         designate   the  Mortgage   Loans  to   be  removed.
                         Mortgage Loans  so designated  will only  be removed
                         upon  satisfaction of  the following  conditions (i)
                         the   Rapid  Amortization  Period   shall  not  have
                         commenced;  (ii) the Transferor  Interest as  of the
                         Transfer Date (as defined herein  under "Description
                         of the Certificates--Optional  Transfers of Mortgage
                         Loans to  the Transferor")  (after giving effect  to
                         such   removal)  exceeds   the  Minimum   Transferor
                         Interest (as  defined below); (iii) the  transfer of
                         any  Mortgage Loans on any  Transfer Date during the
                         Managed Amortization Period (as defined herein under
                         "Summary--Principal    Payments    from    Principal
                         Collections") shall not, in the reasonable belief of
                         the Transferor,  cause a Rapid Amortization Event to
                         occur or an event which with notice or lapse of time
                         or both would constitute a Rapid Amortization Event;
                         (iv)  the  Transferor shall  have  delivered  to the
                         Trustee a "Mortgage Loan Schedule" containing a list
                         of  all Mortgage Loans  remaining in  the Trust Fund
                         after  such   removal;  (v)  the   Transferor  shall
                         represent  and warrant that  no selection procedures
                         which   are  adverse   to  the   interests  of   the
                         Certificateholders or  the Certificate  Insurer were
                         used by the  Transferor in  selecting such  Mortgage
                         Loans;  (vi)  in  connection  with  the  first  such
                         retransfer  of Mortgage  Loans, the  Rating Agencies
                         (as   defined  herein   under  "Summary--Certificate
                         Rating") shall  have been  notified of the  proposed
                         transfer and  prior to  the Transfer Date  shall not
                         have notified  the Transferor  in writing  that such
                         transfer would result  in a reduction or  withdrawal
                         of the ratings assigned to the  Certificates without
                         regard to the Policy; and (vii) the Transferor shall
                         have  delivered to  the Trustee and  the Certificate
                         Insurer  an  officer's  certificate  confirming  the
                         conditions  set forth  in clauses  (i) through  (vi)
                         above.    See  "Description  of  the  Certificates--
                         Optional   Transfers  of   Mortgage  Loans   to  the
                         Transferor" herein.

                         The "Minimum Transferor Interest" as of any date  is
                         an amount equal to the lesser of (a) __% of the Pool
                         Balance on such date and (b) the Transferor Interest
                         as of the Closing Date.

                         During the  term of  the Trust Fund,  all Additional
                         Balances will be transferred to and become  property
                         of the  Trust Fund.   The Pool  Balance at  any time
                         will generally fluctuate from day to day because the
                         amount  of  Additional Balances  and  the amount  of
                         principal  payments  with  respect  to  the Mortgage
                         Loans will usually differ from  day to day.  Because
                         the Transferor Interest is equal to the Pool Balance
                         minus  the  Invested  Amount,  the   amount  of  the
                         Transferor  Interest will fluctuate  from day to day
                         as draws are made with respect to the Mortgage Loans
                         and as Principal Collections are received.

The Mortgage Loans       The Mortgage Loans are  secured by first and  second
                         mortgages  on Mortgaged  Properties  located in  ___
                         states.  

                         The percentage of the Cut-Off Date Principal Balance
                         of   the  Mortgage   Loans   secured  by   Mortgaged
                         Properties  located  in  the  states  of __________,
                         ________, __________,  _______, ______ and  ________
                         is  approximately ____%, ____%,  ____%, ____%, ____%
                         and  ____%, respectively.    The "Combined  Loan-to-
                         Value Ratio" of  each Mortgage Loan is the  ratio of
                         (A) the sum  of (i) the maximum  amount the borrower
                         was permitted  to draw down under the related Credit
                         Line  Agreement (the  "Credit Limit")  and  (ii) the
                         amounts   of  any  related   senior  mortgage  loans
                         (computed as of the date of origination of each such
                         Mortgage  Loan)  to  (B)  the  lesser   of  (i)  the
                         appraised value of the Mortgaged Property or (ii) in
                         the case  of a Mortgaged  Property purchased  within
                         one year of the  origination of the related Mortgage
                         Loan, the purchase price of such Mortgaged Property.
                         As of  the Cut-Off  Date the  Combined Loan-to-Value
                         Ratios ranged from  ____% to ______% and, as  of the
                         Cut-Off Date, the weighted average Combined Loan-to-
                         Value Ratio of the Mortgage Loans  was approximately
                         ____%.

                         (Interest on  each Mortgage Loan is  payable monthly
                         and  computed  on   the  related  daily  outstanding
                         Principal Balance for each day in the billing  cycle
                         at a variable rate per annum (the "Loan Rate") equal
                         at any time (subject to maximum  rates, as described
                         herein  under "Description  of the  Mortgage Loans--
                         Mortgage   Loan  Terms,"  and   further  subject  to
                         applicable usury limitations) to  the sum of (i) the
                         highest prime  rate published  in the  "Money Rates"
                         section of The Wall Street Journal and (ii) a Margin
                         within the range of ____% to ____%).  As of the Cut-
                         Off   Date,   the   weighted  average   Margin   was
                         approximately  ____%.    Loan  Rates   are  adjusted
                         monthly on the  first business  day of the  calendar
                         month preceding the Due Date.   As to each  Mortgage
                         Loan,  the "Due Date" is the (fifteenth) day of each
                         month.  The  Cut-Off Date Principal Balances  ranged
                         from zero to  $__________ and averaged approximately
                         $__________.  Credit Limits under the Mortgage Loans
                         as of  the Cut-Off Date  ranged from  $__________ to
                         $__________ and averaged approximately  $__________.
                         Each Mortgage Loan was originated in the period from
                         _______________, 199_ to ________________, 199_.  As
                         of  the  Cut-Off  Date,  the  maximum  Credit  Limit
                         Utilization    Rate   (as   defined   herein   under
                         "Description  of  the Mortgage  Loans--General") was
                         100%  and   the   weighted  average   Credit   Limit
                         Utilization Rate was approximately ____%.  As of the
                         Cut-Off  Date, approximately  ____% of  Cut-Off Date
                         Principal Balance of  the Mortgage Loans represented
                         first liens  on  the related  Mortgaged  Properties,
                         while  approximately  ____%  of the  Mortgage  Loans
                         represented second liens.   As of the Cut-Off  Date,
                         the Mortgage Loans had remaining terms  to scheduled
                         maturity ranging  from ___ months to  ___ months and
                         had  a weighted average of approximately ___ months.
                         See "Description of the Mortgage Loans" herein.

Denominations            The  Certificates will  be offered  for purchase  in
                         denominations  of  $1,000  and  multiples of  $1  in
                         excess  thereof.   The  interest in  the  Trust Fund
                         evidenced  by   a   Certificate   (the   "Percentage
                         Interest") will be  equal to the  percentage derived
                         by dividing  the denomination of such Certificate by
                         the Original Certificate Principal Balance.

Registration of 
Certificates             The  Certificates will initially  be issued in book-
                         entry form.  Persons acquiring  beneficial ownership
                         interests in the Certificates ("Certificate Owners")
                         may  elect  to  hold  their   Certificate  interests
                         through The Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), in the
                         United  States,  or  Cedel  Bank,  soci t   anonyme,
                         ("CEDEL") or the  Euroclear System ("Euroclear"), in
                         Europe.   Transfers within  DTC, CEDEL or Euroclear,
                         as the case  may be, will be in  accordance with the
                         usual rules and operating procedures of the relevant
                         system.   So long as the Certificates are Book-Entry
                         Certificates (as  defined herein  under "Description
                         of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates"), such
                         Certificates  will  be  evidenced  by  one  or  more
                         Certificates registered in  the name  of Cede &  Co.
                         ("Cede"),  as  the  nominee  of DTC  or  one  of the
                         relevant  depositaries (collectively,  the "European
                         Depositaries").    Cross-market  transfers   between
                         persons holding directly  or indirectly through DTC,
                         on the one hand, and counterparties holding directly
                         or  indirectly  through CEDEL  or Euroclear,  on the
                         other, will be effected in DTC through Citibank N.A.
                         ("Citibank") or The  Chase Manhattan Bank ("Chase"),
                         the relevant  depositaries  of CEDEL  or  Euroclear,
                         respectively,  and each  a  participating member  of
                         DTC.  The Certificates  will initially be registered
                         in  the  name  of  Cede.     The  interests  of  the
                         Certificateholders  will  be  represented  by   book
                         entries on  the  records of  DTC  and  participating
                         members  thereof.    No  Certificate  Owner  will be
                         entitled   to   receive  a   definitive  certificate
                         representing  such person's interest,  except in the
                         event  that  Definitive  Certificates  (as   defined
                         herein under "Description of the Certificates--Book-
                         Entry  Certificates") are  issued under  the limited
                         circumstances  described  under "Description  of the
                         Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates"  herein.  All
                         references  in  this  Prospectus  Supplement  to any
                         Certificates  reflect  the   rights  of  Certificate
                         Owners only as such  rights may be exercised through
                         DTC and its participating  organizations for so long
                         as such  Certificates are  held by  DTC.   See "Risk
                         Factors--Book-Entry  Certificates", "Description  of
                         the  Certificates--Book-Entry  Certificates"  herein
                         and "Annex I" hereto.

Provident                The  Provident  Bank,  an Ohio  banking  corporation
                         headquartered  in Cincinnati,  Ohio.   The principal
                         executive offices of  Provident are  located at  One
                         East Fourth  Street,  Cincinnati, Ohio  45202.   See
                         "Provident" herein.

Collections              All collections on the Mortgage Loans will generally
                         be  allocated in  accordance  with  the Credit  Line
                         Agreements between  amounts collected in  respect of
                         interest   and  amounts  collected   in  respect  of
                         principal.   As to  any Distribution Date, "Interest
                         Collections" will be equal to the amounts  collected
                         during the related  Collection Period, including the
                         portion  of  Net  Liquidation  Proceeds  (as defined
                         below) allocated to  interest pursuant to  the terms
                         of the  Credit Line  Agreements less Servicing  Fees
                         for the related Collection Period.

                         As to any Distribution Date, "Principal Collections"
                         will  be  equal  to  the  sum  of  (i)  the  amounts
                         collected  during  the  related  Collection  Period,
                         including  the portion  of Net  Liquidation Proceeds
                         allocated to principal pursuant to the terms  of the
                         Credit Line Agreements and (ii) any Transfer Deposit
                         Amounts (as defined herein under "Description of the
                         Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates").
 
                         "Net   Liquidation  Proceeds"  with   respect  to  a
                         Mortgage  Loan are  the proceeds  (excluding amounts
                         drawn on the Policy) received in connection with the
                         liquidation  of any  Mortgage Loan,  whether through
                         trustee's  sale,  foreclosure  sale   or  otherwise,
                         reduced by related  expenses, but not including  the
                         portion,  if any,  of such  amount that  exceeds the
                         Principal  Balance of  the  Mortgage Loan  plus  any
                         accrued and  unpaid interest thereon  to the end  of
                         the  Collection Period  during  which such  Mortgage
                         Loan became a Liquidated Mortgage Loan.

                         With respect  to any Distribution  Date, the portion
                         of   Interest    Collections   allocable    to   the
                         Certificates ("Investor Interest Collections")  will
                         equal the  product of  (a) Interest  Collections for
                         such Distribution Date and (b) the Investor Floating
                         Allocation   Percentage.     With  respect   to  any
                         Distribution Date, the "Investor Floating Allocation
                         Percentage"  is  the   percentage  equivalent  of  a
                         fraction determined by dividing the  Invested Amount
                         at   the  close   of  business   on   the  preceding
                         Distribution  Date (or  at the  Closing Date  in the
                         case of  the first  Distribution Date)  by the  Pool
                         Balance at the  beginning of the related  Collection
                         Period.      The   remaining  amount   of   Interest
                         Collections  will  be  allocated  to  the Transferor
                         Interest as more  fully described under "Description
                         of  the  Certificates--Allocations and  Collections"
                         herein.

                         On  each Distribution  Date,  the Investor  Interest
                         Collections  will be applied  in the following order
                         of priority:  (i) as  payment to the Trustee for its
                         fee for services rendered pursuant to the Agreement;
                         (ii)  as  payment for  the  premium for  the Policy;
                         (iii) as  payment for  the accrued interest  due and
                         any overdue accrued interest (with interest thereon)
                         on   the  Certificate   Principal  Balance   of  the
                         Certificates;  (iv) to pay  any Investor Loss Amount
                         (as defined herein under "Summary--Collections") for
                         such Distribution  Date;  (v)  as  payment  for  any
                         Investor Loss  Amount  for a  previous  Distribution
                         Date that was not previously  (a) funded by Investor
                         Interest     Collections     allocable    to     the
                         Certificateholders,    (b)     absorbed    by    the
                         Overcollateralization  Amount  (as  defined   herein
                         under "Summary-Collection"), (c)  funded by  amounts
                         on  deposit in the  Spread Account or  (d) funded by
                         draws  on the Policy; (vi)  to reimburse prior draws
                         made from the Policy  (with interest thereon); (vii)
                         to  pay  principal  on the  Certificates  until  the
                         Invested  Amount  exceeds the  Certificate Principal
                         Balance   by   the  Required   Overcollateralization
                         Amount, each as defined herein under "Description of
                         the Certificates--Distributions on the Certificates"
                         (such amount,  if any, paid pursuant  to this clause
                         (vii) being referred  to herein as  the "Accelerated
                         Principal  Distribution Amount");  (viii)  any other
                         amounts required to  be deposited in an  account for
                         the  benefit   of   the  Certificate   Insurer   and
                         Certificateholders  pursuant  to  the  Agreement  or
                         amounts owed to the Certificate Insurer  pursuant to
                         the Insurance  Agreement; (ix) certain  amounts that
                         may  be required to  be paid to  the Master Servicer
                         pursuant to the Agreement; and (x) to the Transferor
                         to  the   extent   permitted  as   described   under
                         "Description of  the Certificates--Distributions  on
                         the Certificates" herein.

                         Investor  Interest Collections  available after  the
                         payment of  interest  on  the  Certificates  may  be
                         insufficient to cover any Investor Loss Amount.   If
                         such  insufficiency   results  in  the   Certificate
                         Principal  Balance exceeding the  Invested Amount, a
                         draw in an amount equal  to such difference will  be
                         made on the  Policy in accordance with the  terms of
                         the Policy.

                         The  "Overcollateralization Amount"  on any  date of
                         determination is the  amount, if any,  by which  the
                         Invested Amount  exceeds  the Certificate  Principal
                         Balance on such day.  Payments to Certificateholders
                         pursuant to clause (iii) above will be interest pay- 
                         ments on the Certificates.  Payments to Certificate-
                         holders pursuant to clauses (iv), (v) and (vii) will
                         be principal  payments  on the Certificates and will
                         therefore reduce the Certificate  Principal Balance,
                         however, payments pursuant to clause (vii)  will not
                         reduce the Invested Amount. The Accelerated Principal
                         Distribution Amount is  not guaranteed by the Policy.

                         "Liquidation Loss Amount" means  with respect to any
                         Liquidated Mortgage Loan, the unrecovered  Principal
                         Balance thereof at the end of the related Collection
                         Period  in   which  such  Mortgage   Loan  became  a
                         Liquidated Mortgage Loan, after giving effect to the
                         Net  Liquidation Proceeds  in connection  therewith.
                         The "Investor  Loss Amount" shall be  the product of
                         the Investor Floating Allocation Percentage  and the
                         Liquidation Loss Amount  for such Distribution Date.
                         See "Description  of the Certificates--Distributions
                         on the Certificates" herein.

                         Principal Collections will  be allocated between the
                         Certificateholders  and  the  Transferor  ("Investor
                         Principal  Collections"  and  "Transferor  Principal
                         Collections", respectively) in accordance with their
                         percentage  interests in the  Mortgage Loans  of __%
                         and __%,  respectively, as of the  Cut-Off Date (the
                         "Fixed Allocation Percentage"),  but a lesser amount
                         of  Principal  Collections  may  be  distributed  to
                         Certificateholders during  the Managed  Amortization
                         Period,  as described  below.   The "Investor  Fixed
                         Allocation Percentage" shall be __%.

                         The   Master   Servicer   will    deposit   Interest
                         Collections and Principal Collections in  respect of
                         the  Mortgage Loans  in an  account  established for
                         such  purpose under  the Agreement  (the "Collection
                         Account").   See "Description of  the Certificates--
                         Payments  on Mortgage Loans;  Deposits to Collection
                         Account" herein.

Collection Period        As to  any Distribution  Date other  than the  first
                         Distribution  Date, the  "Collection Period"  is the
                         calendar   month  preceding   the   month  of   such
                         Distribution  Date.   As to  the  first Distribution
                         Date,   the  "Collection   Period"  is   the  period
                         beginning after  the Cut-Off Date and  ending on the
                         last day of _____________, 199_.

Interest            Interest on the Certificates will be distributed  monthly
                    on the fifteenth day of each month or, if such day is not
                    a Business  Day, then  the next  succeeding Business  Day
                    (each,   a    "Distribution    Date"),   commencing    on
                    ______________,  199_, at  the Certificate  Rate for  the
                    related  Interest  Period   (as  defined  below).     The
                    "Certificate Rate" for an Interest Period  will generally
                    equal the sum  of ((a) the London Interbank  offered rate
                    for  one-month United  States  dollar deposits  ("LIBOR")
                    appearing  on the Telerate  Screen Page  3750, as  of the
                    second  LIBOR  Business  Day  (as  defined  herein  under
                    "Description  of  the Certificates--Distributions  on the
                    Certificates") prior to  the first  day of such  Interest
                    Period  (or as of  two LIBOR  Business Days prior  to the
                    Closing Date, in the case of the first Interest 

                    Period) and (b) ____%.)   Notwithstanding the  foregoing,
                    in no event  will the amount  of interest required  to be
                    distributed  in  respect  of   the  Certificates  on  any
                    Distribution  Date exceed an  amount derived  from a rate
                    equal  to the weighted average of  the Loan Rates (net of
                    the  Servicing Fee Rate,  the fee payable  to the Trustee
                    and  the  rate  at  which  the  premium  payable  to  the
                    Certificate Insurer  is calculated) weighted on the basis
                    of  the daily balance  of each  Mortgage Loan  during the
                    related  billing cycle  prior  to  the Collection  Period
                    relating  to such  Distribution  Date.   Interest  on the
                    Certificates in  respect  of any  Distribution Date  will
                    accrue from the  preceding Distribution  Date (or in  the
                    case of the first Distribution Date, from the date of the
                    initial issuance of the Certificates (the "Closing Date")
                    through the  day preceding  such Distribution  Date (each
                    such period,  an "Interest Period")  on the basis  of the
                    actual number of days in  the Interest Period and a  360-
                    day year.

                    Interest payments on the Certificates will be funded from
                    Investor Interest  Collections, any  funds on deposit  in
                    the  Spread Account and  from draws  on the Policy.   See
                    "Description of the Certificates" herein.

Principal Payments 
from Principal 
Collections         For the period beginning  on the first Distribution  Date
                    and, unless a Rapid Amortization Event shall have earlier
                    occurred,   ending   on   the   Distribution    Date   in
                    _____________, 200_ (the "Managed  Amortization Period"),
                    the   amount   of   Principal   Collections   payable  to
                    Certificateholders  as of  each Distribution  Date during
                    the Managed Amortization Period will equal, to the extent
                    funds  are available  therefor,  the Scheduled  Principal
                    Collections  Distribution  Amount  for such  Distribution
                    Date.    On  any  Distribution  Date during  the  Managed
                    Amortization Period, the "Scheduled Principal Collections
                    Distribution Amount"  shall equal  the lesser of  (i) the
                    Maximum Principal Payment (as defined below) and (ii) the
                    Alternative Principal  Payment (as defined  below).  With
                    respect  to any Distribution Date, the "Maximum Principal
                    Payment" will  equal the  product of  the Investor  Fixed
                    Allocation Percentage and Principal Collections  for such
                    Distribution  Date.   With  respect  to any  Distribution
                    Date, the "Alternative Principal Payment"  will equal the
                    greater of (x) ____% of the Certificate Principal Balance
                    immediately prior to such  Distribution Date and (y)  the
                    amount,  but not less than zero, of Principal Collections
                    for  such   Distribution  Date  less   the  aggregate  of
                    Additional Balances created during the related Collection
                    Period.

                    Beginning with the first  Distribution Date following the
                    end  of the  Managed Amortization  Period, the  amount of
                    Principal  Collections payable  to Certificateholders  on
                    each  Distribution  Date  will be  equal  to  the Maximum
                    Principal Payment.  See "Description of the Certificates-
                    -Distributions on the Certificates" herein.

                    In addition, to  the extent funds are  available therefor
                    (including  funds  available under  the  Policy),  on the
                    Distribution     Date     in     _____________,     20__,
                    Certificateholders will be entitled to receive as payment
                    of   principal  an   amount  equal  to   the  outstanding
                    Certificate Principal Balance.

                    Distributions of  Principal  Collections based  upon  the
                    Investor  Fixed  Allocation   Percentage  may  result  in
                    distributions  of  principal  to  Certificateholders   in
                    amounts that  are greater relative to  the declining Pool
                    Balance than would be the  case if the Investor  Floating
                    Allocation   Percentage  were   used  to   determine  the
                    percentage  of   Principal  Collections   distributed  in
                    respect   of  the   Invested  Amount.     The   aggregate
                    distributions of principal to Certificateholders will not
                    exceed the Original Certificate Principal Balance.

The Certificate 
Insurer             (Insurer) (the "Certificate Insurer")  is a              
                    insurance company engaged exclusively  in the business of
                    writing  financial  guaranty  insurance,  principally  in
                    respect  of  securities offered  in domestic  and foreign
                    markets.  The Certificate Insurer's claims-paying ability
                    is rated ______ by ______________________________________
                    and  _____  by ____________________________________.  See
                    "The Certificate Insurer" in this Prospectus Supplement.

Policy              On or before the Closing Date, the  Policy will be issued
                    by the Certificate Insurer pursuant to the  provisions of
                    the Insurance  and  Indemnity Agreement  (the  "Insurance
                    Agreement") to be dated as  of _____________, 199_, among
                    Provident(, the Trustee) and the Certificate Insurer.

                    The Policy will irrevocably and unconditionally guarantee
                    payment  on each Distribution Date to the Trustee for the
                    benefit  of the Certificateholders  of (i) the Guaranteed
                    Principal  Distribution Amount  (as  defined below)  with
                    respect  to the  Certificates for such  Distribution Date
                    and  (ii)  accrued   and  unpaid  interest  due   on  the
                    Certificates (together,  the "Guaranteed Distributions"),
                    with such Guaranteed Distributions having been calculated
                    in accordance with the original terms of the Certificates
                    or  the Agreement except  for amendments or modifications
                    to which  the Certificate  Insurer  has given  its  prior
                    written  consent.    The  effect  of  the  Policy  is  to
                    guarantee the  timely  payment of  interest  on, and  the
                    ultimate payment of  the principal amount of, all  of the
                    Certificates.

                    The  "Guaranteed Principal  Distribution Amount"  for any
                    Distribution  Date shall  be  the  amount  by  which  the
                    Certificate Principal Balance (after giving effect to all
                    other amounts distributable and allocable to principal on
                    the Certificates  on such Distribution Date)  exceeds the
                    Invested Amount for such Distribution Date.  In addition,
                    the Policy will guarantee  the payment of the outstanding
                    Certificate Principal Balance on the Distribution Date in
                    ____________,  20__ (after  giving  effect to  all  other
                    amounts distributable and allocable to principal  on such
                    Distribution Date).

                    (In  accordance with the  Agreement, the  Trustee will be
                    required  to  establish  and  maintain  an  account  (the
                    "Spread  Account") for  the  benefit  of the  Certificate
                    Insurer and the Certificateholders.   As specified in the
                    Agreement,  the Certificate Insurer  will be  entitled to
                    reimbursement from funds on deposit in the Spread Account
                    of  certain amounts previously  paid by it.   Further, as
                    specified in the Agreement, the Trustee will use funds on
                    deposit  in the Spread  Account to  make distributions to
                    the Certificateholders  prior to  making a  claim on  the
                    Policy.  The  Trustee shall deposit the  amounts into the
                    Spread Account as required by the Agreement.)

                    In  the   absence   of   payments   under   the   Policy,
                    Certificateholders  will  directly  bear  the  credit and
                    other risks  associated with their undivided  interest in
                    the Trust Fund.   See "Description of the  Certificates--
                    The Policy" herein.

Overcollateralization
Amount              The  distribution of  Accelerated  Principal Distribution
                    Amounts,  if any, to Certificateholders may result in the
                    Invested  Amount  being  greater  than   the  Certificate
                    Principal      Balance,     thereby      creating     the
                    Overcollateralization Amount.  The  Overcollateralization
                    Amount, if any, will be  available to absorb any Investor
                    Loss Amount not covered by Investor Interest Collections.
                    Payments  of Accelerated  Principal Distribution  Amounts
                    are not covered by the Policy.  Any Investor Loss Amounts
                    not  covered by  such  overcollateralization, amounts  on
                    deposit  in  the  Spread  Account  or  Investor  Interest
                    Collections will be covered by draws on the Policy to the
                    extent provided therein.

(Pre-Funding 
Account             On  the   Closing  Date,  $__________   (the  "Pre-Funded
                    Amount") will  be  deposited  in an  account  (the  "Pre-
                    Funding Account"), which account shall  be in the name of
                    and  maintained by the  Trustee and shall  be part of the
                    Trust  Fund  and  will  be  used  to  acquire  Subsequent
                    Mortgage Loans.    During  the period  beginning  on  the
                    Closing Date and  terminating on ____________,  19__ (the
                    "Funding   Period"),  the   Pre-Funded  Amount   will  be
                    maintained in  the Pre-Funding  Account.   The Pre-Funded
                    Amount will be reduced during  the Funding Period by  the
                    amount thereof used to purchase Subsequent Mortgage Loans
                    in accordance with the Agreement.  Any Pre-Funded  Amount
                    remaining  at  the  end  of the  Funding  Period  will be
                    distributed to  holders of  the  classes of  Certificates
                    entitled to receive principal on the Distribution Date in
                    ________  19__ in  reduction of  the related  Certificate
                    Principal Balances, thus resulting in a partial principal
                    prepayment of the related Certificates on such date.

Capitalized Interest 
Account             On the Closing Date there will be deposited in an account
                    (the "Capitalized Interest Account") maintained  with and
                    in the name of the Trustee on behalf of the Trust  Fund a
                    portion of the proceeds of  the sale of the Certificates.
                    The amount deposited therein will be used  by the Trustee
                    on the Distribution Dates in __________ 19__, __________,
                    19__  and __________ 19__ to cover shortfalls in interest
                    on  the Certificates  that may arise  as a  result of the
                    utilization of the Pre-Funding  Account for the  purchase
                    by the Trust Fund of  Subsequent Mortgage Loans after the
                    Closing Date.   Any amounts remaining in  the Capitalized
                    Interest Account  at the  end of the  Funding Period  are
                    required to be paid directly to Provident.)

Record Date         The last  day preceding  a Distribution Date  or, if  the
                    Certificates  are no longer  Book-Entry Certificates, the
                    last day of the month preceding a Distribution Date.

Servicing           The Master  Servicer will  be responsible  for servicing,
                    managing and  making collections  on the  Mortgage Loans.
                    The  Master  Servicer  will  deposit all  collections  in
                    respect of the Mortgage Loans into the Collection Account
                    as  described under  "Description  of the  Certificates--
                    Payments  on  Mortgage  Loans;  Deposits   to  Collection
                    Account" herein.  On the third Business Day prior to each
                    Distribution Date (the "Determination Date"),  the Master
                    Servicer  will   calculate,  and  instruct   the  Trustee
                    regarding the amounts available  to be paid, as described
                    under  "Description  of  the   Certificates--Payments  on
                    Mortgage  Loans; Deposits to  Collection Account" herein,
                    to the Certificateholders on such Distribution Date.  See
                    "Description  of the  Certificates--Distributions on  the
                    Certificates" herein.   With  respect to  each Collection
                    Period, the Master Servicer will receive from collections
                    in respect of interest on  the Mortgage Loans, on  behalf
                    of itself,  a portion  of such collections  as a  monthly
                    servicing  fee (the  "Servicing  Fee") in  the amount  of
                    approximately  ____% per annum (the "Servicing Fee Rate")
                    on the aggregate Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans
                    as of the first day of each such Collection Period.   See
                    "Description of  the Certificates--Servicing Compensation
                    and Payment  of  Expenses" herein.    In certain  limited
                    circumstances,  the  Master  Servicer  may  resign or  be
                    removed,  in which event  either the Trustee  or a third-
                    party servicer  will be  appointed as a  successor Master
                    Servicer.  See "Description of  the Certificates--Certain
                    Matters Regarding the Master Servicer and the Transferor"
                    herein.

Final Payment of
Principal; 
Termination         The Trust  Fund will  terminate on the  Distribution Date
                    following the later of (A) payment in full of all amounts
                    owing  to the Certificate Insurer and (B) the earliest of
                    (i)  the  Distribution  Date  on  which  the  Certificate
                    Principal Balance  has been  reduced  to zero,  (ii)  the
                    final  payment or other liquidation  of the last Mortgage
                    Loan in the Trust Fund,  (iii) the optional retransfer to
                    the  Transferor of  the Certificates, as  described below
                    and (iv) the Distribution  Date in ______________,  20__.
                    The Certificates  will be subject to  optional retransfer
                    to  the  Transferor on  any Distribution  Date  after the
                    Certificate  Principal  Balance is  reduced to  an amount
                    less  than  or equal  to  $________________  (__% of  the
                    Original Certificate  Principal Balance) and  all amounts
                    due and owing to the Certificate Insurer and unreimbursed
                    draws on the  Policy, together with interest  thereon, as
                    provided under  the Insurance Agreement, have  been paid.
                    The retransfer  price will  be equal  to the  sum of  the
                    outstanding Certificate Principal Balance and accrued and
                    unpaid  interest thereon at  the Certificate Rate through
                    the  day  preceding the  final  Distribution  Date.   See
                    "Description of The Certificates--Termination; Retirement
                    of   the  Certificates"  herein   and  "The  Agreements--
                    Termination; Optional Termination" in the Prospectus.
                    In addition, the Trust Fund may be liquidated as a result
                    of   certain   events   of   bankruptcy,   insolvency  or
                    receivership   relating   to   the   Transferor.      See
                    "Description  of   the  Certificates--Rapid  Amortization
                    Events" herein.

Trustee             (                       ), a ____________________________
                    (the  "Trustee") will  act as  Trustee  on behalf  of the
                    Certificateholders.

Mandatory Retransfer of
Certain Mortgage 
Loans               Provident   will   make   certain   representations   and
                    warranties in the Agreement with respect  to the Mortgage
                    Loans.      If   Provident  breaches   certain   of   its
                    representations  and  warranties  with  respect   to  any
                    Mortgage Loan and  such breach  materially and  adversely
                    affects  the interests of  the Certificateholders  or the
                    Certificate Insurer and is not cured within the specified
                    period,  the Mortgage Loan will be removed from the Trust
                    Fund upon the  expiration of a specified  period from the
                    date on which Provident becomes aware  or receives notice
                    of  such breach and will be reassigned to the Transferor.
                    For an explanation of the compensation paid in respect of
                    such retransferred Mortgage Loan, see "Description of the
                    Certificates--Assignment of Mortgage Loans" herein.

Federal Income Tax
Consequences        Subject  to  the  qualifications set  forth  in  "Federal
                    Income Tax Consequences" herein, Brown & Wood LLP special
                    tax  counsel to Provident  is of the  opinion that, under
                    existing law,  a Certificate  will be treated  as a  debt
                    instrument  for federal  income  tax purposes  as of  the
                    Closing Date.    Under  the  Agreement,  the  Transferor,
                    Provident and  the Certificateholders will agree to treat
                    the Certificates  as indebtedness for federal  income tax
                    purposes.   Furthermore,  Brown  & Wood  LLP  special tax
                    counsel to  Provident is  of the opinion  that the  Trust
                    Fund will  not be treated  as either an  association or a
                    publicly traded  partnership taxable as  a corporation or
                    as  a taxable  mortgage pool.    See "Federal  Income Tax
                    Consequences" herein and in the Prospectus for additional
                    information concerning the  application of federal income
                    tax laws.

ERISA 
Considerations      The  acquisition of a  Certificate by a  pension or other
                    employee benefit plan (a  "Plan") subject to the Employee
                    Retirement  Income  Security  Act  of  1974,  as  amended
                    ("ERISA"),  could,   in  some  instances,  result   in  a
                    "prohibited  transaction"  or   other  violation  of  the
                    fiduciary responsibility  provisions  of ERISA  and  Code
                    Section 4975.    Certain exemptions  from the  prohibited
                    transaction rules could be applicable to the  acquisition
                    of  the  Certificates.   Any  Plan fiduciary  considering
                    whether to purchase  any Certificate on behalf of  a Plan
                    should   consult   with   its   counsel   regarding   the
                    applicability of  the provisions of  ERISA and the  Code.
                    See "ERISA Considerations" herein and in the Prospectus.

Legal Investment
Considerations      The  Certificates will  not constitute  "mortgage related
                    securities" for purposes of the Secondary Mortgage Market
                    Enhancement Act of 1984 ("SMMEA"), because not all of the
                    Mortgages   securing  the   Mortgage   Loans  are   first
                    mortgages.   Accordingly,  many institutions  with  legal
                    authority to invest in comparably rated  securities based
                    solely on  first mortgages may not  be legally authorized
                    to invest  in the  Certificates.   See "Legal  Investment
                    Considerations"  herein  and  "Legal  Investment"  in the
                    Prospectus.

Certificate Rating  It  is a condition  to the  issuance of  the Certificates
                    that they be  rated "___" by _____ and "___" by _________
                    (each  a "Rating Agency").   In general,  ratings address
                    credit  risk  and  do  not  address  the  likelihood   of
                    prepayments.   See "Ratings"  herein and "Risk  Factors--
                    Rating of the Securities" in the Prospectus.

Risk Factors        For  a discussion  of  certain risks  associated with  an
                    investment in  the  Certificates, see  "Risk Factors"  on
                    Page S-16 herein and on page 12 in the Prospectus.



                                 RISK FACTORS

     Investors should  consider the  following risks in  connection with  the
purchase of Certificates.

     Risk  of Reduced  Liquidity Because  of Owning  Book-Entry Certificates.
Issuance of the  Certificates in book-entry form may reduce  the liquidity of
such Certificates  in the  secondary trading  market since  investors may  be
unwilling  to purchase  Certificates for  which  they cannot  obtain physical
certificates.  See "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates"
herein and "Risk Factors-Book-Entry Registration" in the Prospectus.

     Since transactions in the Certificates can be effected only through DTC,
CEDEL,  Euroclear,  participating  organizations, indirect  participants  and
certain banks, the ability of a Certificate Owner  to pledge a Certificate to
persons or entities  that do not participate  in the DTC, CEDEL  or Euroclear
system may  be limited due to lack of a physical certificate representing the
Certificates.  See "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates"
herein and "Risk Factors-Book-Entry Registration" in the Prospectus.

     Payment   Delay  as   a  Result   of  Owning   Book-Entry  Certificates.
Certificate  Owners   may  experience   some  delay   in  their   receipt  of
distributions  of  interest  and  principal on  the  Certificates  since such
distributions  will be forwarded  by the Trustee  to DTC and  DTC will credit
such  distributions to  the accounts of  its Participants  (as defined herein
under "Description of the  Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates") which will
thereafter credit them to the  accounts of Certificate Owners either directly
or indirectly through indirect participants.  Certificate Owners  will not be
recognized as Certificateholders  as such term is used in  the Agreement, and
Certificate  Owners   will   be  permitted   to   exercise  the   rights   of
Certificateholders only  indirectly through  DTC and  its Participants.   See
"Description of  the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates" herein  and "Risk
Factors--Book-Entry Registration" in the Prospectus.

     Cash Flow  Considerations  and Risks  of  Shortfalls.   Minimum  monthly
payments  on the Mortgage  Loans will at  least equal and  may exceed accrued
interest.   Even  assuming  that the  Mortgaged  Properties provide  adequate
security  for the Mortgage Loans, substantial  delays could be encountered in
connection with the  liquidation of  Mortgage Loans that  are delinquent  and
resulting  shortfalls in distributions  to Certificateholders could  occur if
the Certificate Insurer were unable  to perform on its obligations  under the
Policy.   Further,  liquidation expenses  (such  as legal  fees, real  estate
taxes, and  maintenance and preservation  expenses) will reduce  the proceeds
payable  to  Certificateholders  and  thereby  reduce  the security  for  the
Mortgage Loans.  In the event any of the Mortgaged Properties fail to provide
adequate security  for the  related Mortgage Loans,  Certificateholders could
experience  a loss  if the  Certificate  Insurer were  unable to  perform its
obligations under the Policy.

     Prepayment Considerations and Effect on  Yield to Maturity and  Weighted
Average Life of Certificates.  Substantially all of the Mortgage Loans may be
prepaid in whole or in part at any time without penalty.   Home equity loans,
such  as the Mortgage Loans, have  been originated in significant volume only
during  the  past few  years  and  Provident is  not  aware  of any  publicly
available  studies or  statistics on  the rate of  prepayment of  such loans.
Generally,  home  equity  loans  are not  viewed  by  borrowers  as permanent
financing.   Accordingly, the Mortgage Loans may  experience a higher rate of
prepayment than  traditional loans.   The Trust Fund's  prepayment experience
may be affected  by a  wide variety  of factors,  including general  economic
conditions, interest  rates, the  availability of  alternative financing  and
homeowner  mobility.  In  addition, substantially  all of the  Mortgage Loans
contain  due-on-sale provisions and  the Master  Servicer intends  to enforce
such provisions unless  (i) such enforcement is  not permitted by  applicable
law  or (ii)  the  Master Servicer,  in a  manner consistent  with reasonable
commercial practice, permits the purchaser of the  related Mortgaged Property
to assume the Mortgage Loan.  To the extent permitted by applicable law, such
assumption will not  release the original borrower from  its obligation under
any such Mortgage  Loan.   See "Description of  the Certificates" herein  and
"Certain Legal Aspects of Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses" in the Prospectus for a
description  of certain  provisions of  the Credit  Line Agreements  that may
affect  the  prepayment experience  on  the  Mortgage Loans.    The yield  to


maturity  and weighted  average life  of  the Certificates  will be  affected
primarily by the rate  and timing of prepayments on the Mortgage  Loans.  Any
reinvestment risks resulting from a faster or slower incidence of  prepayment
of Mortgage  Loans will  be borne entirely  by the  Certificateholders.   See
"Maturity and  Prepayment Considerations"  herein and  "Yield and  Prepayment
Considerations" in the Prospectus.

     Certificate Rating  Based  Primarily  on Claims-Paying  Ability  of  the
Certificate Insurer.  The rating of the Certificates will depend primarily on
an  assessment by  the Rating  Agencies of  the Mortgage  Loans and  upon the
claims-paying ability of the Certificate Insurer.   Any reduction in a rating
assigned to the claims-paying ability of 

the Certificate Insurer  below the rating initially given to the Certificates
may result in a reduction in  the rating of the Certificates.  The  rating by
the Rating Agencies of the Certificates is  not a recommendation to purchase,
hold or sell the Certificates, inasmuch as such rating does not comment as to
the  market price  or suitability  for a  particular investor.   There  is no
assurance that the ratings will  remain in place for any given period of time
or that the ratings will not be  lowered or withdrawn by the Rating Agencies.
In general, the ratings address credit risk and do not address the likelihood
of  prepayments.    The  ratings  of the  Certificates  do  not  address  the
possibility of the  imposition of United States withholding  tax with respect
to non-U.S. persons.

     Legal  Considerations   --  Lien   Priority   and  Possible   Delay   in
Distributions or Losses.  The Mortgage Loans  are secured by mortgages (which
generally are  second mortgages).   With respect  to Mortgage Loans  that are
secured by  first mortgages, the Master Servicer  has the power under certain
circumstances to  consent to a  new mortgage  lien on the  Mortgaged Property
having priority  over such Mortgage Loan.   Therefore, there  is generally no
limit on the principal amount  of prior liens that can be placed ahead of the
Mortgage Loans.   Mortgage Loans secured by second mortgages  are entitled to
proceeds  that remain from the  sale of the  related Mortgaged Property after
any  related  senior  mortgage  loan  and  prior statutory  liens  have  been
satisfied.  If such proceeds are insufficient to satisfy such loans and prior
liens in  the aggregate and the Certificate Insurer  is unable to perform its
obligations under  the Policy, the  Certificateholders will bear the  risk of
delay in  distributions while a  deficiency judgment against  the borrower is
obtained and the risk of  loss if the deficiency judgment cannot  be obtained
or is insufficient to satisfy the Mortgage Loan.  See "Certain  Legal Aspects
of the Loans" in the Prospectus.

     Bankruptcy and Insolvency Risks.  Provident and the Trust will treat the
transfer of  the Mortgage Loans  from Provident to  the Trust  as a sale  for
accounting purposes.  However, in  the event of the insolvency of  Provident,
it  is possible  that a  receiver or  conservator (or  similar  official) for
Provident, may attempt to recharacterize the sale of  the Mortgage Loans as a
borrowing by  Provident, secured by a pledge of  the Mortgage Loans.  Certain
provisions of the  Federal Deposit Insurance Act  (state law) may  permit the
FDIC or state  regulator to avoid such security interest.   This position, if
argued or accepted by a  court, could prevent timely payments of  amounts due
on  the  Certificates  and result  in  a  reduction of  payments  due  on the
Certificates.  Provident will, however, mark its records to indicate that the
Mortgage Loans have been sold to the Trust Fund.

     In the  event of a bankruptcy or insolvency  of the Master Servicer, the
bankruptcy trustee or receiver may  have the power to prevent the  Trustee or
the  Certificateholders from appointing a successor  Master Servicer.  In the
event of the insolvency  of the Master Servicer  and if cash collections  are
commingled with the  Master Servicer's own funds  for at least ten  days, the
Trust  Fund will  likely not have  a perfected  interest in  such collections
since such collections would not have  been deposited in a segregated account
within ten  days after the collection  thereof, and the  inclusion thereof in
the bankruptcy estate of the Master Servicer may result in delays  in payment
and failure to pay amounts due on the Certificates.

     In addition,  federal  and  state statutory  provisions,  including  the
federal  bankruptcy laws  and  state laws  affording relief  to  debtors, may
interfere with  or  affect the  ability  of the  secured  mortgage lender  to
realize upon  its security.  For  example, in a proceeding  under the federal
Bankruptcy Code, a lender may not  foreclose on a mortgaged property  without
the  permission of the bankruptcy court.  The rehabilitation plan proposed by
the debtor  may  provide, if  the  mortgaged  property is  not  the  debtor's
principal residence and the  court determines that the value of the mortgaged
property is less than  the principal balance of  the mortgage loan, that  the
secured indebtedness be reduced to the value of the mortgaged property  as of
the  date of  the commencement  of  the bankruptcy,  rendering  the lender  a
general  unsecured  creditor for  the  difference, and  also  may reduce  the
monthly payments  due under such mortgage  loan, change the rate  of interest
and alter  the mortgage  loan repayment  schedule.   The effect  of any  such
proceedings under the federal  Bankruptcy Code, including but not  limited to
any  automatic stay,  could result  in delays  in receiving  payments on  the
Mortgage Loans and reductions in the aggregate amount of such payments.

     (Risk of Losses as a Result of Geographic Concentration.  As of the Cut-
Off Date, approximately  _____% (by  Cut-Off Date Principal  Balance) of  the
Mortgaged Properties are  located in  the State  of __________.   An  overall
decline  in the  __________ residential  real estate  market could  adversely
affect the  values of the  Mortgaged Properties securing such  Mortgage Loans
such that the Principal Balances of the related Mortgage Loans, together with
any primary financing on such Mortgaged Properties, could equal or exceed the
value of such Mortgaged Properties.  As the residential real estate market is
influenced  by many factors,  including the general  condition of the economy
and  interest  rates,  no  assurances  may  be  given  that  the   __________
residential  real  estate   market  will  not  weaken.    If  the  __________
residential  real  estate market  should  experience  an  overall decline  in
property values after  the dates of origination of the  Mortgage  Loans,  the 
rates of losses on the  Mortgage  Loans  would  be  expected  to  increase,  
and could  increase substantially.)

     Master  Servicer's Ability to  Change the  Terms of the  Mortgage Loans.
The  Master Servicer  may agree  to changes  in the  terms of  a Credit  Line
Agreement, provided  that  such  changes  (i) do  not  adversely  affect  the
interest of the Certificateholders  or the Certificate Insurer, and  (ii) are
consistent with prudent business  practice.  There can  be no assurance  that
changes in applicable law or the marketplace for home equity loans or prudent
business  practice will not  result in changes  in the terms  of the Mortgage
Loans.   In  addition,  the Agreement  permits  the  Master Servicer,  within
certain  limitations described therein, to  increase the Credit  Limit of the
related  Mortgage Loan or reduce the Margin for such Mortgage Loan.  Any such
increase in  the Credit Line of  a Mortgage Loan would  increase the Loan-to-
Value  Ratio of such Mortgage Loan  and, accordingly, would increase the risk
of  the Trust  Fund's investment  in such  Mortgage Loan.   In  addition, any
reduction in the Margin of  a Mortgage Loan would reduce the excess cash flow
available to absorb losses.

     Delinquent Mortgage Loans.   The Trust Fund will  include Mortgage Loans
which are 89 or  fewer days delinquent as  of the Cut-Off Date.   The Cut-Off
Date  Principal Balance of  Mortgage Loans which  are between 30  days and 89
days delinquent as of the Cut-Off  Date was $_________________.  If there are
not  sufficient funds  from the  Investor Interest  Collections to  cover the
Investor Loss Amounts  for any  Distribution Date, the  Overcollateralization
Amount and the amount  on deposit in the Spread Account have  been reduced to
zero, and the Certificate Insurer fails  to perform its obligations under the
Policy, the aggregate amount of  principal returned to the Certificateholders
may  be  less  than  the  Certificate  Principal  Balance   on  the  day  the
Certificates are issued.

     (Risk of Prepayment  Due to Subsequent Mortgage  Loans.  The ability  of
the  Trust to  purchase mortgage  loans  after the  date  of this  Prospectus
Supplement and  on or prior to ____________,  19__ that meet the requirements
for transfer during  the Funding Period under the Agreement  is affected by a
variety of factors,  including interest rates, unemployment levels,  the rate
of inflation and  consumer perception of  economic conditions generally.   On
the Distribution Date  in ____________ 19__,  a principal prepayment  will be
made to  the holders of the  Certificates in the amount  which represents the
excess  of the original  Pre-Funded Amount over the  Principal Balance of all
Subsequent  Mortgage Loans as of the related  Cut-Off Date (i.e., the balance
on  deposit  in  the Pre-Funding  Account  on such  date  (net  of investment
earnings)).  Although no  assurances can be given, Provident intends  that no
material principal prepayment will be  required to be made to the  holders of
the  Certificates  on  the  Distribution  Date in  ____________  19__.    Any
reinvestment  risk resulting from  such prepayment will  be borne entirely by
the Certificateholders.)

     For a discussion of additional risks pertaining to the Certificates, see
"Risk Factors" in the Prospectus.


                           THE CERTIFICATE INSURER

     The following information set forth in this section has been provided by
the Certificate  Insurer.   Accordingly,  neither  Provident nor  the  Master
Servicer makes any representation as to the accuracy and completeness of such
information.
                     (Description of Certificate Insurer)


                             THE MASTER SERVICER

GENERAL

     The Master Servicer  will service the Mortgage Loans  in accordance with
the terms set forth in the Agreement.  The Master Servicer may perform any of
its  obligations under the Agreement through one  or more subservicers.  Not-
withstanding any  such subservicing  arrangement,  the Master  Servicer  will
remain liable for its servicing duties and obligations under the Agreement as
if the Master Servicer alone were servicing the Mortgage Loans.



THE MASTER SERVICER

     Provident  will be responsible for servicing  the Mortgage Loans for the
Trust  in  accordance  with  the  terms  of  the Agreement.    (Beginning  on
__________, _____________ (the "Subservicer") will service the Mortgage Loans
for  Provident  pursuant  to a  Subservicing  Agreement, to  be  dated  as of
(______________),  between Provident  and  the Subservicer.    The terms  and
conditions  of the  Subservicing  Agreement are  consistent with  and  do not
violate the provisions of the Agreement.  Such subservicing does  not relieve
Provident  from any  of  its  obligations to  service  the  Mortgage Loan  in
accordance with the terms and conditions of the Agreement.)

     Provident is  the  principal banking  subsidiary  of Provident  Bancorp,
Inc., a  Cincinnati-based  bank holding  company  registered under  the  Bank
Holding Company  Act.   Provident  Bancorp,  Inc. operates  throughout  Ohio,
Northern Kentucky,  Southeastern Indiana  and Florida.   As  of ____________,
Provident Bancorp, Inc. had total assets of $____  billion, net loans of $___
billion, deposits  of $____ billion  and total shareholders'  equity of $____
million.   Provident Bancorp's tier 1 and total capital ratios were ____% and
_____%, respectively.  For the  (___) months ended ______________,  Provident
Bancorp had net earnings of $____  million.  As of _______________, Provident
Bancorp  had total  assets  of  $____ billion,  net  loans of  $___  billion,
deposits  of $___  billion and  total shareholders'  equity of  $___ million.
Provident Bancorp's  tier I and  total capital  ratios were ____%  and ____%,
respectively.    For the  fiscal  year  ended  __________________,  Provident
Bancorp,  Inc.  had  net  earnings of  $___  million.    Provident represents
approximately 96% of Provident Bancorp, Inc.'s assets.


                         THE HOME EQUITY LOAN PROGRAM

CREDIT AND UNDERWRITING GUIDELINES

     The   following  is  a   description  of  the   underwriting  guidelines
customarily  employed by  Provident with respect  to Mortgage  Loans which it
purchases or  originates.  Each Mortgage  Loan was underwritten  according to
these guidelines.  Provident believes its standards are consistent with those
utilized  by home  equity  lenders generally.   The  underwriting  process is
intended to assess  both the prospective borrower's ability  to repay and the
adequacy of the  real property security as  collateral for the loan  granted.
In certain  cases, loans  may be made  outside of  those guidelines  with the
prior approval of an underwriting manager of Provident.

     Provident  generally originates  or purchases  loans which  either fully
amortize over  a period not to exceed 360  months or provide for amortization
over a 360 month schedule  with a "balloon" payment required at  the maturity
date, which will not be less than  fifteen years after origination.  The loan
amounts generally range from  a minimum of $10,000  to a maximum of  $500,000
unless  a higher  amount is  specifically approved  by  a senior  official of
Provident.  Provident  primarily originates or  purchases non-purchase  money
first or  second mortgage loans  although Provident also  originates purchase
money first mortgage loans.

     The homes  used for collateral to secure the loans may be either primary
residential (which includes second and vacation homes) or investor owned one-
to  four-family  homes,  condominiums,  townhouses  or  manufactured housing.
Generally, each home  must have a minimum appraised value as described below.
Mobile housing  or agricultural land are not accepted as collateral.  In some
cases,  the  loan  may  be  secured  by  the  owner-occupied  residence  plus
additional real estate collateral.

     Each property proposed as security for a loan must be appraised not more
than six months prior to the  date of such loan.  The  combined loan-to-value
ratio  of the first and second mortgages generally  may not exceed 85%.  If a
prior  mortgage exists, Provident  first reviews the  first mortgage history.
If it  contains open-end,  advance or  negative amortization  provisions, the
maximum potential  first mortgage balance is used in calculating the combined
loan-to-value ratio which determines the maximum loan amount.

     For Provident's full documentation process, each mortgage applicant must
provide,  and Provident  must verify,  personal  financial information.   The
applicant's total  monthly obligations (which includes principal and interest
on each mortgage, tax assessments, other loans, charge accounts and all other
scheduled  indebtedness) generally cannot exceed 60% of the applicant's gross
monthly income.  Applicants  who are salaried employees must  provide current
employment information in addition to two recent years of  employment history
and Provident  verifies this information.  Verifications are based on written
confirmation from employers or a combination of the two most recent pay stubs,
the  two most  recent years'  W-2 tax forms  and telephone  confirmation from   
the  employer.   Self-employed applicants must be self-employed in  the  same  
field  for  a  minimum  of  two  years.   The  self-employed  applicant  must 
provide  signed  copies  of  complete  federal  income tax returns (including 
schedules) filed for the most recent two years.

     For Provident's non-income  verifier program, proof of one  year history
of employment plus proof  of current self-employed status  is required.   The
applicant's debt-to-income ratio is calculated  based on income as  certified
by the  borrower on  the application  and must  be reasonable.   The  maximum
Combined Loan-to-Value ratio may  not exceed 80% for the  non-income verifier
program.

     A credit report by  an independent credit  reporting agency is  required
reflecting the applicant's complete credit history.  The credit report should
reflect all  delinquencies  of 30  days  or more,  repossessions,  judgments,
foreclosures, garnishments, bankruptcies, divorce actions and similar adverse
credit practices that can  be discovered by a  search of public records.   If
the report  is obtained  more than  60 days  prior to  the loan closing,  the
lender must determine that the reponed information has not changed.   Written
verification is obtained of any first mortgage balance if not reported in the
credit bureau.

     Generally, the applicant should have an acceptable  credit history given
the amount of  equity available, the strength  of the applicant's  employment
history  and the level  of the applicant's  income to debt  obligations.  The
rescission period (generally, a period of three days) must have expired prior
to funding a loan.  The rescission period may not be waived  by the applicant
except as  permitted by law.   Either  an ALTA title  insurance policy  or an
attorney's opinion of title is required for all loans.

     The  applicant is  required to  secure property  insurance in  an amount
sufficient to cover the new loan  and any prior mortgage.  If the sum  of the
outstanding  first  mortgage,  if  any,  and the  home  equity  loan  exceeds
replacement  value, insurance  equal to  replacement value  may be  accepted.
Provident must  ensure that  its name  and address is  properly added  to the
"Mortgage Clause" of the insurance policy.  In  the event Provident's name is
added to a "Loss  Payee Clause" and the  policy does not provide for  written
notice  of  policy  changes  or  cancellation,  an  endorsement  adding  such
provision is required.

     Provident's  credit  underwriting  guidelines  require  that  any  major
deferred maintenance on any property  must bc cured from the proceeds  of the
loan.

SERVICING OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Master Servicer has established standard policies  for the servicing
and  collection of the  home equity  loans.   Servicing includes, but  is not
limited to, (i)  the collection and aggregation  of payments relating  to the
Mortgage Loans;  (ii)  the supervision  of  delinquent Mortgage  Loans,  loss
mitigation  efforts,   foreclosure  proceedings   and,  if   applicable,  the
disposition of Mortgaged Properties; and (iii) the preparation of tax related
information in connection with the Mortgage Loans.

     Billing  statements are  mailed monthly  by  the Master  Servicer.   The
statement details all  debits and credits and  specifies the minimum  payment
due and the available credit line.  Notice of changes in  the applicable loan
rate  are  provided  by  the  Master  Servicer  to  the  Mortgagor  with such
statements.  All payments are due by the fifteenth day of the month.

     With respect  to  Mortgage  Loans,  the general  policy  of  the  Master
Servicer is to initiate foreclosure in the underlying property (i) after such
loan is  75 days or more  delinquent and satisfactory  arrangements cannot be
made with the Mortgagor or  (ii) if a notice of  default on a senior lien  is
received by the Master Servicer. Foreclosure proceedings may be terminated if
the   delinquency  is  cured.  Mortgage  Loans  to  borrowers  in  bankruptcy
proceedings may  be restructured in  accordance with law  and with a  view to
maximizing recovery of such Mortgage Loans, including any deficiencies.

     Once  foreclosure is  initiated by  the Master  Servicer, a  foreclosure
tracking system  is used  to monitor  the progress of  the proceedings.   The
system  includes state specific parameters to monitor whether proceedings are
progressing within the time frame typical for the state in which the property
is located. During the foreclosure proceeding, the Master Servicer determines
the amount of the foreclosure bid and whether to liquidate the Mortgage Loan.

     After  foreclosure,  if  the home  equity  loan  is secured  by  a first
mortgage lien, the  Master Servicer may liquidate the  Mortgaged Property and
charge  off  the home  equity loan  balance which  was not  recovered through
liquidation  proceeds.   If the  Mortgaged Property  was subject to  a senior
lien, the Master Servicer will either directly manage the foreclosure sale of
the  property and satisfy such lien at the  time of sale or take other action
as deemed necessary to protect the interest in the Mortgaged Property.  If in
the judgment  of the Master  Servicer, the cost of  maintaining or purchasing
the senior  lien position exceeds  the economic  benefit of such  action, the
Master Servicer will generally charge off the entire home equity loan and may
seek a money judgment against the borrower.

     Servicing and  charge-off policies and  collection practices  may change
over  time  in accordance  with, among  other  things, the  Master Servicer's
business   judgment,  changes  in  the  portfolio  and  applicable  laws  and
regulations.

DELINQUENCY EXPERIENCE

     The following table sets forth Provident's delinquency experience on its
servicing  portfolio of mortgage loans (including mortgage loans serviced for
others) similar to the Mortgage  Loans for the periods indicated.   There can
be no assurance that the delinquency experience on the Mortgage Loans will be
consistent with the historical information provided below.  Accordingly, this
information should not  be considered to  reflect the  credit quality of  the
Mortgage Loans included in the Trust, or a basis of assessing the likelihood,
amount or severity of losses on the Mortgage Loans.  The statistical data  in
the table  is  based on  all  of the  closed-end  fixed and  adjustable  rate
mortgage loans in Provident's servicing portfolio.

     The information in the  tables below has not been adjusted  to eliminate
the effect of the significant growth in the size of Provident's mortgage loan
portfolio during the periods shown.  Accordingly, delinquency as a percentage
of aggregate  principal balance  of Mortgage Loans  serviced for  each period
would  be  higher  than  those  shown  if  a  group  of  mortgage  loans were
artificially  isolated at  a  point in  time and  the information  showed the
activity only  in that isolated group.   However, since most  of the mortgage
loans  in Provident's  mortgage loan  portfolio are  not fully  seasoned, the
delinquency information for such an isolated group would also be distorted to
some degree.  As of  July 31, 1996, there have been no  losses on Provident's
mortgage loan servicing portfolio.

     The following table  sets forth information relating  to the delinquency
experience of mortgage loans similar to and including the Mortgage  Loans for
the (three) quarters ended (December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996).


                                                    Quarter Ended
                                            March 31, 1996                    December 31, 1995

                                    Number of                            Number of
                                      Loans          Dollar Amount         Loans        Dollar Amount
                                                                                    
Portfolio . . . . . . . . . .          (765           $72,345,012           310          $31,214,760
Delinquency percentage(1) . .

  30-59 days  . . . . . . . .         0.26%              0.28%             0.00%            0.00%
  60-89 days  . . . . . . . .         0.39%              0.42%             0.00%            0.00%
  90 days or more . . . . . .         0.13%              0.13%             0.00%            0.00%
Total . . . . . . . . . . . .         0.78%              0.83%             0.00%            0.00%)



__________
(1)  The  period of delinquency is based on the  number of days the
     payment is contractually past due.


                      DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

GENERAL

     The Mortgage  Loans  were originated  pursuant  to loan  agreements  and
disclosure  statements (the  "Credit  Line Agreements")  and  are secured  by
mortgages or  deeds of trust, which  are either first or  second mortgages or
deeds  of  trust,  on Mortgaged  Properties  located  in  ____  states.   The
Mortgaged  Properties  securing  the Mortgage  Loans  consist  of residential
properties that  are one-  to four-family properties.   See  "--Mortgage Loan
Terms" below.

     The Cut-Off Date Pool Balance is $______________, which is  equal to the
aggregate Principal  Balances of the Mortgage  Loans as of the  Cut-Off Date.
As of  the  Cut-Off Date,  the Mortgage  Loans  were not  more  than 89  days
delinquent.  The average Cut-Off Date  Principal  Balance  was  approximately 
$         , the minimum Cut-Off  Date Principal Balance was zero, the maximum
Cut-Off Date Principal  Balance was $        , the minimum Loan  Rate and the
maximum Loan Rate as  of the Cut-Off Date were      % and       %  per annum,
respectively, and the weighted average  Loan Rate as of the Cut-Off  Date was
approximately      % per annum.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the weighted average
Credit Limit Utilization  Rate was approximately       %, the  minimum Credit
Limit Utilization Rate was zero and the maximum Credit Limit Utilization Rate
was 100%.  The "Credit Limit Utilization Rate"  is determined by dividing the
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance of a Mortgage  Loan by the Credit Limit of the
related  Credit Line Agreement.  The remaining term to scheduled maturity for
the Mortgage  Loans as  of the Cut-Off  Date ranged  from      months  to    
months  and the  weighted average  remaining term  to scheduled  maturity was
approximately     months.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratio of  the Mortgage Loans ranged  from      % to ______%  and the weighted
average Combined  Loan-to-Value Ratio was approximately     %.   The Combined
Loan-to-Value  Ratio for  a  Mortgage  Loan  is the  ratio  (expressed  as  a
percentage) of (A) the  sum of (i) the Credit Limit of  the Mortgage Loan and
(ii)  any outstanding  principal balances  of mortgage  loans senior  to such
Mortgage Loan (calculated at the date of origination of the Mortgage Loan) to
(B) the lesser of (i)  the appraised value of the related  Mortgaged Property
as set  forth in the loan  files at such date  of origination or  (ii) in the
case of  a Mortgaged Property purchased within one year of the origination of
the  related Mortgage Loan,  the purchase  price of such  Mortgaged Property.
Credit Limits under the Mortgage Loans as of the Cut-Off Date ranged from $  
     to $             and averaged approximately  $          .   The weighted
average  second mortgage  ratio (which  is the  Credit Limit for  the related
Mortgage Loan,  provided such Mortgage Loan was  in the second lien position,
divided by the sum of such Credit Limit and the outstanding principal balance
of any mortgage loan senior to the related Mortgage Loan) was approximately  
  %.  As of  the Cut-Off Date, approximately      % by Cut-Off Date Principal
Balance  of  the  Mortgage  Loans  represented  first liens  on  the  related
Mortgaged  Properties, while  approximately         %  of the  Mortgage Loans
represented second liens.  As of  the Cut-Off Date, approximately        % of
the  Mortgage Loans  are secured  by Mortgaged  Properties which  are single-
family residences  and ___%  were owner-occupied.   As of  the Cut-Off  Date,
approximately      %,      %,     %,      %,     % and      % by Cut-Off Date
Principal Balance are  located in __________, ________,  __________, _______,
______  and ________), respectively.   In no  event will more than  5% of the
Cut-Off Date  Pool Principal Balance  of the  Mortgage Pool deviate  from the
characteristics of the Mortgage Loans described herein.

MORTGAGE LOAN TERMS

     (A borrower may access a  Mortgage Loan by writing a check in  a minimum
amount of $250.   The Mortgage Loans  bear interest at a variable  rate which
changes monthly on the first  business day of the related month  with changes
in  the applicable Index Rate.   The Mortgage Loans  are subject to a maximum
per annum interest  rate (the "Maximum Rate") ranging from (_____% to _____%)
per  annum and subject  to applicable usury  limitations.  As  of the Cut-Off
Date,  the weighted average  Maximum Rate  was approximately         %.   See
"Certain Legal  Aspects of  the Loans--Applicability  of Usury  Laws" in  the
Prospectus.  The daily periodic rate on the  Mortgage Loans (the "Loan Rate")
is  the sum of the Index Rate  plus the spread (the "Margin") which generally
ranges between ____% and ____%  and had a weighted average, as of the Cut-Off
Date, of approximately     %, divided by 365 days.  The "Index Rate" is based
on the highest "prime rate" published in  the 'Money Rates' table of The Wall
Street Journal as of the first business day of each calendar month.)

     Set  forth below  is a  description  of certain  characteristics of  the
Mortgage Loans as of the Cut-Off Date:


                              PRINCIPAL BALANCES



                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
         Range of Principal Balances                Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
                                                                                          
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .                      $                                %
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ to $_________  . . . . . . . . . .
$_______ and over . . . . . . . . . . . . .
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                          100.00%
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
	


                          GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION(1)



                                                                                         Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                    State                           Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------   
                                                                                         
                                                                 $                                 %






                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------   
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%

                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------



- --------------------
(1)  Geographic  location  is determined  by  the  address of  the  Mortgaged
     Property securing the related Mortgage Loan.


                       COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS(1)



                                                                                Percent of
              Range of Combined                                                             Pool
             Loan-to-Value Ratios                   Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------   
                                                                                  
_____% to ______% . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                                 %
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
______% to ______%  . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------   
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------


- -----------
(1)  The ratio (expressed as a  percentage) of (A) the sum of (i)  the Credit
     Limit  of the Mortgage Loans and (ii) any outstanding principal balances
     of mortgage loans senior  to the Mortgage Loans (calculated  at the date
     of  origination of  the Mortgage  Loans) to  (B) the  lesser of  (i) the
     appraised  value of the related Mortgaged Property  as set forth in loan
     files at  such date of  origination or (ii) in  the case of  a Mortgaged
     Property purchased within  one year  of the origination  of the  related
     Mortgage Loan, the purchase price of such Mortgaged Property.


                                PROPERTY TYPE


                                                                                Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                Property Type                       Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------   
                                                                                   
Single Family . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                                 %
Two- to Four-Family . . . . . . . . . . . .
Condominium . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PUD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------




                                LIEN PRIORITY



                                                                                Percent of
                                                                                            Pool
                Lien Priority                       Number                               by Cut-Off
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Date
                                                   Mortgage          Principal            Principal
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------   
                                                                                   
                                                    Loans             Balance              Balance

First Lien  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                             %
Second Lien . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                           100.00%
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------
                                                  ----------     ----------------          ---------


                                LOAN RATES(1)




                                                                            
                                                Number                               Percent of Pool
                                                  of           Cut-Off Date          by Cut-Off Date 
                  Range of                     Mortgage          Principal              Principal
                  Loan Rates                     Loans             Balance               Balance
___________________________________________   _________        _____________         _______________
                                                                              
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                                %
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                              _________        _____________         ______________
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      $                          100.00%
                                              _________        _____________         ______________
                                              _________        _____________         ______________

- ---------
(1)  Approximately     %  of the  Mortgage  Loans by  Cut-Off Date  Principal
     Balance are subject to an introductory rate of _____% per annum.


                                    MARGIN



                                                                                
                                                       Number                               Percent of Pool  
                                                         of           Cut-Off Date          by Cut-Off Date   
                  Range of                            Mortgage          Principal              Principal
                   Margins                             Loans             Balance                Balance
- ---------------------------------------------        ----------       ------------          ---------------
                                                                                                    

_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                           $                               %
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                     ----------       ------------          ---------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                           $                         100.00%
                                                     ----------       ------------          ---------------
                                                     ----------       ------------          ---------------



                        CREDIT LIMIT UTILIZATION RATES



                                                                                
                                                     Number                               
                                                       of           Cut-Off Date        Percent of Pool    
             Range of Credit Limit                   Mortgage         Principal         by Cut-Off Date 
              Utilization Rates                       Loans            Balance         Principal Balance 
                                                     ----------     ------------       -----------------
                                                                                               
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          $                               %
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____% to _____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                     ----------       ------------      ---------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          $                         100.00%
                                                     ----------       ------------      ---------------
                                                     ----------       ------------          ---------------



                                CREDIT LIMITS



                                                    Number
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date          Percent of Pool
                                                   Mortgage          Principal           by Cut-Off Date
            Range of Credit Limits                  Loans             Balance           Principal Balance
- -------------------------------------------        ---------       ------------         -----------------
                                                                                
$__________to $_________  . . . . . . . . .                        $                                 %
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ to $_________  . . . . . . . . .
$_________ and over . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       $                            100.00%
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------




                                MAXIMUM RATES


                                                                               
                                                   Number                                
                                                     of             Cut-Off Date          Percent of Pool    
                                                   Mortgage          Principal           by Cut-Off Date 
                Maximum Rates                       Loans             Balance           Principal Balance 
- -------------------------------------------        ---------       -------------        -----------------
                                                                                

_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                                   %
_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
_____%  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                             100.00%
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------


                  MONTHS REMAINING TO SCHEDULED MATURITY(1)




                                                                                
               
                                                     Number                               
                                                       of           Cut-Off Date            Percent of Pool  
               Range of Months                      Mortgage         Principal              by Cut-Off Date
       Remaining to Scheduled Maturity               Loans            Balance              Principal Balance 
- -------------------------------------------        ---------       ------------            -----------------
                                                                                    
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                                 %
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
___ to ___  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                           100.00%
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------



- ------------------
(1)  Assumes that  the Draw Period  for Mortgage  Loans with  five year  Draw
     Periods will be extended for an additional five years.


                               ORIGINATION YEAR




                                                     Number                               
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Percent of Pool  
                                                    Mortgage          Principal             by Cut-Off Date
             Origination Year                        Loans             Balance             Principal Balance 
- -------------------------------------------        ---------       ------------            -----------------
                                                                                     

____  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                                 %
____  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                           100.00%
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------


                              DELINQUENCY STATUS






                                                     Number                               
                                                      of           Cut-Off Date             Percent of Pool  
                                                    Mortgage        Principal               by Cut-Off Date
         Number of Days Delinquent                   Loans           Balance               Principal Balance 
- -------------------------------------------        ---------       ------------            -----------------
                                                                                      
0 to 29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                                 %
30 to 59  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
60 to 89  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------
     Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        $                           100.00%
                                                   ---------       ------------            -----------------
                                                   ---------       ------------         -----------------




(CONVEYANCE OF SUBSEQUENT MORTGAGE LOANS

     The  Agreement  permits  the  Trust  Fund  to purchase  from  Provident,
subsequent to the date hereof and prior to _______, 19__, Subsequent Mortgage
Loans  in  an amount  not  to  exceed  approximately $________  in  aggregate
principal balance  for inclusion in the Trust Fund.  Each Subsequent Mortgage
Loan  will have been originated or  purchased by Provident in accordance with
the  underwriting guidelines  set forth  above  under "The  Home Equity  Loan
Program--Credit and  Underwriting Guidelines."  Accordingly,  the statistical
characteristics of the Mortgage Pool set forth above are based exclusively on
the  Initial  Mortgage  Loans  and the  statistical  characteristics  of  the
Mortgage  Pool  after giving  effect  to  the acquisition  of  any Subsequent
Mortgage Loans will likely differ from the 

information  specified herein.    The  date on  which  Provident transfers  a
Subsequent Mortgage Loan to the Trust Fund shall be referred to herein as the
"Subsequent Transfer Date".

     In any  event,  each conveyance  of Subsequent  Mortgage  Loans will  be
subject  to,  among  other  things,  the  following  conditions:    (i)  such
Subsequent Mortgage Loans must (a) satisfy the eligibility criteria set forth
in  the Prospectus  under "The  Loan  Program--Representations by  Provident;
Repurchases" and  (b) comply with each representation and  warranty as to the
Mortgage Loans set forth in the Agreement; (ii) such Subsequent Mortgage Loan
must  not have been  selected by  Provident in a  manner that  it believes is
adverse  to  the  interests of  the  Certificateholders,  (iii) no Subsequent
Mortgage Loan  may be ___  or more  days contractually delinquent  as of  the
applicable  Cut-Off  Date;  (iv)  no  Subsequent Mortgage  Loan  may  have  a
remaining term to maturity in excess of ___ years; (v) no Subsequent Mortgage
Loan may have a Mortgage Rate less than ____%; (vi) following the purchase of
such Subsequent Mortgage Loans by the Trust Fund, the Mortgage Loans (a) will
have a weighted  average Mortgage  Rate of at  least ____%; (b)  will have  a
weighted  average Combined  Loan-to-Value Ratio of  not more  than ____%; (c)
will not have  a weighted average remaining  term to stated maturity  of more
than ____ months;  and (d) will,  in each case,  have a principal balance  in
excess of $_______  as of the Cut-Off Date; (vii)  Provident (and the Trustee
shall not have been notified  by either Rating Agency that the  conveyance of
such Subsequent Mortgage  Loans will result in  a qualification, modification
or withdrawal of its then-current rating of any class of Certificates) (shall
have  notified each  Rating  Agency of  such  conveyance as  required by  the
Agreement); and (viii)  the Trustee shall have  received certain opinions  of
counsel as  to, among other  things, the enforceability  and validity of  the
transfer agreements relating  to such conveyance of such  Subsequent Mortgage
Loans.)


                    MATURITY AND PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     The Agreement, except  as otherwise described herein, provides  that the
Certificateholders  will be  entitled to  receive on  each Distribution  Date
distributions  of principal, in  the amounts described  under "Description of
the  Certificates--Distributions  on  the  Certificates"  herein,  until  the
Certificate  Principal Balance  is  reduced  to  zero.   During  the  Managed
Amortization  Period, Certificateholders will  receive amounts from Principal
Collections based upon their Fixed Allocation Percentage subject to reduction
as described below.  During the Rapid Amortization Period, Certificateholders
will receive amounts from Principal Collections based solely upon their Fixed
Allocation Percentage.  Because prior  distributions of Principal Collections
to  Certificateholders  serve  to  reduce the  Investor  Floating  Allocation
Percentage but do not change  their Fixed Allocation Percentage,  allocations
of Principal Collections  based on the Fixed Allocation Percentage may result
in distributions of principal to the  Certificateholders in amounts that are,
in most  cases, greater  relative to  the declining  balance of  the Mortgage
Loans than would be  the case if the Investor  Floating Allocation Percentage
were used to determine the percentage of Principal Collections distributed to
Certificateholders.   This is  especially true during  the Rapid Amortization
Period when the Certificateholders are entitled to receive Investor Principal
Collections  and  not  a  lesser  amount.   In  addition,  Investor  Interest
Collections  may   be  distributed  as  principal  to  Certificateholders  in
connection  with the  Accelerated  Principal  Distribution  Amount,  if  any.
Moreover,  to  the extent  of  losses  allocable to  the  Certificateholders,
Certificateholders may  also receive  as payment of  principal the  amount of
such losses either  from Investor Interest Collections or, in some instances,
draws under the Policy.  The level of losses may therefore affect the rate of
payment of principal on the Certificates.

     To  the extent  obligors make  more draws  than principal  payments, the
Transferor  Interest may grow.  Because  during the Rapid Amortization Period
the Certificateholders share of Principal Collections is based upon its Fixed
Allocation  Percentage (without  reduction),  an increase  in  the Transferor
Interest  due  to  additional  draws may  also  result  in Certificateholders
receiving principal at a greater rate.  The Agreement permits the Transferor,
at  its  option,  but subject  to  the  satisfaction  of  certain  conditions
specified in  the  Agreement, including  the conditions  described below,  to
remove certain Mortgage Loans from the Trust Fund at any time during the life
of the Trust Fund, so long as the Transferor Interest (after giving effect to
such  removal)  is not  less  than the  Minimum  Transferor  Interest.   Such
removals   may  affect  the  rate  at   which  principal  is  distributed  to
Certificateholders by reducing the  overall Pool Balance and thus  the amount
of Principal  Collections.   See "Description  of the  Certificates--Optional
Retransfers of Mortgage Loans to the Transferor" herein.

     All of the Mortgage Loans may be prepaid in full or in part at any time.
The prepayment experience with  respect to the Mortgage Loans will affect the
weighted average life of the Certificates.

     The  rate of  prepayment  on the  Mortgage  Loans cannot  be  predicted.
Provident is not aware of any publicly available studies or statistics on the
rate of prepayment of such Mortgage Loans.  Generally,  home equity revolving
credit   lines  are  not   viewed  by   borrowers  as   permanent  financing.
Accordingly, the Mortgage  Loans may experience a  higher rate of  prepayment
than traditional  first  mortgage loans.    On the  other hand,  because  the
Mortgage Loans  amortize  as described  under  "Description of  the  Mortgage
Loans--Mortgage Loan  Terms"  herein,  rates  of  principal  payment  on  the
Mortgage  Loans will  generally be  slower than  those of  traditional fully-
amortizing first  mortgages in the  absence of  prepayments on such  Mortgage
Loans.   The  prepayment experience  of the  Trust Fund  with respect  to the
Mortgage  Loans may  be  affected by  a wide  variety  of factors,  including
general   economic   conditions,  prevailing   interest   rate   levels,  the
availability of alternative financing, homeowner mobility, the  frequency and
amount  of  any future  draws  on  the  Credit  Line Agreements  and  changes
affecting the  deductibility  for Federal  income  tax purposes  of  interest
payments  on home equity  credit lines.   Substantially  all of  the Mortgage
Loans contain  "due-on-sale" provisions,  and, with  respect to  the Mortgage
Loans, the  Master Servicer intends  to enforce such provisions,  unless such
enforcement is  not permitted by applicable law.   The enforcement of a "due-
on-sale" provision will have the  same effect as a prepayment of  the related
Mortgage Loan.  See "Certain Legal Aspects of The Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses"
in the Prospectus.

     The yield to an investor who purchases the Certificates in the secondary
market at a price other than par will vary from the anticipated yield if  the
rate of prepayment on the Mortgage Loans is  actually different than the rate
anticipated by such investor at the time such Certificates were purchased.

     Collections on the Mortgage Loans may vary because,  among other things,
borrowers may make payments  during any month as  low as the minimum  monthly
payment for such month or as high as the entire outstanding principal balance
plus accrued interest and the fees and charges thereon.   It is possible that
borrowers may fail  to make scheduled payments.  Collections  on the Mortgage
Loans may vary due to seasonal purchasing and payment habits of borrowers.

     No assurance can be  given as to the level  of prepayments that will  be
experienced  by the  Trust Fund  and it  can  be expected  that a  portion of
borrowers will  not prepay  their Mortgage Loans  to any  significant degree.
See "Yield and Prepayment Considerations" in the Prospectus.


                     POOL FACTOR AND TRADING INFORMATION


     The "Pool  Factor" is  a seven-digit decimal  which the  Master Servicer
will  compute monthly  expressing the  Certificate Principal  Balance of  the
Certificates  as  of each  Distribution  Date  (after  giving effect  to  any
distribution of principal  on such Distribution Date) as  a proportion of the
Original Certificate Principal Balance.  On the Closing Date, the Pool Factor
will  be 1.0000000.   See "Description of  the Certificates--Distributions on
the  Certificates"  herein.   Thereafter,  the Pool  Factor  will decline  to
reflect  reductions in  the related  Certificate Principal  Balance resulting
from  distributions of principal to the  Certificates and the Invested Amount
of any unreimbursed Liquidation Loss Amounts.

     Pursuant to  the  Agreement,  monthly reports  concerning  the  Invested
Amount, the  Pool Factor and various other items  of information will be made
available  to the Certificateholders.  In addition,  within 60 days after the
end of each calendar year, beginning with the 199_ calendar year, information
for tax reporting purposes will be made available to each person who has been
a Certificateholder of record at any time during the preceding calendar year.
See "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates" and "--Reports
to Certificateholders" herein.


                       DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

     The Certificates will be issued pursuant to the  Agreement.  The form of
the Agreement  has been filed as an exhibit  to the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus Supplement and the Prospectus is a part.  The following
is  a  description of  the material  provisions of  the Agreement.   Wherever
particular sections or defined terms of  the Agreement are referred to,  such
sections or defined terms are hereby incorporated herein by reference.


GENERAL

     The Certificates will be issued in denominations of $1,000 and multiples
of $1 in excess  thereof and will evidence  specified undivided interests  in
the Trust  Fund.  The  property of  the Trust  Fund will consist  of, to  the
extent  provided in the Agreement:  (i) each  of the Mortgage Loans that from
time to time  are subject to the Agreement; (ii)  collections on the Mortgage
Loans received after  the Cut-Off Date  (exclusive of payments in  respect of
accrued  interest due  on  or  prior to  the  Cut-Off  Date; (iii)  Mortgaged
Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans that are acquired by foreclosure or
deed in  lieu of foreclosure;  (iv) the Collection  Account and  the Security
Account  for  the Certificates  (excluding  net  earnings thereon);  (v)  the
Policy; and  (vi) the  Spread Account  (for  the benefit  of the  Certificate
Insurer  and the  Certificateholders).   Definitive Certificates  (as defined
below),  if issued, will  be transferable  and exchangeable at  the corporate
trust  office of  the Trustee,  which  will initially  maintain the  Security
Register for  the Certificates.   See "--Book-Entry Certificates"  below.  No
service charge will be made  for any registration of exchange or  transfer of
Certificates,  but the  Trustee may require  payment of  a sum  sufficient to
cover any tax or other governmental charge.

     The aggregate undivided  interest in the Trust  Fund represented by  the
Certificates as of the Closing Date will equal $               (the "Original
Invested  Amount"), which  represents __% of  the Cut-Off  Date Pool Balance.
The "Original Certificate Principal Balance"  will equal $                  .
Following  the  Closing Date,  the  "Invested  Amount"  with respect  to  any
Distribution  Date will be  an amount equal  to the Original  Invested Amount
minus (i) the amount of Investor Principal Collections previously distributed
to Certificateholders,  and minus (ii) an amount equal  to the product of the
Investor  Floating Allocation  Percentage  and the  Liquidation Loss  Amounts
(each as defined herein  under "--Distributions on  the Certificates").   The
principal amount  of the outstanding Certificates (the "Certificate Principal
Balance")  on  any Distribution  Date is  equal  to the  Original Certificate
Principal Balance  minus  the aggregate  of amounts  actually distributed  as
principal   to  the   Certificateholders.   See   "--Distributions   on   the
Certificates"  below.   Each  Certificate  represents  the right  to  receive
payments of interest  at the  Certificate Rate and  payments of principal  as
described below.

     The Transferor will own the remaining undivided interest in the Mortgage
Loans  (the "Transferor Interest"),  which is equal to  the Pool Balance less
the Invested Amount.  The Transferor Interest will initially equal $        ,
which represents _% of the Cut-Off  Date Pool Balance.  The Transferor as  of
any date is the  owner of the Transferor Interest which initially will be the
Transferor.  In general, the  Pool Balance will vary each day as principal is
paid on  the  Mortgage Loans,  liquidation  losses are  incurred,  Additional
Balances are  drawn down by borrowers  and Mortgage Loans are  transferred to
the Trust Fund.

     The Transferor has  the right to sell or pledge  the Transferor Interest
at  any time, provided (i)  the Rating Agencies  have notified the Transferor
and the Trustee in writing that such action will not result in  the reduction
or  withdrawal of the ratings assigned to  the Certificates, and (ii) certain
other conditions specified in the Agreement are satisfied.

     The Certificates will not be listed on any securities exchange.

BOOK-ENTRY CERTIFICATES

     The  Certificates  will  be  book-entry  Certificates  (the  "Book-Entry
Certificates").   Persons  acquiring  beneficial ownership  interests in  the
Certificates  ("Certificate Owners")  may  elect to  hold their  Certificates
through the Depository Trust Company  ("DTC") in the United States, or  CEDEL
or  Euroclear  (in  Europe) if  they  are  participants of  such  systems, or
indirectly through organizations which are participants in such systems.  The
Book-Entry Certificates  will be  issued in  one or  more certificates  which
equal the aggregate principal balance  of the Certificates and will initially
be registered  in the name  of Cede  & Co., the  nominee of  DTC.  CEDEL  and
Euroclear will hold omnibus positions on behalf of their participants through
customers' securities accounts in CEDEL's  and Euroclear's names on the books
of their  respective depositaries which  in turn will hold  such positions in
customers' securities  accounts in  the depositaries' names  on the  books of
DTC.  Citibank  will act  as  depositary  for CEDEL  and  Chase  will act  as
depositary  for Euroclear  (in  such capacities,  individually  the "Relevant
Depositary"  and collectively  the "European  Depositaries").   Investors may
hold  such beneficial  interests in  the  Book-Entry Certificates  in minimum
denominations representing  Certificate Principal  Balances of $1,000  and in
multiples of  $1 in  excess thereof.   Except as  described below,  no person
acquiring a  Book-Entry  Certificate (each,  a  "beneficial owner")  will  be
entitled to receive  a physical certificate representing  such Certificate (a
"Definitive Certificate").   Unless  and  until  Definitive Certificates  are 
issued,  it   is  anticipated   that  the  only   "Certificateholder" of  the 
Certificates   will  be  Cede  &   Co.,  as   nominee  of   DTC.  Certificate  
Owners   will   not   be   Certificateholders  as  that  term  is used in the 
Agreement.  Certificate   Owners   are  only  permitted  to  exercise   their  
rights  indirectly  through   the participating  organizations  that  utilize 
the  services  of  DTC, including securities  brokers  and dealers, banks and
trust companies  and  clearing corporations and certain other organizations 
("Participants") and DTC.

     The beneficial  owner's ownership  of a  Book-Entry Certificate  will be
recorded on  the records of  the brokerage firm, bank,  thrift institution or
other  financial   intermediary  (each,  a  "Financial   Intermediary")  that
maintains  the beneficial  owner's account  for such purpose.   In  turn, the
Financial Intermediary's  ownership of  such Book-Entry  Certificate will  be
recorded on the records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as agent
for the Financial Intermediary,  whose interest will  in turn be recorded  on
the records of DTC, if the beneficial owner's Financial Intermediary is not a
DTC participant and on the records of CEDEL or Euroclear, as appropriate).
     Certificate Owners will receive all  distributions of principal of,  and
interest  on,  the   Certificates  from  the  Trustee  through  DTC  and  DTC
participants.   While  the  Certificates are  outstanding  (except under  the
circumstances described  below), under the rules,  regulations and procedures
creating  and affecting DTC and its operations (the "Rules"), DTC is required
to make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose  behalf it acts with
respect  to  the  Certificates  and  is  required  to  receive  and  transmit
distributions   of  principal   of,  and   interest  on,   the  Certificates.
Participants and organizations which have  indirect access to the DTC system,
such as  banks, brokers,  dealers and trust  companies that clear  through or
maintain  a custodial  relationship with  a  Participant, either  directly or
indirectly  ("Indirect  Participants")  with  whom  Certificate  Owners  have
accounts with respect to  Certificates are similarly  required to make  book-
entry  transfers and  receive and  transmit such  distributions on  behalf of
their  respective  Certificate  Owners.   Accordingly,  although  Certificate
Owners will not  possess certificates, the Rules provide a mechanism by which
Certificate Owners  will receive distributions and  will be able  to transfer
their interest.

     Certificate  Owners  will   not  receive  or  be  entitled   to  receive
certificates  representing their  respective interests  in  the Certificates,
except  under the limited  circumstances described  below.  Unless  and until
Definitive  Certificates  are   issued,  Certificate   Owners  who  are   not
Participants may transfer ownership of Certificates only through Participants
and  Indirect  Participants by  instructing  such  Participants and  Indirect
Participants to  transfer Certificates, by  book-entry transfer, through  DTC
for  the account  of the  purchasers of  such Certificates, which  account is
maintained  with their  respective  Participants.   Under  the  Rules and  in
accordance  with   DTC's  normal  procedures,   transfers  of   ownership  of
Certificates will  be executed through DTC and the accounts of the respective
Participants  at  DTC   will  be  debited  and  credited.     Similarly,  the
Participants  and Indirect Participants  will make debits  or credits, as the
case  may be,  on  their records  on  behalf of  the  selling and  purchasing
Certificate Owners.

     Because  of time  zone differences,  credits of  securities received  in
CEDEL, or Euroclear  as a result of a transaction with  a Participant will be
made  during,  subsequent  securities  settlement  processing  and dated  the
business  day  following, the  DTC  settlement date.    Such  credits or  any
transactions in  such  securities, settled  during  such processing  will  be
reported to  the relevant Euroclear  or, CEDEL Participants on  such business
day.  Cash received in CEDEL or Euroclear as, a result of sales of securities
by  or  through  a  CEDEL  Participant  (as  defined,  below)  or   Euroclear
Participant  (as defined below) to  a DTC Participant  will be, received with
value on the DTC settlement date but will be available in the, relevant CEDEL
or  Euroclear cash account only as of  the business day following, settlement
in  DTC.   For  information  with respect  to  tax documentation  procedures,
relating to  the Certificates, see "Federal  Income Tax Consequences--Foreign
Investors"  and  "--Backup  Withholding"  herein  and  "Global,    Clearance,
Settlement And  Tax Documentation Procedures--Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax
Documentation Requirements" in Annex I hereto.

     Transfers  between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC rules.
Transfers between CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

     Cross-market transfers  between persons  holding directly  or indirectly
through DTC,  on  the one  hand,  and directly  or  indirectly through  CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC
in accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing  system  by  the  Relevant Depositary;  however,  such  cross market
transactions will require  delivery of instructions to the  relevant European
international  clearing  system  by  the   counterparty  in  such  system  in
accordance with its rules and procedures and within its established deadlines
(European time).   The relevant European international clearing  system will,
if the transaction meets its  settlement requirements, deliver  instructions 
to the Relevant Depositary to take action to effect final settlement on  its 
behalf by delivering or receiving securities in DTC, and making or receiving 
payment in accordance with normal procedures for same  day funds  settlement 
applicable to DTC.   CEDEL Participants and Euroclear  Participants may  not 
deliver instructions directly to the European Depositaries.

     DTC  which  is  a  New York-chartered  limited  purpose  trust  company,
performs  services  for  its  participants,  some  of   which  (and/or  their
representatives) own  DTC. In accordance with  its normal procedures,  DTC is
expected to record the  positions held by each  DTC participant in the  Book-
Entry Certificates,  whether held  for its own  account or  as a  nominee for
another  person.  In general, beneficial ownership of Book-Entry Certificates
will be subject  to the rules, regulations  and procedures governing DTC  and
DTC participants as in effect from time to time.

     CEDEL is  incorporated under  the laws of  Luxembourg as  a professional
depository.  CEDEL  holds  securities  for  its  participating  organizations
("CEDEL  Participants")  and  facilitates  the  clearance  and  settlement of
securities transactions between CEDEL  Participants through electronic  book-
entry changes in accounts of CEDEL Participants, thereby eliminating the need
for physical movement  of certificates.  Transactions may be settled in CEDEL
in any of 28 currencies, including  United States dollars.  CEDEL provides to
its  CEDEL  Participants,  among  other  things,  services  for  safekeeping,
administration, clearance and settlement of internationally traded securities
and securities lending and borrowing.  CEDEL interfaces with domestic markets
in several  countries.   As a  professional depository,  CEDEL is  subject to
regulation by  the  Luxembourg Monetary  Institute.   CEDEL participants  are
recognized financial  institutions around the world,  including underwriters,
securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust companies, clearing corporations
and certain other organizations.  Indirect access to CEDEL is also  available
to others, such  as banks, brokers,  dealers and  trust companies that  clear
through or maintain a custodial relationship with a CEDEL Participant, either
directly or indirectly.

     Euroclear was created  in 1968  to hold securities  for participants  of
Euroclear ("Euroclear  Participants") and  to clear  and settle  transactions
between Euroclear  Participants  through simultaneous  electronic  book-entry
delivery against payment, thereby eliminating  the need for physical movement
of  certificates  and  any  risk  from  lack  of  simultaneous  transfers  of
securities  and  cash.    Transactions  may  now  be  settled  in  any  of 32
currencies, including  United States  dollars.   Euroclear  includes  various
other services,  including securities  lending and  borrowing and  interfaces
with   domestic  markets  in  several  countries  generally  similar  to  the
arrangements for cross-market transfers with  DTC described above.  Euroclear
is operated by the Brussels, Belgium  office of Morgan Guaranty Trust Company
of New  York  (the  "Euroclear  Operator"),  under  contract  with  Euroclear
Clearance   Systems    S.C.,   a   Belgian   cooperative   corporation   (the
"Cooperative").  All operations are conducted by the Euroclear Operator,  and
all Euroclear securities  clearance accounts and Euroclear cash  accounts are
accounts with the Euroclear  Operator, not the Cooperative.   The Cooperative
establishes  policy  for  Euroclear  on  behalf  of  Euroclear  Participants.
Euroclear Participants  include banks (including  central banks),  securities
brokers and dealers and other professional financial intermediaries. Indirect
access to  Euroclear is also available  to other firms that  clear through or
maintain  a  custodial relationship  with  a  Euroclear  Participant,  either
directly or indirectly.

     The  Euroclear Operator  is  the Belgian  branch of  a New  York banking
corporation  which is a member bank of  the Federal Reserve System.  As such,
it is regulated and examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System and  the New York  State Banking  Department, as well  as the  Belgian
Banking Commission.

     Securities  clearance  accounts  and cash  accounts  with  the Euroclear
Operator are governed  by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear
and the related  Operating Procedures of the Euroclear  System and applicable
Belgian law  (collectively,  the "Terms  and  Conditions").   The  Terms  and
Conditions  govern  transfers  of  securities   and  cash  within  Euroclear,
withdrawals  of securities and cash from  Euroclear, and receipts of payments
with respect  to securities in  Euroclear.   All securities in  Euroclear are
held  on a  fungible basis  without attribution  of specific  certificates to
specific  securities clearance accounts.   The Euroclear  Operator acts under
the Terms and Conditions only on behalf of Euroclear Participants, and has no
record   of  or   relationship   with  persons   holding   through  Euroclear
Participants.

     Distributions  on  the Book-Entry  Certificates  will  be made  on  each
Distribution  Date by  the  Trustee to  DTC.   DTC  will  be responsible  for
crediting the amount of such  payments to the accounts of the  applicable DTC
participants  in  accordance   with  DTC's  normal  procedures.     Each  DTC
participant  will  be  responsible  for  disbursing  such   payments  to  the
beneficial owners  of the Book-Entry Certificates  that it represents  and to
each Financial Intermediary for which it  acts as agent.  Each such Financial  
Intermediary will  be  responsible  for  disbursing  funds to  the beneficial  
owners of  the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents.

     Under  a  book-entry   format,  beneficial  owners  of   the  Book-Entry
Certificates  may experience some  delay in their  receipt of payments, since
such payments will be  forwarded by the Trustee to Cede & Co., as nominee for
DTC ("Cede").   Distributions with respect to Certificates held through CEDEL
or Euroclear  will be credited to the cash  accounts of CEDEL Participants or
Euroclear  Participants in accordance  with the  relevant system's  rules and
procedures,  to  the extent  received  by  the  Relevant  Depositary.    Such
distributions will  be subject to  tax reporting in accordance  with relevant
United  States   tax  laws  and   regulations.    See   "Federal  Income  Tax
Consequences--Foreign  Investors" and "--Backup Withholding" herein.  Because
DTC can  only act  on behalf  of Financial Intermediaries,  the ability  of a
beneficial  owner to pledge  Book-Entry Certificates  to persons  or entities
that do not participate in  the Depository system, or otherwise take  actions
in respect of such Book-Entry Certificates, may be limited due to the lack of
physical  certificates  for  such  Book-Entry  Certificates.    In  addition,
issuance  of the  Book-Entry Certificates in  book-entry form  may reduce the
liquidity  of  such  Certificates  in  the  secondary  market  since  certain
potential investors may be unwilling  to purchase Certificates for which they
cannot obtain physical certificates.

     Monthly and  annual reports on  the Trust  Fund provided  by the  Master
Servicer to  Cede, as nominee  of DTC,  may be made  available to  beneficial
owners upon request, in accordance with the rules, regulations and procedures
creating and affecting the Depository, and to the Financial Intermediaries to
whose DTC accounts the Book-Entry Certificates  of such beneficial owners are
credited.

     DTC has advised  the Transferor and the  Trustee that, unless  and until
Definitive Certificates are issued, DTC will take any action permitted  to be
taken by the holders of the  Book-Entry Certificates under the Agreement only
at  the direction  of  one  or more  Financial  Intermediaries to  whose  DTC
accounts  the Book-Entry Certificates  are credited, to  the extent that such
actions  are  taken  on  behalf of  Financial  Intermediaries  whose holdings
include such Book-Entry  Certificates.  CEDEL or  the Euroclear Operator,  as
the case  may be,  will take  any other  action permitted  to be  taken by  a
Certificateholder  under the  Agreement on behalf  of a  CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear  Participant  only  in  accordance  with  its  relevant  rules  and
procedures and subject  to the ability of  the Relevant Depositary to  effect
such  actions on  its behalf  through  DTC.   DTC may  take  actions, at  the
direction  of the  related Participants,  with  respect to  some Certificates
which conflict with actions taken with respect to other Certificates.

     Definitive Certificates will be issued to beneficial owners of the Book-
Entry Certificates, or their nominees, rather than to DTC, only if (a) DTC or
the Transferor advises the Trustee in writing that DTC is no  longer willing,
qualified or  able to discharge properly its  responsibilities as nominee and
depository with  respect to the Book-Entry Certificates and the Transferor or
the Trustee is unable to locate a qualified successor, (b) the Transferor, at
its sole  option, elects to terminate a book-entry  system through DTC or (c)
after the occurrence  of an Event of Servicing Termination (as defined herein
under  "--Events   of  Servicing  Termination"),   beneficial  owners  having
Percentage Interests  aggregating  not  less  than  51%  of  the  Certificate
Principal Balance of  the Book-Entry Certificates advise the  Trustee and DTC
through the Financial Intermediaries and the DTC participants in writing that
the continuation of a book-entry system  through DTC (or a successor thereto)
is no longer in the best interests of beneficial owners.

     Upon the occurrence of  any of the events  described in the  immediately
preceding paragraph,  the Trustee will  be required to  notify all beneficial
owners of the occurrence  of such event and  the availability through DTC  of
Definitive Certificates.   Upon surrender by DTC of the global certificate or
certificates representing  the Book-Entry  Certificates and  instructions for
re-registration,  the  Trustee   will  issue  Definitive  Certificates,   and
thereafter  the  Trustee  will  recognize  the  holders  of  such  Definitive
Certificates as Certificateholders under the Agreement.

     Although   DTC,  CEDEL  and  Euroclear  have  agreed  to  the  foregoing
procedures   in  order   to  facilitate   transfers  of   Certificates  among
participants of DTC,  CEDEL and  Euroclear, they are  under no obligation  to
perform  or continue to  perform such procedures  and such procedures  may be
discontinued at any time.


ASSIGNMENT OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     At the time of  issuance of the Certificates, Provident will transfer to
the Trust  Fund all of its right, title and  interest in and to each Mortgage
Loan  (including any  Additional  Balances arising  in  the future),  related
Credit Line Agreements, mortgages  and other related documents (collectively,
the "Related Documents"), including  all  collections  received  on  or  with 
respect to each such  Mortgage Loan  after  the  Cut-Off Date  (exclusive  of 
payments in respect of accrued interest due on or prior to  the Cut-Off Date.
The  Trustee, concurrently with  such transfer, will deliver the Certificates 
to Provident and the Transferor Certificate (as defined in the Agreement)  to 
the Transferor.   Each Mortgage Loan transferred to  the  Trust Fund  will be  
identified  on  a  schedule  (the  "Mortgage Loan Schedule") delivered to the 
Trustee pursuant to the Agreement.  Such schedule will include information as 
to the  Cut-Off Date  Principal Balance of  each Mortgage Loan, as well as 
information with respect to the Loan Rate. 

     Within 90 days of the Closing Date, the Trustee will review the Mortgage
Loans and the Related Documents and if any  Mortgage Loan or Related Document
is found to be defective in any material respect and such defect is not cured
within  90 days following  notification thereof to  Provident by the Trustee,
the Transferor will be obligated to accept the transfer of such Mortgage Loan
from  the Trust  Fund.   Upon such  transfer, the  Principal Balance  of such
Mortgage  Loan will  be deducted  from the  Pool Balance,  thus  reducing the
amount  of  the Transferor  Interest.    If  the deduction  would  cause  the
Transferor Interest  to become less than  the Minimum Transferor  Interest at
such time  (a "Transfer Deficiency"),  Provident will be obligated  to either
substitute an Eligible  Substitute Mortgage Loan  or make a deposit  into the
Collection Account in the amount (the "Transfer Deposit Amount") equal to the
amount by  which the Transferor  Interest would be  reduced to less  than the
Minimum Transferor Interest at such  time.  Any such deduction,  substitution
or deposit, will be considered a payment  in full of such Mortgage Loan.  Any
Transfer  Deposit  Amount   will  be  treated  as  a   Principal  Collection.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, however, prior to all required deposits to the
Collection Account being made  no such transfer shall  be considered to  have
occurred  unless  such  deposit is  actually  made.   The  obligation  of the
Transferor to  accept a transfer  of a  Defective Mortgage Loan  is the  sole
remedy regarding  any defects  in the  Mortgage Loans  and Related  Documents
available to the Trustee or the Certificateholders.  

     An "Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan" is a mortgage loan substituted by
Provident  for a  Defective Mortgage  Loan which  must, on  the date  of such
substitution, (i) have an outstanding Principal Balance (or  in the case of a
substitution of more than one Mortgage Loan for a Defective Mortgage Loan, an
aggregate  Principal  Balance),  not  __%  more  or  less  than  the Transfer
Deficiency relating to such  Defective Mortgage Loan; (ii)  have a Loan  Rate
not less than the Loan Rate of  the Defective Mortgage Loan and not more than
_% in excess of the  Loan Rate of such Defective Mortgage Loan;  (iii) have a
Loan Rate based on the same Index with adjustments  to such Loan Rate made on
the  same Interest  Rate Adjustment Date  as that  of the  Defective Mortgage
Loan; (iv)  have a Margin that is  not less than the  Margin of the Defective
Mortgage Loan and  not more than ___ basis points higher  than the Margin for
the  Defective Mortgage Loan; (v) have a mortgage of the same or higher level
of priority  as the mortgage  relating to  the Defective Mortgage  Loan; (vi)
have a remaining  term to maturity not  more than ___ months earlier  and not
more  than  __  months later  than  the  remaining term  to  maturity  of the
Defective Mortgage Loan;  (vii) comply with each representation  and warranty
as  to the Mortgage Loans set forth in the Agreement (deemed to be made as of
the date of substitution); (viii) in general, have an original Combined Loan-
to-Value Ratio not greater than that of the Defective Mortgage Loan; and (ix)
satisfy certain  other conditions specified in the  Agreement.  To the extent
the Principal  Balance of an Eligible  Substitute Mortgage Loan is  less than
the  Principal Balance  of the  related Defective  Mortgage  Loan and  to the
extent  that  the Transferor  Interest  would  be reduced  below  the Minimum
Transferor Interest, the Transferor will be required to make a deposit to the
Collection Account equal to such difference.

     Provident  will make certain  representations and  warranties as  to the
accuracy in all  material respects  of certain information  furnished to  the
Trustee  with respect  to each  Mortgage Loan  (e.g., Cut-Off  Date Principal
Balance  and the  Loan Rate).    In addition,  Provident  will represent  and
warrant on  the Closing  Date that  at  the time  of transfer  to the  Trust,
Provident has transferred or assigned  all of its rights, title and  interest
in each Mortgage Loan and the Related Documents, free of any lien (subject to
certain exceptions).   Upon discovery of a breach  of any such representation
and warranty  which materially  and adversely  affects the  interests of  the
Certificateholders  or the Certificate  Insurer in the  related Mortgage Loan
and  Related Documents,  Provident  will  have  a period  of  90  days  after
discovery or notice of the breach to effect a cure.  If the  breach cannot be
cured within the 90-day period, the Transferor will be obligated to  accept a
transfer  of  the Defective  Mortgage Loan  from the  Trust  Fund.   The same
procedure  and  limitations  that  are  set forth  in  the  second  preceding
paragraph  for the  transfer of  Defective Mortgage Loans  will apply  to the
transfer  of a Mortgage  Loan that is  required to be  transferred because of
such breach of a  representation or warranty in the Agreement that materially
and adversely affects the interests of the Certificateholders.  

     Mortgage  Loans required to be transferred  to Provident as described in
the preceding paragraphs are referred to as "Defective Mortgage Loans."

     Pursuant  to  the  Agreement,  the  Master  Servicer  will  service  and
administer the Mortgage Loans as more fully set forth above.

AMENDMENTS TO CREDIT LINE AGREEMENTS

     Subject to applicable law,  the Master Servicer may change the  terms of
the  Credit Line Agreements at any time provided that such changes (i) do not
adversely affect  the interest of  the Certificateholders or  the Certificate
Insurer, and (ii) are consistent with prudent business practice. In addition,
the  Agreement  permits  the  Master  Servicer,  within  certain  limitations
described therein, to increase the Credit Limit of the  related Mortgage Loan
or reduce the Margin for such Mortgage Loan.

OPTIONAL TRANSFERS OF MORTGAGE LOANS TO THE TRANSFEROR

     In order  to permit  the Transferor to  remove Mortgage  Loans from  the
Trust Fund at  such times, if any,  as the overcollateralization exceeds  the
level  required  to  maintain  the  ratings  on  the   Certificates,  on  any
Distribution Date  the Transferor may, but shall  not be obligated to, remove
on such Distribution Date (the "Transfer  Date") from the Trust Fund, certain
Mortgage Loans without notice to  the Certificateholders.  The Transferor  is
permitted to designate  the Mortgage Loans to be removed.   Mortgage Loans so
designated  will  only   be  removed  upon  satisfaction   of  the  following
conditions:   (i)  the  Rapid Amortization Period  shall not have  commenced;
(ii) the Transferor Interest as of such Transfer Date (after giving effect to
such removal)  exceeds the Minimum Transferor Interest; (iii) the transfer of
any  Mortgage Loans  on any  Transfer  Date during  the Managed  Amortization
Period shall  not, in the reasonable belief of  the Transferor, cause a Rapid
Amortization Event to occur or an event which with notice or lapse of time or
both would constitute  a Rapid Amortization Event; (iv)  the Transferor shall
have delivered to the Trustee a "Mortgage Loan Schedule" containing a list of
all Mortgage Loans  remaining in the Trust  Fund after such removal;  (v) the
Transferor shall represent and warrant that no selection procedures which the
Transferor  reasonably  believes   are  adverse  to  the  interests   of  the
Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer were used by the  Transferor in
selecting  such  Mortgage  Loans;  (vi) in  connection  with  the  first such
retransfer of Mortgage Loans, the Rating Agencies shall have been notified of
the proposed transfer and prior to  the Transfer Date shall not have notified
the Transferor in writing that  such transfer would result in a  reduction or
withdrawal of the  ratings assigned to the Certificates without regard to the
Policy; and  (vii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and the
Certificate Insurer  an officer's  certificate confirming the  conditions set
forth in clauses (i) through (vi) above.  

     As of any date of determination, the "Minimum Transferor Interest" is an
amount equal to the lesser of (a) _% of the Pool Balance on such date and (b)
the Transferor Interest as of the Closing Date.


PAYMENTS ON MORTGAGE LOANS; DEPOSITS TO COLLECTION ACCOUNT

     The  Trustee  shall establish  and  maintain  on  behalf of  the  Master
Servicer  an  account  (the  "Collection Account")  for  the  benefit  of the
Certificateholders and the Transferor,  as their interests  may appear.   The
Collection Account will  be an Eligible Account (as  defined below).  Subject
to the investment provision described in the following paragraphs, within two
days of receipt by the  Master Servicer of amounts in respect of the Mortgage
Loans (excluding amounts  representing administrative  charges, annual  fees,
taxes,  assessments,  credit insurance  charges,  insurance  proceeds  to  be
applied  to the  restoration or  repair of  a  Mortgaged Property  or similar
items),  the  Master Servicer  will deposit  such  amounts in  the Collection
Account.   Amounts so deposited may  be invested in Eligible  Investments (as
described below) maturing no later than one Business Day prior to the date on
which  the amount  on deposit  therein  is required  to be  deposited  in the
Collection Account or  on such  Distribution Date if  approved by the  Rating
Agencies and the Certificate Insurer.   Not later than the third Business Day
prior  to  each Distribution  Date  (the  "Determination  Date"), the  Master
Servicer will notify the Trustee of the amount of such deposit to be included
in funds available for the related Distribution Date.

     An "Eligible  Account" is  (i)  an account  that  is maintained  with  a
depository  institution whose  debt obligations  at the  time of  any deposit
therein have the highest short-term debt  rating by the Rating Agencies, (ii)
one or more accounts with a depository institution having a minimum long-term
unsecured debt rating of "____" by _______ and  "____" by ___, which accounts
are fully insured by  either the Savings Association Insurance  Fund ("SAIF")
or  the  Bank  Insurance  Fund  ("BIF")  of  the  Federal  Deposit  Insurance 
Corporation established by  such fund,  (iii)   a  segregated  trust  account 
maintained with the Trustee or  an Affiliate of the Trustee in its fiduciary 
capacity  or (iv)  otherwise  acceptable   to  each  Rating  Agency and  the 
Certificate  Insurer as evidenced by a letter from each  Rating  Agency  and 
the Certificate Insurer to the Trustee, without  reduction  or  withdrawal of 
their then current ratings of the Certificates.

     "Eligible Investments" are specified in the Agreement and are limited to
(i) direct  obligations  of, or  obligations fully  guaranteed  as to  timely
payment of  principal and interest  by, the  United States or  any agency  or
instrumentality thereof, provided that such obligations are backed by the
                         --------
full faith  and credit of  the United  States; (ii) repurchase  agreements on
obligations specified  in clause (i) maturing not more than three months from
the date of acquisition thereof, provided that the short-term unsecured debt
                                 --------
obligations of the party  agreeing to repurchase such obligations  are at the
time rated by each Rating  Agency in its highest short-term rating  category;
(iii) certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers' acceptances (which,
if Moody's is a  Rating Agency, shall each  have an original maturity  of not
more than 90 days and, in the case of bankers' acceptances, shall in no event
have  an original  maturity of  more than  365 days)  of any  U.S. depository
institution or trust company incorporated under the laws of the United States
or any  state thereof and subject  to supervision and examination  by federal
and/or state banking authorities, provided that the unsecured short-term debt
                                  --------
obligations of  such depository institution or  trust company at the  date of
acquisition  thereof have been  rated by each  of the Rating  Agencies in its
highest  unsecured short-term  debt rating  category;  (iv) commercial  paper
(having original  maturities of  not more  than 90  days) of any  corporation
incorporated under the  laws of the United States or  any state thereof which
on the  date of acquisition  has been rated by  the Rating Agencies  in their
highest  short-term  rating  categories;  (v)  short  term  investment  funds
("STIFS") sponsored by any trust company or bank incorporated under  the laws
of  the United States or any  state thereof which on  the date of acquisition
has been  rated by  the Rating  Agencies in their  respective highest  rating
category of long term unsecured debt; (vi) interests in any money market fund
which at the date of acquisition of the interests in such fund and throughout
the time as the  interest is held  in such fund has  the rating specified  by
each  Rating Agency;  and  (vii)  other obligations  or  securities that  are
acceptable to each Rating Agency as an Eligible Investment hereunder and will
not result in a  reduction in the then current rating of the Certificates, as
evidenced by a letter to such effect from such Rating Agency and with respect
to  which  the  Master  Servicer  has  received  confirmation that,  for  tax
purposes, the  investment complies with  the last clause of  this definition;
provided that no instrument described hereunder shall evidence either the
- --------
right to receive (a) only interest with respect to the obligations underlying
such instrument  or (b)  both principal  and interest  payments derived  from
obligations  underlying  such  instrument  and  the  interest  and  principal
payments with respect to such instrument  provided a yield to maturity at par
greater than  120% of the  yield to maturity at  par of the  underlying obli-
gations; and provided, further, that no instrument described hereunder may
             --------  -------
be purchased at a price greater than par if such instrument may be prepaid or
called at a price less than its purchase price prior to its stated maturity.


ALLOCATIONS AND COLLECTIONS

     All  collections on  the Mortgage Loans  will generally  be allocated in
accordance  with the  Credit  Line Agreements  between  amounts collected  in
respect of interest and amounts collected in respect of principal.  As to any
Distribution  Date,  "Interest Collections"  will  be  equal  to the  amounts
collected during the related Collection Period, including such portion of Net
Liquidation  Proceeds allocated  to interest  pursuant  to the  terms of  the
Credit Line Agreements less Servicing Fees for the related Collection Period.

     As to any  Distribution Date, "Principal Collections"  will be equal  to
the sum of (i)  the amounts collected during  the related Collection  Period,
including such  portion of  Net Liquidation  Proceeds allocated  to principal
pursuant to  the terms of  the Credit Line  Agreements and (ii)  any Transfer
Deposit Amounts.   "Net Liquidation Proceeds" with respect to a Mortgage Loan
are equal  to the Liquidation Proceeds, reduced  by related expenses, but not
including the  portion, if  any, of  such amount  that exceeds  the Principal
Balance of the Mortgage Loan plus  accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the
end  of the  Collection  Period during  which  such  Mortgage Loan  became  a
Liquidated Mortgage Loan.  "Liquidation Proceeds" are the proceeds (excluding
any  amounts drawn on the Policy) received in connection with the liquidation
of any Mortgage  Loan, whether  through trustee's sale,  foreclosure sale  or
otherwise.

     With  respect  to  any  Distribution   Date,  the  portion  of  Interest
Collections allocable to the  Certificates ("Investor Interest  Collections")
will equal the product of (a) Interest Collections for such Distribution Date
and (b)  the Investor Floating  Allocation Percentage.   With respect  to any
Distribution Date, the "Investor Floating Allocation 

Percentage" is the percentage equivalent of a fraction determined by dividing
the  Invested Amount at the  close of business  on the preceding Distribution
Date (or the Closing Date  in the case of the first Distribution Date) by the
Pool Balance  at  the  beginning  of  the related  Collection  Period.    The
remaining amount of Interest Collections  will be allocated to the Transferor
Interest.

     Principal Collections  will be allocated  between the Certificateholders
and  the  Transferor   ("Investor  Principal  Collections"   and  "Transferor
Principal Collections", respectively) as described herein.

     The Trustee  will deposit any  amounts drawn  under the Policy  into the
Collection Account.

     With  respect  to any  date, the  "Pool Balance"  will  be equal  to the
aggregate of  the Principal Balances of  all Mortgage Loans as  of such date.
The Principal Balance  of a Mortgage Loan  (other than a Liquidated  Mortgage
Loan) on any day is equal to the Cut-Off Date Principal Balance thereof, plus
(i) any Additional Balances in  respect of such Mortgage Loan minus  (ii) all
collections credited against  the Principal Balance of such  Mortgage Loan in
accordance  with the related  Credit Line Agreement  prior to such  day.  The
Principal  Balance  of a  Liquidated Mortgage  Loan  after final  recovery of
related Liquidation Proceeds shall be zero.


DISTRIBUTIONS ON THE CERTIFICATES

     Beginning  with  the  first  Distribution  Date  (which  will  occur  on
__________,  199_), distributions  on the  Certificates will  be made  by the
Trustee or the Paying Agent on each Distribution Date to the persons in whose
names such Certificates  are registered at the  close of business on  the day
prior to each Distribution Date  or, if the Certificates are no  longer Book-
Entry Certificates, at the  close of business  on the last  day of the  month
preceding such Distribution Date (the "Record Date").  The term "Distribution
Date"  means the  (fifteenth) day  of each  month or,  if such  day is  not a
Business Day, then the next succeeding  Business Day.  Distributions will  be
made  by   check  or  money   order  mailed  (or   upon  the  request   of  a
Certificateholder owning  Certificates  having denominations  aggregating  at
least $_________, by wire transfer or otherwise) to the address of the person
entitled thereto (which, in the case of Book-Entry Certificates,  will be DTC
or  its  nominee) as  it  appears  on  the  Certificate Register  in  amounts
calculated as described herein on the Determination Date.  However, the final
distribution  in  respect  of  the  Certificates  will  be  made  only   upon
presentation and surrender thereof at the office or the agency of the Trustee
specified  in the notice  to Certificateholders  of such  final distribution.
For purposes of the Agreement, a "Business  Day" is any day other than (i)  a
Saturday or Sunday or (ii) a  day on which banking institutions in the  State
of California are required or authorized by law to be closed.

     Application of  Interest Collections.   On  each Distribution  Date, the
Trustee  or the Paying Agent will  apply the Investor Interest Collections in
the following manner and order of priority:

          (i)  as payment  to the Trustee for  its fee for services  rendered
     pursuant to the Agreement;

          (ii)  as payment for the premium for the Policy;
          (iii)   as  payment for the  accrued interest  due and  any overdue
     accrued  interest (with interest thereon to the extent permitted by law)
     on the Certificate Principal Balance of the Certificates;

          (iv)   to pay Certificateholders the Investor Loss  Amount for such
     Distribution Date;

          (v)    as  payment for  any  Investor  Loss Amount  for  a previous
     Distribution Date  that  was  not  previously  (a)  funded  by  Investor
     Interest  Collections, (b) absorbed by the Overcollateralization Amount,
     (c) funded by amounts on deposit in the Spread Account or (d)  funded by
     draws on the Policy;

          (vi)   to reimburse prior draws made from the Policy (with interest
     thereon);

          (vii)   to pay  principal on  the Certificates  until the  Invested
     Amount  exceeds  the  Certificate  Principal  Balance  by  the  Required
     Overcollateralization  Amount (such  amount  so  paid, the  "Accelerated
     Principal Distribution Amount");

          (viii)   any other amounts required  to be deposited  in an account
     for the benefit of the Certificate Insurer and the Certificateholders or
     owed to the Certificate Insurer pursuant to the Insurance Agreement;

          (ix)  certain amounts that may be required to be paid to the Master
     Servicer pursuant to the Agreement; and

          (x)  to the Transferor to the extent permitted as described herein.
 
     Payments to Certificateholders pursuant to clause (iii) will be interest
payments on  the Certificates.   Payments  to Certificateholders  pursuant to
clauses (iv),  (v) and (vii) will  be principal payments on  the Certificates
and  will  therefore  reduce  the  Certificate  Principal  Balance,  however,
payments pursuant  to clause (vii) will not reduce  the Invested Amount.  The
Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount is not guaranteed by the Policy.

     To the extent that Investor Interest Collections are  applied to pay the
interest  on  the   Certificates,  Investor   Interest  Collections  may   be
insufficient to cover Investor  Loss Amounts.  If such  insufficiency results
in the  Certificate Principal Balance  exceeding the Invested Amount,  a draw
will be made on the Policy in accordance with the terms of the Policy.

     The "Required Overcollateralization Amount" shall be an amount set forth
in the  Agreement.   "Liquidation  Loss  Amount" means  with respect  to  any
Liquidated Mortgage  Loan, the unrecovered  Principal Balance  thereof during
the Collection  Period  in  which  such Mortgage  Loan  became  a  Liquidated
Mortgage  Loan,  after  giving effect  to  the  Net  Liquidation Proceeds  in
connection therewith.  The "Investor Loss Amount" shall be the product of the
Investor Floating Allocation  Percentage and the Liquidation Loss  Amount for
such Distribution Date.

     A "Liquidated Mortgage  Loan" means,  as to any  Distribution Date,  any
Mortgage Loan in  respect of which the Master Servicer  has determined, based
on the servicing procedures specified in the Agreement, as of the  end of the
preceding Collection Period that all Liquidation Proceeds which it expects to
recover with  respect to the  disposition of  the related Mortgaged  Property
have  been recovered.   The  Investor Loss  Amount will  be allocated  to the
Certificateholders.

     As to any Distribution Date other than the first Distribution  Date, the
"Collection Period" is  the calendar month preceding each  Distribution Date.
As to  the first  Distribution Date,  the "Collection Period"  is the  period
beginning  after   the  Cut-Off  Date   and  ending  on   the  last   day  of
_______________ 199_.

     Interest  will  be  distributed  on   each  Distribution  Date  at   the
Certificate Rate for  the related  Interest Period (as  defined below).   The
"Certificate Rate" for a  Distribution Date will  generally equal the sum  of
((a) LIBOR, calculated  as specified below, as  of the second LIBOR  Business
Day prior to the immediately preceding Distribution Date  (or as of two LIBOR
Business  Days  prior  to  the  Closing  Date,  in  the  case  of  the  first
Distribution Date) plus (b) ____% per annum.)  Notwithstanding the foregoing,
in no event will the amount of interest required to be distributed in respect
of  the Certificates  on any  Distribution Date  exceed a  rate equal  to the
weighted average of  the Loan Rates (net  of the Servicing Fee  Rate, the fee
payable to  the Trustee  and the  rate at  which the  premium payable  to the
Certificate Insurer is calculated) weighted on the basis of the daily balance
of  each  Mortgage  Loan during  the  related  billing  cycle  prior  to  the
Collection Period relating to such Distribution Date.

     Interest on  the Certificates in  respect of any  Distribution Date will
accrue on the  Certificate Principal Balance from the  preceding Distribution
Date (or  in the case of  the first Distribution  Date, from the date  of the
initial  issuance of the  Certificates (the "Closing  Date")) through the day
preceding such Distribution Date (each such period, an "Interest Period")  on
the basis of the actual number of  days in the Interest Period and a  360-day
year.   Interest payments on  the Certificates will  be funded from  Investor
Interest Collections and, if necessary, from draws on the Policy.

     (Calculation of the LIBOR Rate.  On each Distribution Date, LIBOR  shall
be established by the Trustee and as to any Interest Period, LIBOR will equal
the rate for United States dollar deposits for one month which appears on the
Telerate Screen Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M., London time, on  the second LIBOR
Business  Day prior  to the  first day  of such  Interest Period.   "Telerate
Screen Page  3750" means the display designated as  page 3750 on the Telerate
Service (or such other page as may replace page 3750 on that service  for the
purpose of  displaying London interbank  offered rates  of major banks).   If
such rate does not appear on such page (or such other page as may 

replace that  page on that service, or if  such service is no longer offered,
such  other  service  for displaying  LIBOR  or comparable  rates  as  may be
selected by Provident after consultation with the  Trustee), the rate will be
the Reference Bank Rate.  The "Reference Bank Rate" will be determined on the
basis  of the rates  at which  deposits in  U.S. Dollars  are offered  by the
reference  banks (which  shall  be  three major  banks  that  are engaged  in
transactions  in the  London interbank  market,  selected by  Provident after
consultation with the Trustee) as of 11:00 A.M., London time, on the day that
is two LIBOR  Business Days prior  to the immediately  preceding Distribution
Date to prime banks in the London interbank market for a period  of one month
in amounts  approximately equal to  the principal amount of  the Certificates
then outstanding.  The  Trustee will request the  principal London office  of
each of the reference  banks to provide a quotation of its rate.  If at least
two such quotations are provided, the rate will be the arithmetic mean of the
quotations.   If  on such  date fewer  than  two quotations  are provided  as
requested, the rate will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted by one or
more major banks in New  York City, selected by Provident after  consultation
with the  Trustee, as  of 11:00 A.M.,  New York City  time, on such  date for
loans in U.S. Dollars to  leading European banks for a period of one month in
amounts approximately equal to the principal  amount of the Certificates then
outstanding.   If no such quotations can be  obtained, the rate will be LIBOR
for the  prior Distribution Date.   "LIBOR Business Day" means  any day other
than (i) a Saturday or a  Sunday or (ii) a day on which  banking institutions
in  the State of New York  or in the city of  London, England are required or
authorized by law to be closed.)

     Transferor  Collections.    Collections   allocable  to  the  Transferor
Interest that are  not distributed to Certificateholders will  be distributed
to the Transferor only to  the extent that such distribution will  not reduce
the  amount of the  Transferor Interest as  of the related  Distribution Date
below  the  Minimum Transferor  Interest.   Amounts  not  distributed  to the
Transferor  because of such  limitations will  be retained in  the Collection
Account  until  the  Transferor  Interest  exceeds  the  Minimum   Transferor
Interest, at which time such  excess shall be released to the Transferor.  If
any such  amounts are  still  retained in  the  Collection Account  upon  the
commencement  of the Rapid Amortization Period,  such amounts will be paid to
the Certificateholders as a reduction of the Certificate Principal Balance.

     Overcollateralization.   The  distribution of the  aggregate Accelerated
Principal  Distribution Amount, if  any, to Certificateholders  may result in
the Invested  Amount being  greater than  the Certificate  Principal Balance,
thereby creating overcollateralization.  The Overcollateralization Amount, if
any, will be available to absorb any Investor Loss Amount that is not covered
by Investor Interest Collections.

     Distributions of Principal Collections.  For the period beginning on the
first  Distribution Date and,  unless a  Rapid Amortization Event  shall have
earlier occurred, ending on the Distribution Date in ______________ 20__ (the
"Managed Amortization  Period"), the amount of  Principal Collections payable
to  Certificateholders  as  of  each Distribution  Date  during  the  Managed
Amortization Period  will equal, to the extent  funds are available therefor,
the Scheduled Principal Collections Distribution Amount for such Distribution
Date.  On any  Distribution Date during the Managed Amortization  Period, the
"Scheduled Principal Collections Distribution  Amount" shall equal the lesser
of  (i) the  Maximum  Principal  Payment  (as defined  below)  and  (ii)  the
Alternative  Principal Payment  (as  defined  below).   With  respect to  any
Distribution Date, the "Maximum Principal Payment" will  equal the product of
the Investor Fixed  Allocation Percentage and Principal Collections  for such
Distribution  Date.  With respect to  any Distribution Date, the "Alternative
Principal Payment"  will equal the  greater of (x)  0___% of the  Certificate
Principal  Balance immediately  prior to such  Distribution Date  and (y) the
amount,  but  not  less  than   zero,  of  Principal  Collections  for   such
Distribution  Date less the  aggregate of Additional  Balances created during
the related Collection Period.

     Beginning  with the  first Distribution  Date following  the end  of the
Managed Amortization Period,  the amount of Principal Collections  payable to
Certificateholders on  each Distribution  Date will be  equal to  the Maximum
Principal Payment.

     The   amount   of   Principal   Collections   to   be   distributed   to
Certificateholders  on the  first Distribution  Date  will reflect  Principal
Collections  and Additional Balances during the first Collection Period which
is  the period  beginning after  the  Cut-Off Date  through the  last day  of
__________ 199_.

     Distributions  of Principal  Collections based  upon the  Investor Fixed
Allocation   Percentage  may   result  in   distributions  of   principal  to
Certificateholders in amounts that are greater relative to the declining Pool
Balance than would be the case if the Investor Floating Allocation Percentage
were used to determine the percentage of Principal 

Collections  distributed  in  respect  of  the   Invested  Amount.  Principal
Collections not allocated to the Certificateholders will be  allocated to the
Transferor Interest.    The  aggregate  distributions  of  principal  to  the
Certificateholders  will  not  exceed  the  Original   Certificate  Principal
Balance.

     In addition, to the extent  of funds available therefor (including funds
available under the Policy), on  the Distribution Date in ____________  20__,
Certificateholders  will be entitled to receive as  a payment of principal an
amount equal to the outstanding Certificate Principal Balance.

     The  Paying Agent.   The  Paying Agent  shall initially be  the Trustee,
together with  any successor thereto in  such capacity (the  "Paying Agent").
The Paying Agent shall  have the revocable power  to withdraw funds from  the
Collection   Account  for  the   purpose  of  making   distributions  to  the
Certificateholders.

RAPID AMORTIZATION EVENTS

     As  described  above,  the  Managed Amortization  Period  will  continue
through the Distribution Date in           20  , unless a Rapid Amortization
                                 ----------  --
Event occurs  prior to such date in which  case the Rapid Amortization Period
will commence prior to such  date.  "Rapid Amortization Event" refers  to any
of the following events:

          (a)       failure  on the  part of  the  Transferor (i)  to make  a
     payment  or deposit required  under the Agreement  within three Business
     Days after the date such  payment or deposit is  required to be made  or
     (ii) to observe or perform  in any material respect any other  covenants
     or  agreements  of the  Transferor  set  forth in  the  Agreement, which
     failure continues  unremedied for  a  period of  60 days  after  written
     notice;

          (b)       any representation or warranty made  by the Transferor in
     the Agreement proves to have been incorrect in any material respect when
     made and continues to be incorrect  in any material respect for a period
     of 60  days after written notice and as  a result of which the interests
     of  the  Certificateholders  are   materially  and  adversely  affected;
     provided,  however, that a Rapid Amortization  Event shall not be deemed
     to occur if the Transferor has  purchased or made a substitution for the
     related Mortgage Loan or Mortgage Loans if applicable during such period
     (or  within an additional  60 days with  the consent of  the Trustee) in
     accordance with the provisions of the Agreement;

          (c)       the  occurrence   of   certain  events   of   bankruptcy,
     insolvency or receivership relating to the Transferor; or

          (d)       the  Trust Fund  becomes  subject  to regulation  by  the
     Securities and Exchange  Commission as an investment  company within the
     meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

     In  the case  of any  event  described in  clause  (a) or  (b), a  Rapid
Amortization  Event  will  be deemed  to  have occurred  only  if,  after the
applicable  grace period,  if  any, described  in  such  clauses, either  the
Trustee or  Certificateholders holding Certificates evidencing  more than 51%
of the Percentage  Interests or the Certificate Insurer (so  long as there is
no default by  the Certificate Insurer in the performance  of its obligations
under  the Policy),  by written notice  to Provident and  the Master Servicer
(and to the Trustee, if given by the Certificateholders) declare that a Rapid
Amortization Event has occurred  as of the date of such notice.   In the case
of any event  described in clause (c) or (d), a Rapid Amortization Event will
be deemed  to have occurred without any notice or other action on the part of
the Trustee or the Certificateholders immediately upon the occurrence of such
event.

     In addition to the consequences  of a Rapid Amortization Event discussed
above, if the Transferor voluntarily files a bankruptcy petition or goes into
liquidation or  any person is appointed  a receiver or bankruptcy  trustee of
the  Transferor, on  the day  of any  such filing  or appointment  no further
Additional Balances will  be transferred  to the Trust  Fund, the  Transferor
will immediately cease to transfer Additional  Balances to the Trust Fund and
the Transferor will promptly give notice to the Trustee of any such filing or
appointment.   Within  15 days,  the Trustee  will  publish a  notice of  the
liquidation or the filing  or appointment stating that the Trustee intends to
sell, dispose of or otherwise liquidate the Mortgage Loans in a  commercially
reasonable  manner  and  to  the  best  of its  ability.    Unless  otherwise
instructed  within  a  specified  period  by  Certificateholders representing
undivided  interests aggregating  more than  51%  of the  aggregate principal
amount  of the Certificates,  the Trustee will sell,  dispose of or otherwise
liquidate  the Mortgage  Loans in  a  commercially reasonable  manner and  on
commercially   reasonable  terms.     Any   proceeds  will  be   treated   as  
collections  allocable  to  the  Certificateholders  and  the Investor  Fixed  
Allocation  Percentage of  such remaining proceeds and will be distributed to 
the   Certificateholders  on   the  date  such  proceeds  are  received  (the  
"Dissolution  Distribution  Date").   (If  the   portion  of   such  proceeds  
allocable  to  the Certificateholders  are not sufficient to pay  in full the 
remaining amount  due  on  the  Certificates,  the  Policy  will  cover  such 
shortfall.)

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a conservator, receiver or trustee-in-
bankruptcy is appointed  for the Transferor  and no Rapid Amortization  Event
exists other  than such  conservatorship, receivership or  insolvency of  the
Transferor, the conservator,  receiver or trustee-in-bankruptcy may  have the
power to prevent  the commencement of  the Rapid Amortization  Period or  the
sale of Mortgage Loans described above.

THE POLICY

     (On  or before  the  Closing Date,  the  Policy will  be  issued by  the
Certificate  Insurer pursuant  to  the provisions  of the  Agreement  and the
Insurance and Indemnity Agreement (the "Insurance  Agreement") to be dated as
of ____________,  199_, among  Provident, (the  Trustee) and  the Certificate
Insurer.

     The Policy  will irrevocably  and unconditionally  guarantee payment  on
each   Distribution  Date   to   the  Trustee   for   the  benefit   of   the
Certificateholders  the  full and  complete  payment  of  (i) the  Guaranteed
Principal  Distribution  Amount  (as  defined  below)  with  respect  to  the
Certificates for such Distribution Date and (ii) accrued and unpaid  interest
due on the Certificates (together, the "Guaranteed Distributions"), with such
Guaranteed  Distributions  having  been  calculated  in  accordance  with the
original terms of the  Certificates or the Agreement except for amendments or
modifications to  which the Certificate Insurer  has given its  prior written
consent.   The  effect of the  Policy is  to guarantee the  timely payment of
interest on, and the ultimate payment of the principal amount of, all  of the
Certificates.

     The "Guaranteed Principal Distribution Amount"  shall be the amount,  if
any,  by which the Certificate Principal  Balance (after giving effect to all
other amounts distributable  and allocable to principal  on the Certificates)
exceeds the Invested Amount as of such Distribution Date (after giving effect
to  all  other  amounts  distributable  and  allocable  to  principal  on the
Certificates for  such  Distribution Date).   In  addition,  the Policy  will
guarantee the payment of the outstanding Certificate Principal Balance on the
Distribution Date  in ______________ 20__  (after giving effect  to all other
amounts distributable and allocable to principal on such Distribution Date).
     In accordance  with  the Agreement,  the  Trustee  will be  required  to
establish and maintain an account  (the "Spread Account") for the  benefit of
the  Certificate  Insurer  and  the Certificateholders.    The  Trustee shall
deposit the amounts into the Spread Account as required by the Agreement.

     Payment of claims on the Policy will be made by the  Certificate Insurer
following Receipt  by the Certificate  Insurer of the appropriate  notice for
payment on the later to  occur of (i) 12:00 noon, New York  City time, on the
second Business Day  following Receipt of  such notice  for payment and  (ii)
12:00 noon, New York City time, on the relevant Distribution Date.

     If payment of any amount guaranteed by the Certificate Insurer  pursuant
to the Policy is avoided as a preference payment under applicable bankruptcy,
insolvency, receivership  or similar  law, the  Certificate Insurer  will pay
such  amount out of the funds of the  Certificate Insurer on the later of (a)
the date when due to be  paid pursuant to the Order referred to below  or (b)
the first  to occur of (i)  the fourth Business Day following  Receipt by the
Certificate  Insurer from the  Trustee of (A)  a certified copy  of the order
(the  "Order")  of  the court  or  other  governmental  body which  exercised
jurisdiction to the  effect that the Certificateholder is  required to return
the  amount of any  Guaranteed Distributions distributed  with respect to the
Certificates during the term of the related Policy because such distributions
were avoidable  preference payments  under applicable  bankruptcy law,  (B) a
certificate  of the Certificateholder that the Order  has been entered and is
not subject to  any stay and (C) an assignment duly executed and delivered by
the  Certificateholder,  in  such  form  as  is reasonably  required  by  the
Certificate Insurer and provided to the Certificateholder  by the Certificate
Insurer,  irrevocably assigning  to the  Certificate  Insurer all  rights and
claims of the Certificateholder relating to or arising under the Certificates
against  the debtor  which  made such  preference payment  or  otherwise with
respect  to  such preference  payment, or  (ii) the  date  of Receipt  by the
Certificate Insurer from the Trustee of the items referred to in clauses (A),
(B)  and (C)  above if,  at least four  Business Days  prior to  such date of
Receipt, the Certificate Insurer shall have Received written notice from the 
Trustee that such items were to  be delivered on such date and such  date was
specified in such notice.   Such payment shall be disbursed to  the receiver,
conservator, debtor-in-possession or trustee in bankruptcy named in the Order
and  not  to  the  Trustee   or  any  Certificateholder  directly  (unless  a
Certificateholder  has   previously  paid  such   amount  to   the  receiver,
conservator, debtor-in-possession or trustee in bankruptcy named in the Order
in which case such payment shall be disbursed to the Trustee for distribution
to  such Certificateholder upon proof of such payment reasonably satisfactory
to the Certificate Insurer).

     The terms "Receipt"  and "Received",  with respect to  the Policy,  mean
actual delivery to the Certificate Insurer and to its fiscal agent  appointed
by the Certificate Insurer  at its option, if any,  prior to 12:00 noon,  New
York City time, on  a Business Day;  delivery either on a  day that is not  a
Business Day or after 12:00 noon,  New York City time, shall be deemed  to be
Receipt on  the next succeeding Business  Day.  If any  notice or certificate
given under  the Policy  by  the Trustee  is not  in proper  form  or is  not
properly completed, executed or delivered it shall be deemed not to have been
Received, and the  Certificate Insurer or the fiscal agent  shall promptly so
advise the Trustee and the Trustee may submit an amended notice.

     Under the Policy, "Business Day" means any day other than (i) a Saturday
or Sunday  or (ii) a  day on which  banking institutions  in The City  of New
York, New  York are authorized or obligated  by law or executive  order to be
closed.

     The Certificate  Insurer's obligations  under the  Policy in  respect of
Guaranteed  Distributions  shall  be  discharged  to  the  extent  funds  are
transferred to  the Trustee as  provided in the  Policy, whether or  not such
funds are properly applied by the Trustee.

     The  Certificate  Insurer shall  be  subrogated to  the  rights  of each
Certificateholder  to   receive  payments  of  principal   and  interest,  as
applicable, with respect  to distributions on the Certificates  to the extent
of any payment by the  Certificate Insurer under the  Policy.  To the  extent
the Certificate Insurer  makes Guaranteed Distributions,  either directly  or
indirectly (as by paying through the Trustee), to the Certificateholders, the
Certificate   Insurer   will   be   subrogated   to   the   rights   of   the
Certificateholders,   as  applicable,   with  respect   to   such  Guaranteed
Distributions, shall be deemed to the extent of the payments so made to  be a
registered  Certificateholder for purposes  of payment and  shall receive all
future Guaranteed  Distributions until all  such Guaranteed Distributions  by
the  Certificate  Insurer  have  been  fully  reimbursed, provided  that  the
Certificateholders  have  received   the  full  amount   of  the   Guaranteed
Distributions.

     The terms  of the Policy cannot be modified,  altered or affected by any
other agreement or instrument, or by the merger, consolidation or dissolution
of the Transferor. The Policy by its  terms may not be cancelled or  revoked.
The Policy is governed by the laws of the State of ________.

     The  Policy is not  covered by the  Property/Casualty Insurance Security
fund specified in  Article 76 of the New  York Insurance Law.   The Policy is
not covered by the Florida  Insurance Guaranty Association created under Part
II  of  Chapter  631  of  the Florida  Insurance  Code.    In  the  event the
Certificate  Insurer were to become  insolvent, any claims  arising under the
Policy  are  excluded from  coverage  by  the California  Insurance  Guaranty
Association, established  pursuant to Article 14.2 of Chapter  1 of part 2 of
Division 1 of the California Insurance Code.

     Pursuant to  the terms of  the Agreement,  unless a Certificate  Insurer
default exists,  the Certificate Insurer shall be deemed  to be the Holder of
the Certificates for  certain purposes (other than with respect to payment on
the  Certificates),  will  be  entitled   to  exercise  all  rights  of   the
Certificateholders thereunder,  without the consent  of such Holders  and the
Holders of  the Certificates  may exercise  such rights only  with the  prior
written consent of  the Certificate  Insurer.  In  addition, the  Certificate
Insurer will have certain additional rights as third party beneficiary to the
Agreement.

     In the  absence of  payments under  the Policy,  Certificateholders will
bear directly  the credit  and other  risks associated  with their  undivided
interest in the Trust Fund.)

(PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

     On  the Closing  Date, $___________  (the "Pre-Funded  Amount") will  be
deposited in an  account (the "Pre-Funding Account"), which  account shall be
in the name of and maintained by the Trustee and shall be part of  the  Trust
Fund  and  will  be   used  to acquire Subsequent Mortgage Loans.  During the 
period beginning on the  Closing Date and terminating on  _____________, 19__
(the "Funding Period"),  the Pre-Funded Amount will be  reduced by the amount
thereof  used to purchase  Subsequent Mortgage  Loans in accordance  with the
Agreement.  Any Pre-Funded Amount remaining at the  end of the Funding Period
will be distributed  to holders of  the classes of  Certificates entitled  to
receive  principal  on  the  Distribution  Date  in ______________,  19__  in
reduction of the related Certificate  Principal Balances (thus resulting in a
partial principal prepayment of the related Certificates on such date). 

     Amounts  on  deposit  in the  Pre-Funding  Account will  be  invested in
Permitted Investments.   All interest  and any other  investment earnings  on
amounts  on  deposit in  the Pre-Funding  Account  will be  deposited  in the
Capitalized Interest Account.


CAPITALIZED INTEREST ACCOUNT

     On  the  Closing  Date  there  will be  deposited  in  an  account  (the
"Capitalized Interest  Account")  maintained with  and  in  the name  of  the
Trustee on behalf of the Trust Fund a portion of the proceeds of  the sale of
the Certificates.  The amount  deposited therein will be used by  the Trustee
on the Distribution Dates in __________________ 19__,  _____________ 19__ and
______________, 19__ to cover shortfalls in interest on the Certificates that
may arise as a  result of the utilization of the  Pre-Funding Account for the
purchase  by the Trust  Fund of Subsequent  Mortgage Loans after  the Closing
Date.   Any amounts remaining in the Capitalized  Interest Account at the end
of the  Funding  Period which  are  not needed  to  cover shortfalls  on  the
Distribution Date in  ___________ 19__ are  required to be  paid directly  to
Provident.)


REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS

     Concurrently  with  each  distribution  to the  Certificateholders,  the
Master   Servicer  will  forward   to  the   Trustee  for  mailing   to  such
Certificateholder a statement setting forth among other items:

          (i)  the Investor Floating Allocation  Percentage for the preceding
     Collection Period;
          (ii)  the amount being distributed to Certificateholders;

          (iii)  the amount of interest included in such distribution and the
     related Certificate Rate;

          (iv)  the amount, if  any, of overdue accrued interest  included in
     such distribution (and the amount of interest thereon);

          (v)  the amount, if any,  of the remaining overdue accrued interest
     after giving effect to such distribution;

          (vi)    the   amount,  if  any,  of   principal  included  in  such
     distribution;
          (vii)   the  amount,  if  any,  of the  reimbursement  of  previous
     Liquidation Loss Amounts included in such distribution;

          (viii)    the  amount,  if  any,  of  the  aggregate   unreimbursed
     Liquidation Loss Amounts after giving effect to such distribution;

          (ix)  the Servicing Fee for such Distribution Date;

          (x)   the Invested  Amount and  the Certificate  Principal Balance,
     each after giving effect to such distribution;

          (xi)   the Pool Balance as  of the end of  the preceding Collection
     Period;

          (xii)  the number and  aggregate Principal Balances of the Mortgage
     Loans as  to which the minimum  monthly payment is delinquent  for 30-59
     days, 60-89 days and 90 or more days, respectively, as of the end of the
     preceding Collection Period;

          (xiii)  the book value of any real estate which  is acquired by the
     Trust Fund through foreclosure or grant of deed in lieu of  foreclosure;
     and
          (xiv)  the amount of any draws on the Policy.

     In the  case of information  furnished pursuant to clauses  (iii), (iv),
(v), (vi), (vii) and (viii) above, the amounts shall be expressed as a dollar
amount per Certificate with a $1,000 denomination.

     Within 60 days  after the end of each calendar  year commencing in 1996,
the Master Servicer will  be required to forward  to the Trustee a  statement
containing  the  information set  forth  in  clauses  (iii)  and  (vi)  above
aggregated for such calendar year.  
COLLECTION AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES ON MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Master Servicer will make reasonable efforts to collect all payments
called for under the Mortgage Loans and will, consistent  with the Agreement,
follow  such collection  procedures  as it  follows from  time  to time  with
respect to the home equity loans in its servicing portfolio comparable to the
Mortgage Loans.   Consistent with the  above, the Master Servicer  may in its
discretion waive  any late payment charge  or any assumption or  other fee or
charge that may be collected in the ordinary course of servicing the Mortgage
Loans.  

     With respect to the Mortgage Loans, the Master Servicer may arrange with
a  borrower a  schedule for  the  payment of  interest due  and unpaid  for a
period, provided  that any  such arrangement  is consistent  with the  Master
Servicer's policies with respect to the home equity mortgage loans it owns or
services.  In accordance with the terms of the Agreement, the Master Servicer
may consent under certain circumstances to the placing of a subsequent senior
lien in respect of a Mortgage Loan.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     The  Agreement provides that the Master Servicer maintain certain hazard
insurance on the Mortgaged Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans.   While
the terms of  the related Credit Line Agreements  generally require borrowers
to maintain certain  hazard insurance, the Master  Servicer will not  monitor
the maintenance of such insurance.

     The Agreement requires the Master Servicer to maintain for any Mortgaged
Property relating to a Mortgage Loan acquired upon  foreclosure of a Mortgage
Loan, or by deed in lieu of such foreclosure, hazard insurance  with extended
coverage in an amount  equal to the lesser of (a) the maximum insurable value
of such Mortgaged  Property or (b) the  outstanding balance of such  Mortgage
Loan  plus  the outstanding  balance  on  any mortgage  loan  senior to  such
Mortgage Loan at the time of foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure, plus
accrued interest and the Master Servicer's good faith estimate of the related
liquidation expenses to  be incurred in connection therewith.   The Agreement
provides that the Master Servicer may satisfy its obligation to cause  hazard
policies to be  maintained by maintaining  a blanket policy insuring  against
losses on  such Mortgaged  Properties.   If such  blanket  policy contains  a
deductible clause, the  Master Servicer will  be obligated to deposit  in the
Collection Account the  sums which would have been deposited  therein but for
such  clause.    The  Master  Servicer  will  satisfy  these requirements  by
maintaining a blanket policy.   As set forth above, all amounts  collected by
the Master Servicer (net of any  reimbursements to the Master Servicer) under
any  hazard policy (except  for amounts to  be applied to  the restoration or
repair  of  the Mortgaged  Property)  will  ultimately  be deposited  in  the
Collection Account.

     In general,  the standard  form  of fire  and extended  coverage  policy
covers physical damage  to or destruction of the improvements on the property
by  fire, lightning,  explosion, smoke,  windstorm  and hail,  and the  like,
strike  and  civil  commotion,  subject  to  the  conditions  and  exclusions
specified  in each  policy.  Although  the policies relating  to the Mortgage
Loans  will be  underwritten by  different  insurers and  therefore will  not
contain identical terms and conditions, the basic  terms thereof are dictated
by state laws and most of  such policies typically do not cover  any physical
damage resulting from the following:  war,  revolution, governmental actions,
floods and other water-related causes, earth movement (including earthquakes,
landslides and mudflows), nuclear reactions, wet or dry rot, vermin, rodents,
insects or domestic  animals, theft  and, in  certain cases  vandalism.   The
foregoing list is merely indicative of  certain kinds of uninsured risks  and
is not intended to be all-inclusive or an exact description of  the insurance
policies relating to the Mortgaged Properties.


REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Master Servicer will foreclose upon or  otherwise comparably convert
to ownership Mortgaged Properties securing such of the Mortgage Loans as come
into default when,  in accordance with applicable  servicing procedures under
the Agreement, no satisfactory arrangements can be made for the collection of
delinquent  payments.     In  connection  with  such  foreclosure   or  other
conversion,  the Master  Servicer  will  follow such  practices  as it  deems
necessary  or advisable  and as are  in keeping with  its general subordinate
mortgage servicing  activities,  provided the  Master  Servicer will  not  be
required to  expend its  own funds  in connection  with foreclosure  or other
conversion,  correction  of default  on  a  related senior  mortgage  loan or
restoration of  any property unless, in its  sole judgment, such foreclosure,
correction or restoration will increase Net Liquidation Proceeds.  The Master
Servicer will be  reimbursed out of Liquidation Proceeds  for advances of its
own funds  as liquidation expenses  before any  Net Liquidation Proceeds  are
distributed to Certificateholders or the Transferor.
SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     With respect to each Collection Period, the Master Servicer will receive
from interest collections in respect of  the Mortgage Loans a portion of such
interest  collections as  a  monthly Servicing  Fee  in the  amount  equal to
approximately  ____%  per  annum  ("Servicing  Fee  Rate") on  the  aggregate
Principal Balances  of the Mortgage Loans as of  the first day of the related
Collection Period (or  at the Cut-Off Date for  the first Collection Period).
All assumption fees, late payment charges and other  fees and charges, to the
extent collected from borrowers, will be  retained by the Master Servicer  as
additional servicing compensation.

     The  Master Servicer will  pay certain ongoing  expenses associated with
the Trust  Fund and incurred  by it in  connection with  its responsibilities
under the  Agreement.  In addition,  the Master Servicer will  be entitled to
reimbursement  for  certain  expenses  incurred  by  it  in  connection  with
defaulted Mortgage Loans and in  connection with the restoration of Mortgaged
Properties,  such  right  of  reimbursement  being  prior  to  the rights  of
Certificateholders to receive any related Net Liquidation Proceeds.


EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

     The Agreement  provides for  delivery on or  before ___________  in each
year, beginning in ___________, 199_,  to the Trustee of an annual  statement
signed by an officer  of the Master  Servicer to the  effect that the  Master
Servicer  has  fulfilled  its   material  obligations  under  the   Agreement
throughout the preceding fiscal year, except  as specified in such statement.

     On or  before _____________ of  each year, beginning  ___________, 199_,
the Master Servicer  will furnish a report  prepared by a firm  of nationally
recognized independent public accountants (who may also render other services
to the  Master Servicer or  the Transferor)  to the Trustee,  the Certificate
Insurer  and the Rating  Agencies to the  effect that such  firm has examined
certain documents and the records relating to servicing of the Mortgage Loans
under  the Agreement and  that, on the  basis of such  examination, such firm
believes that such servicing  was conducted in compliance with  the Agreement
except for (a) such exceptions as such firm believes to be immaterial and (b)
such other exceptions as shall be set forth in such report.  


CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER AND THE TRANSFEROR

     The Agreement provides that the Master Servicer may not  resign from its
obligations  and duties  thereunder, except  in  connection with  a permitted
transfer of servicing, unless  (i) such duties and obligations  are no longer
permissible  under applicable law  or are in  material conflict  by reason of
applicable  law with  any other  activities of  a type  and  nature presently
carried  on by  it or  its  affiliate or  (ii) upon  the satisfaction  of the
following conditions:    (a) the  Master Servicer  has  proposed a  successor
servicer to the  Trustee in writing and  such proposed successor  servicer is
reasonably acceptable to the Trustee; (b) the Rating  Agencies have confirmed
to the  Trustee that the appointment  of such proposed successor  servicer as
the Master  Servicer will not  result in the  reduction or withdrawal  of the
then  current rating  of the  Certificates; and  (c) such  proposed successor
servicer is  reasonably  acceptable to  the  Certificate Insurer.    No  such
resignation  will become effective until the  Trustee or a successor servicer
has assumed the Master Servicer's obligations and duties under the Agreement.

     The Master Servicer may perform any of its duties and  obligations under
the Agreement  through one or  more subservicers  or delegates, which  may be
affiliates of the Master Servicer. Notwithstanding any  such arrangement, the
Master  Servicer will  remain  liable and  obligated to  the Trustee  and the
Certificateholders for the Master Servicer's duties and obligations under the
Agreement,  without any diminution of  such duties and  obligations and as if
the Master Servicer itself were performing such duties and obligations.  

     The Agreement provides that the Master Servicer will indemnify the Trust
Fund and the Trustee from and against any loss, liability, expense, damage or
injury suffered  or sustained as a result of the Master Servicer's actions or
omissions in connection with the servicing and administration of the Mortgage
Loans  which are  not in  accordance with  the provisions  of the  Agreement.
Under the Agreement, the Transferor  will indemnify an injured party  for the
entire amount of any losses, claims, damages or liabilities arising out of or
based on the  Agreement (other than losses resulting from  defaults under the
Mortgage  Loans).   In the  event of  an Event  of Servicing  Termination (as
defined below)  resulting in  the assumption  of servicing  obligations by  a
successor Master Servicer,  the successor Master Servicer will  indemnify the
Transferor for any losses, claims, damages and liabilities  of the Transferor
as described in this  paragraph arising from the successor  Master Servicer's
actions or  omissions.   The Agreement provides  that neither  Provident, the
Transferor nor the  Master Servicer nor their  directors, officers, employees
or agents will be under any other  liability to the Trust Fund, the  Trustee,
the Certificateholders  or any  other  person for  any  action taken  or  for
refraining  from  taking any  action  pursuant  to the  Agreement.   However,
neither Provident,  the Transferor nor the Master  Servicer will be protected
against any liability which  would otherwise be imposed by  reason of willful
misconduct, bad faith or gross negligence of Provident, the Transferor or the
Master Servicer in  the performance of its  duties under the Agreement  or by
reason of reckless disregard of its obligations thereunder.  In addition, the
Agreement provides that the Master Servicer will  not be under any obligation
to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which is not incidental to
its servicing responsibilities  under the Agreement and which  in its opinion
may expose it to any expense or  liability.  The Master Servicer may, in  its
sole discretion, undertake any  such legal action which it may deem necessary
or desirable with respect to the  Agreement and the rights and duties of  the
parties thereto and the interest of the Certificateholders thereunder. 

     Any  corporation  into which  the  Master  Servicer  may  be  merged  or
consolidated, or  any corporation  resulting from  any merger,  conversion or
consolidation  to which  the  Master  Servicer  shall  be  a  party,  or  any
corporation succeeding  to the business  of the Master Servicer  shall be the
successor of the  Master Servicer hereunder, without the  execution or filing
of  any paper or  any further act on  the part of any  of the parties hereto,
anything in the Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding.  


EVENTS OF SERVICING TERMINATION

     "Events of Servicing Termination" will consist  of:  (i) any failure  by
the Master Servicer to deposit in the Collection Account any deposit required
to be made  under the Agreement, which failure continues  unremedied for five
business  days after  the giving  of written  notice of  such failure  to the
Master Servicer by the Trustee, or to  the Master Servicer and the Trustee by
the  Certificate  Insurer  or  Certificateholders  evidencing  an  aggregate,
undivided  interest in  the Trust  Fund of  at least  25% of  the Certificate
Principal Balance; (ii) any failure by the Master Servicer duly to observe or
perform in  any material respect any other of  its covenants or agreements in
the Agreement  which, in  each  case, materially  and adversely  affects  the
interests of the Certificateholders or the Certificate  Insurer and continues
unremedied  for 60 days after the giving of written notice of such failure to
the Master Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and the Trustee
by  the Certificate  Insurer or  Certificateholders evidencing  an aggregate,
undivided  interest in  the Trust  Fund of  at least  25% of  the Certificate
Principal Balance;  or (iii)  certain events  of insolvency,  readjustment of
debt, marshalling of assets and  liabilities or similar proceedings  relating
to  the Master Servicer and certain actions by the Master Servicer indicating
insolvency,  reorganization  or inability  to  pay  its obligations.    Under
certain other  circumstances,  the Certificate  Insurer with  the consent  of
holders of Investor Certificates evidencing  an aggregate, undivided interest
in the  Trust Fund of at least  51% of the Certificate  Principal Balance may
deliver written notice  to the Master Servicer terminating all the rights and
obligations of the Master Servicer under the Agreement.

     Notwithstanding the  foregoing,  a delay  in or  failure of  performance
referred to  under clause  (i) above  for a  period of ten  Business Days  or
referred  to under clause (ii) above for  a period of 60 Business Days, shall
not constitute  an Event of  Servicing Termination if  such delay or  failure
could not  be prevented by the exercise of reasonable diligence by the Master
Servicer and  such delay  or failure  was caused by  an act  of God  or other
similar  occurrence.    Upon the  occurrence  of any  such  event  the Master
Servicer shall not be relieved from using its  best  efforts  to  perform its 
obligations in  a timely manner in accordance with the terms of the Agreement 
and  the   Master  Servicer  shall    provide  the   Trustee,  Provident, the 
Transferor, the Certificate Insurer and the Certificateholders prompt  notice 
of such failure or delay by it, together with a description of its efforts to 
so perform its obligations.


RIGHTS UPON AN EVENT OF SERVICING TERMINATION

     So long as an Event of Servicing Termination  remains unremedied, either
the  Trustee,   or  Certificateholders  evidencing  an  aggregate,  undivided
interest in  the Trust  Fund of  at least  51% of  the Certificate  Principal
Balance or  the Certificate  Insurer,  may terminate  all of  the rights  and
obligations of  the Master  Servicer under  the Agreement and  in and  to the
Mortgage   Loans,   whereupon  the   Trustee   will   succeed   to  all   the
responsibilities, duties  and liabilities  of the  Master Servicer  under the
Agreement and will be entitled to  similar compensation arrangements.  In the
event that the Trustee would be  obligated to succeed the Master Servicer but
is unwilling  or unable so  to act, it  may appoint, or  petition a  court of
competent jurisdiction  for the appointment  of, a  housing and home  finance
institution or  other mortgage  loan or home  equity loan  servicer with  all
licenses and permits required to  perform its obligations under the Agreement
and having  a  net  worth of  at  least  $__________ and  acceptable  to  the
Certificate  Insurer to  act as  successor to the  Master Servicer  under the
Agreement. Pending such appointment, the Trustee will be  obligated to act in
such capacity unless  prohibited by law.  Such successor  will be entitled to
receive  the same compensation that the  Master Servicer would otherwise have
received (or such lesser  compensation as the Trustee and such  successor may
agree).  A receiver or  conservator for the Master Servicer may  be empowered
to prevent  the termination and replacement of  the Master Servicer where the
only Event of Servicing Termination that has occurred is an Insolvency Event.


AMENDMENT

     The Agreement may be amended from time to  time by Provident, the Master
Servicer and the Trustee and with the consent of the Certificate Insurer, but
without  the consent  of the  Certificateholders, to  cure any  ambiguity, to
correct or supplement any  provisions therein which may be  inconsistent with
any other  provisions of the Agreement, to add to the duties of Provident, or
the  Master Servicer or to  add or amend  any provisions of  the Agreement as
required by the Rating Agencies in order to maintain or improve any rating of
the Certificates  (it being understood  that, after obtaining  the ratings in
effect  on the  Closing Date,  neither the  Transferor,  the Trustee  nor the
Master Servicer is obligated to obtain, maintain, or improve any such rating)
or to add any other  provisions with respect to matters or  questions arising
under  the Agreement which shall  not be inconsistent  with the provisions of
the Agreement, provided that such action will not, as evidenced by an opinion
of  counsel,   materially  and   adversely  affect  the   interests  of   any
Certificateholder  or  the  Certificate  Insurer;  provided,  that  any  such
amendment  will  not  be  deemed  to  materially  and  adversely  affect  the
Certificateholders and no  such opinion will be  required to be  delivered if
the person  requesting  such  amendment  obtains a  letter  from  the  Rating
Agencies stating that such amendment would not result in a downgrading of the
then current rating  of the Certificates.  The Agreement  may also be amended
from time to time  by Provident, the Master  Servicer, and the Trustee,  with
the consent of Certificateholders evidencing an aggregate, undivided interest
in the Trust  Fund of at least  51% of the Certificate  Principal Balance and
the Certificate  Insurer  for the  purpose  of adding  any provisions  to  or
changing in any manner or eliminating any of  the provisions of the Agreement
or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Certificateholders,  provided
that no such amendment will (i) reduce in any manner the  amount of, or delay
the  timing of, collections of payments  on the Certificates or distributions
or payments under the Policy which are required to be made on any Certificate
without the  consent of  the holder of  such Certificate  or (ii)  reduce the
aforesaid percentage required to consent  to any such amendment, without  the
consent of the holders of all Certificates then outstanding.  


TERMINATION; RETIREMENT OF THE CERTIFICATES

     The  Trust Fund will  terminate on  the Distribution Date  following the
later of (A) payment in full of all  amounts owing to the Certificate Insurer
and (B) the  earliest of (i) the  Distribution Date on which  the Certificate
Principal Balance has been reduced  to zero, (ii) the final payment  or other
liquidation of the  last Mortgage Loan in the Trust  Fund, (iii) the optional
transfer to the  Transferor of the Certificates, as described  below and (iv)
the Distribution Date in ____________ 20__.

     The Certificates will be subject to  optional transfer to the Transferor
on any  Distribution Date after the Certificate  Principal Balance is reduced
to an amount less than or equal to 5% of the Original Certificate Principal 
Balance  and  all amounts  due  and  owing  to the  Certificate  Insurer  and
unreimbursed draws on the Policy, together with interest thereon, as provided
under the Insurance  Agreement, have been paid.   The transfer price  will be
equal to the sum of the outstanding Certificate Principal Balance and accrued
and unpaid interest thereon at the Certificate Rate through the day preceding
the  final Distribution  Date.   In no  event, however,  will the  Trust Fund
created by  the Agreement continue for more than 21  years after the death of
certain individuals named in the Agreement.  Written notice of termination of
the  Agreement  will be  given  to  each  Certificateholder,  and  the  final
distribution  will  be made  only  upon  surrender  and cancellation  of  the
Certificates at an  office or agency appointed  by the Trustee which  will be
specified in the notice of termination.  

     In  addition, the Trust  Fund may be  liquidated as a  result of certain
events of bankruptcy, insolvency or  receivership relating to the Transferor.
See "--Rapid Amortization Events" herein.
THE TRUSTEE

     (                  ), a ____________________________ with its  principal
place  of business  in  ________,  has been  named  Trustee  pursuant to  the
Agreement.

     The  commercial  bank  or  trust  company serving  as  Trustee  may  own
Certificates  and have normal  banking relationships  with Provident  and the
Certificate Insurer and/or their affiliates.

     The Trustee  may resign at  any time, in  which event Provident  will be
obligated  to appoint  a successor  Trustee, as  approved by  the Certificate
Insurer.  Provident may also remove  the Trustee if the Trustee ceases to  be
eligible to  continue as such under  the Agreement or if  the Trustee becomes
insolvent.   Upon becoming  aware of  such circumstances,  Provident will  be
obligated  to appoint  a successor  Trustee, as  approved by  the Certificate
Insurer.   Any resignation  or removal of  the Trustee  and appointment  of a
successor   Trustee  will  not  become  effective  until  acceptance  of  the
appointment by the successor Trustee.  

     No holder of  a Certificate will have  any right under the  Agreement to
institute  any proceeding  with respect to  the Agreement  unless such holder
previously has given  to the  Trustee written  notice of  default and  unless
Certificateholders evidencing an aggregate,  undivided interest in the  Trust
Fund of  at least 51% of the Certificate  Principal Balance have made written
requests  upon the Trustee  to institute such  proceeding in its  own name as
Trustee thereunder and  have offered to the Trustee  reasonable indemnity and
the Trustee  for  60 days  has neglected  or  refused to  institute any  such
proceeding.  The Trustee  will be under no obligation to  exercise any of the
trusts or powers vested  in it by the Agreement or  to make any investigation
of  matters  arising  thereunder  or  to  institute, conduct  or  defend  any
litigation  thereunder or  in  relation  thereto  at the  request,  order  or
direction of any  of the  Certificateholders, unless such  Certificateholders
have  offered to  the Trustee  reasonable security  or indemnity  against the
cost, expenses and liabilities which may be incurred therein or thereby.  
CERTAIN ACTIVITIES

     The  Trust Fund  will not:   (i)  borrow money;  (ii) make  loans; (iii)
invest  in securities for the purpose  of exercising control; (iv) underwrite
securities; (v) except as  provided in the Agreement, engage  in the purchase
and sale (or turnover) of investments; (vi) offer  securities in exchange for
property (except Certificates for the Mortgage Loans); or (vii) repurchase or
otherwise reacquire its securities.   See "--Evidence as to Compliance" above
for information regarding reports as to the compliance by the Master Servicer
with the terms of the Agreement.


                               USE OF PROCEEDS

     The net proceeds  to be received from the sale  of the Certificates will
be applied by Provident towards general corporate purposes.


                       FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES
GENERAL

     The following  discussion, which  summarizes the  material U.S.  federal
income  tax  aspects  of  the  purchase,  ownership  and  disposition  of the
Certificates,  is based  on the  provisions of the  Internal Revenue  Code of
1986,  as amended  (the  "Code"), the  Treasury  Regulations thereunder,  and
published rulings and court decisions in effect as of the date hereof, all of
which  are subject to change,  possibly retroactively.   This discussion does
not address every  aspect of the U.S.  federal income tax  laws which may  be
relevant  to  Certificate  Owners  in  light  of  their  personal  investment
circumstances or  to certain types  of Certificate Owners subject  to special
treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws (for example, banks and life
insurance  companies).    Accordingly,  investors  should  consult  their tax
advisors  regarding U.S.  federal, state,  local, foreign  and any  other tax
consequences to them of investing in the Certificates.

CHARACTERIZATION OF THE CERTIFICATES AS INDEBTEDNESS

     Based on the application  of existing law to  the facts as set  forth in
the Agreement and other  relevant documents and assuming compliance  with the
terms  of  the  Agreement  as  in  effect on  the  date  of  issuance  of the
Certificates, Brown  &  Wood LLP,  special  tax  counsel to  Provident  ("Tax
Counsel"), is of  the opinion that the  Certificates will be treated  as debt
instruments for federal income  tax purposes as of  such date.   Accordingly,
upon  issuance,  the Certificates  will be  treated  as "Debt  Securities" as
described in the  Prospectus.  See "Federal  Income Tax Consequences" in  the
Prospectus.

     The Transferor and the Certificateholders express in the Agreement their
intent  that, for  all tax  purposes, the  Certificates will  be indebtedness
secured  by  the   Mortgage  Loans.    The  Transferor,   Provident  and  the
Certificateholders, by accepting the Certificates, and each Certificate Owner
by its acquisition of a beneficial  interest in a Certificate, have agreed to
treat the Certificates  as indebtedness for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
However, because  different  criteria  are  used  to  determine  the  non-tax
accounting  characterization of  the transaction,  the Transferor  intends to
treat this transaction as a sale of an interest in the Asset Balances of  the
Mortgage Loans for financial accounting and certain regulatory purposes.

     In general, whether for  U.S. federal income tax purposes  a transaction
constitutes  a sale of property or a  loan, the repayment of which is secured
by property, is a question of fact, the resolution of which is based upon the
economic substance  of the transaction rather than its  form or the manner in
which it is labeled.  While the  Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS") and the
courts have set forth several factors to be taken into account in determining
whether  the substance of  a transaction is  a sale of property  or a secured
loan,  the  primary factor  in  making  this  determination  is  whether  the
transferee has assumed the risk of loss or other economic burdens relating to
the property and has obtained the benefits of ownership thereof.  Tax Counsel
has analyzed and relied on  several factors in reaching its opinion  that the
weight  of the benefits  and burdens of  ownership of the  Mortgage Loans has
been  retained by  the  Transferor  and  has  not  been  transferred  to  the
Certificate Owners.

     In some  instances, courts  have held that  a taxpayer  is bound  by the
particular form it has chosen for a transaction, even if the substance of the
transaction does not accord with its form.   Tax Counsel has advised that the
rationale of those cases will not apply to this transaction, because the form
of the transaction as reflected in the  operative provisions of the documents
either  accords  with the  characterization of  the  Certificates as  debt or
otherwise makes the rationale of those cases inapplicable to this situation.
TAXATION OF INTEREST INCOME OF CERTIFICATE OWNERS

     Assuming that the Certificate Owners are holders of debt obligations for
U.S. federal income tax purposes, the Certificates generally will  be taxable
as Debt Securities.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences" in the Prospectus.

     While it  is not anticipated that  the Certificates will be  issued at a
greater  than  de  minimis  discount, under  Treasury  regulations  (the "OID
Regulations")  it is  possible that  the  Certificates could  nevertheless be
deemed  to  have been  issued  with original  issue  discount ("OID")  if the
interest  were  not  treated  as  "unconditionally  payable"  under  the  OID
Regulations.  If such regulations were to apply, all of the taxable income to
be recognized with respect to the  Certificates would be includible in income
of  Certificate Owners as OID, but  would not be  includible again  when  the 
interest  is actually received.   See  "Federal  Income   Tax  Consequences--
Taxation of Debt  Securities; Interest  and   Acquisition  Discount"  in  the  
Prospectus  for  a  discussion  of  the application of  the OID rules  if the 
Certificates  are in  fact issued at  a  greater than de minimis  discount or 
are treated  as having been issued  with  OID under the OID Regulations.  For 
purposes  of  calculating  OID,  it  is  likely that the Certificates will be 
treated   as   Pay-Through  Securities.    POSSIBLE   CLASSIFICATION  OF  THE 
CERTIFICATES AS A PARTNERSHIP  OR ASSOCIATION TAXABLE AS A CORPORATION

     The opinion of Tax Counsel is not binding on the  courts or the IRS.  It
is possible  that the IRS  could assert that, for  purposes of the  Code, the
transaction contemplated by this Prospectus with respect  to the Certificates
constitutes a  sale of the  Mortgage Loans  (or an interest  therein) to  the
Certificate  Owners  and   that  the  proper  classification   of  the  legal
relationship between the Transferor and the Certificate Owners resulting from
this  transaction is that  of a partnership or  a publicly traded partnership
treated as a corporation.  Since Tax Counsel has opined that the Certificates
will be treated as  indebtedness in the  hands of the Certificateholders  for
U.S. federal income tax  purposes, the Transferor will not attempt  to comply
with  U.S.   federal  income   tax  reporting   requirements  applicable   to
partnerships or corporations.

     If it were determined that this transaction created an entity classified
as a  publicly traded partnership  taxable as a  corporation, the  Trust Fund
would be subject to U.S. federal income tax  at corporate income tax rates on
the income it derives from the Mortgage Loans, which would reduce the amounts
available for distribution  to the Certificate Owners.  Cash distributions to
the  Certificate  Owners generally  would  be  treated as  dividends  for tax
purposes to the extent of such corporation's earnings and profits.

     If the  transaction were treated  as creating a partnership  between the
Certificate Owners  and the Transferor,  the partnership itself  would not be
subject to U.S. federal income tax  (unless it were to be characterized as  a
publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation); rather, the Transferor
and  each Certificate Owner  would be taxed  individually on their respective
distributive shares of the partnership's  income, gain, loss, deductions  and
credits.   The amount  and timing of  items of income  and deductions  of the
Certificate Owner could  differ if the  Certificates were held to  constitute
partnership  interests rather  than indebtedness.   Assuming that  all of the
provisions  of the  Agreement, as  in  effect on  the date  of  issuance, are
complied with, it is the opinion of Tax Counsel that the  Trust Fund will not
be  treated  as   either  an  association  or  a  partnership  taxable  as  a
corporation.


POSSIBLE CLASSIFICATION AS A TAXABLE MORTGAGE POOL

     In relevant part,  Section 7701(i) of the Code provides  that any entity
(or  a portion  of  an entity)  that  is a  "taxable mortgage  pool"  will be
classified  as a  taxable corporation  and will  not be  permitted to  file a
consolidated U.S.  federal income tax return  with another corporation.   Any
entity (or a  portion of any entity)  will be a taxable mortgage  pool if (i)
substantially all of its assets consist of debt instruments, more than 50% of
which are  real estate mortgages, (ii)  the entity is the  obligor under debt
obligations with  two or more  maturities, and (iii)  under the terms  of the
entity's  debt obligations (or  an underlying arrangement),  payments on such
debt obligations  bear a  relationship to  the debt instruments  held by  the
entity.

     Assuming that all of  the provisions of the  Agreement, as in effect  on
the  date of issuance, are complied with,  Tax Counsel is of the opinion that
the arrangement  created by the Agreement will not be a taxable mortgage pool
under Section  7701(i) of  the Code because  only one  class of  indebtedness
secured by the Mortgage Loans is being issued.

     The opinion of Tax Counsel is not binding on the  IRS or the courts.  If
the IRS were to contend successfully  (or future regulations were to provide)
that  the arrangement  created by the  Agreement is a  taxable mortgage pool,
such arrangement would be subject to U.S. federal corporate income tax on its
taxable income  generated by ownership  of the  Mortgage Loans.   Such a  tax
might reduce  amounts available for distributions to Certificate Owners.  The
amount of such a tax  would depend upon whether distributions to  Certificate
Owners  would be  deductible  as interest  expense in  computing  the taxable
income of such an arrangement as a taxable mortgage pool.


FOREIGN INVESTORS

     In general, subject to certain exceptions, Tax Counsel is of the opinion
that interest (including OID)  paid on a  Certificate to a nonresident  alien
individual,  foreign corporation  or other  non-United States  person is  not
subject  to U.S.  federal income  tax,  provided that  such  interest is  not
effectively connected with a trade or business of the recipient in the United
States  and  the  Certificate  Owner provides  the  required  foreign  person
information  certification.    See  "Federal  Income  Tax   Consequences--Tax
Treatment of Foreign Investors" in the Prospectus.

     If the interests of the Certificate Owners were deemed to be partnership
interests,  the partnership would  be required, on a  quarterly basis, to pay
withholding  tax equal  to the  product, for  each foreign  partner,  of such
foreign partner's distributive share of "effectively connected" income of the
partnership multiplied by the highest rate of  tax applicable to that foreign
partner.   In  addition, such  foreign  partner would  be  subject to  branch
profits tax.   Each non-foreign partner  would be required to  certify to the
partnership that  it is not  a foreign person.   The  tax withheld from  each
foreign  partner would be credited against such foreign partner's U.S. income
tax liability.

     If the  Trust  Fund were  taxable  as a  corporation,  distributions  to
foreign  persons, to  the  extent treated  as dividends,  would  generally be
subject  to withholding at the rate of 30%,  unless such rate were reduced by
an applicable tax treaty.
BACKUP WITHHOLDING

     Certain Certificate Owners may  be subject to backup withholding  at the
rate  of  31% with  respect  to  interest paid  on  the  Certificates if  the
Certificate  Owners, upon issuance, fail to  supply the Trustee or his broker
with  his taxpayer  identification  number,  furnish  an  incorrect  taxpayer
identification  number,   fail  to  report  interest,   dividends,  or  other
"reportable payments" (as  defined in the  Code) properly, or, under  certain
circumstances, fail to  provide the  Trustee or his  broker with a  certified
statement,  under  penalty  of perjury,  that  he is  not  subject  to backup
withholding.

     The Trustee will be required to report annually to the IRS, and to  each
Certificateholder of record, the amount of interest paid (and OID accrued, if
any) on  the Certificates  (and  the amount  of  interest withheld  for  U.S.
federal income  taxes, if any)  for each calendar  year, except as  to exempt
holders  (generally,  holders  that  are  corporations,  certain   tax-exempt
organizations  or nonresident aliens  who provide  certification as  to their
status as nonresidents).  As  long as the only "Certificateholder" of  record
is Cede, as nominee for DTC, Certificate  Owners and the IRS will receive tax
and  other  information  including  the   amount  of  interest  paid  on  the
Certificates  owned from Participants  and Indirect Participants  rather than
from  the Trustee.   (The  Trustee,  however, will  respond  to requests  for
necessary  information  to  enable  Participants,  Indirect  Participants and
certain  other  persons   to  complete  their  reports.)     Each  non-exempt
Certificate Owner  will be required to  provide, under penalty  of perjury, a
certificate on  IRS Form W-9  containing his  or her  name, address,  correct
federal taxpayer identification number and a  statement that he or she is not
subject  to backup withholding.  Should a nonexempt Certificate Owner fail to
provide the required certification, the Participants or Indirect Participants
(or the  Paying Agent) will be required to  withhold 31% of the interest (and
principal) otherwise payable to the holder, and remit the withheld amount  to
the IRS as a credit against the holder's federal income tax liability.

                                 STATE TAXES

     Provident makes  no representations  regarding the  tax consequences  of
purchase, ownership or disposition of the  Certificates under the tax laws of
any state.  Investors considering  an investment in  the Certificates  should
consult their own tax advisors regarding such tax consequences.

     ALL  INVESTORS  SHOULD CONSULT  THEIR  OWN  TAX  ADVISORS REGARDING  THE
FEDERAL, STATE,  LOCAL OR  FOREIGN INCOME TAX  CONSEQUENCES OF  THE PURCHASE,
OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF THE CERTIFICATES.


                             ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     Any Plan fiduciary which proposes  to cause a Plan to acquire any of the
Certificates should  consult with its counsel  with respect to  the potential
consequences under  the Employee Retirement  Income Security Act of  1974, as
amended ("ERISA"),  and the Code, of  the Plans acquisition  and ownership of
such Certificates.  See "ERISA Considerations" in the Prospectus.

     The   U.S.  Department  of   Labor  has   granted  to  _________________
("Underwriter")  Prohibited  Transaction  Exemption _____  (the  "Exemption")
which  exempts  from the  application  of  the prohibited  transaction  rules
transactions relating to (1)  the acquisition, sale  and holding by Plans  of
certain  certificates representing  an undivided  interest in  certain asset-
backed pass-through trusts, with respect to  which Underwriter or any of  its
affiliates  is  the sole  underwriter  or the  manager  or co-manager  of the
underwriting  syndicate; and (2)  the servicing, operation  and management of
such asset-backed pass-through trusts,  provided that the general  conditions
and certain  other conditions set forth in the  Exemption are satisfied.  The
Exemption  will  apply  to  the  acquisition,  holding   and  resale  of  the
Certificates by a Plan provided that certain conditions are met.

     For a general description  of the Exemption and the conditions that must
be satisfied for the  Exemption to apply,  see "ERISA Considerations" in  the
Prospectus.

     The  Underwriter  believes   that  the  Exemption  will   apply  to  the
acquisition and holding of the Certificates  by Plans and that all conditions
of the Exemption other than those within the control of the investors will be
met.

     Any Plan fiduciary  considering whether to purchase any  Certificates on
behalf of a Plan should consult with its  counsel regarding the applicability
of the  fiduciary  responsibility and  prohibited  transaction provisions  of
ERISA and the Code to such investment.  Among other things, before purchasing
any  Certificates,   a  fiduciary  of   a  Plan  subject  to   the  fiduciary
responsibility provisions of ERISA or an employee benefit plan subject to the
prohibited   transaction  provisions  of   the  Code  should   make  its  own
determination as to the availability of  the exemptive relief provided in the
Exemption,  and  also  consider  the  availability  of any  other  prohibited
transaction exemptions.


                       LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     Although, as  a condition  to their issuance,  the Certificates  will be
rated in the highest rating category of the Rating Agencies, the Certificates
will  not  constitute  "mortgage  related securities"  for  purposes  of  the
Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act  of 1984 ("SMMEA"), because not all
of   the  Mortgages  securing   the  Mortgage  Loans   are  first  mortgages.
Accordingly, many institutions  with legal authority to  invest in comparably
rated securities based on first mortgage loans may not  be legally authorized
to invest  in the Certificates,  which because  they evidence interests  in a
pool  that  includes   junior  mortgage  loans  are   not  "mortgage  related
securities" under SMMEA.  See "Legal Investment" in the Prospectus.


                                 UNDERWRITING

     Subject to  the  terms and  conditions  set  forth in  the  underwriting
agreement, dated ___________,  199_ (the  "Underwriting Agreement"),  between
Provident and (Underwriter) (the "Underwriter"), Provident has agreed to sell
to the Underwriter, and the Underwriter has agreed to purchase from Provident
all the Certificates.  

     In the  Underwriting Agreement, the  Underwriter has agreed,  subject to
the terms and conditions  set forth therein, to purchase all the Certificates
offered hereby if any of the Certificates are purchased.

     Provident has been advised by the Underwriter that it proposes initially
to  offer the Certificates to  the public in Europe and  the United States at
the offering  price set forth on the cover page hereof and to certain dealers
at such  price less  a discount  not in  excess of ____%  of the  Certificate
denominations.  The  Underwriter may  allow and  such dealers  may reallow  a
discount not in  excess of _____% of the Certificate denominations to certain
other dealers.  After the initial public offering, the public offering price,
such concessions and such discounts may be changed.

     The  Underwriting Agreement provides  that Provident  will indemnify the
Underwriter against  certain civil  liabilities, including  liabilities under
the Act.

                                LEGAL MATTERS

     Certain legal  matters with respect  to the Certificates  will be passed
upon for  Provident by  Brown &  Wood LLP,  New York,  New York  and Keating,
Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L., Cincinnati, Ohio and for the Underwriter by (    ).


                                   EXPERTS

     The consolidated  balance  sheets of  (Insurer) and  Subsidiaries as  of
___________, 199_ and 199_ and the related consolidated statements of income,
changes in  shareholder's equity, and cash flows for  each of the three years
in  the period  ended ___________,  199_, incorporated  by reference  in this
Prospectus Supplement,  have  been incorporated  herein  in reliance  on  the
report  of ________________________,  independent accountants,  given  on the
authority of that firm as experts in accounting and auditing.


                                   RATINGS

     It is  a condition to issuance  that the Certificates be  rated "___" by
_____ and "___" by _________.

     A  securities  rating  addresses  the   likelihood  of  the  receipt  by
Certificateholders of distributions on the Mortgage Loans.   The rating takes
into  consideration  the  characteristics  of  the  Mortgage  Loans  and  the
structural,  legal and  tax aspects  associated with  the Certificates.   The
ratings on the Certificates do not, however,  constitute statements regarding
the likelihood  or  frequency of  prepayments on  the Mortgage  Loans or  the
possibility that  Certificateholders might  realize a lower  than anticipated
yield.

     The  ratings assigned to the Certificates will depend primarily upon the
creditworthiness  of the  Certificate Insurer.    Any reduction  in a  rating
assigned  to the claims-paying  ability of the  Certificate Insurer below the
ratings initially assigned to the  Certificates may result in a  reduction of
one or more of the ratings assigned to the Certificates.

     A securities  rating  is  not a  recommendation  to buy,  sell  or  hold
securities and may be  subject to revision or  withdrawal at any time by  the
assigning  rating organization.   Each securities rating  should be evaluated
independently of similar ratings on different securities.

     Provident has not requested a rating  of the Certificates by any  rating
agency other than the Rating Agencies; there can be no assurance, however, as
to whether any other rating agency will rate the Certificates or, if it does,
what  rating would  be  assigned  by such  other  rating agency.  The  rating
assigned by such other rating agency to the Certificates could be  lower than
the respective ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies.


                            INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS

                                                                         Page
                                                                       ----


Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-39
Additional Balances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Alternative Principal Payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-41
Beneficial owner  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
BIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Book-Entry Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
Business Day  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39, S-44
Capitalized Interest Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-45
Cede  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-35
CEDEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
CEDEL Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Certificate Insurer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11
Certificate Owners  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-32
Certificate Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Certificate Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-10, S-40
Certificateholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33, S-53
Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-4
Chase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7
Citibank  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7
Closing Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-1, S-10, S-40
Code  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Collection Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-37
Collection Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-40
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5
Cooperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Credit Limit  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5
Credit Limit Utilization Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Credit Line Agreements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3, S-22
Cut-Off Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Cut-Off Date Pool Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Defective Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Definitive Certificate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
Determination Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-37
Dissolution Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-1, S-10, S-39
DTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-32
Due Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Eligible Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Eligible Investments  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
ERISA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15, S-54
Euroclear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Euroclear Operator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Euroclear Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
European Depositaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-32
Events of Servicing Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Exemption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-54
Financial Intermediary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
Fixed Allocation Percentage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9
Funding Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-45
Guaranteed Distributions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-43
Guaranteed Principal Distribution Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-43
Index Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Indirect Participants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
Insurance Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-43
Interest Collections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-38
Interest Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-40
Invested Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Investor Fixed Allocation Percentage  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9
Investor Floating Allocation Percentage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-38
Investor Interest Collections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-38
Investor Loss Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-40
Investor Principal Collections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-39
IRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
LIBOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10
LIBOR Business Day  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Liquidated Mortgage Loan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Liquidation Loss Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-40
Liquidation Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Loan Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-22
Managed Amortization Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-41
Margin  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Maximum Principal Payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-41
Maximum Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-22
Minimum Transferor Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-37
Mortgage Loan Schedule  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-36, S-37
Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Mortgaged Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Net Liquidation Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-38
OID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
OID Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Original Certificate Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Original Invested Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-32
Overcollateralization Amount  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9
Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
Paying Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Percentage Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Plan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Policy  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Pool Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3, S-39
Pool Factor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-31
Pre-Funded Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-44
Pre-Funding Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-44
Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Principal Collections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-38
Provident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3, S-19
Rapid Amortization Event  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Rating Agency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Receipt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Received  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Record Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Reference Bank Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-35
Relevant Depositary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-32
Required Overcollateralization Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-33
SAIF  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Scheduled Principal Collections Distribution Amount . . . . . . .  S-10, S-41
Servicing Fee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13
Servicing Fee Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-47
SMMEA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15, S-54
Spread Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-43
STIFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-38
Subsequent Transfer Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-30
Subservicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-19
Tax Counsel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Telerate Screen Page 3750 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Terms and Conditions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-34
Transfer Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-37
Transfer Deficiency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
Transfer Deposit Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
Transferor  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Transferor Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-4, S-32
Transferor Principal Collections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-39
Trust Fund  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-1, S-3
Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3, S-14
Underwriter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-54
Underwriting Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-54


                                   ANNEX I

        GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES

     Except  in  certain limited  circumstances,  the  globally offered  Home
Equity   Loan  Asset   Backed  Certificates,   Series  199_-_   (the  "Global


Securities") will  be available only  in book-entry form.   Investors in  the
Global  Securities  may  hold  such  Global  Securities  through any  of  The
Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), CEDEL or Euroclear.  The Global  Securities
will be tradeable as  home market instruments in  both the European and  U.S.
domestic markets.  Initial settlement and all secondary trades will settle in
same-day funds.

     Secondary market  trading  between investors  holding Global  Securities
through  CEDEL  and  Euroclear  will be  conducted  in  the  ordinary way  in
accordance with their normal rules and operating procedures and in accordance
with conventional eurobond practice (i.e., seven calendar day settlement).

     Secondary  market trading  between investors  holding Global  Securities
through  DTC  will  be  conducted  according  to  the  rules  and  procedures
applicable to  U.S. corporate  debt obligations  and prior  Home Equity  Loan
Asset Backed Certificates issues.

     Secondary cross-market  trading  between  CEDEL  or  Euroclear  and  DTC
Participants holding  Certificates will  be effected  on a  delivery-against-
payment  basis through the respective Depositaries of CEDEL and Euroclear (in
such capacity) and as DTC Participants.

     Non-U.S.  holders (as  described  below) of  Global  Securities will  be
subject  to  U.S.  withholding  taxes   unless  such  holders  meet   certain
requirements and  deliver appropriate  U.S. tax documents  to the  securities
clearing organizations or their participants.
INITIAL SETTLEMENT

     All Global Securities will be held in book-entry form by DTC in the name
of  Cede &  Co.  as  nominee of  DTC.   Investors'  interests  in the  Global
Securities will be represented through financial institutions acting on their
behalf as direct  and indirect Participants in  DTC.  As a  result, CEDEL and
Euroclear  will hold positions on behalf  of their participants through their
respective Depositaries, which in  turn will hold such positions  in accounts
as DTC Participants.

     Investors  electing to  hold their  Global Securities  through DTC  will
follow the  settlement practices applicable  to prior Home  Equity Loan Asset
Backed Certificates  issues.   Investor securities custody  accounts will  be
credited  with  their holdings  against  payment  in  same-day funds  on  the
settlement date.

     Investors  electing to  hold their  Global Securities  through CEDEL  or
Euroclear  accounts  will  follow  the  settlement procedures  applicable  to
conventional eurobonds,  except  that  there  will  be  no  temporary  global
security and no "lock-up"  or restricted period.   Global Securities will  be
credited to  the securities custody  accounts on the settlement  date against
payment in same-day funds.


SECONDARY MARKET TRADING

     Since the purchaser determines the place of delivery, it is important to
establish at  the time of the  trade where both the  purchaser's and seller's
accounts are  located to ensure  that settlement can  be made on  the desired
value date.

     Trading  between DTC Participants.  Secondary market trading between DTC
Participants will  be settled using  the procedures applicable  to prior Home
Equity Loan Asset Backed Certificates issues in same-day funds.

     Trading between  CEDEL and/or Euroclear Participants.   Secondary market
trading between CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants  will be settled
using the procedures applicable to conventional eurobonds in same-day funds.

     Trading  between DTC  seller and  CEDEL  or Euroclear  purchaser.   When
Global Securities are to be transferred from the account of a DTC Participant
to  the  account  of a  CEDEL  Participant or  a  Euroclear  Participant, the
purchaser  will send  instructions  to  CEDEL or  Euroclear  through a  CEDEL
Participant or  Euroclear  Participant at  least one  business  day prior  to
settlement.  CEDEL  or Euroclear will instruct the  respective Depositary, as
the case may be, to  receive the Global Securities against payment.   Payment
will include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and including the
last coupon payment date to  and excluding the settlement date, on  the basis
of the  actual number of days  in such accrual  period and a year  assumed to
consist of 360  days.  For transactions  settling on the  31st of the  month,
payment will include  interest accrued to and excluding the  first day of the
following month.  Payment will  then be made by the respective  Depositary of
the DTC  Participant's  account against  delivery of  the Global  Securities.
After settlement has been  completed, the Global Securities will  be credited
to the respective  clearing system and by the clearing  system, in accordance
with  its  usual  procedures,  to   the  CEDEL  Participant's  or   Euroclear
Participant's account.    The securities  credit  will appear  the  next  day
(European time) and the cash debt will be back-valued to, and the interest on
the Global  Securities will accrue from,  the value date (which  would be the
preceding day when settlement  occurred in New York).   If settlement is  not
completed on the  intended value date (i.e.,  the trade fails), the  CEDEL or
Euroclear cash debt will be valued instead as of the actual settlement date.

     CEDEL  Participants  and  Euroclear  Participants  will   need  to  make
available to the  respective clearing systems the funds  necessary to process
same-day  funds  settlement.  The  most  direct  means  of  doing  so  is  to
preposition  funds for settlement, either from cash on hand or existing lines
of credit,  as  they would  for  any  settlement occurring  within  CEDEL  or
Euroclear.  Under this approach, they may take on credit exposure to CEDEL or
Euroclear until the Global Securities are credited to their accounts one  day
later.

     As an  alternative, if CEDEL or Euroclear has  extended a line of credit
to  them, CEDEL  Participants  or Euroclear  Participants  can elect  not  to
preposition funds  and allow that  credit line to  be drawn upon  the finance
settlement.     Under  this  procedure,   CEDEL  Participants  or   Euroclear
Participants purchasing Global  Securities would incur overdraft  charges for
one  day, assuming they cleared the overdraft when the Global Securities were
credited to their accounts.  However, interest on the Global Securities would
accrue from the value date.   Therefore, in many cases the  investment income
on the  Global Securities earned during that one-day period may substantially
reduce or offset the  amount of such overdraft charges, although  this result
will depend on each CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear Participant's particular
cost of funds.

     Since the settlement is taking place during New York business hours, DTC
Participants  can employ their usual procedures for sending Global Securities
to  the respective European Depositary for  the benefit of CEDEL Participants
or Euroclear Participants.   The sale proceeds  will be available to  the DTC
seller on  the settlement date.  Thus, to the DTC Participants a cross-market
transaction  will  settle  no  differently  than  a  trade  between  two  DTC
Participants.

     Trading between  CEDEL or  Euroclear Seller and  DTC Purchaser.   Due to
time  zone  differences  in  their favor,  CEDEL  Participants  and Euroclear
Participants  may employ their customary procedures for transactions in which
Global Securities are to  be transferred by  the respective clearing  system,
through the  respective Depositary, to  a DTC Participant.   The  seller will
send  instructions  to CEDEL  or  Euroclear  through a  CEDEL  Participant or
Euroclear  Participant at  least one  business day prior  to settlement.   In
these cases  CEDEL or Euroclear will  instruct the respective  Depositary, as
appropriate,  to  deliver the  Global  Securities  to  the DTC  Participant's
account against payment.  Payment will include interest accrued on the Global
Securities from and  including the last coupon  payment to and excluding  the
settlement date on  the basis of  the actual number of  days in such  accrual
period and a year assumed to consist of 360  days.  For transactions settling
on  the 31st  of the  month,  payment will  include interest  accrued to  and
excluding the first  day of the  following month.   The payment will then  be
reflected in the  account of the  CEDEL Participant or Euroclear  Participant
the  following  day,   and  receipt  of  the  cash  proceeds   in  the  CEDEL
Participant's  or Euroclear Participant's account would be back-valued to the
value date (which would be the preceding day, when settlement occurred in New
York).  Should the CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant have a  line of
credit with  its  respective clearing  system  and elect  to  be in  debt  in
anticipation  of  receipt of  the  sale proceeds  in its  account,  the back-
valuation  will extinguish any  overdraft incurred over  that one-day period.

If settlement is  not completed on the  intended value date (i.e.,  the trade
fails), receipt of the cash proceeds in the  CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear
Participant's account  would instead  be valued as  of the  actual settlement
date.

     Finally,  day traders  that use  CEDEL  or Euroclear  and that  purchase
Global Securities from DTC Participants for delivery to CEDEL Participants or
Euroclear Participants should note that these trades would automatically fail
on  the sale  side unless  affirmative  action were  taken.   At least  three
techniques should be readily available to eliminate this potential problem:

     (a)  borrowing  through  CEDEL  or  Euroclear  for one  day  (until  the
purchase  side of  the day  trade is  reflected in  their CEDEL  or Euroclear
accounts) in accordance with the clearing system's customary procedures;

     (b)  borrowing the Global Securities in  the U.S. from a DTC Participant
no  later than  one day  prior  to settlement,  which would  give the  Global
Securities  sufficient time  to  be reflected  in  their CEDEL  or  Euroclear
account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or

     (c)  staggering the value dates for  the buy and sell sides of the trade
so that the value date for the purchase from the DTC  Participant is at least
one  day prior to  the value date  for the sale  to the  CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear Participant.


CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS

     A beneficial owner of Global Securities holding securities through CEDEL
or  Euroclear (or through DTC if the  holder has an address outside the U.S.)
will  be subject to  the 30% U.S.  withholding tax that  generally applies to
payments of interest (including original  issue discount) on registered  debt
issued  by U.S.  Persons,  unless (i)  each  clearing system,  bank  or other
financial institution that holds customers' securities in the ordinary course
of its  trade  or  business  in  the chain  of  intermediaries  between  such
beneficial owner and  the U.S. entity required to  withhold tax complies with
applicable certification  requirements and  (ii) such beneficial  owner takes
one of the following steps to obtain an exemption or reduced tax rate:
     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons (Form  W-8).  Beneficial owners of Global
Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption from the
withholding tax by filing a signed Form W-8 (Certificate  of Foreign Status).
If the information  shown on Form W-8 changes,  a new Form W-8 must  be filed
within 30 days of such change.

     Exemption for  non-U.S. Persons with effectively  connected income (Form
4224).  A non-U.S. Person,  including a non-U.S.  corporation or bank  with a
U.S. branch, for which the interest income  is effectively connected with its
conduct of a trade or business in the United States,  can obtain an exemption
from the  withholding tax by filing Form  4224 (Exemption from Withholding of
Tax on Income Effectively Connected  with the Conduct of a Trade  or Business
in the United States).

     Exemption  or  reduced rate  for  non-U.S.  Persons  resident in  treaty
countries (Form 1001).  Non-U.S. Persons that are Certificate Owners residing
in  a country that  has a  tax treaty  with the United  States can  obtain an
exemption or  reduced tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by filing Form
1001  (Ownership, Exemption  or  Reduced Rate  Certificate).   If  the treaty
provides  only for a  reduced rate, withholding  tax will be  imposed at that
rate unless the filer alternatively files Form W-8. Form 1001 may be filed by
the Certificate Owners or his agent.

     Exemption for  U.S. Persons  (Form  W-9).   U.S.  Persons can  obtain  a
complete  exemption  from the  withholding tax  by  filing Form  W-9 (Payer's
Request for Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).

     U.S. Federal Income Tax Reporting Procedure.  The Certificate Owner of a
Global  Security or, in  the case of  a Form 1001  or a Form  4224 filer, his
agent, files by submitting the appropriate form to the person through whom it
holds (the  clearing agency, in the  case of persons holding  directly on the
books of the  clearing agency).   Form W-8  and Form  1001 are effective  for
three calendar years and Form 4224 is effective for one calendar year.

     The  term "U.S. Person"  means (i) a  citizen or resident  of the United
States, (ii)  a corporation or partnership organized in  or under the laws of
the United States or any political subdivision thereof or (iii) an estate the
income of which is includible in gross income for United States tax purposes,
regardless of its source or (iv) a trust if  a court within the United States
is able  to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust
and one  or  more  United  States trustees  have  authority  to  control  all
substantial decisions  of the  trust.   This summary does  not deal  with all
aspects  of U.S.  federal  income tax  withholding  that may  be  relevant to
foreign holders of the 

Global Securities.   Investors are advised to consult  their own tax advisors
for specific tax advice concerning their holding  and disposing of the Global
Securities.

  -------------------------------------     ---------------------------------
       No dealer,  salesman or  other
  person has been  authorized to give
  any  information  or  to  make  any
  representation  not   contained  in
  this Prospectus  Supplement or  the                PROVIDENT HOME
  Prospectus and, if  given or  made,          EQUITY LOAN TRUST 199__-__
  such information  or representation
  must not  be relied upon  as having
  been authorized  by the  Company or
  (Underwriter).     This  Prospectus                 $___________
  Supplement  and the  Prospectus  do                (Approximate)
  not  constitute  an  offer  of  any
  securities   other  than  those  to
  which they  relate or  an offer  to
  sell,   or  a  solicitation  of  an
  offer to buy, to any  person in any               Home Equity Loan
  jurisdiction  where  such  an offer          Asset Backed Certificates
  or solicitation would be  unlawful.                Series 199_-_
  Neither   the  delivery   of   this
  Prospectus   Supplement   and   the
  Prospectus   nor   any   sale  made
  hereunder    shall,    under    any              THE PROVIDENT BANK
  circumstances,      create      any        Transferor and Master Servicer
  implication  that  the  information
  contained herein  is correct as  of
  any   time   subsequent  to   their
  respective dates.
                                           __________________________________
           TABLE OF CONTENTS              
                                 Page
                                 ----             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
                                                  ___________, 199_
  PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT                    __________________________________
  Summary . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3    
  Risk Factors  . . . . . . . .  S-16
  The Certificate Insurer . . .  S-18
  The Master Servicer . . . . .  S-18
  The Home Equity Loan Program   S-19                (UNDERWRITER)
  Description of the 
  Mortgage Loans . . . . . . .   S-22
  Maturity and Prepayment      
  Considerations  . . . . . . .  S-30
  Pool Factor and Trading
  Information . . . . . . . . .  S-31
  Description of the
  Certificates  . . . . . . . .  S-31
  Use of Proceeds . . . . . . .  S-50
  Federal Income Tax 
  Consequences  . . . . . . . .  S-51
  State Taxes . . . . . . . . .  S-53
  ERISA Considerations  . . . .  S-54
  Legal Investment 
  Considerations . . . . . .  .  S-54
  Underwriting  . . . . . . . .  S-54
  Legal Matters . . . . . . . .  S-55
  Experts . . . . . . . . . . .  S-55
  Ratings . . . . . . . . . . .  S-55
  Index of Defined Terms  . . .  S-56
  Annex I . . . . . . . . . . .  S-59

  PROSPECTUS

  Prospectus  Supplement  or  Current
  Report on Form 8K . . . . . . .   2
  Available Information . . . . .   2
  Incorporation of Certain Documents
    by Reference  . . . . . . . .   2
  Reports to Securityholders  . .   3
  Summary of Terms  . . . . . . .   4
  Risk Factors  . . . . . . . . .  11
  The Trust Fund  . . . . . . . .  17
  Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . .  21
  Loan Program  . . . . . . . . .  22
  The Provident Bank  . . . . . . .
  Description of the Securities .  24
  Credit Enhancement  . . . . . .  38
  Yield and Prepayment 
  Considerations  . . . . . . . .  43
  The Agreements  . . . . . . . .  45
  Certain Legal Aspects of 
    the Loans   . . . . . . . . .  57
  Federal Income Tax 
    Consequences . . . . . . . ..  71
  State Tax Considerations  . . .  90
  ERISA Considerations  . . . . .  90
  Legal Investment  . . . . . . .  93
  Method of Distribution  . . . .  94
  Legal Matters . . . . . . . . .  95
  Financial Information . . . . .  95
  Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . .  95
  Index of Defined Terms  . . . .  97
 --------------------------------------     --------------------------------- 













   Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment.  A
registration statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission.  These securities may not be sold nor may
offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the registration statement
becomes effective.  This prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or
the solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these
securities in any State in which such offer, solicitation or sale would be
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the securities laws of
any such State.

                  SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED MAY 15, 1997
    

PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(TO PROSPECTUS DATED (_____________)

                                $            

                     (PROVIDENT MORTGAGE PASS-THROUGH TRUST 199___)
                      ($              CLASS A-1      % CERTIFICATES 
                       $              CLASS A-2      % CERTIFICATES
                       $              CLASS A-3      % CERTIFICATES
                       $              CLASS A-4      % CERTIFICATES
                       $              CLASS A-5      % CERTIFICATES)
                       $              CLASS A-6 VARIABLE RATE CERTIFICATES

                     MORTGAGE PASS-THROUGH CERTIFICATES,
                                SERIES 199___
                              ------------------
                             THE PROVIDENT BANK,
                        AS SELLER AND MASTER SERVICER
                              ------------------

     The Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series _________ (the
"Certificates"), will consist of six Classes (each, a "Class") of senior
Certificates: the Class A-1 Certificates, the Class A-2 Certificates, the
Class A-3 Certificates, the Class A-4 Certificates, the Class A-5
Certificates and Class A-6 Certificates (collectively, the "Class A
Certificates") and one Class of subordinated Certificates (the "Class R
Certificates").  Only the Class A Certificates (the "Offered Certificates")
are being offered hereby.

     The Certificates will evidence in the aggregate the entire beneficial
interest in a pool (the "Mortgage Pool") of fixed- and adjustable-rate
mortgage loans (the "Mortgage Loans") consisting of two groups ("Loan Group
1" and "Loan Group 2", respectively, and each a "Loan Group") held by
(Provident Mortgage Pass-Through Trust 199___) (the "Trust") to be formed
pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement among The Provident Bank
("Provident"), as seller (the "Seller") and as master servicer (the "Master
Servicer"), and ________________________________________, as trustee (the
"Trustee").  The Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5
Certificates (collectively, the "Group 1 Certificates") will represent
undivided ownership interests in Loan Group 1 which consists of Mortgage
Loans with fixed interest rates.  The Class A-6 Certificates (the "Group 2
Certificates") will represent undivided ownership interests in Loan Group 2
which consists of Mortgage Loans with adjustable interest rates.  The assets
of the Trust will also include certain other property.  The Mortgage Loans 
are secured by first deeds of trust or mortgages primarily on one- to
four-family residential properties. 
                                               (Cover continued on next page)
                              ------------------
        PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD REVIEW THE INFORMATION SET FORTH
           UNDER "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE S-14 HEREIN AND ON PAGE 12
                       IN THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS.
                              ------------------
 THE CERTIFICATES REPRESENT INTERESTS IN THE TRUST ONLY AND DO NOT REPRESENT
            INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF PROVIDENT, THE TRUSTEE
           OR ANY AFFILIATE  THEREOF, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED
             HEREIN.  NEITHER THE CERTIFICATES NOR THE MORTGAGE 
                   LOANS ARE INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY ANY 
                             GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.
                                       
 THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
      EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COM-
             MISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
                 PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR THE PROSPECTUS. ANY
                     REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
                              CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

     The Offered Certificates are being offered by the Underwriter from time
to time in negotiated transactions or otherwise at varying prices to be
determined, in each case, at the time of sale.

     The aggregate proceeds to Provident from the sale of the Offered
Certificates will be approximately $       , plus accrued interest, before
deducting expenses payable by Provident, estimated to be $         in the
aggregate.
                            ------------------

     The Offered Certificates are offered subject to prior sale and subject
to the Underwriter's right to reject orders in whole or in part.  It is
expected that delivery of the Offered Certificates will be made in book-entry
form only through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company, CEDEL Bank,
soci t  anonyme, and the Euroclear System on or about (__________) (the
"Closing Date").  The Offered Certificates will be offered in Europe and the
United States of America.

                            ------------------

                                (Underwriter)


(Date)

(Cover continued from previous page)

     Distributions on the Class A Certificates will be made on the 25th day
of each month or, if such date is not a Business Day, then on the next
succeeding Business Day (each, a "Distribution Date"), commencing in
_____________.  On each Distribution Date, holders of the Class A
Certificates will be entitled to receive, from and to the limited extent of
funds available in the Distribution Account (as defined herein under
"Description of the Certificates--Deposits to Collection Account and
Distribution Account"), distributions with respect to interest and principal
calculated as set forth herein.  The Certificates are not guaranteed by
Provident, the Trustee or any affiliate of any thereof.  However, the Class A
Certificates will have the benefit of an irrevocable and unconditional
certificate guaranty insurance policy (the "Policy") issued by (the
"Certificate Insurer") pursuant to which the Certificate Insurer will
guarantee payments to the related Certificateholders as described herein. 
See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--The Policy" herein.

     The effective yield to the Certificateholders of each Class of Group I
Certificates will be lower than the yield otherwise produced by the
Certificate Rate for each such Class and the purchase price of such
Certificates because distributions will not be payable to the
Certificateholders until the 25th day of the month following the month of
accrual (without any additional distribution of interest or earnings thereon
in respect of such delay).  See "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS--Payment
Delay Feature of Group I Certificates."

     There is currently no market for the Offered Certificates and there can
be no assurance that such a market will develop or if it does develop that it
will continue.  See "RISK FACTORS" herein.

     An election will be made to treat the assets of the Trust as a "real
estate mortgage investment conduit" (a "REMIC") for federal income tax
purposes.  As described more fully herein and in the Prospectus, the Offered
Certificates will constitute "regular interests" in the REMIC.  See "Certain
Federal Income Tax Consequences" in the Prospectus.

               ------------------------------------

     Until ninety days after the date of this Prospectus Supplement, all
dealers effecting transactions in the Offered Certificates, whether or not
participating in this distribution, may be required to deliver a Prospectus
Supplement and Prospectus.  This is in addition to the obligation of dealers
acting as underwriters to deliver a Prospectus Supplement and Prospectus with
respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.

              ------------------------------------

     The Offered Certificates constitute part of a separate series of
Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates being offered by The Provident Bank from
time to time pursuant to its Prospectus dated ____________.  This Prospectus
Supplement does not contain complete information about the offering of the
Offered Certificates.  Additional information is contained in the Prospectus
and investors are urged to read both this Prospectus Supplement and the
Prospectus in full.  Sales of the Offered Certificates may not be consummated
unless the purchaser has received both this Prospectus Supplement and the
Prospectus.

                   INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

     There are incorporated herein by reference all documents filed by
Provident with the Commission pursuant to Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d)
of the 1934 Act, on or subsequent to the date of this Prospectus and prior to
the termination of the offering of the Offered Certificates made by this
Prospectus Supplement.  Provident will provide without charge to each person
to whom this Prospectus Supplement and Prospectus are delivered, on request
of such person, a copy of any or all of the documents incorporated herein by
reference other than the exhibits to such documents (unless such exhibits are
specifically incorporated by reference in such documents).  Requests should
be directed to ______________________________________________________.


                                   SUMMARY

     The following summary of certain pertinent information is qualified in
its entirety by reference to the detailed information appearing elsewhere in
this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. Certain
capitalized terms used in the Summary are defined elsewhere in this
Prospectus Supplement or in the Prospectus.  Reference is made to the Index
of Defined Terms herein and the Glossary of Terms in the Prospectus for the
definitions of certain capitalized terms.

Trust          (Provident Mortgage Pass-Through Trust 199___) (the "Trust")
               will be formed pursuant to a pooling and servicing agreement
               (the "Agreement") to be dated as of _________________ (the
               "Cut-Off Date") among The Provident Bank, ("Provident"), as
               seller (the "Seller") and as master servicer (together with
               any successor in such capacity, the "Master Servicer"), and
               ________________________ ________________, as trustee (the
               "Trustee").  The property of the Trust will include: a pool of
               fixed- and adjustable-rate mortgage loans (the "Mortgage
               Loans"), secured by first deeds of trust or mortgages on
               residential properties that are primarily one- to four-family
               properties (the "Mortgaged Properties"); payments in respect
               of the Mortgage Loans received on and after the Cut-Off Date
               (exclusive of payments in respect of interest on the Mortgage
               Loans due prior to the Cut-Off Date and received thereafter);
               property that secured a Mortgage Loan which has been acquired
               by foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure; rights under
               certain hazard insurance policies covering the Mortgaged
               Properties; and certain other property, as described more
               fully herein.  In addition, Provident has caused the
               Certificate Insurer to issue an irrevocable and unconditional
               financial guaranty insurance policy (the "Policy") for the
               benefit of the holders of the Class A Certificates, pursuant
               to which the Certificate Insurer will guarantee payments to
               such Certificateholders as described herein.

               The Trust property initially will include the unpaid principal
               balance of each Mortgage Loan as of the Cut-Off Date.  With
               respect to any date, the "Pool Principal Balance" will be
               equal to the aggregate of the Principal Balances of all
               Mortgage Loans as of such date.  The "Cut-Off Date Principal
               Balance" with respect to each Mortgage Loan is the unpaid
               principal balance thereof as of the Cut-Off Date.  With
               respect to any date, the "Loan Group 1 Principal Balance" and
               the "Loan Group 2 Principal Balance" will be equal to the
               aggregate of the Principal Balances of all Mortgage Loans in
               Loan Group 1 and Loan Group 2, respectively, as of such date. 
               The Loan Group 1 Principal Balance and the Loan Group 2
               Principal Balance are each sometimes referred to herein as a
               "Loan Group Principal Balance."  The "Principal Balance" of a
               Mortgage Loan (other than a Liquidated Mortgage Loan) on any
               day is equal to its Cut-Off Date Principal Balance minus all
               collections applied in reduction of the Cut-Off Date Principal
               Balance of such Mortgage Loan.  The Principal Balance of a
               Liquidated Mortgage Loan (as defined herein under "Description
               of the Certificates--Principal") after the Due Period in which
               such Mortgage Loan becomes a Liquidated Mortgage Loan shall be
               zero.

Securities     The Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 199___ (the
               "Certificates") will consist of six Classes of senior
               certificates: the Class A-1 Certificates, the Class A-2
               Certificates, the Class A-3 Certificates, the Class A-4
               Certificates, the Class A-5 Certificates and the Class A-6
               Certificates (collectively, the "Class A Certificates") and
               one Class of subordinated certificates (the "Class R
               Certificates").  Only the Class A Certificates (the "Offered
               Certificates") are offered hereby.  Each Class of Offered
               Certificates represents the right to receive payments of
               interest at the rates set forth on the cover hereof (with
               respect to each such Class, the "Certificate Rate"), payable
               monthly, and payments of principal to the extent provided
               below.  The Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3, Class A-4 and
               Class A-5 Certificates (collectively, the "Group 1
               Certificates") will represent undivided ownership interests in
               Loan Group 1 which consists of Mortgage Loans with fixed
               interest rates.  The Class A-6 Certificates (the "Group 2
               Certificates") will represent undivided ownership interests in
               Loan Group 2 which consists of Mortgage Loans with adjustable
               interest rates.  The aggregate undivided interest in the Trust
               represented by the Class A Certificates as of the Cut-Off Date
               will equal $            of principal (the "Original Aggregate
               Class A Principal Balance").  The aggregate undivided interest
               in Loan Group 1 represented by the Group 1 Certificates as of
               the Cut-Off Date will equal $           of principal.  The
               aggregate undivided interest in Loan Group 2 represented by
               the Class A-3 Certificates as of the Cut-Off Date will equal
               $        of principal.  The principal amount of a Class of
               Class A Certificates (each, a "Class A Principal Balance") on
               any date is equal to the applicable Class A Principal Balance
               on the Closing Date minus the aggregate of amounts actually
               distributed as principal to the holders of such Class of Class
               A Certificates.  On any date, the "Aggregate Class A Principal
               Balance" is, with respect to the Group 1 Certificates, the
               aggregate of the Class A Principal Balances of the Group 1
               Certificates and with respect to the Group 2 Certificates, the
               Class A-6 Principal Balance on such date.

The Mortgage 
Loans          The Mortgage Loans are expected to consist of $         in
               principal amount of fixed- and adjustable-rate mortgage loans
               secured by first deeds of trust or mortgages on Mortgaged
               Properties located in __ states and the District of Columbia. 
               The Loan-to-Value Ratio of each Mortgage Loan, computed on the
               date such loan was originated (the "Loan-to-Value Ratio") did
               not exceed      % as of the Cut-Off Date.  The weighted
               average Loan-to-Value Ratio of the Mortgage Loans was      %
               as of the Cut-Off Date.  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE
               LOANS" herein.  Interest on each Mortgage Loan is payable
               monthly on the outstanding Principal Balance thereof at a rate
               per annum (the "Loan Rate") specified in the related Mortgage
               Note.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the Loan Rates ranged from    
               % to      % per annum and the weighted average Loan Rate was   
                 % per annum.  The Cut-Off Date Principal Balances of the
               Mortgage Loans ranged from $          to $           and
               averaged $          .  Each Mortgage Loan was originated in
               the period from            to               .

               Loan Group 1.  All of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 have
               Loan Rates which are fixed for the life of such Mortgage
               Loans.  As of the Cut-Off Date, there are ___ Mortgage Loans
               in Loan Group 1.  The aggregate Principal Balance of the
               Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 was $_____________ (the
               "Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal Balance").  As of the
               Cut-Off Date with respect to the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group
               1, the average Principal Balance was $_________; the Loan
               Rates ranged from ____% to _____%; the weighted average Loan
               Rate was ______%; the weighted average Loan-to-Value Ratio was 
                   %; and the weighted average remaining term to stated
               maturity was ___ months.  The remaining terms to stated
               maturity of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 ranged from ___
               months to ___ months.  The original term to stated maturity of
               each Mortgage Loan in Loan Group 1 was ___ months.  The
               maximum Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group
               1 was $__________ and the minimum Principal Balance of the
               Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 was $________.  

               Approximately      % of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 are
               Balloon Loans.  All of the Balloon Loans amortize over ___
               months.  No Mortgage Loan in Loan Group 1 will mature later
               than               .

               Loan Group 2.  All of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 have
               Loan Rates which are subject to adjustment based on changes in
               (LIBOR), as further discussed under "DESCRIPTION OF THE
               MORTGAGE LOANS" herein.  As of the Cut-Off Date, there are
               _____ Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2.  The aggregate Principal
               Balance of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 was
               $______________ (the "Cut-Off Date Loan Group 2 Principal
               Balance").  As of the Cut-Off Date with respect to the
               Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2, the average Principal Balance
               was $_________; the Loan Rates ranged from ____% to _____%;
               the weighted average Loan Rate was _____%; the weighted
               average Loan-to-Value Ratio was      %; and the weighted
               average remaining term to stated maturity was ___ months.  The
               remaining terms to stated maturity of the Mortgage Loans in
               Loan Group 2 ranged from ___ months to ___ months.  The
               original term to stated maturity each Mortgage Loan in Loan
               Group 2 was ___ months.  The maximum Principal Balance of the
               Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 was $__________ and the minimum
               Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 was
               $________.  None of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 are
               Balloon Loans.  No Mortgage Loan in Loan Group 2 will mature
               later than                  .

               All of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 have minimum and
               maximum Loan Rates.  The weighted average minimum Loan Rate of
               the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately      % per
               annum, with minimum Loan Rates that range from approximately   
               % per annum to    % per annum.  The weighted average maximum
               Loan Rate of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 is
               approximately      % per annum, with maximum Loan Rates that
               range from approximately      % per annum to      % per annum. 
               The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 have a weighted average
               gross margin of approximately    % per annum, with gross
               margins that range from approximately      % per annum to    %
               per annum.  The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 have a weighted
               average periodic cap of approximately    % per annum, with
               periodic caps that range from approximately      % per annum
               to    % per annum.

               See "DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS" herein.

Denominations  The Class A Certificates will be offered for purchase in
               denominations of $1,000 and multiples of $1 in excess thereof.


Registration of
Class A 
Certificates   The Class A Certificates will initially be issued in
               book-entry form.  Persons acquiring beneficial ownership
               interests in the Class A Certificates ("Certificate Owners")
               will hold their Class A Certificate interests through The
               Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), in the United States, or
               Cedel Bank soci t  anonyme ("CEDEL") or the Euroclear System
               ("Euroclear"), in Europe.  Transfers within DTC, CEDEL or
               Euroclear, as the case may be, will be in accordance with the
               usual rules and operating procedures of the relevant system. 
               So long as the Class A Certificates are Book-Entry
               Certificates (as defined herein under "Description of the
               Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates"), such Certificates
               will be evidenced by one or more Certificates registered in
               the name of Cede & Co. ("Cede"), as the nominee of DTC or one
               of the relevant depositaries (collectively, the "European
               Depositaries").  Cross-market transfers between persons
               holding directly or indirectly through DTC, on the one hand,
               and counterparties holding directly or indirectly through
               CEDEL or Euroclear, on the other, will be effected in DTC
               through Citibank N.A. ("Citibank") or Chemical Bank
               ("Chemical"), the relevant depositaries of CEDEL and
               Euroclear, respectively, and each a participating member of
               DTC.  The interests of such Certificateholders will be
               represented by book-entries on the records of DTC and
               participating members thereof.  No Certificate Owner will be
               entitled to receive a definitive certificate representing such
               person's interest, except in the event that Definitive
               Certificates (as defined herein under "Description of the
               Certificates--Book-Entry Certificates") are issued under the
               limited circumstances described herein.  All references in
               this Prospectus Supplement to any Class A Certificates reflect
               the rights of Certificate Owners only as such rights may be
               exercised through DTC and its participating organizations for
               so long as such Class A Certificates are held by DTC.  See
               "RISK FACTORS--Book-Entry Certificates", "DESCRIPTION OF THE
               CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Certificates" herein and "ANNEX I"
               hereto.

Provident      The Provident Bank, an Ohio banking corporation (the "Seller"
               or the "Master Servicer" as applicable).  The principal
               executive offices of the Seller and Master Servicer are
               located at One East Fourth Street, Cincinnati, Ohio 45202
               (Telephone: (513) 579-2000).  See "THE PROVIDENT BANK" in the
               Prospectus.

Certificate 
Rate           The "Certificate Rate" on any Distribution Date with respect
               to the Class A-1 Certificates is    % per annum; the Class A-2
               Certificates is    % per annum; the Class A-3 Certificates is  
                % per annum; the Class A-4 Certificates is    % per annum;
               and the Class A-5 Certificates is    % per annum.  The
               "Certificate Rate" on any Distribution Date with respect to
               the Class A-6 Certificates will equal the least of (A) the sum
               of the LIBOR Rate (as defined herein under "DESCRIPTION OF THE
               CERTIFICATES--The Certificate Rate") plus ____% (or ____% for
               each Distribution Date occurring after the date on which the
               Master Servicer has the right to terminate the Trust), (B) the
               Net Funds Cap for such Distribution Date and (C) ____% per
               annum.  The "Net Funds Cap" for any Distribution Date shall
               equal the difference between (A) the average of the Loan Rates
               of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 as of the first day of
               the month preceding the month of such Distribution Date,
               weighted on the basis of the related Principal Balances as of
               such date and (B) the sum of (i) the Master Servicing Fee Rate
               and the rate at which the Trustee Fee and the premium payable
               to the Certificate Insurer are calculated and (ii) commencing
               with the thirteenth Distribution Date, 0.50%.  Interest on the
               Group 1 Certificates in respect of any Distribution Date will
               accrue during each Interest Period on the basis of a 360-day
               year consisting of twelve 30-day months.  Interest on the
               Group 2 Certificates in respect of any Distribution Date will
               accrue during each Interest Period on the basis of a 360-day
               year and the actual number of days elapsed.

               "Interest Period" means, with respect to each Distribution
               Date and the Group 1 Certificates, the period from the first
               day of the calendar month preceding the month of such
               Distribution Date through the last day of such calendar month. 
               "Interest Period" means, with respect to each Distribution
               Date and the Group 2 Certificates, the period from the
               Distribution Date in the month preceding the month of such
               Distribution Date (or, in the case of the first Distribution
               Date, from the Closing Date) through the day before such
               Distribution Date.

Distributions: On the 25th day of each month, or if such a day is not a
               Business Day, then the next succeeding Business Day,
               commencing in ____________ (each such day, a "Distribution
               Date"), the Trustee will be required to distribute from funds
               available therefor in the Distribution Account (as described
               herein) to the holders of the Offered Certificates of record
               as of the applicable Record Date, in the priorities described
               below, an aggregate amount equal to the sum of (a) the Class
               Interest Distribution for each Class of Offered Certificates,
               and (b) the Class A Principal Distribution for each
               Certificate Group.  So long as an Insurer Default has not
               occurred and is continuing, the Class A Principal Distribution
               relating to the Group 1 Certificates will be distributed,
               sequentially, to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3, Class
               A-4 and Class A-5 Certificates, in that order, such that no
               Class of Group 1 Certificates having a higher numerical
               designation is entitled to distributions of principal until
               the Class A Principal Balance of each such Class of
               Certificates having a lower numerical designation has been
               reduced to zero.  On any Distribution Date during the
               continuance of an Insurer Default, the Class A Principal
               Distribution relating to the Group 1 Certificates will be
               distributed to the Group 1 Certificates outstanding on a pro
               rata basis in accordance with the Class A Principal Balance of
               each such Class.  The Class A Principal Distribution relating
               to the Group 2 Certificates will be distributed to the Class
               A-6 Certificates.  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--
               Distributions" herein.

               Interest

               On each Distribution Date, to the extent of funds available
               therefor as described herein, interest will be distributed
               with respect to each Class of Class A Certificates in an
               amount (each, a "Class Interest Distribution") equal to the
               sum of (a) one month's interest at the related Certificate
               Rate on the related Class A Principal Balance immediately
               prior to such Distribution Date (the "Class Monthly Interest
               Distributable Amount") and (b) any Class Interest Carryover
               Shortfall for such Class of Class A Certificates for such
               Distribution Date.  As to any Distribution Date and Class of
               Class A Certificates, Class Interest Carryover Shortfall is
               the sum of (i) the excess of the related Class Monthly
               Interest Distributable Amount for the preceding Distribution
               Rate and any outstanding Class Interest Carryover Shortfall
               with respect to such Class on such preceding Distribution
               Date, over the amount in respect of interest that is actually
               distributed to such Class on such preceding Distribution Date
               plus (ii) one month's interest on such excess, to the extent
               permitted by law, at the related Certificate Rate.

               On each Distribution Date, the Class Interest Distribution for
               each Class of Class A Certificates in a particular Certificate
               Group will be distributed on an equal priority and any
               shortfall in the amount required to be distributed as interest
               thereon to each such Class will be allocated between such
               Classes pro rata based on the amount each such Class would
               have been distributed in the absence of such shortfall.

               Principal

               On each Distribution Date, to the extent of funds available
               therefor as described herein, principal will be distributed to
               the holders of the Class A Certificates of a Certificate Group
               then entitled to distributions of principal in an amount equal
               to the lesser of (A) the related Aggregate Class A Principal
               Balance and (B) the related Class A Principal Distribution for
               such Distribution Date.  "Class A Principal Distribution"
               means, with respect to any Distribution Date and Certificate
               Group, the sum of the related Class A Monthly Principal
               Distributable Amount for such Distribution Date and any
               outstanding Class A Principal Carryover Shortfall as of the
               close of the preceding Distribution Date.

               "Class A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount" means, with
               respect to any Distribution Date and Certificate Group, to the
               extent of funds available therefor as described herein, the
               amount equal to the sum of the following amounts (without
               duplication) with respect to the immediately preceding Due
               Period (as defined below): (i) each payment of principal on a
               Mortgage Loan in the related Loan Group received by the Master
               Servicer during such Due Period, including all full and
               partial principal prepayments, (ii) the Principal Balance as
               of the end of the immediately preceding Due Period of each
               Mortgage Loan in the related Loan Group that became a
               Liquidated Mortgage Loan for the first time during the related
               Due Period, (iii) the portion of the Purchase Price allocable
               to principal of all repurchased Defective Mortgage Loans in
               the related Loan Group with respect to such Due Period, (iv)
               any Substitution Adjustment Amounts received on or prior to
               the previous Determination Date and not yet distributed with
               respect to the related Loan Group and (v) such portion (not
               greater than 100%) of Excess Spread (as defined below), if
               any, required to be distributed on such Distribution Date to
               satisfy the required level of overcollateralization for the
               related Loan Group for such Distribution Date (the
               "Distributable Excess Spread").

               If the required level of overcollateralization for a
               Certificate Group is reduced below the then existing amount of
               overcollateralization (described below) or if the required
               level of overcollateralization for such Certificate Group is
               satisfied, the amount of the related Class A Monthly Principal
               Distributable Amount on the following Distribution Date will
               be correspondingly reduced by the amount of such reduction or
               by the amount necessary such that the overcollateralization
               will not exceed the required level of overcollateralization
               for a Certificate Group after giving effect to the
               distribution in respect of principal with respect to such
               Certificate Group to be made on such Distribution Date.

               "Due Period" means, with respect to any Determination Date or
               Distribution Date, the calendar month immediately preceding
               such Determination Date or Distribution Date, as the case may
               be.

               For a description of a "Liquidated Mortgage Loan" see
               "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Principal" herein.

               "Excess Spread" means, with respect to any Distribution Date
               and Loan Group, the positive excess, if any, of (x) Available
               Funds (as defined herein under "Description of the
               Certificates--Deposits to the Distribution Account") for the
               related Certificate Group for such Distribution Date over (y)
               the amount required to be distributed pursuant to subclause A
               items (i) through (iv), with respect to the Group 1
               Certificates and subclause B items (i) through (iv), with
               respect to the Group 2 Certificates, in each case set forth
               under the heading "DESCRIPTION OF CERTIFICATES--Priority of
               Distributions" on such Distribution Date.  Distributions of
               Excess Spread relating to a Loan Group to the holders of Class
               A Certificates of the related Certificate Group will result in
               acceleration of principal payments to the holders of such
               Class A Certificates creating overcollateralization to the
               extent required by the Agreement.  This feature will have the
               effect of reducing the weighted average lives of the Class A
               Certificates.  See "DESCRIPTION OF CERTIFICATES--
               Overcollateralization Provisions" and "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD
               CONSIDERATIONS" herein.

               The last scheduled Distribution Date for each Class of Offered
               Certificates is as follows: Class A-1 Certificates,          ;
               Class A-2 Certificates,               ; Class A-3


               Certificates,               ; Class A-4 Certificates,          
                     ; Class A-5 Certificates,               ; and Class A-6
               Certificates,               .  It is expected that the actual
               last Distribution Date for each Class of Offered Certificates
               will occur significantly earlier than such scheduled
               Distribution Dates.  See "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD
               CONSIDERATIONS."

Over-
collateraliz-
ation          The credit enhancement provisions of the Trust result in a
               limited acceleration of the Class A Certificates of a
               Certificate Group relative to the amortization of the Mortgage
               Loans in the related Loan Group in the early months of the
               transaction.  The accelerated amortization is achieved by the
               application of Excess Spread relating to a Loan Group to
               principal distributions on the Class A Certificates of the
               related Certificate Group.  This acceleration feature creates,
               with respect to each Certificate Group, overcollateralization
               (i.e., the excess of the aggregate outstanding Principal
               Balance of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group over
               the related Aggregate Class A Principal Balance).  Once the
               required level of overcollateralization is reached for a
               Certificate Group, and subject to the provisions described in
               the next paragraph, the acceleration feature for such
               Certificate Group will cease, until necessary to maintain the
               required level of overcollateralization for such Certificate
               Group.

               The Agreement will provide that, subject to certain floors,
               caps and triggers, the required level of overcollateralization
               with respect to a Certificate Group may increase or decrease
               over time.  An increase in the required level of
               overcollateralization for a Certificate Group will result if
               the delinquency or default experience on the Mortgage Loans in
               the related Loan Group exceeds certain levels set forth in the
               Agreement.  In that event, amortization of the related Class A
               Certificates would be accelerated relative to the Mortgage
               Loans until the level of overcollateralization reaches its
               required level.  The required level of overcollateralization
               may be decreased under certain circumstances, which will slow
               the amortization of the Class A Certificates of the related
               Certificate Group relative to the Mortgage Loans.

               See "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS" and "DESCRIPTION OF
               THE CERTIFICATES--Overcollateralization Provisions."

Cross-
collateraliz-
ation          In addition to the foregoing, the Agreement provides for
               crosscollateralization through the application of Excess
               Spread generated by one Loan Group to fund shortfalls in
               Available Funds in the other Loan Group, subject to certain
               prior requirements of such Available Funds.  See "DESCRIPTION
               OF THE CERTIFICATES--Priority of Distributions" and
               "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS."

The Policy     The Policy will unconditionally and irrevocably guarantee
               principal payments (as described in the next sentence) on the
               Class A Certificates plus accrued and unpaid interest due on
               the Class A Certificates.  On each Distribution Date, a draw
               will be made on the Policy equal to the sum of (a) the amount
               by which interest accrued during the applicable Interest
               Period at the applicable Certificate Rate for each Class of
               Class A Certificates on the related outstanding Class A
               Principal Balance exceeds the amount on deposit in the
               Distribution Account available to be distributed therefor on
               such Distribution Date and (b) with respect to each
               Certificate Group, the amount (each, a "Guaranteed Principal
               Amount"), if any, by which the Aggregate Class A Principal
               Balance exceeds the related Loan Group Principal Balance at
               the end of the previous month (after giving effect to all
               amounts distributable and allocable to principal on the
               related Class A Certificates on such Distribution Date).  In
               addition, the Policy will guarantee the payment in full of the
               applicable Aggregate Class A Principal Balance to the Group 1
               Certificates and the Group 2 Certificates on the Distribution
               Date in              and              , respectively (after
               giving effect to all other amounts distributable and allocable
               to principal on such Classes on such Distribution Date).

               In the absence of payments under the Policy, Class A
               Certificateholders will directly bear the credit and other
               risks associated with their undivided interest in the Trust. 
               See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--The Policy," herein.

The Certificate 
Insurer        (________________________________________________________)(the
               "Certificate Insurer").  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES-
               -The Policy" and "THE CERTIFICATE INSURER" herein.

(Pre-Funding 
Account        On the Closing Date, $__________ (the "Pre-Funded Amount")
               will be deposited in an account (the "Pre-Funding Account"),
               which account shall be in the name of and maintained by the
               Trustee and shall be part of the Trust Fund and will be used
               to acquire Subsequent Mortgage Loans.  During the period
               beginning on the Closing Date and terminating on ____________,
               19__ (the "Funding Period"), the Pre-Funded Amount will be
               maintained in the Pre-Funding Account.  The Pre-Funded Amount
               will be reduced during the Funding Period by the amount
               thereof used to purchase Subsequent Mortgage Loans in
               accordance with the Agreement.  Any Pre-Funded Amount
               remaining at the end of the Funding Period will be distributed
               to holders of the classes of Certificates entitled to receive
               principal on the Distribution Date in ________ 19__ in
               reduction of the related Certificate Principal Balances, thus
               resulting in a partial principal prepayment of the related
               Certificates on such date.  The Pre-Funding Account shall not
               be an asset of the REMIC.  All reinvestment earnings on the
               Pre-Funding Account shall be owned by, and be taxable to, the
               Seller.

Capitalized 
Interest
Account        On the Closing Date there will be deposited in an account (the
               "Capitalized Interest Account") maintained with and in the
               name of the Trustee on behalf of the Trust Fund a portion of
               the proceeds of the sale of the Certificates.  The amount
               deposited therein will be used by the Trustee on the
               Distribution Dates in __________ 19__, __________, 19__ and
               __________ 19__ to cover shortfalls in interest on the
               Certificates that may arise as a result of the utilization of
               the Pre-Funding Account for the purchase by the Trust Fund of
               Subsequent Mortgage Loans after the Closing Date.  Any amounts
               remaining in the Capitalized Interest Account at the end of
               the Funding Period are required to be paid directly to
               Provident.)  The Capitalized Interest Account shall not be an
               asset of the REMIC.  All reinvestment earnings on the
               Capitalized Interest Account shall be owned by, and be taxable
               to, the Seller.

Servicing      The Master Servicer will be responsible for servicing,
               managing and making collections on the Mortgage Loans.  The
               Master Servicer will deposit all collections in respect of the 
               Mortgage Loans into the Collection Account as described
               herein.  On the eighteenth day of the month (each, a
               "Determination Date"), the Trustee will calculate the amounts
               to be paid, as described herein, to the Certificateholders on
               the next Distribution Date.  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE
               CERTIFICATES--Priority of Distributions."  With respect to
               each Due Period, the Master Servicer will receive from
               payments in respect of interest on the Mortgage Loans, on
               behalf of itself, a portion of such payments as a monthly
               servicing fee (the "Master Servicing Fee") in the amount of    
               % per annum (the "Master Servicing Fee Rate") on the Principal
               Balance of each Mortgage Loan as of the first day of each such
               Due Period.  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Servicing
               Compensation and Payment of Expenses."  In certain limited
               circumstances, the Master Servicer may resign or be removed,
               in which event either the Trustee or a third-party servicer
               will be appointed as successor master servicer.  See
               "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Certain Matters Regarding
               the Master Servicer" herein.

Trustee        (______________________________________), a _________________
               (the "Trustee").

Monthly 
Advances  (The Master Servicer is required to remit to the Trustee no later
          than two Business Days prior to each Distribution Date, for deposit
          in the Distribution Account, an amount equal to the scheduled
          installment of interest and principal due on each Mortgage Loan but
          not received by the Master Servicer during the related Due Period
          (a "Monthly Advance").  Such obligation of the Master Servicer
          continues with respect to each Mortgage Loan until such Mortgage
          Loan becomes a Liquidated Mortgage Loan.  The Master Servicer is
          not required to make any Monthly Advances which it determines would
          be nonrecoverable.  Monthly Advances are reimbursable to the Master
          Servicer subject to certain conditions and restrictions, and are
          intended to provide sufficient funds for the payment of interest on
          the Class A Certificates.)  See "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--
          ADVANCES" herein.

Prepayment Interest
Shortfalls     Not later than the Determination Date, the Master Servicer is
               required to remit to the Trustee, without any right of
               reimbursement, an amount equal to, with respect to each
               Mortgage Loan as to which a principal prepayment in full was
               received during the related Due Period, the lesser of (a) the
               excess, if any, of 30 days' interest on the Principal Balance
               of such Mortgage Loan at the Loan Rate (or at such lower rate
               as may be in effect for such Mortgage Loan because of
               application of the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act of
               1940, as amended (the "Civil Relief Act")), minus the Master
               Servicing Fee for such Mortgage Loan over the amount of
               interest actually paid by the related Mortgagor in connection
               with such principal prepayment (with respect to all such
               Mortgage Loans, the "Prepayment Interest Shortfall") and (b)
               the sum of the aggregate Master Servicing Fee received by the
               Master Servicer in the most recently ended Due Period.

               Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls will not be covered by
               the Policy, although Prepayment Interest Shortfalls, after
               application of the Master Servicing Fee will be so covered. 
               The Master Servicer is not obligated to offset any of the
               Master Servicing Fee against, or to provide any other funds to
               cover, any shortfalls in interest collections on the Mortgage


               Loans that are attributable to the application of the Civil
               Relief Act ("Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls").  See
               "RISK FACTORS--Payments on the Mortgage Loans" herein.

Optional Termination 
by the Master
Servicer       The Master Servicer may, at its option, terminate the
               Agreement on any date on which the aggregate Principal Balance
               of the Mortgage Loans is less than 5% of the Cut-Off Date Pool
               Principal Balance at the price described herein under
               "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Termination; Retirement of
               the Certificates."

Certain Federal 
Tax 
Considerations For federal income tax purposes, the Trust created by the
               Agreement will be treated as a "real estate mortgage
               investment conduit" ("REMIC").  In the opinion of Brown & Wood
               LLP, tax counsel to Provident ("Tax Counsel"), the Class A
               Certificates will constitute "regular interests" in the REMIC
               and will be treated as debt instruments of the REMIC for
               federal income tax purposes with payment terms equivalent to
               the terms of such Certificates.  The Class R Certificates (the
               "Residual Certificates") will constitute the sole class of
               "residual interests" in the REMIC and will be the Class of
               Residual Certificates, as described in the Prospectus.

               The holders of the Offered Certificates will be required to
               include in income interest on such Certificates in accordance
               with the accrual method of accounting.

               The Offered Certificates may, depending on their issue price,
               be treated as having been issued with original issue discount
               for federal income tax purposes.  For further information
               regarding the federal income tax consequences of investing in
               the Offered Certificates, see "FEDERAL INCOME TAX
               CONSEQUENCES" herein and "FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES" in
               the Prospectus.

ERISA 
Considerations The acquisition of an Offered Certificate by a pension or
               other employee benefit plan (a "Plan") subject to the Employee
               Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA"),
               could, in some instances, result in a "prohibited transaction"
               or other violation of the fiduciary responsibility provisions
               of ERISA and Code Section 4975.  Certain exemptions from the
               prohibited transaction rules could be applicable to the
               acquisition of such Offered Certificates.  Any Plan fiduciary
               considering whether to purchase any Offered Certificate on
               behalf of a Plan should consult with its counsel regarding the
               applicability of the provisions of ERISA and the Code.

               Subject to the considerations and conditions described under
               "ERISA CONSIDERATIONS" herein, it is expected that the Offered
               Certificates may be purchased by a Plan.

Legal Investment
Considerations The Offered Certificates will constitute "mortgage related
               securities" for purposes of the Secondary Mortgage Market
               Enhancement Act of 1984 ("SMMEA") so long as they are rated in
               one of the two highest rating categories by at least one
               nationally recognized statistical rating organization and, as
               such, are legal investments for certain entities to the extent
               provided in SMMEA.

               Institutions whose investment activities are subject to review
               by federal or state regulatory authorities should consult with
               their counsel or the applicable authorities to determine
               whether an investment in the Offered Certificates complies
               with applicable guidelines, policy statements or restrictions. 
               See "LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS" herein and "LEGAL
               INVESTMENT" in the Prospectus.

Certificate 
Rating         It is a condition to the issuance of the Offered Certificates
               that they receive ratings of "AAA" by
               __________________________ and _____ by ____
               _________________________________________________.  In
               general, ratings address credit risk and do not address the
               likelihood of prepayments.  See "RATINGS" herein and "RISK
               FACTORS--Rating of the Securities" in the Prospectus.


                                 RISK FACTORS

     Consequences on Liquidity and Payment Delay Because of Owning Book-Entry
Certificates.  Issuance of the Offered Certificates in book-entry form may
reduce the liquidity of such Certificates in the secondary trading market
since investors may be unwilling to purchase Offered Certificates for which
they cannot obtain physical certificates. Since transactions in the Offered
Certificates can be effected only through DTC, CEDEL, Euroclear,
participating organizations, indirect participants and certain banks, the
ability of a Certificate Owner to pledge an Offered Certificate to persons or
entities that do not participate in the DTC, CEDEL or Euroclear system or
otherwise to take actions in respect of such Certificates, may be limited due
to lack of a physical certificate representing the Offered Certificates. 
Certificate Owners may experience some delay in their receipt of
distributions of interest and principal on the Offered Certificates since
such distributions will be forwarded by the Trustee to DTC and DTC will
credit such distributions to the accounts of its Participants (as defined
herein under "DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Certificates")
which will thereafter credit them to the accounts of Certificate Owners
either directly or indirectly through indirect participants.  See
"DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Certificates" herein.

     Cash Flow Considerations and Risks of Shortfall.  With respect to      %
of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 (by Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal
Balance), collections on such Mortgage Loans may vary because, among other
things, borrowers are not required to make monthly payments of principal that
will be sufficient to amortize such Mortgage Loans by their maturity
(collectively, "Balloon Loans").  The ability of a borrower to make such a
payment may depend on the ability of the borrower to obtain refinancing of
the balance due on a Balloon Loan.  An increase in interest rates over the
Loan Rate applicable at the time a Balloon Loan was originated may have an
adverse effect on the borrower's ability to obtain refinancing or to pay the
required monthly payment.  Collections on the Mortgage Loans may also vary
due to seasonal purchasing and payment habits of borrowers.

     With respect to certain Balloon Loans, general credit risk may also be
greater to holders of Group 1 Certificates than to holders of instruments
representing interests in level payment fully amortizing first mortgage
loans.  Even assuming that the Mortgaged Properties provide adequate security
for the Mortgage Loans, substantial delays could be encountered in connection
with the liquidation of Mortgage Loans that are delinquent and resulting
shortfalls in distributions to Certificateholders could occur if the
Certificate Insurer were unable to perform its obligations under the Policy. 
Further, liquidation expenses (such as legal fees, real estate taxes, and
maintenance and preservation expenses) will reduce the proceeds payable to
Certificateholders and thereby reduce the security for the Mortgage Loans. 
In the event any of the Mortgaged Properties fail to provide adequate
security for the related Mortgage Loans, Certificateholders could experience
a loss if the Certificate Insurer were unable to perform its obligations
under the Policy.

     Prepayment Considerations and Effect on Yield to Maturity and Weighted
Average Life of Certificates.  All of the Mortgage Loans may be prepaid in
whole or in part at any time.  However, approximately __% of the Mortgage
Loans are subject to prepayment penalties which vary from jurisdiction to
jurisdiction.  The Trust's prepayment experience may be affected by a wide
variety of factors, including general economic conditions, interest rates,
the availability of alternative financing and homeowner mobility.  In
addition, all of the Mortgage Loans contain due-on-sale provisions and the
Master Servicer will be required by the Agreement to enforce such provisions
unless (i) such enforcement is not permitted by applicable law or (ii) the
Master Servicer, in a manner consistent with reasonable commercial practice,
permits the purchaser of the related Mortgaged Property to assume the
Mortgage Loan.  To the extent permitted by applicable law, such assumption
will not release the original borrower from its obligation under any such
Mortgage Loan.  See "CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS--Due-on-Sale Clauses in
Mortgage Loans" in the Prospectus.

     Certificate Rating Based Primarily on Claims-Paying Ability of the
Certificate Insurer.  The rating of the Offered Certificates will depend
primarily on an assessment by the Rating Agencies of the Mortgage Loans and
upon the claims-paying ability of the Certificate Insurer.  Any reduction in
a rating assigned to the claims-paying ability of the Certificate Insurer
below the rating initially given to the Offered Certificates may result in a
reduction in the rating of the Offered Certificates.  The rating by the
Rating Agencies of the Offered Certificates is not a recommendation to
purchase, hold or sell the Offered Certificates, inasmuch as such rating does
not comment as to the market price or suitability for a particular investor. 
There is no assurance that the ratings will remain in place for any given
period of time or that the ratings will not be lowered or withdrawn by the
Rating Agencies.  In general, the ratings address credit risk and do not
address the likelihood of prepayments.  The ratings of the Offered
Certificates do not address the possibility of the imposition of United
States withholding tax with respect to non-U.S. persons.

     Legal Considerations Resulting from Sale Treatment.  The sale of the
Mortgage Loans from the Seller to the Trust will be treated by the Seller and
the Trust as a sale of the Mortgage Loans.  The Seller will warrant that such
transfer is a sale of its interest in the Mortgage Loans.  In the event of an
insolvency of the Seller, it is possible that a receiver or conservator for,
or a creditor of, the Seller, may argue that the transaction between the
Seller and the Trust, with respect to the Mortgage Loans was a pledge of such
Mortgage Loans in connection with a borrowing by the Seller rather than a
true sale.  Such an attempt, even if unsuccessful, could result in delays in
distributions on the Offered Certificates.

     (The terms of the Agreement provide that the Seller will maintain
possession of the documentation relating to each Mortgage Loan (the "Mortgage
File"), and no assignment of any Mortgage is required to be recorded in the
name of the Trustee, unless an Assignment Event occurs.  Within 30 days of
any such occurrence, the Seller, at its expense, is required to deliver the
Mortgage File to the Trustee and to either cause proper assignments of each
Mortgage to be recorded, at its expense, or to deliver assignments of each
Mortgage, in recordable form, to the Trustee, together with an opinion of
counsel to the effect that recordation of such assignments in not necessary
in order to perfect the interests of the Trust in such Mortgages.  Prior to
delivery and recording, the interest of the Trustee in the Mortgages, the
Mortgage Notes and the proceeds thereof may be subject to the claims of
creditors or to sale to a third party, as well as to a receiver or
conservator appointed in the event of the insolvency of the Seller.

     An "Assignment Event" will occur on the 30th day following either (i)
the occurrence and continuance of an Event of Default, (ii) the reduction of
the Seller's long-term unsecured debt rating below "Baa2" by Moody's or "BBB"
by S&P or (iii) the suspension, termination or withdrawal of the Seller's
long-term unsecured debt rating by Moody's or S&P.

     In an insolvency proceeding of the Seller, if the Mortgage Notes have
not been delivered to the Trustee and the Mortgages have not been assigned of
record in the real property recording office, the Trust may be a general
unsecured creditor of the Seller.  If the Trust were determined to be a
general unsecured creditor of the Seller, the Mortgages, the Mortgage Notes
and the proceeds thereof would not be available to make payments on the
Offered Certificates.)

     Payments on the Mortgage Loans and Effect of Reduced Payments of
Interest on the Mortgage Loans.  When a principal prepayment in full is made
on a Mortgage Loan, the Mortgagor is charged interest only up to the date of
such prepayment, instead of for a full month which may result in a Prepayment
Interest Shortfall.  The Master Servicer is obligated to pay, without any
right of reimbursement, those shortfalls in interest collections payable on
the Class A Certificates that are attributable to Prepayment Interest
Shortfalls, but only to the extent of the Master Servicing Fee for the
related Due Period (any such payment, "Compensating Interest").  The Master
Servicing Fee will not be available to cover any shortfalls in interest
collections on the Mortgage Loans that are attributable to Civil Relief Act
Interest Shortfalls.  Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls will not be
covered by payments under the Policy, although Prepayment Interest
Shortfalls, after application of the Master Servicing Fee as described above,
will be so covered.

     (Risk of Losses as a Result of Geographic Concentration.  The Mortgaged
Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans are located in __ states and the
District of Columbia.  However, most of the Mortgaged Properties are located
in (state or region).  Certain regions of the country, including (state or
region), recently have experienced a severe decline in real estate values. 
Approximately      % and     % (by aggregate principal balance as of the
Cut-Off Date) of the Mortgaged Properties relating to the Mortgage Loans are
located in          and     

      , respectively.  To the extent that (state or region) has experienced
or may experience in the future weaker economic conditions or greater rates
of decline in real estate values than the United States generally, such a
concentration of the Mortgage Loans may be expected to exacerbate the
foregoing risks.  The Seller can neither quantify the impact of any recent
property value declines on the Mortgage Loans nor predict whether, to what
extent or for how long such declines may continue.)

     (Risk of Prepayment Due to Subsequent Mortgage Loans.  The ability of
the Seller to purchase mortgage loans subsequent to the date hereof and on or
prior to ____________, 19__ that meet the requirements for transfer during
the Funding Period under the Agreement is affected by a variety of factors,
including interest rates, unemployment levels, the rate of inflation and
consumer perception of economic conditions generally.  On the Distribution
Date in ____________ 19__, a principal prepayment will be made to the holders
of the Certificates in the amount which represents the excess of the original
Pre-Funded Amount over the Principal Balance of all Subsequent Mortgage Loans
as of the related Cut-Off Date (i.e., the balance on deposit in the Pre-
Funding Account on such date (net of investment earnings)).  All Subsequent
Mortgage Loans shall be added from a specified group of Mortgage Loans. 
Although no assurances can be given, Provident intends that no material
principal prepayment will be required to be made to the holders of the
Certificates on the Distribution Date in ____________ 19__.  Any reinvestment
risk resulting from such prepayment will be borne entirely by the
Certificateholders.)


                           THE CERTIFICATE INSURER

     The information set forth in this section and in the financial
statements of the Certificate Insurer set forth in Appendix A and Appendix B
hereto have been provided by the Certificate Insurer.  No representation is
made by the Underwriter, the Seller, the Master Servicer or any of their
affiliates as to the accuracy or completeness of any such information.

     _____________ is not obligated to pay the debts of or claims against the
Certificate Insurer.  The Certificate Insurer is domiciled in the State of
New York and licensed to do business in all (50 states, the District of
Columbia, the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico, the Commonwealth of the Northern
Mariana Islands, the Virgin Islands of the United States and the Territory of
Guam).

     The tables below present selected financial information of the
Certificate Insurer determined in accordance with statutory accounting
practices prescribed or permitted by insurance regulatory authorities ("SAP")
and generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP"):


                                                SAP
                         December 31, 1996                 Quarterly Report
                             (Audited)                       (Unaudited)
                                             (in millions)





                                                 GAAP
                         December 31, 1996                 Quarterly Report
                             (Audited)                       (Unaudited)
                                             (in millions)

     Audited financial statements  of the Certificate Insurer  as of December
31,  1996 and  1995 and  for each  of  the three  years in  the period  ended
December 31,  1996 are included  herein as Appendix  A.   Unaudited financial
statements of the Certificate Insurer for the (      )-month period ended
(                     )  are included herein as  Appendix B.   Such financial
statements have been  prepared on the basis of  generally accepted accounting
principles.   Copies  of  the  Certificate Insurer's  1996  year-end  audited
financial  statements  prepared  in  accordance  with  statutory   accounting
practices are available from the Certificate Insurer.

     A  copy  of the  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K is  available  from  the
Certificate Insurer or  the Securities and Exchange Commission.   The address
of the Certificate Insurer is _______________________________________.

     The  Certificate  Insurer does  not  accept any  responsibility  for the
accuracy or completeness of this  Prospectus or any information or disclosure
contained  herein,  or omitted  herefrom,  other  than  with respect  to  the
accuracy of the information regarding  the Policy and the Certificate Insurer
set forth  under the headings  "DESCRIPTION OF THE  CERTIFICATES--The Policy"
and in Appendices A and B.

     Moody's Investors Service,  Inc. rates the claims paying  ability of the
Certificate Insurer "Aaa".

     Standard & Poor's Rating Services rates the claims paying ability of the
Certificate Insurer "AAA".

     Fitch  Investors Service  L.P. rates  the claims  paying ability  of the
Certificate Insurer "AAA".

     Each   rating   of   the  Certificate   Insurer   should   be  evaluated
independently.   The ratings reflect  the respective rating  agency's current
assessment of the creditworthiness of the Certificate Insurer and its ability
to pay claims  on its policies of  insurance.  Any further  explanation as to
the  significance  of  the  above  ratings  may be  obtained  only  from  the
applicable rating agency.

     The  above ratings  are not  recommendations to  buy,  sell or  hold the
Certificates, and such ratings  may be subject to  revision or withdrawal  at
any time by the rating agencies.  Any downward revision  or withdrawal of any
of the  above ratings may have an  adverse effect on the market  price of the
Certificates.  The Certificate Insurer does not guaranty the market  price of
the  Certificates nor does it  guaranty that the  ratings on the Certificates
will not be revised or withdrawn.


                              THE PROVIDENT BANK

     Provident will be  responsible for servicing the Mortgage  Loans for the
Trust  in  accordance  with  the  terms  of  the  Agreement.    Beginning  on
_______________, __________________________ (the  "Subservicer") will service
the Mortgage Loans for Provident  pursuant to a Subservicing Agreement, dated
as of _____________, 199__, between Provident and the Subservicer.  The terms
and conditions of the  Subservicing Agreement are consistent with  and do not
violate the provisions  of the Agreement.  Such subservicing does not relieve
Provident  from any  of  its  obligations to  service  the  Mortgage Loan  in
accordance with the terms and conditions of  the Agreement.  See "--Servicing
and Collection Procedures."

     Provident  is the  principal banking  subsidiary  of Provident  Bancorp,
Inc.,  a Cincinnati  based bank  holding  company registered  under the  Bank
Holding Company  Act.   Provident  Bancorp,  Inc. operates  throughout  Ohio,
Northern Kentucky and  Southeastern Indiana.  As of ______________, Provident
Bancorp, Inc. had total assets of $____ billion, net loans of $_____ billion,


deposits of $_____  billion and total shareholders' equity  of $____ million.
For the fiscal  year ended ________________, Provident Bancorp,  Inc. had net
earnings of $____  million.  At _________________,  Provident Bancorp, Inc.'s
tier  1  and total  capital  ratios  were  _____% and  _____%,  respectively.
Provident represents approximately 96% of Provident Bancorp, Inc.'s assets.

CREDIT AND UNDERWRITING GUIDELINES

     The   following  is  a   description  of  the   underwriting  guidelines
customarily employed  by Provident  with respect to  Mortgage Loans  which it
purchases or  originates.  Each  Mortgage Loan was underwritten  according to
these guidelines.  Provident believes its standards are consistent with those
utilized by similar lenders generally.   The underwriting process is intended
to assess both  the prospective borrower's ability to repay  and the adequacy
of the real property security as collateral for the loan granted.  In certain
cases, loans may be made outside of those guidelines with the  prior approval
of an underwriting manager of Provident.

     Provident generally  originates or  purchases loans  which either  fully
amortize over a period  not to exceed 360 months or  provide for amortization
over a 360 month schedule with  a "balloon" payment required at the  maturity
date,  which will not be less than fifteen (15) years after origination.  The
loan  amounts  generally range  from a  minimum  of $10,000  to a  maximum of
$500,000 unless a higher amount is specifically approved by a senior official
of Provident.  Provident primarily originates or purchases non-purchase money
first or second  mortgage loans  although Provident  also originates  certain
purchase money first mortgages.

     The homes used for collateral to secure  the loans may be either primary
residential (which includes second and vacation homes) or investor owned one-
for  four-family homes,  condominiums,  townhouses or  manufactured  housing.
Generally, each home must have a minimum appraised  value as described below.
Mobile housing or  agricultural land are not accepted as collateral.  In some
cases,  the  loan  may  be  secured  by  the  owner-occupied  residence  plus
additional collateral.

     Each property proposed as security for a loan must be appraised not more
than six months prior to the  date of such loan.  The combined  loan-to-value
ratio of the first  and second mortgages generally may not exceed  85%.  If a
prior  mortgage exists, Provident  first reviews the  first mortgage history.
If  it contains  open-end, advance or  negative amortization  provisions, the
maximum potential first mortgage balance  is used in calculating the combined
loan-to-value ratio which determines the maximum loan amount.

     For Provident's full documentation process, each mortgage applicant must
provide,  and Provident  must verify,  personal  financial information.   The
applicant's  total monthly obligations (which includes principal and interest
on each mortgage, tax assessments, other loans, charge accounts and all other
scheduled indebtedness) generally cannot exceed 60% of  the applicant's gross
monthly income.   Applicants who are salaried employees  must provide current
employment information in addition to  two recent years of employment history
and Provident verifies this information.   Verifications are based on written
confirmation  from employers  or a  combination of  the two  most recent  pay
stubs,  the two most  recent years' W-2 tax  forms and telephone confirmation
from the  employer.   Self-employed applicants must  be self-employed  in the
same field for  a minimum  of two  years.  The  self-employed applicant  must
provide  signed copies  of  complete federal  income  tax returns  (including
schedules) filed for the most recent two years.

     For Provident's non-income verifier  program, proof of one year  history
of employment plus proof  of current self-employed  status is required.   The
applicant's debt-to-income ratio is  calculated based on income  as certified
by the  borrower on  the application  and must  be reasonable.   The  maximum
combined loan-to-value ratio  may not exceed 80% for  the non-income verifier
program.
 
     A credit  report by an  independent credit reporting agency  is required
reflecting the applicant's complete credit history.  The credit report should
reflect all delinquencies of 30 days or more, repossessions, judgments, 
foreclosures, garnishments, bankruptcies, divorce actions and similar adverse
credit practices that  can be discovered by  a search of public  records.  If
the report  is obtained  more than 60  days prior  to the  loan closing,  the
lender must determine that the reported information has not changed.  Written
verification is obtained of any first mortgage balance if not reported in the
credit bureau.

     Generally, the applicant  should have an acceptable credit history given
the amount  of equity available,  the strength of the  applicant's employment
history  and the level  of the applicant's  income to debt  obligations.  The
rescission period (generally, a period of three days) must have expired prior
to funding  a loan.  The rescission period may not be waived by the applicant
except as  permitted by law.   Either  an ALTA title  insurance policy or  an
attorney's opinion of title is required for all loans.

     The  applicant is  required to  secure property  insurance in  an amount
sufficient  to cover the new loan and any  prior mortgage.  If the sum of the
outstanding  first  mortgage,  if  any,  and the  home  equity  loan  exceeds
replacement value,  insurance  equal to  replacement value  may be  accepted.
Provident must ensure  that its  name and  address is properly  added to  the
"Mortgage Clause" of  the insurance policy.  In the event Provident's name is
added to a  "Loss Payee Clause" and  the policy does not provide  for written
notice  of  policy  changes  or  cancellation,  an  endorsement  adding  such
provision is required.

     Provident's  credit  underwriting  guidelines  require  that  any  major
deferred maintenance on any property must  be cured from the proceeds of  the
loan.

SERVICING AND COLLECTION PROCEDURES

     The following is a description  of the servicing and collection policies
and procedures customarily and currently employed by the Master Servicer with
respect to its  mortgage loan and servicing  portfolio.  The Master  Servicer
revises such  policies and procedures  from time to  time in  connection with
changing economic and market conditions and changing legal requirements.

     Centralized controls  and standards have been established  by the Master
Servicer for the servicing and collection of mortgage loans in its portfolio.
Servicing of the Master Servicer's portfolio is conducted through its primary
office in San Diego, California.  Servicing  includes, but is not limited to,
post-origination  loan   processing,  customer   servicer,  collections   and
liquidations.

     The  Master  Servicer's   collection  policy  emphasizes  working   with
borrowers  in default  in  an effort  to  bring  payments current  and  avoid
foreclosures.   Under  the Master  Servicer's  current collection  procedures
(which may change from time  to time), collectors contact borrowers according
to the following schedule:

        DAYS OF
     DELINQUENCY
     -----------

          7              An initial contact is made  to attempt to arrange  a
                         definite payment arrangement.
          10-20          On the  tenth day of  delinquency, if no  promise to
                         pay has been  established, a letter is  sent, and at
                         least three calls are made within this period, after
                         which a  late charge is  assessed and a  late charge
                         notice is mailed.
          20-30          If  the mortgagor has not been reached, skip tracing
                         begins.   The  credit  application is  consulted for
                         points of contact.   A credit report is  ordered and
                         other creditors are called.
          31             A two month  letter is mailed.  Follow  up calls are
                         made  on  all  accounts lacking  a  promise  to pay.
                         Property  inspections  are  ordered   on  all  loans
                         lacking a promise to pay.
          45-50          Demand letters are mailed.
          65-70          Foreclosure review is performed.  A document file is
                         assembled  for   the   attorney   to   prepare   for
                         foreclosure.  Brokers'  price opinions are requested
                         in  order to  determine  property  value.    If  the
                         delinquent  loan  is   a  second  lien,   the  first
                         lienholder  is  notified  that  the  file  is  being
                         prepared for foreclosure.
          75-80          The  file  is  referred  to  an  attorney  to  begin
                         foreclosure.   All  subsequent  calls regarding  the
                         loan  are referred  to  the attorney.    Foreclosure
                         proceedings  are completed  within  the time  limits
                         designated by the state.

DELINQUENCY AND LOSS EXPERIENCE

     The   following  table  sets  forth  Provident's  delinquency  and  loss
experience on  its total  loan portfolio  of mortgage  loans  similar to  the
Mortgage Loans at  the dates indicated.   There can be no assurance  that the
delinquency and loss experience on the Mortgage Loans will be consistent with
the historical  information provided  below.   Accordingly, this  information
should not be considered to reflect the credit quality of the  Mortgage Loans
included in the  Trust, or  a basis  of assessing the  likelihood, amount  or
severity of  losses on the Mortgage Loans.  The statistical data in the table
is based  on  all of  the  loans in  Provident;s  servicing portfolio.    The
Mortgage  Loans may, in  general, be more  recently originated  than, and are
likely  to have  other  characteristics  which  distinguish  them  from,  the
majority of the loans in Provident's servicing portfolio.

     The information in  the tables below has not been  adjusted to eliminate
the effect of the significant growth in the size of Provident's mortgage loan
portfolio during  the periods  shown.  Accordingly,  loss and  delinquency as
shown if a group of  mortgage loans were artificially isolated at  a point in
time  and the  information showed the  activity only in  that isolated group.
However,  since most  of  the  mortgage loans  in  Provident's mortgage  loan
portfolio are  not fully seasoned,  the delinquency and loss  information for
such an isolated group would also be distorted to some degree.

     The  following table sets forth information  relating to the delinquency
and loss experience of mortgage loans  similar to and including the  Mortgage
Loans for the three quarters ended (December 31, 1995) and (March 31, 1996).



                                                      Quarter Ended
                                                March 31, 1996                 December 31, 1995
                                          Number of         Dollar        Number of
                                            Loans           Amount          Loans        Dollar Amount
                                                                             
Portfolio . . . . . . . . . . . .            (765        $72,345,012         310          $31,214,760
Delinquency percentage(1)
  30-59 days  . . . . . . . . . .           0.26%           0.28%           0.00%            0.00%
  60-89 days  . . . . . . . . . .           0.39%           0.42%           0.00%            0.00%
  90 days or more . . . . . . . .           0.13%           0.13%           0.00%            0.00%
Total . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           0.83%           0.83%           0.00%            0.00%
Percentage of Net Gains/
  (Losses) on liquidated
  loans . . . . . . . . . . . . .           _____%          _____%          _____%          _____%)


- --------------
     (1)  The  period of  delinquency is  based  on the  number  of days  the
          payment is contractually past due.


                      DESCRIPTION OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

GENERAL

     The statistical information  presented in this Prospectus  Supplement is
only with respect to  the Mortgage Loans and describes the  Mortgage Loans in
Loan  Group 1  and the Mortgage  Loans in  Loan Group 2  and is  based on the
characteristics of such Loan Group as of the Cut-Off Date.

     The Mortgage  Loans are  divided into  two Loan  Groups.   Loan Group  1
consists of Mortgage Loans with fixed interest rates.  Loan Group  2 consists
of Mortgage Loans with adjustable interest rates.

     The Mortgage Loans  to be purchased by  the Trust will be  originated or
purchased by Provident and sold by Provident to the Trust.

     The Mortgage  Pool consists of        Mortgage  Loans with an  aggregate
Principal Balance as of the Cut-Off Date of $              (the "Cut-Off Date
Pool Principal Balance").  The Mortgage Pool consists of fixed and adjustable
rate mortgage loans with remaining terms to stated maturity of not more than 
 months (including both fully amortizing and Balloon Loans).  Approximately  
 % of the Mortgage Loans (by Cut-Off Date Pool Principal Balance) were 30  to
59 days delinquent.  No Mortgage Loan was more than 59 days  delinquent as of
the Cut-Off Date.   With respect to  the Mortgage Loans, the  average Cut-Off
Date Principal Balance was $            , the minimum Cut-Off  Date Principal
Balance was $        , the maximum Cut-Off Date Principal Balance was 
$           , the  minimum Loan Rate and the maximum Loan Rate on the Cut-Off
Date were     % and      % per annum, respectively, and the  weighted average
Loan Rate as of the Cut-Off Date was      %  per annum.  The weighted average
Loan-to-Value Ratio of the Mortgage  Loans was      % as of the Cut-Off Date.
Approximately       %  of the Mortgage Loans (by  Cut-Off Date Pool Principal
Balance) are Balloon Loans.  Each Mortgage Loan was originated on or after   
       .  The  remaining terms to stated  maturity as of the Cut-Off  Date of
the Mortgage Loans  range from     months to     months; the weighted average
remaining  term to stated  maturity of the  Mortgage Loans as  of the Cut-Off
Date is     months.  In no event  will more than 5% of the  Cut-Off Date Pool
Principal Balance  of the Mortgage  Pool deviate from the  characteristics of
the Mortgage Loans described herein.

     The Mortgage  Loans provide  that interest is  charged to  the borrowers
thereunder, and  payments are due from such borrowers,  as of a scheduled day
of each month which is fixed  at the time of origination.   Scheduled monthly
payments made by  the borrowers on the Mortgage Loans either earlier or later
than  the  scheduled due  dates  thereof  will  not affect  the  amortization
schedule  or the  relative  application  of such  payments  to principal  and
interest.

LOAN GROUP 1 STATISTICS

     The  sum of the columns below  may not equal the  total indicated due to
rounding.   In addition, unless  otherwise set forth herein,  all percentages
set forth  herein with  respect to  the Mortgage  Loans in  Loan Group  1 are
percentages of the Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal Balance.

     The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 consist of ___ loans, and the related
Mortgaged Properties are  located in __ states and  the District of Columbia.
As of the Cut-Off Date,  the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1  had an aggregate
Principal Balance  of $__________ (the  "Cut-Off Date Loan Group  1 Principal
Balance"), the maximum Principal Balance of any of the Mortgage Loans in Loan
Group 1 was $__________, the minimum Principal Balance thereof was $________,
and the  Principal Balance of such Mortgage  Loans averaged $_________. As of


the Cut-Off Date, the Loan Rates on the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 ranged
from  ____%  to _____%  per annum,  and  the weighted  average Loan  Rate for
Mortgage Loans  in Loan Group  1 was ______%  per annum.   As of  the Cut-Off
Date,  the original term  to stated maturity  of each Mortgage  Loans in Loan
Group 1 was ___ months, the remaining term to stated maturity ranged from ___
months to ___ months, the weighted average remaining term to stated  maturity
was ___ months and the Loan-to-Value Ratio (as defined below) ranged from    
% to       % with a weighted average  Loan-to-Value Ratio of       %.  All of
the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 are secured by first  liens.      % of the
Mortgage  Loans in Loan  Group 1 require  monthly payments  of principal that
will fully amortize  such Mortgage Loans by their  respective maturity dates,
and      % of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1 are Balloon Loans.


                 CUT-OFF DATE LOAN GROUP 1 PRINCIPAL BALANCES

                                          Cut-Off Date      % of Cut-OffDate
Range of Cut-Off         Number of       Loan Group 1       Loan Group 1
Date Principal Balances  Mortgage Loans  Principal Balance  Principal Balance
- -----------------------  --------------  -----------------  -----------------




                     GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION BY STATE(1)
                                 LOAN GROUP 1

                             Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date
          Number of          Loan Group 1          Loan Group 1
State     Mortgage Loans     Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- -----     --------------     -----------------     -----------------










                           LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS(1)
                                 LOAN GROUP 1


                                       Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                      Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Loan-to-Value Ratio   Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -------------------   --------------   -----------------   -----------------












- -------------
(1)  The  Loan-to-Value Ratios ("Loan-to-Value Ratio") shown above are equal,
     with  respect to  each  Mortgage  Loan, to  (i)  the original  principal
     balance of such Mortgage Loan at the date of origination divided by (ii)
     the lesser  of (a) the  value of the  related Mortgaged Property,  based
     upon the appraisal made at the time of origination of such Mortgage Loan
     or (b)  the purchase price  of such  Mortgaged Property if  the Mortgage
     Loan  proceeds  from  such  Mortgage  Loan are  used  to  purchase  such
     Mortgaged Property.



                                  LOAN RATES
                                 LOAN GROUP 1


                                       Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
                      Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Loan Rates            Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ----------            --------------   -----------------   -----------------


















                       ORIGINAL TERM TO STATED MATURITY
                                 LOAN GROUP 1




Original to                             Cut-Off Date       % of Cut-Off Date
Term stated           Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Maturity              Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -----------           --------------   -----------------   -----------------






                     REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY
                                 LOAN GROUP 1




Remaining Term                          Cut-Off Date       % of Cut-Off Date
to stated             Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Maturity              Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- --------------        --------------   -----------------   -----------------











                           MONTHS SINCE ORIGINATION
                                 LOAN GROUP 1


                                       Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
Months since          Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Origination           Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ------------          --------------   -----------------   -----------------








                                PROPERTY TYPE
                                 LOAN GROUP 1

                                       Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date 
                      Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Property Type         Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- -------------         --------------   -----------------   -----------------









                                OCCUPANCY TYPE
                                 LOAN GROUP 1


                                       Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date 
                      Number of        Loan Group 1        Loan Group 1
Occupancy type        Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- --------------        --------------   -----------------   -----------------



     (CONVEYANCE OF SUBSEQUENT MORTGAGE LOANS

     The  Agreement  permits  the  Trust  Fund  to purchase  from  Provident,
subsequent to the date hereof and prior to _______, 19__, Subsequent Mortgage
Loans  in  an amount  not  to  exceed  approximately $________  in  aggregate
principal balance for inclusion  in the Trust Fund.  Each Subsequent Mortgage
Loan will have  been originated or purchased by Provident  in accordance with
the underwriting  guidelines set forth  above under "Underwriting  and Credit
Guidelines."   Accordingly, the  statistical characteristics of  the Mortgage
Pool set forth above are based exclusively  on the Initial Mortgage Loans and
the statistical characteristics  of the Mortgage Pool after  giving effect to
the acquisition of any Subsequent Mortgage  Loans will likely differ from the
information specified herein.  The date  on which Provident  transfers a 
Subsequent  Mortgage Loan to  the Trust Fund shall be referred to herein 
as the "Subsequent Transfer Date".

     In  any event,  each conveyance  of  Subsequent Mortgage  Loans will  be
subject  to,  among  other  things,  the  following  conditions:    (i)  such
Subsequent Mortgage Loans must (a) satisfy the eligibility criteria set forth
in  the Prospectus  under  "The  Loan  Program--Representations  by  Sellers;
Repurchases" and (b) comply  with each representation and warranty  as to the
Mortgage Loans set forth in the Agreement; (ii) such Subsequent Mortgage Loan
must not have been  selected by either  the Seller or  Provident in a  manner
that  it believes  is adverse  to  the interests  of the  Certificateholders,
(iii) no  Subsequent Mortgage  Loan may  be  ___ or  more days  contractually
delinquent as  of the  applicable Cut-Off Date;  (iv) no  Subsequent Mortgage
Loan  may have a  remaining term to maturity  in excess of  ___ years; (v) no
Subsequent  Mortgage Loan  may have  a Mortgage  Rate less  than ____%;  (vi)
following the purchase of such  Subsequent Mortgage Loans by the Trust  Fund,
the Mortgage Loans (a) will have a weighted average Mortgage Rate of at least
____%; (b) will  have a weighted average Loan-to-Value Ratio of not more than
____%; (c) will not have a weighted average remaining term to stated maturity
of more  than ____  months; and  (d)  will, in  each case,  have a  principal
balance in excess  of $_______ as of  the Cut-Off Date; (vii)  Provident (and
the  Trustee shall not  have been notified  by either Rating  Agency that the
conveyance of such Subsequent Mortgage  Loans will result in a qualification,
modification  or  withdrawal of  its  then-current  rating  of any  class  of
Certificates) (shall have  notified each Rating Agency of  such conveyance as
required  by the  Agreement);  and  (viii) the  Trustee  shall have  received
certain opinions of counsel as to, among other things, the enforceability and
validity  of the  transfer agreements  relating  to such  conveyance of  such
Subsequent Mortgage  Loans.)   All Subsequent Mortgage  Loans shall  be added
from a specified group of Mortgage Loans.

LOAN GROUP 2 STATISTICS

     The sum of the columns below may not equal the total indicated due to
rounding.  In addition, unless otherwise set forth herein, all percentages
set forth herein with respect to the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 are
percentages of the Cut-Off Date Loan Group 2 Principal Balance.

     The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 bear interest rates that adjust based
on the London interbank offered rate for six-month United States dollar
deposits.

     The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 consist of _____ loans, and the
related Mortgaged Properties are located in 22 states and the District of
Columbia.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 had an
aggregate Principal Balance of $______________ (the "Cut-Off Date Loan Group
2 Principal Balance"), the maximum Principal Balance of any of the Mortgage
Loans in Loan Group 2 was $__________, the minimum Principal Balance thereof
was $________ and the Principal Balance of such Mortgage Loans averaged
$_________.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the Loan Rates on the Mortgage Loans in
Loan Group 2 ranged from ____% to _____% per annum, and the weighted average
Loan Rate for Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 was _____% per annum.  As of the
Cut-Off Date, the original term to stated maturity of the Mortgage Loans in
Loan Group 2 was ___ months, the remaining term to stated maturity ranged
from ___ months to ___ months, the weighted average remaining term to stated
maturity was ___ months and the Loan-to-Value Ratio (as defined below) ranged
from      % to      % with a weighted average Loan-to-Value Ratio of      %. 
The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 had stated maturities ranging from         
   to             .  (All) of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 require
monthly payments of principal that will fully amortize such Mortgage Loans by
their respective maturity dates.  All of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2
have Loan Rates which adjust semi-annually.  All of the Mortgage Loans in
Loan Group 2 have minimum and maximum Loan Rates.  The weighted average
minimum Loan Rate of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately     
% per annum, with minimum Loan Rates that range from approximately    % per
annum to    % per annum.  The weighted average maximum Loan Rate of the
Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately      % per annum, with
maximum Loan Rates that range from approximately      % per annum to      %
per annum.  The Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 have a weighted average gross
margin of approximately    % per annum, with gross margins that range from
approximately      % per annum to    % per annum.  The Mortgage Loans in Loan
Group 2 have a weighted average periodic cap of approximately    % per annum,
with periodic caps that range from approximately      % per annum to    % per
annum.      % of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 adjust after (one) year;  
   % of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 adjust after (three) years;      %
of the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 adjust after (five) years.  The
weighted average number of months to the next reset date of the Mortgage
Loans in Loan Group 2 is approximately      , with a maximum number of months
of      and a minimum number of months of    .


                 CUT-OFF DATE LOAN GROUP 2 PRINCIPAL BALANCES




Range of Cut-Off                       Cut-Off Date        % of Cut-Off Date
Date Principal        Number of        Loan Group 2        Loan Group 2
Balances              Mortgage Loans   Principal Balance   Principal Balance
- ---------------       --------------   -----------------   -----------------































                     GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION BY STATE(1)
                                 LOAN GROUP 2



                                  Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date    
             Number of            Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
State        Mortgage Loans       Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- -----        --------------       -----------------     -----------------






















- ------------------
(1)  Determined  by  property  address  designated  as such  in  the  related
     Mortgage.




                           LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS(1)
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


                                     Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off  Date
Loan-to-         Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Value Ratio      Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- -----------      --------------      -----------------     -----------------


















- ------------------
(1)  The  Loan-to-Value Ratios ("Loan-to-Value Ratio") shown above are equal,
     with  respect to  each  Mortgage  Loan, to  (i)  the original  principal
     balance of such Mortgage Loan at the date of origination divided by (ii)
     the  lesser of  (a) the value  of the related  Mortgaged Property, based
     upon the appraisal made at the time of origination of such Mortgage Loan
     or (b)  the purchase price  of such  Mortgaged Property if  the Mortgage
     Loan  proceeds  from  such  Mortgage  Loan are  used  to  purchase  such
     Mortgaged Property.


                                  LOAN RATES
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


                                     Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date 
                 Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Loan Rates       Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- ----------       --------------      -----------------     -----------------























                       ORIGINAL TERM TO STATED MATURITY
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


Original Term                        Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date
to Stated        Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Maturity         Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- ------------     --------------      -----------------     -----------------










                     REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


Remaining                            Cut-Off Date         % of Cut-Off Date
Term to            Number of         Loan Group 2         Loan Group 2
Stated Maturity    Mortgage Loans    Principal Balance    Principal Balance
- ---------------    --------------    -----------------    -----------------















                           MONTHS SINCE ORIGINATION
                                 LOAN GROUP 2



                                     Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date
Month since      Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Origination      Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- -----------      --------------      -----------------     -----------------










                                PROPERTY TYPE
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


                                    Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date  
                 Number of          Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Property Type    Mortgage Loans     Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- -------------    --------------     -----------------     -----------------















                                OCCUPANCY TYPE
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


                                      Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date
Occupancy         Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Type              Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- ---------        --------------      -----------------     -----------------












                                    MARGIN
                                 LOAN GROUP 2

                                     Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date 
                 Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Margin           Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- ------           --------------      -----------------     -----------------















                                 LIFETIME CAP
                                 LOAN GROUP 2


                                     Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date 
                 Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
lifetime Cap     Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- ------------     --------------      -----------------     -----------------















                                    FLOOR
                                 LOAN GROUP 2



                                     Cut-Off Date          % of Cut-Off Date 
                 Number of           Loan Group 2          Loan Group 2
Floor            Mortgage Loans      Principal Balance     Principal Balance
- -----            --------------      -----------------     -----------------











                     PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS

GENERAL

     The rate of principal payments on the Offered Certificates of each
Class, the aggregate amount of distributions on the Offered Certificates and
the yield to maturity of the Offered Certificates will be related to the rate
and timing of payments of principal on the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan
Group.  The rate of principal payments on the Mortgage Loans will in turn be
affected by the amortization schedules of the Mortgage Loans and by the rate
of principal prepayments (including for this purpose prepayments resulting
from refinancing, liquidations of the Mortgage Loans due to defaults,
casualties, condemnations and repurchases by the Seller).  The Mortgage Loans
may be prepaid by the Mortgagors at any time.  However, approximately __% of
the Mortgage Loans are subject to prepayment penalties which vary from
jurisdiction to jurisdiction.

     Prepayments, liquidations and purchases of the Mortgage Loans in a Loan
Group (including any optional purchase by the Master Servicer of the
remaining Mortgage Loans in connection with the termination of the Trust)
will result in distributions on the related Offered Certificates of principal
amounts which would otherwise be distributed over the remaining terms of such
Mortgage Loans.  Since the rate of payment of principal of the Mortgage Loans
will depend on future events and a variety of factors, no assurance can be
given as to such rate or the rate of principal prepayments.  The extent to
which the yield to maturity of an Offered Certificate may vary from the
anticipated yield will depend upon the degree to which a Certificate is
purchased at a discount or premium, and the degree to which the timing of
payments thereon is sensitive to prepayments, liquidations and purchases of
such Mortgage Loans.

     The rate of prepayment on the Mortgage Loans cannot be predicted.  The
prepayment experience of the Trust with respect to the Mortgage Loans may be
affected by a wide variety of factors, including economic conditions,
prevailing interest rate levels, the availability of alternative financing
and homeowner mobility and changes affecting the deductibility for Federal
income tax purposes of interest payments on loans.  All of the Mortgage Loans
contain "due-on-sale" provisions, and, with respect to the Mortgage Loans,
the Master Servicer is required by the Agreement to enforce such provisions,
unless such enforcement is not permitted by applicable law.  The enforcement
of a "due-on-sale" provision will have the same effect as a prepayment of the
related Mortgage Loan.  See "CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS--Due-on-Sale
Clauses in Mortgage Loans" in the Prospectus.

     As with fixed rate obligations generally, the rate of prepayment on a
pool of mortgage loans with fixed rates such as the Mortgage Loans in the
Loan Group 1 is affected by prevailing market rates for mortgage loans of a
comparable term and risk level.  When the market interest rate is below the
interest rate on a mortgage, mortgagors may have an increased incentive to
refinance their mortgage loans.  Depending on prevailing market rates, the
future outlook for market rates and economic conditions generally, some
mortgagors may sell or refinance mortgaged properties in order to realize
their equity in the mortgaged properties, to meet cash flow needs or to make
other investments.

     All of the Mortgage Loans in the Loan Group 2 are adjustable-rate
mortgage loans.  As is the case with conventional fixed-rate mortgage loans,
adjustable-rate mortgage loans may be subject to a greater rate of principal
prepayments in a declining interest rate environment.  For example, if
prevailing interest rates fall significantly, adjustable-rate mortgage loans
could be subject to higher prepayment rates than if prevailing interest rates
remain constant because the availability of fixed-rate mortgage loans at
competitive interest rates may encourage mortgagors to refinance their
adjustable-rate mortgage loans at competitive interest rates may encourage
mortgagors to refinance their adjustable-rate mortgage loans to "lock in" a
lower fixed interest rate.  However, no assurance can be given as to the
level of prepayments that the Mortgage Loans will experience.

     In addition to the foregoing factors affecting the weighted average life
of the Offered Certificates, the use of Distributable Excess Spread to pay
principal of the Offered Certificates of the related Certificate Group to the
extent required by the Agreement will result in the acceleration of the Class
A-1 and Class A-6 Certificates, as applicable, relative to the amortization 
of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group in early months of the 
transaction as well as, with respect to Group 1 Certificates, accelerating 
the first date on which each other Class of Group 1 Certificates will begin 
to receive distributions of principal than would otherwise be the case.  
This acceleration feature creates overcollateralization which results 
from the excess of the aggregate Principal Balance of Mortgage Loans in a 
Loan Group over the Aggregate Class A Principal Balance of the related 
Certificate Group.  Once the required level of overcollateralization for 
a Certificate Group is reached, the acceleration feature for such 
Certificate Group will cease, unless necessary to maintain the required 
level of overcollateralization for such Certificate Group. See 
"DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Overcollateralization Provisions."

WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIVES

     Generally, greater than anticipated prepayments of principal will
increase the yield on Offered Certificates purchased at a price less than par
and will decrease the yield on Offered Certificates purchased at a price
greater than par.  The effect on an investor's yield due to principal
prepayments on the Mortgage Loans occurring at a rate that is faster (or
slower) than the rate anticipated by the investor in the period immediately
following the issuance of the Certificates will not be entirely offset by a
subsequent like reduction (or increase) in the rate of principal payments. 
The weighted average life of the Offered Certificates will also be affected
by the amount and timing of delinquencies and defaults on the Mortgage Loans
and the recoveries, if any, on defaulted Mortgage Loans and foreclosed
properties.

     The "weighted average life" of a Certificate refers to the average
amount of time that will elapse from the date of issuance to the date each
dollar in respect of principal of such Certificate is repaid.  The weighted
average life of any Class of the Class A Certificates will be influenced by,
among other factors, the rate at which principal payments are made on the
Mortgage Loans, including, with respect to the Group 1 Certificates, final
payments made upon the maturity of Balloon Loans.

     Prepayments on Mortgage Loans are commonly measured relative to a
prepayment standard or model.  The model used in this Prospectus Supplement
is the prepayment assumption (the "Prepayment Assumption"), which represents
an assumed rate of prepayment each month relative to the then outstanding
principal balance of the pool of mortgage loans for the life of such mortgage
loans.  A 100% Prepayment Assumption assumes a conditional prepayment rate
("CPR") of 4% per annum of the outstanding principal balance of such mortgage
loans in the first month of the life of the mortgage loans and an additional
1.45% (precisely 16/11) (expressed as a percentage per annum) in each month
thereafter until the twelfth month; beginning in the twelfth month and in
each month thereafter during the life of the mortgage loans, a conditional
prepayment rate of 20% per annum each month is assumed.  As used in the table
below, 0% Prepayment Assumption assumes a conditional prepayment rate equal
to 0% of the Prepayment Assumption, i.e., no prepayments.  Correspondingly,
(200)% Prepayment Assumption assumes prepayment rates equal to (200)% of the
Prepayment Assumption, and so forth.  The Prepayment Assumption does not
purport to be a historical description of prepayment experience or a
prediction of the anticipated rate of prepayment of any pool of mortgage
loans, including the Mortgage Loans.  Provident believes that no existing
statistics of which it is aware provide a reliable basis for holders of
Offered Certificates to predict the amount or the timing of receipt of
prepayments on the Mortgage Loans.

     Since the tables were prepared on the basis of the assumptions in the
following paragraph, there are discrepancies between characteristics of the
actual Mortgage Loans and the characteristics of the Mortgage Loans assumed
in preparing the tables.  Any such discrepancy may have an effect upon the
percentages of the Principal Balances outstanding and weighted average lives
of the Offered Certificates set forth in the tables.  In addition, since the
actual Mortgage Loans in the Trust have characteristics which differ from
those assumed in preparing the tables set forth below, the distributions of
principal on the Offered Certificates may be made earlier or later than as
indicated in the tables.

     For the purpose of the tables below, it is assumed that: (i) the
Mortgage Loans consist of pools of loans with the level-pay and balloon
amortization characteristics set forth below, (ii) the Closing Date for the
Class A Certificates is ________________, (iii) distributions on the Class A
Certificates are made on the 25th day of each month regardless of the day on
which the Distribution Date actually occurs, commencing in _____________ and
are made in accordance with the priorities described herein, (iv) the
scheduled monthly payments of principal and interest on the Mortgage Loans
will be timely delivered on the first day of each month (with no defaults),
commencing in _______________, (v) the Mortgage Loans' prepayment rates are a
multiple of the Prepayment Assumption, (vi) all prepayments are prepayments
in full received on the last day of each month (commencing ______________)
and include 30 days' interest thereon, (vii) no optional termination is
exercised, (viii) the Class A Certificates of each Class have the respective
Certificate Rates and initial Class A Principal Balances as set forth herein,
(ix) the overcollateralization levels are set initially as specified in the
Agreement, and thereafter decrease in accordance with the provisions of the
Agreement, ((x) with respect to pools of loans with an assumed Cut-Off Date
of _________________, interest will be calculated at a rate of   % per annum
for one month), (xi) six-month LIBOR for each Interest Period will be      %
and (xii) one-month LIBOR for each Interest Period will be      %.



                                                                              
                                      Original      Original    Remaining
                                      Amortization  Term to     Term to
Amortization    Principal             Term          Maturity    Maturity
Methodology     Balance    Loan Rate  (months)      (months)    (months)
____________    ________   _________  ____________  ________    _________
                                                 


GROUP 1
 Balloon......  $
 Level Pay....  $
 Level Pay....  $



     Subject to the foregoing discussion and assumptions, the following table
indicates the weighted average life of each Class of Class A Certificates,
and sets forth the percentages of the initial Class A Principal Balance of
each such Class of Class A Certificates that would be outstanding after each
of the dates shown at various percentages of Prepayment Assumption.



                                      Months to            Maximum 
Amortization       Princial    Loan   Rate        Gross    Interest
Methodology        Balance     Rate   Change      Margin   Rate
____________       ________    _____  ________    ________  _______

                                            

GROUP 2
  Balloon......     $
  Level Pay....     $
  Level Pay....     $

(table continue)





                                Original       Original   Remaining
                    Minimum     Amortization   Term to    Term to
Amortization        Interest    Term           Maturity   Maturity
Methodology         Rate        (months)       (months)   (months)
____________        ________    ____________   ________   ________
                                             

GROUP 2
  Balloon......     $
  Level Pay....     $
  Level Pay....   $




            PERCENT OF INITIAL CLASS A PRINCIPAL BALANCE OUTSTANDING
           AT THE FOLLOWING PERCENTAGES OF THE PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION


                               CLASS A-1         CLASS A-2
                               _________         _________

DISTRIBUTION DATE        %    %    %    %    %    %    %    %
                         _    _    _    _    _    _    _    _

Initial
 Percentage........      100  100  100  100  100  100  100  100

Weighted Average
 Life (years)*.....

- ------------------
*    The weighted average life of a Certificate of any class is determined by
     (i) multiplying the amount of each distribution in reduction of the
     related Class A Principal Balance by the number of years from the date
     of issuance of the Certificate to the related Distribution Date, (ii)
     adding the results, and (iii) dividing the sum by the highest related
     Principal Balance of the Certificate.


                               CLASS A-3         CLASS A-4
                               _________         _________
   
DISTRIBUTION DATE        %    %    %    %    %    %    %    %
                         _    _    _    _    _    _    _    _

Initial
 Percentage........      100  100  100  100  100  100  100  100

Weighted Average
 Life (years)*.....


- ------------------
*    The weighted average life of a Certificate of any class is determined by
     (i) multiplying the amount of each distribution in reduction of the
     related Class A Principal Balance by the number of years from the date
     of issuance of the Certificate to the related Distribution Date, (ii)
     adding the results, and (iii) dividing the sum by the highest related
     Principal Balance of the Certificate.


                               CLASS A-5         CLASS A-6
                               _________         _________
  
DISTRIBUTION DATE        %    %    %    %    %    %    %    %
                         _    _    _    _    _    _    _    _



Initial
 Percentage........      100  100  100  100  100  100  100  100

Weighted Average
 Life (years)*.....


- ------------------
*    The weighted average life of a Certificate of any class is determined by
     (i) multiplying the amount of each distribution in reduction of the
     related Class A Principal Balance by the number of years from the date
     of issuance of the Certificate to the related Distribution Date, (ii)
     adding the results, and (iii) dividing the sum by the highest related
     Principal Balance of the Certificate.

     These tables have been prepared based on the assumptions described above
(including the assumptions regarding the characteristics and performance of
the Mortgage Loans, which differ from the actual characteristics and
performance thereof) and should be read in conjunction therewith.

                       DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

     The Certificates will be issued pursuant to the Agreement.  The form of
the Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus Supplement and the Prospectus is a part.  The following
summaries describe certain provisions of the Agreement.  The summaries do not
purport to be complete and are subject to, and are qualified in their
entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of the Agreement.  Wherever
particular sections or defined terms of the Agreement are referred to, such
sections or defined terms are hereby incorporated herein by reference.

GENERAL

     The Offered Certificates will be issued in denominations of $1,000 and
multiples of $1 in excess thereof and will evidence specified undivided
interests in the Trust.  The property of the Trust will consist of, to the
extent provided in the Agreement: (i) the Mortgage Loans; (ii) payments on
the Mortgage Loans received on and after the Cut-Off Date (exclusive of
payments in respect of interest on the Mortgage Loans due prior to the
Cut-Off Date and received thereafter); (iii) Mortgaged Properties relating to
the Mortgage Loans that are acquired by foreclosure or deed in lieu of
foreclosure; (iv) the Collection Account and the Distribution Account and
funds on deposit therein (excluding net earnings thereon); and (v) rights
under certain hazard insurance policies covering the Mortgaged Properties. 
In addition, Provident has caused the Certificate Insurer to issue an
irrevocable and unconditional certificate guaranty insurance policy (the
"Policy") for the benefit of the holders of the Class A Certificates,
pursuant to which the Certificate Insurer will guarantee payments to such
Certificateholders as described herein.  Definitive Certificates (as defined
below) will be transferable and exchangeable at the corporate trust office of
the Trustee, which will initially act as Certificate Registrar.  See "--
Book-Entry Certificates" below.  No service charge will be made for any
registration of exchange or transfer of Certificates, but the Trustee may
require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental
charge.

     Each Mortgage Loan in the Trust will be assigned to one of two mortgage
loan groups ("Loan Group 1" and "Loan Group 2", respectively, and each a
"Loan Group").  The Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5
Certificates (collectively, the "Group 1 Certificates") will represent
undivided ownership interests in the Mortgage Loans assigned to Loan Group 1,
all collections thereon (exclusive of payments in respect of interest on such
Mortgage Loan due prior to the Cut-Off Date and received thereafter) and the
proceeds thereof.  The Class A-6 Certificates (the "Group 2 Certificates")
will represent undivided ownership interests in the Mortgage Loans assigned
to Loan Group 2, all collections thereon (exclusive of payments in respect of
interest on such Mortgage Loans due prior to the Cut-Off Date and received
thereafter) and the proceeds thereof.  The principal amount of a Class of
Class A Certificates (each, a "Class A Principal Balance") on any
Distribution Date is equal to the applicable Class A Principal Balance on the
Closing Date minus the aggregate of amounts actually distributed as principal
to the holders of such Class of Class A Certificates.  On any date, the
"Aggregate Class A Principal Balance" is, with respect to the Group 1
Certificates, the aggregate of the Class A Principal Balances of the Class
A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5 Certificates and with
respect to the Group 2 Certificates, the Class A Principal Balance of the
Class A-6 Certificates.

     The Class A Certificates will be issued in six Classes, Class A-1 (the
"Class A-1 Certificates"), Class A-2 (the "Class A-2 Certificates"), Class
A-3 (the "Class A-3 Certificates"), Class A-4 (the "Class A-4 Certificates"),
Class A-5 (the "Class A-5 Certificates") and Class A-6 (the "Class A-6
Certificates").  Only the Class A Certificates (the "Offered Certificates")
are being offered hereby.  Each Class of Offered Certificates represents the
right to receive payments of interest at the Certificate Rate for such Class
and payments of principal as described below.

     The Person in whose name a Certificate is registered as such in the
Certificate Register is referred to herein as a "Certificateholder."

     The "Percentage Interest" of a Class A Certificate as of any date of
determination will be equal to the percentage obtained by dividing the
denomination of such Certificate by the Class A Principal Balance for the
related Class as of the Cut-Off Date.

     The Certificates will not be listed on any securities exchange.

BOOK-ENTRY CERTIFICATES

     The Offered Certificates will be book-entry Certificates (the
"Book-Entry Certificates").  Persons acquiring beneficial ownership interests
in the Offered Certificates ("Certificate Owners") will hold their Offered
Certificates through the Depository Trust Company ("DTC") in the United
States, or CEDEL or Euroclear (in Europe) if they are participants of such
systems, or indirectly through organizations which are participants in such
systems.  The Book-Entry Certificates will be issued in one or more
certificates which equal the aggregate principal balance of the Offered
Certificates and will initially be registered in the name of Cede, the
nominee of DTC.  CEDEL and Euroclear will hold omnibus positions on behalf of
their participants through customers' securities accounts in CEDEL's and
Euroclear's names on the books of their respective depositaries which in turn
will hold such positions in customers' securities accounts in the
depositaries' names on the books of DTC.  Citibank will act as depositary for
CEDEL and Chemical will act as depositary for Euroclear (in such capacities,
individually the "Relevant Depositary" and collectively the "European
Depositaries").  Investors may hold such beneficial interests in the
Book-Entry Certificates in minimum denominations representing Certificate
Principal Balances of $1,000 and in multiples of $1 in excess thereof. 
Except as described below, no person acquiring a Book-Entry Certificate
(each, a "beneficial owner") will be entitled to receive a physical
certificate representing such Certificate (a "Definitive Certificate"). 
Unless and until Definitive Certificates are issued, it is anticipated that
the only "Certificateholder" of the Offered Certificates will be Cede, as
nominee of DTC.  Certificate Owners will not be Certificateholders as that
term is used in the Agreement.  Certificate Owners are only permitted to
exercise their rights indirectly through Participants and DTC.

     The beneficial owner's ownership of a Book-Entry Certificate will be
recorded on the records of the brokerage firm, bank, thrift institution or
other financial intermediary (each, a "Financial Intermediary") that
maintains the beneficial owner's account for such purpose.  In turn, the
Financial Intermediary's ownership of such Book-Entry Certificate will be
recorded on the records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as agent
for the Financial Intermediary, whose interest will in turn be recorded on
the records of DTC, if the beneficial owner's Financial Intermediary is not a
DTC participant and on the records of CEDEL or Euroclear, as appropriate).

     Certificate Owners will receive all distributions of principal of, and
interest on, the Offered Certificates from the Trustee through DTC and DTC
participants.  While the Offered Certificates are outstanding (except under
the circumstances described below), under the rules, regulations and
procedures creating and affecting DTC and its operations (the "Rules"), DTC
is required to make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose behalf
it acts with respect to the Offered Certificates and is required to receive
and transmit distributions of principal of, and interest on, the Offered
Certificates.  Participants and indirect participants with whom Certificate
Owners have accounts with respect to Offered Certificates are similarly
required to make book-entry transfers and receive and transmit such
distributions on behalf of their respective Certificate Owners.  Accordingly,
although Certificate Owners will not possess certificates, the Rules provide
a mechanism by which Certificate Owners will receive distributions and will
be able to transfer their interest.

     Certificate Owners will not receive or be entitled to receive
certificates representing their respective interests in the Offered
Certificates, except under the limited circumstances described below.  Unless
and until Definitive Certificates are issued, Certificate Owners who are not
Participants may transfer ownership of Offered Certificates only through
Participants and indirect participants by instructing such Participants and
indirect participants to transfer Offered Certificates, by book-entry
transfer, through DTC for the account of the purchasers of such Offered
Certificates, which account is maintained with their respective Participants. 
Under the Rules and in accordance with DTC's normal procedures, transfers of
ownership of Offered Certificates will be executed through DTC and the
accounts of the respective Participants at DTC will be debited and credited. 
Similarly, the Participants and indirect participants will make debits or
credits, as the case may be, on their records on behalf of the selling and
purchasing Certificate Owners.

     Because of time zone differences, credits of securities received in
CEDEL or Euroclear as a result of a transaction with a Participant will be
made during subsequent securities settlement processing and dated the
business day following the DTC settlement date.  Such credits or any
transactions in such securities settled during such processing will be
reported to the relevant Euroclear or CEDEL Participants on such business
day.  Cash received in CEDEL or Euroclear as a result of sales of securities
by or through a CEDEL Participant (as defined below) or Euroclear Participant
(as defined below) to a DTC Participant will be received with value on the
DTC settlement date but will be available in the relevant CEDEL or Euroclear
cash account only as of the business day following settlement in DTC.  For
information with respect to tax documentation procedures relating to the
Certificates, see "FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES--Foreign Investors" and
"Backup Withholding" herein and "GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX
DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES--Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax Documentation
Requirements" in Annex I hereto.

     Transfers between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC rules. 
Transfers between CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

     Cross-market transfers between persons holding directly or indirectly
through DTC, on the one hand, and directly or indirectly through CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC
in accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing system by the Relevant Depositary; however, such cross market
transactions will require delivery of instructions to the relevant European
international clearing system by the counterparty in such system in
accordance with its rules and procedures and within its established deadlines
(European time).  The relevant European international clearing system will,
if the transaction meets its settlement requirements, deliver instructions to
the Relevant Depositary to take action to effect final settlement on its
behalf by delivering or receiving securities in DTC, and making or receiving
payment in accordance with normal procedures for same day funds settlement
applicable to DTC.  CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants may not
deliver instructions directly to the European Depositaries.

     DTC, which is a New York-chartered limited purpose trust company,
performs services for its participants, some of which (and/or their
representatives) own DTC.  In accordance with its normal procedures, DTC is
expected to record the positions held by each DTC participant in the
Book-Entry Certificates, whether held for its own account or as a nominee for
another person.  In general, beneficial ownership of Book-Entry Certificates
will be subject to the rules, regulations and procedures governing DTC and
DTC participants as in effect from time to time.

     CEDEL is incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg as a professional
depository.  CEDEL holds securities for its participating organizations
("CEDEL Participants") and facilitates the clearance and settlement of
securities transactions between CEDEL Participants through electronic
book-entry changes in accounts of CEDEL Participants, thereby eliminating the
need for physical movement of certificates.  Transactions may be settled in
CEDEL in any of 28 currencies, including United States dollars.  CEDEL
provides to its CEDEL Participants, among other things, services for
safekeeping, administration, clearance and settlement of internationally
traded securities and securities lending and borrowing.  CEDEL interfaces
with domestic markets in several countries.  As a professional depository,
CEDEL is subject to regulation by the Luxembourg Monetary Institute.  CEDEL
participants are recognized financial institutions around the world,
including underwriters, securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust
companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations.  Indirect
access to CEDEL is also available to others, such as banks, brokers, dealers
and trust companies that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship
with a CEDEL Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     Euroclear was created in 1968 to hold securities for its participants
("Euroclear Participants") and to clear and settle transactions between
Euroclear Participants through simultaneous electronic book-entry delivery
against payment, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of
certificates and any risk from lack of simultaneous transfers of securities
and cash.  Transactions may be settled in any of 32 currencies, including
United States dollars.  Euroclear includes various other services, including
securities lending and borrowing and interfaces with domestic markets in
several countries generally similar to the arrangements for cross-market
transfers with DTC described above.  Euroclear is operated by the Brussels,
Belgium office of Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York (the "Euroclear
Operator"), under contract with Euroclear Clearance Systems S.C., a Belgian
cooperative corporation (the "Cooperative").  All operations are conducted by
the Euroclear Operator, and all Euroclear securities clearance accounts and
Euroclear cash accounts are accounts with the Euroclear Operator, not the
Cooperative.  The Cooperative establishes policy for Euroclear on behalf of
Euroclear Participants.  Euroclear Participants include banks (including
central banks), securities brokers and dealers and other professional
financial intermediaries.  Indirect access to Euroclear is also available to
other firms that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a
Euroclear Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     The Euroclear Operator is the Belgian branch of a New York banking
corporation which is a member bank of the Federal Reserve System.  As such,
it is regulated and examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System and the New York State Banking Department, as well as the Belgian
Banking Commission.

     Securities clearance accounts and cash accounts with the Euroclear
Operator are governed by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear
and the related Operating Procedures of the Euroclear System and applicable
Belgian law (collectively, the "Terms and Conditions").  The Terms and
Conditions govern transfers of securities and cash within Euroclear,
withdrawals of securities and cash from Euroclear, and receipts of payments
with respect to securities in Euroclear.  All securities in Euroclear are
held on a fungible basis without attribution of specific certificates to
specific securities clearance accounts.  The Euroclear Operator acts under
the Terms and Conditions only on behalf of Euroclear Participants, and has no
record of or relationship with persons holding through Euroclear
Participants.

     Distributions on the Book-Entry Certificates will be made on each
Distribution Date by the Trustee to DTC.  DTC will be responsible for
crediting the amount of such payments to the accounts of the applicable DTC
participants in accordance with DTC's normal procedures.  Each DTC
participant will be responsible for disbursing such payments to the
beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents and to
each Financial Intermediary for which it acts as agent.  Each such Financial
Intermediary will be responsible for disbursing funds to the beneficial
owners of the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents.

     Under a book-entry format, beneficial owners of the Book-Entry
Certificates may experience some delay in their receipt of payments, since
such payments will be forwarded by the Trustee to Cede.  Distributions with
respect to Certificates held through CEDEL or Euroclear will be credited to
the cash accounts of CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants in
accordance with the relevant system's rules and procedures, to the extent
received by the Relevant Depositary.  Such distributions will be subject to
tax reporting in accordance with relevant United States tax laws and
regulations.  See "FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES--Foreign Investors" and
"Backup Withholding" herein.  Because DTC can only act on behalf of Financial
Intermediaries, the ability of a beneficial owner to pledge Book-Entry
Certificates to persons or entities that do not participate in the Depository
system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such Book-Entry Certificates,
may be limited due to the lack of physical certificates for such Book-Entry
Certificates.  In addition, issuance of the Book-Entry Certificates in
book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such Certificates in the
secondary market since certain potential investors may be unwilling to
purchase Certificates for which they cannot obtain physical certificates.

     Monthly and annual reports on the Trust will be provided to Cede, as
nominee of DTC, and may be made available by Cede to beneficial owners upon
request, in accordance with the rules, regulations and procedures creating
and affecting the Depository, and to the Financial Intermediaries to whose
DTC accounts the Book-Entry Certificates of such beneficial owners are
credited.

     DTC has advised the Trustee that, unless and until Definitive
Certificates are issued, DTC will take any action permitted to be taken by
the holders of the Book-Entry Certificates under the Agreement only at the
direction of one or more Financial Intermediaries to whose DTC accounts the
Book-Entry Certificates are credited, to the extent that such actions are
taken on behalf of Financial Intermediaries whose holdings include such
Book-Entry Certificates.  CEDEL or the Euroclear Operator, as the case may
be, will take any other action permitted to be taken by a Certificateholder
under the Agreement on behalf of a CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant
only in accordance with its relevant rules and procedures and subject to the
ability of the Relevant Depositary to effect such actions on its behalf
through DTC.  DTC may take actions, at the direction of the related
Participants, with respect to some Class A Certificates which conflict with
actions taken with respect to other Class A Certificates.

     Definitive Certificates will be issued to beneficial owners of the
Book-Entry Certificates, or their nominees, rather than to DTC, only if (a)
DTC or Provident advises the Trustee in writing that DTC is no longer
willing, qualified or able to discharge properly its responsibilities as
nominee and depository with respect to the Book-Entry Certificates and
Provident or the Trustee is unable to locate a qualified successor, (b)
Provident, at its sole option, with the consent of the Trustee, elects to
terminate a book-entry system through DTC or (c) after the occurrence of an
Event of Servicing Termination (as defined under "--Events of Servicing
Termination), beneficial owners having Percentage Interests aggregating not
less than 51% of the aggregate Class A Principal Balance of the Book-Entry
Certificates advise the Trustee and DTC through the Financial Intermediaries
and the DTC participants in writing that the continuation of a book-entry
system through DTC (or a successor thereto) is no longer in the best
interests of beneficial owners.

     Upon the occurrence of any of the events described in the immediately
preceding paragraph, the Trustee will be required to notify all beneficial
owners of the occurrence of such event and the availability through DTC of
Definitive Certificates.  Upon surrender by DTC of the global certificate or
certificates representing the Book-Entry Certificates and instructions for
re-registration, the Trustee will issue Definitive Certificates, and
thereafter the Trustee will recognize the holders of such Definitive
Certificates as Certificateholders under the Agreement.

     Although DTC, CEDEL and Euroclear have agreed to the foregoing
procedures in order to facilitate transfers of Class A Certificates among
participants of DTC, CEDEL and Euroclear, they are under no obligation to
perform or continue to perform such procedures and such procedures may be
discontinued at any time.

     Neither Provident, the Master Servicer nor the Trustee will have any
responsibility for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made on
account of beneficial ownership interests of the Book-Entry Certificates held
by Cede, as nominee for DTC, or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any
records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.


ASSIGNMENT OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     On the Closing Date Provident will transfer to the Trust all of its
right, title and interest in and to each Mortgage Loan, the related Mortgage
Notes, Mortgages and other related documents (collectively, the "Related
Documents"), including all payments received on or with respect to each such
Mortgage Loan on or after the applicable Cut-Off Date (exclusive of payments
in respect of interest on the Mortgage Loans due prior to the Cut-Off Date
and received thereafter).  The Trustee, concurrently with such transfer, will
deliver the Certificates to Provident.  Each Mortgage Loan transferred to the
Trust will be identified on a schedule (the "Mortgage Loan Schedule")
delivered to the Trustee pursuant to the Agreement.  The Mortgage Loan
Schedule will include information as to the Principal Balance of each
Mortgage Loan as of the Cut-Off Date, its Loan Rate as well as other
information.

     (Under the terms of the Agreement, Provident will maintain possession of
the documentation relating to each Mortgage Loan (the "Mortgage File") for so
long as an Assignment Event has not occurred.  Within 60 days of an
Assignment Event, the Seller will cause as soon as practicable the Mortgage
Files pertaining to each Mortgage Loan to be delivered to the Trustee.  In
the Agreement, the Trustee will acknowledge the assignment of the Mortgage
Loans to the Trust and Provident will agree to hold the Mortgage Files for
and on behalf of the Trustee.)

     Within 60 days of an Assignment Event, the Trustee will review the
Mortgage Loans and the Related Documents pursuant to the Agreement and if any
Mortgage Loan or Related Document is found to be defective in any material
respect and such defect is not cured within 90 days following notification
thereof to the Seller, the Seller will be obligated to either (i) substitute
for such Mortgage Loan an Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan; however, such
substitution is permitted only within two years of the Closing Date and may
not be made unless an opinion of counsel is provided to the effect that such
substitution will not disqualify the Trust as a REMIC or result in a
prohibited transaction tax under the Code or (ii) purchase such Mortgage Loan
at a price (the "Purchase Price") equal to the outstanding Principal Balance
of such Mortgage Loan as of the date of purchase, plus all accrued and unpaid
interest thereon, computed at the Loan Rate, net of the Master Servicing Fee
(if Provident is the Master Servicer), plus the amount of any unreimbursed 
Servicing Advances made by the Master Servicer.  The Purchase Price will 
be deposited in the Collection Account on or prior to the next succeeding 
Determination Date after such obligation arises.  The obligation of the 
Seller to repurchase or substitute for a Defective Mortgage Loan is the 
sole remedy regarding any defects in the Mortgage Loans and Related 
Documents available to the Trustee or the Certificateholders.

     In connection with the substitution of an Eligible Substitute Mortgage
Loan, the Seller will be required to deposit in the Collection Account on or
prior to the next succeeding Determination Date after such obligation arises
an amount (the "Substitution Adjustment") equal to the excess of the
Principal Balance of the related Defective Mortgage Loan over the Principal
Balance of such Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan.

     An "Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan" is a Mortgage Loan substituted by
the Seller for a Defective Mortgage Loan which must, on the date of such
substitution, (i) have an outstanding Principal Balance (or in the case of a
substitution of more than one Mortgage Loan for a Defective Mortgage Loan, an
aggregate Principal Balance), not in excess of and not more than 5% less than
the Principal Balance of the Defective Mortgage Loan; (ii) have a Loan Rate
not less than the Loan Rate of the Defective Mortgage Loan and not more than
1% in excess of the Loan Rate of such Defective Mortgage Loan; (iii) if such
Defective Mortgage Loan is in Loan Group 2, have a Loan Rate based on the
same Index with adjustments to such Loan Rate made on the same Interest Rate
Adjustment Date as that of the Defective Mortgage Loan and have a Margin that
is not less than the Margin of the Defective Mortgage Loan and not more than
100 basis points higher than the Margin for the Defective Mortgage Loan; or
(iv) have a Mortgage of the same or higher level of priority as the Mortgage
relating to the Defective Mortgage Loan at the time such Mortgage was trans-
ferred to the Trust; (v) have a remaining term to maturity not more than six
months earlier and not later than the remaining term to maturity of the
Defective Mortgage Loan; (vi) comply with each representation and warranty
set forth in Section 2.04 (deemed to be made as of the date of substitution);
(vii) have an original Loan-to-Value Ratio not greater than that of the
Defective Mortgage Loan; (viii) if such Defective Mortgage Loan is in Loan
Group 2, have a Lifetime Rate Cap and a Periodic Rate Cap no lower than the
Lifetime Rate Cap and Periodic Rate Cap, respectively, applicable to such
Defective Mortgage Loan; and (ix) be of the same type of Mortgaged Property
as the Defective Mortgage Loan or a detached single family residence.  More
than one Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan may be substituted for a Defective
Mortgage Loan if such Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loans meet the foregoing
attributes in the aggregate and such substitution is approved in writing in
advance by the Certificate Insurer.

     The Seller will make certain representations and warranties as to the
accuracy in all material respects of certain information furnished to the
Trustee with respect to each Mortgage Loan (e.g., Cut-Off Date Principal
Balance and the Loan Rate).  In addition, the Seller will represent and
warrant, on the Closing Date, that, among other things: (i) at the time of
transfer to the Trust, the Seller has transferred or assigned all of its
right, title and interest in each Mortgage Loan and the Related Documents,
free of any lien; and (ii) each Mortgage Loan complied, at the time of
origination, in all material respects with applicable state and federal laws. 
Upon discovery of a breach of any such representation and warranty which
materially and adversely affects the interests of the Trust, the
Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer in the related Mortgage Loan
and Related Documents, the Seller will have a period of 60 days after
discovery or notice of the breach to effect a cure. If the breach cannot be
cured within the 60-day period, the Seller will be obligated to (i)
substitute for such Defective Mortgage Loan an Eligible Substitute Mortgage
Loan or (ii) purchase such Defective Mortgage Loan from the Trust.  The same
procedure and limitations that are set forth above for the substitution or
purchase of Defective Mortgage Loans as a result of deficient documentation
relating thereto will apply to the substitution or purchase of a Defective
Mortgage Loan as a result of a breach of a representation or warranty in the
Agreement that materially and adversely affects the interests of the
Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer.

     Mortgage Loans required to be transferred to the Seller as described in
the preceding paragraphs are referred to as "Defective Mortgage Loans."

     Pursuant to the Agreement, the Master Servicer will service and
administer the Mortgage Loans as more fully set forth above.


PAYMENTS ON MORTGAGE LOANS; DEPOSITS TO COLLECTION ACCOUNT AND DISTRIBUTION
ACCOUNT

     The Master Servicer shall establish and maintain in the name of the
Trustee a separate trust account (the "Collection Account") for the benefit
of the holders of the Certificates.  The Collection Account will be an
Eligible Account (as defined below).  Subject to the investment provision
described in the following paragraphs, upon receipt by the Master Servicer of
amounts in respect of the Mortgage Loans (excluding amounts representing the
Master Servicing Fee), the Master Servicer will deposit such amounts in the
Collection Account.  Amounts so deposited may be invested in Eligible
Investments (as described in the Agreement) maturing no later than two
Business Days prior to the next succeeding date on which amounts on deposit
therein are required to be deposited in the Distribution Account.

     The Trustee will establish an account (the "Distribution Account") into
which will be deposited amounts withdrawn from the Collection Account for
distribution to Certificateholders on a Distribution Date.  The Distribution
Account will be an Eligible Account.  Amounts on deposit therein may be
invested in Eligible Investments maturing on or before the Business Day prior
to the related Distribution Date.

     An "Eligible Account" is an account that is (i) maintained with a
depository institution whose debt obligations at the time of any deposit
therein have the highest short-term debt rating by the Rating Agencies, and
whose accounts are fully insured by either the Savings Association Insurance
Fund ("SAIF") or the Bank Insurance Fund ("BIF") of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation established by such fund with a minimum long-term
unsecured debt rating of "A2" by Moody's and "A" by S&P, otherwise acceptable
to each Rating Agency and the Certificate Insurer as evidenced by a letter
from each Rating Agency and the Certificate Insurer to the Trustee, without
reduction or withdrawal of their then current ratings of the Certificates.

     Eligible Investments are specified in the Agreement and are limited to
investments which meet the criteria of the Rating Agencies from time to time
as being consistent with their then current ratings of the Certificates. 
"Eligible Investments" are limited to (i) direct obligations of, or
obligations fully guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest
by, the United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof, provided that
                                                               --------
such obligations are backed by the full faith and credit of the United States; 
(ii) repurchase agreements on obligations specified in clause (i) maturing 
not more than three months from the date of acquisition thereof, provided 
                                                                 ________
that the short-term unsecured debt obligations of the party agreeing to 
repurchase such obligations are at the time rated by each Rating Agency in 
its highest short-term rating category; (iii) certificates of deposit, 
time deposits and bankers' acceptances (which, if Moody's is a Rating Agency, 
shall each have an original maturity of not more than 90 days and, in the case 
of bankers' acceptances, shall in no event have an original maturity of more 
than 365 days) of any U.S. depository institution or trust company 
incorporated under the laws of the United States or any state thereof and 
subject to supervision and examination by federal and/or state banking 
authorities, provided that the unsecured short-term debt obligations of 
             ________
such depository institution or trust company at the date of acquisition
thereof have been rated by each of the Rating Agencies in its highest
unsecured short-term debt rating category; (iv) commercial paper (having
original maturities of not more than 90 days) of any corporation incorporated
under the laws of the United States or any state thereof which on the date of
acquisition has been rated by the Rating Agencies in their highest short-term
rating categories; (v) short term investment funds ("STIFS") sponsored by any
trust company or bank incorporated under the laws of the United States or any
state thereof which on the date of acquisition has been rated by the Rating
Agencies in their respective highest rating category of long term unsecured
debt; (vi) interests in any money market fund which at the date of
acquisition of the interests in such fund and throughout the time as the
interest is held in such fund has the rating specified by each Rating Agency;
and (vii) other obligations or securities that are acceptable to each Rating
Agency as an Eligible Investment hereunder and will not result in a reduction
in the then current rating of the Certificates, as evidenced by a letter to
such effect from such Rating Agency and with respect to which the Master
Servicer has received confirmation that, for tax purposes, the investment
complies with the last clause of this definition; provided that no
                                                  ________
instrument described hereunder shall evidence either the right to receive (a)
only interest with respect to the obligations underlying such instrument or
(b) both principal and interest payments derived from obligations underlying
such instrument and the interest and principal payments with respect to such
instrument provided a yield to maturity at par greater than 120% of the yield
to maturity at par of the underlying obligations; and provided, further, that
                                                      ________  ______
no instrument described hereunder may be purchased at a price greater than 
par if such instrument may be prepaid or called at a price less than its 
purchase price prior to its stated maturity.

ADVANCES

     Not later than two Business Days prior to each Distribution Date, the
Master Servicer will remit to the Trustee for deposit in the Distribution
Account an amount, to be distributed on the related Distribution Date, equal
to the sum of the interest accrued and principal due on each Mortgage Loan
through the related Due Date but not received by the Master Servicer as of
the close of business on the last day of the related Due Period (net of the
Master Servicing Fee) (the "Monthly Advance").  Such obligation of the Master
Servicer continues with respect to each Mortgage Loan until such Mortgage
Loan becomes a Liquidated Mortgage Loan.

     In the course of performing its servicing obligations, the Master
Servicer will pay all reasonable and customary "out-of-pocket" costs and
expenses incurred in the performance of its servicing obligations, including,
but not limited to, the cost of (i) the preservation, restoration and
protection of the Mortgaged Properties, (ii) any enforcement or judicial
proceedings, including foreclosures, and (iii) the management and liquidation
of Mortgaged Properties acquired in satisfaction of the related Mortgage. 
Each such expenditure will constitute a "Servicing Advance".

     The Master Servicer's right to reimbursement for Servicing Advances is
limited to late collections on the related Mortgage Loan, including
Liquidation Proceeds, Insurance Proceeds and such other amounts as may be
collected by the Master Servicer from the related Mortgagor or otherwise
relating to the Mortgage Loan in respect of which such unreimbursed amounts
are owed.  The Master Servicer's right to reimbursement for Monthly Advances
shall be limited to late collections of interest on any Mortgage Loan and to
Liquidation Proceeds and Insurance Proceeds on the related Mortgage Loan. 
The Master Servicer's right to such reimbursements is prior to the rights of
Certificateholders.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Master Servicer is not required to
make any Monthly Advance or Servicing Advance if in the good faith judgment
and sole discretion of the Master Servicer, the Master Servicer determines
that such advance will not be ultimately recoverable from collections
received from the Mortgagor in respect of the related Mortgage Loan or other
recoveries in respect of such Mortgage Loan (a "Nonrecoverable Advance"). 
However, if any Servicing Advance or Monthly Advance is determined by the
Master Servicer to be nonrecoverable from such sources, the amount of such
Nonrecoverable Advance may be reimbursed to the Master Servicer from other
amounts on deposit in the Collection Account.

DISTRIBUTION DATES

     On each Distribution Date, the Offered Certificateholders will be
entitled to receive, from amounts then on deposit in the Distribution
Account, to the extent of funds available therefor in accordance with the
priorities and in the amounts described below under "Priority of
Distributions," an aggregate amount equal to the sum of (a) the Class
Interest Distribution for each Class of Offered Certificates and (b) the
Class A Principal Distribution for each Certificate Group.  Distributions
will be made (i) in immediately available funds to holders of Offered
Certificates holding Certificates, the aggregate principal balance of which
is at least $1,000,000, by wire transfer or otherwise, to the account of such
Certificateholder at a domestic bank or other entity having appropriate
facilities therefor, if such Certificateholder has so notified the Trustee in
accordance with the Agreement, or (ii) by check mailed to the address of the
person entitled thereto as it appears on the register (the "Certificate
Register") maintained by the Trustee as registrar (the "Certificate
Registrar").

DEPOSITS TO THE DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNT

     No later than one Business Day prior to each Distribution Date, the
following amounts in respect of a Loan Group and the previous Due Period
shall be deposited into the Distribution Account and shall constitute the
"Available Funds" for the related Certificate Group for such Distribution
Date: (i) payments of principal and interest on the Mortgage Loans in such
Loan Group (net of amounts representing the Master Servicing Fee with respect
to each Mortgage Loan in the related Loan Group and reimbursement for related
Monthly Advances and Servicing Advances); (ii) Net Liquidation Proceeds and
Insurance Proceeds with respect to the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group (net
of amounts applied to the restoration or repair of a Mortgaged Property);
(iii) the Purchase Price for repurchased Defective Mortgage Loans with
respect to the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group and any related Substitution
Adjustment Amounts; (iv) payments from the Master Servicer in connection with
(a) Monthly Advances, (b) Prepayment Interest Shortfalls and (c) the
termination of the Trust with respect to the Mortgage Loans in such Loan
Group as provided in the Agreement; and (v) any amounts paid under the Policy
in respect of the related Certificate Group.

PRIORITY OF DISTRIBUTIONS

     On each Distribution Date the Trustee shall withdraw from the
Distribution Account the sum of (a) the Available Funds with respect to the
Group 1 Certificates and (b) the Available Funds with respect to the Group 2
Certificates (such sum, the "Amount Available"), and make distributions
thereof as described below and to the extent of the Amount Available:

          A.  With respect to the Group 1 Certificates, the Available Funds
     with respect to such Certificate Group in the following order of
     priority:

               (i)   to the Trustee, the Trustee fee for such Loan Group for
          such Distribution Date;

               (ii)  to holders of each Class of Group 1 Certificates, an
          amount equal to the related Class Interest Distribution for such
          Distribution Date;

               (iii)  sequentially, to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3,
          Class A-4 and Class A-5 Certificateholders, in that order, until
          the respective Class A Principal Balance of each such Class is
          reduced to zero, the related Class A Principal Distribution (other
          than the portion constituting the Distributable Excess Spread) for
          such Distribution Date; provided, however, that after
            --------  -------
          the occurrence and continuance of an Insurer Default, such portion 
          of the Class A Principal Distribution for the Group 1 Certificates 
          will be distributed pro rata to the holders thereof based on the 
          respective Class A Principal Balances;

               (iv) to the Certificate Insurer, the amount owing to the
          Certificate Insurer under the Insurance Agreement for the premium
          payable in respect of the Group 1 Certificates; and

               (v)  sequentially, to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3,
          Class A-4 and Class A-5 Certificateholders, in that order, until
          the respective Class A Principal Balance of each such Class is
          reduced to zero, the related Distributable Excess Spread for such
          Distribution Date; provided, however, that after the
                                    ________  _______
          occurrence and continuance of an Insurer Default, such
          Distributable Excess Spread for the Group 1 Certificates will be
          distributed pro rata to the holders thereof based on the respective
          Class A Principal Balances.

          B.  With respect to the Group 2 Certificates, the Available Funds
     with respect to such Certificate Group in the following order of
     priority:

               (i)  to the Trustee, the Trustee fee for such Loan Group for
          such Distribution Date;

               (ii) to the holders of the Class A-6 Certificates, an amount
          equal to the Class Interest Distribution for the Class A-6
          Certificates for such Distribution Date;

               (iii)     to the holders of the Class A-6 Certificates, the
          Class A Principal Distribution for the Class A-6 Certificates
          (other than the portion constituting the Distributable Excess
          Spread);

               (iv) to the Certificate Insurer, the amount owing to the
          Certificate Insurer under the Insurance Agreement for the premium
          payable in respect of the Group 2 Certificates; and

               (v)  to the holders of the Class A-6 Certificates until the
          Class A-6 Principal Balance is reduced to zero, the related
          Distributable Excess Spread for such Distribution Date.

          C.  On any Distribution Date, to the extent Available Funds for a
     Certificate Group are insufficient to make the distributions specified
     above pursuant to the applicable subclause, Available Funds for the
     other Certificate Group remaining after making the distributions
     required to be made pursuant to the applicable subclause for such other
     Certificate Group shall be distributed to the extent of such
     insufficiency in accordance with the priorities for distribution set
     forth in the subclause above with respect to the Certificate Group
     experiencing such insufficiency.

          D.  After making the distributions referred to in subclauses A, B
     and C above, the Trustee shall make distributions in the following order
     of priority, to the extent of the balance of the Amount Available:

               (i)  to the Master Servicer, the amount of any accrued and
          unpaid Master Servicing Fee;

               (ii) to the Certificate Insurer, amounts owing to the
          Certificate Insurer for reimbursement for prior draws made on the
          Policy;

               (iii)     to the Master Servicer, the amount of Nonrecoverable
          Advances not previously reimbursed;

               (iv) to the Certificate Insurer, any other amounts owing to
          the Certificate Insurer under the Insurance Agreement;

               (v)  to the Class A-6 Certificateholders, the Class A-6
          Interest Carryover; and

               (vi) to the Class R Certificateholders, the balance.

     "Class A-6 Interest Carryover" means, with respect to any Distribution
Date on which the Certificate Rate for the Class A-6 Certificates is based
upon the Net Funds Cap, the excess of (i) the amount of interest the Class A-
6 Certificates would be entitled to receive on such Distribution Date had
such rate been calculated pursuant to the lesser of clause (A) and clause (C)
of the definition of Certificate Rate over (ii) the amount of interest the
Class A-6 Certificates actually receives on such Distribution Date, plus
accrued interest thereon at the rate determined pursuant to clause (i) above
for such Distribution Date.


THE CERTIFICATE RATE

     The "Certificate Rate" for any Interest Period with respect to: the
Class A-1 Certificates will be     % per annum, the Class A-2 Certificates
will be     % per annum, the Class A-3 Certificates will be     % per annum,
the Class A-4 Certificates will be     % per annum and the Class A-5
Certificates will be     % per annum.  Interest in respect of any
Distribution Date will accrue on the Group 1 Certificates during each
Interest Period on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day
months.

     The "Certificate Rate" with respect to the Class A-6 Certificates for an
Interest Period will equal the least of (A) the sum of the LIBOR Rate plus
____% (or ____% for each Distribution Date occurring after the date on which
the Master Servicer has the right to terminate the Trust), (B) the Net Funds
Cap for such Distribution Date and (C) ____% per annum.  With respect to the
Class A-6 Certificates, interest in respect of any Distribution Date will
accrue during each Interest Period on the basis of a 360-day year and the
actual number of days elapsed.

     The "LIBOR Rate" is the rate for United States dollar deposits for one
month which appear on the Telerate Screen LIBO Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M.,
London time, on the second LIBOR Business Day prior to the first day of any
Interest Period relating to the Class A-6 Certificates (or the second LIBOR
Business Day prior to the Closing Date, in the case of the first Distribution
Date).  If such rate does not appear on such page (or such other page as may
replace that page on that service, or if such service is no longer offered,
such other service for displaying the LIBOR Rate or comparable rates as may
be reasonably selected by Provident, after consultation with the Trustee),
the rate will be the Reference Bank Rate.  If no such quotations can be
obtained and no Reference Bank Rate is available, the LIBOR Rate will be the
LIBOR Rate applicable to the preceding Distribution Date.  On the second
LIBOR Business Day immediately preceding each Distribution Date, the Trustee
shall determine the LIBOR Rate for the Interest Period commencing on such
Distribution Date and inform the Master Servicer of such rate.

INTEREST

     On each Distribution Date, to the extent of funds available therefor as
described herein, interest will be distributed with respect to each Class of
Class A Certificates in an amount (each, a "Class Interest Distribution")
equal to the sum of (a) one month's interest at the related Certificate Rate
on the related Class A Principal Balance immediately prior to such
Distribution Date (the "Class Monthly Interest Distributable Amount") and (b)
any Class Interest Carryover Shortfall for such Class of Class A Certificates
for such Distribution Date.  As to any Distribution Date and Class of Class A
Certificates, Class Interest Carryover Shortfall is the sum of (i) the excess
of the related Class Monthly Interest Distributable Amount for the preceding
Distribution Rate and any outstanding Class Interest Carryover Shortfall with
respect to such Class on such preceding Distribution Date, over the amount in
respect of interest that is actually distributed to such Class on such
preceding Distribution Date plus (ii) one month's interest on such excess, to
the extent permitted by law, at the related Certificate Rate.   The interest
entitlement described in (a) above will be reduced by such Class' pro rata
share of Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls, if any, for such Distribution
Date.  Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls will not be covered by payments
under the Policy.

     On each Distribution Date, the Class Interest Distribution for each
Class of Class A Certificates in a particular Certificate Group will be
distributed on an equal priority and any shortfall in the amount required to
be distributed as interest thereon to each such Class will be allocated
between such Classes pro rata based on the amount each such Class would have
been distributed in the absence of such shortfall.  See "--
Crosscollateralization" below.


PRINCIPAL

     On each Distribution Date, to the extent of funds available thereof, in
accordance with the priorities described above under "--Priorities of
Distributions," principal will be distributed to the holders of Class A
Certificates of each Certificate Group then entitled to distributions of
principal in an amount equal to the lesser of (A) the related Aggregate Class
A Principal Balance and (B) the related Class A Principal Distribution for
such Distribution Date.  "Class A Principal Distribution" means, with respect
to any Distribution Date and Certificate Group, the sum of the related Class
A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount for such Distribution Date and any
outstanding Class A Principal Carryover Shortfall as of the close of business
on the preceding Distribution Date.

     "Class A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount" means, with respect to
any Distribution Date and Certificate Group, to the extent of funds available
therefor as described herein the amount equal to the sum of the following
amounts (without duplication) with respect to the immediately preceding Due
Period (as defined below): (i) each payment of principal on a Mortgage Loan
in the related Loan Group received by the Master Servicer during such Due
Period, including all full and partial principal prepayments, (ii) the
Principal Balance as of the end of the immediately preceding Due Period of
each Mortgage Loan in the related Loan Group that became a Liquidated
Mortgage Loan for the first time during the related Due Period, (iii) the
portion of the Purchase Price allocable to principal of all repurchased
Defective Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group with respect to such Due
Period, (iv) any Substitution Adjustment Amounts received on or prior to the
previous Determination Date and not yet distributed with respect to the
related Loan Group and (v) such portion (not greater than 100%) of Excess
Spread, if any, required to be distributed on such Distribution Date to
satisfy the required level of overcollateralization for the related Loan
Group for such Distribution Date (the "Distributable Excess Spread").

     "Class A Principal Carryover Shortfall" means, with respect to any
Distribution Date and Certificate Group, the excess of the sum of the related
Class A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount for the preceding Distribution
Date and any outstanding Class A Principal Carryover Shortfall with respect
to such Certificate Group on such preceding Distribution Date over the amount
in respect of principal that is actually distributed to the Class A
Certificateholders of such Certificate Group on such preceding Distribution
Date.

     If the required level of overcollateralization for a Certificate Group
is reduced below the then existing amount of overcollateralization (described
below) or if the required level of overcollateralization for such Certificate
Group is satisfied, the amount of the related Class A Monthly Principal
Distributable Amount on the following Distribution Date will be
correspondingly reduced by the amount of such reduction or by the amount
necessary such that the overcollateralization will not exceed the required
level of overcollateralization for a Certificate Group after giving effect to
the distribution in respect of principal with respect to such Certificate
Group to be made on such Distribution Date.

     The application of Distributable Excess Spread in respect of a
Certificate Group is intended to create overcollateralization to provide a
source of additional cashflow to cover losses on the Mortgage Loans in the
related Loan Group.  If the amount of losses in a particular Due Period for
such Loan Group exceeds the amount of the related Excess Spread for the
related Distribution Date, subject to the provisions described below under "-
- -Crosscollateralization," the amount distributed in respect of principal will
be reduced.  A draw on the Policy in respect of principal will not be made
until the Class A Principal Balance of a Certificates Group exceeds the
aggregate Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group. 
See "--The Policy" herein.  Accordingly, there may be Distribution Dates on
which Class A Certificateholders receive little or no distributions in
respect of principal.

     So long as an Insurer Default has not occurred and is continuing,
distributions of the Class A Principal Distribution with respect to the Group
1 Certificates will be applied, sequentially, to the distribution of
principal to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5
Certificates, in that order, such that no Class of Group 1 Certificates
having a higher numerical designation is entitled to distributions of
principal until the Class A Principal Balance of each such Class of
Certificates having a lower numerical designation has been reduced to zero. 
On any Distribution Date if an Insurer Default has occurred and is
continuing, the Class A Principal Distribution with respect to the Group 1
Certificates will be applied to the distribution of principal of each such
Class outstanding on a pro rata basis in accordance with the Class A
Principal Balance of each such Class.

     On each Distribution Date following an Insurer Default, net losses
realized in respect of Liquidated Mortgage Loans in a Loan Group (to the
extent such amount is not covered by Available Funds from the related Loan
Group or the crosscollateralization mechanics described herein) will reduce
the amount of overcollateralization, if any, with respect to the related
Certificate Group.

     "Due Period" means, with respect to any Determination Date or
Distribution Date, the calendar month immediately preceding such
Determination Date or Distribution Date, as the case may be.

     A "Liquidated Mortgage Loan", as to any Distribution Date, is a Mortgage
Loan with respect to which the Master Servicer has determined, in accordance
with the servicing procedures specified in the Agreement, as of the end of
the preceding Due Period, that all Liquidation Proceeds which it expects to
recover with respect to such Mortgage Loan (including disposition of the
related REO Property) have been recovered.

     "Excess Spread" means, with respect to any Distribution Date and Loan
Group, the positive excess, if any, of (x) Available Funds for the related
Certificate Group for such Distribution Date over (y) the amount required to
be distributed pursuant to subclause A items (i) through (iv), with respect
to the Group 1 Certificates and subclause B items (i) through (iv), with
respect to the Group 2 Certificates, in each case set forth under the heading
"DESCRIPTION OF CERTIFICATES--Priority of Distributions" on such Distribution
Date.

     An "Insurer Default" will occur in the event the Certificate Insurer
fails to make a payment required under the Policy or if certain events of
bankruptcy or insolvency occur with respect to the Certificate Insurer.

THE POLICY

     The following information has been supplied by the Certificate Insurer
for inclusion in this Prospectus Supplement.  Accordingly, neither Provident
nor the Master Servicer makes any representation as to the accuracy and
completeness of such information.

     The Certificate Insurer, in consideration of the payment of the premium
and subject to the terms of the Policy, thereby unconditionally and
irrevocably guarantees to any Owner that an amount equal to each full and
complete Insured Payment will be received by __________________________, or
its successor, as trustee for the Owners (the "Trustee"), on behalf of the
Owners from the Certificate Insurer, for distribution by the Trustee to each
Owner of each Owner's proportionate share of the Insured Payment.  The
Certificate Insurer's obligations under the Policy with respect to a
particular Insured Payment shall be discharged to the extent funds equal to
the applicable Insured Payment are received by the Trustee, whether or not
such funds are properly applied by the Trustee.  Insured Payments shall be
made only at the time set forth in the Policy and no accelerated Insured
Payments shall be made regardless of any acceleration of the Class A
Certificates, unless such acceleration is at the sole option of the
Certificate Insurer.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph, the Policy does not cover
shortfalls, if any, attributable to the liability of the Trust, the REMIC or
the Trustee for withholding taxes, if any (including interest and penalties
in respect of any such liability).

     The Certificate Insurer will pay any Insured Payment that is a
Preference Amount on the Business Day following receipt on a Business Day by
the Fiscal Agent (as described below) of (i) a certified copy of the order
requiring the return of a preference payment, (ii) an opinion of counsel
satisfactory to the Certificate Insurer that such order is final and not
subject to appeal, (iii) an assignment in such form as is reasonably required
by the Certificate Insurer, irrevocably assigning to the Certificate Insurer
all rights and claims of the Owner relating to or arising under the Class A
Certificates against the debtor that made such preference payment or
otherwise with respect to such Preference Amount and (iv) appropriate
instruments to effect the appointment of the Certificate Insurer as agent for
such Owner in any legal proceeding related to such Preference Amount, such
instruments being in a form satisfactory to the Certificate Insurer, provided
that if such documents are received after 12:00 noon New York City time on
such Business Day, they will be deemed to be received on the following
Business Day.  Such payments shall be disbursed to the receiver or trustee in
bankruptcy named in the final order of the court exercising jurisdiction on
behalf of the Owners and not any Owner directly unless such Owner has
returned principal or interest paid on the Class A Certificates to such
receiver or trustee in bankruptcy, in which case such payment shall be
disbursed to such Owner.

     The Certificate Insurer will pay any other amount payable under the
Policy no later than 12:00 noon New York City time on the later of the
Distribution Date on which the Deficiency Amount is due or the Business Day
following receipt in New York, New York on a Business Day by State Street
Bank and Trust Company, N.A., as Fiscal Agent for the Certificate Insurer or
any successor fiscal agent appointed by the Certificate Insurer (the "Fiscal
Agent") of a Notice (as described below); provided that if 
                                                       ________
such Notice is received after 12:00 noon New York City time on such Business
Day, it will be deemed to be received on the following Business Day.  If any
such Notice received by the Fiscal Agent is not in proper form or is
otherwise insufficient for the purpose of making claim under the Policy it
shall be deemed not to have been received by the Fiscal Agent for purposes of
this paragraph, and the Certificate Insurer or the Fiscal Agent, as the case
may be, shall promptly so advise the Trustee and the Trustee may submit an
amended Notice.

     Insured Payments due under the Policy unless otherwise stated therein
will be disbursed by the Fiscal Agent to the Trustee on behalf of the Owners
by wire transfer of immediately available funds in the amount of the Insured
Payment less, in respect of Insured Payments related to Preference Amounts,
any amount held by the Trustee for the payment of such Insured Payment and
legally available therefor.

     The Fiscal Agent is the agent of the Certificate Insurer only and the
Fiscal Agent shall in no event be liable to the Owners for any acts of the
Fiscal Agent or any failure of the Certificate Insurer to deposit or cause to
be deposited, sufficient funds to make payments due under the Policy.

     As used in the Policy, the following terms shall have the following
meanings:

          "Agreement" means the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of
     _________________, between The Provident Bank, as Seller and Master
     Servicer, and the Trustee, as trustee, without regard to any amendment
     or supplement thereto unless such amendment or modification has been
     approved in writing by the Certificate Insurer.

          "Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday, a Sunday or a
     day on which banking institutions in New York City or the city in which
     the corporate trust office of the Trustee under the Agreement is located
     are authorized or obligated by law or executive order to close.

          "Deficiency Amount" means for any Distribution Date (A) the excess,
     if any, of (i) Class Monthly Interest Distributable Amount (net of any
     Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls) plus any Class Interest Carryover
     Shortfall over (ii) funds on deposit in the Distribution Account (net of
     the Trustee's Fee and the Insurance Premium for such Distribution Date)
     and (B) the Guaranteed Principal Amount.

          "Guaranteed Principal Amount" means for any Distribution Date (a)
     the amount which is required to reduce the then outstanding Class A
     Principal Balance after giving effect to the distributions, if any, to
     the Holders in respect of principal on such Distribution Date to an
     amount equal to the Aggregate Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans as
     of the last day of the immediately preceding Due Period and (b) on
     __________, ____ after all distributions have been made including
     distributions pursuant to clause (a) of this definition of "Guaranteed
     Principal Amount," an amount equal to the then outstanding Class A
     Principal Balance.

          "Insured Payment" means (i) as of any Distribution Date, any
     Deficiency Amount and (ii) any Preference Amount.

          "Notice" means the telephonic or telegraphic notice, promptly
     confirmed in writing (in the case of a telephonic notice) by telecopy,
     substantially in the form of Exhibit A attached to the Policy, the
     original of which is subsequently delivered by registered or certified
     mail, from the Trustee specifying the Insured Payment which shall be due
     and owing on the applicable Distribution Date.

          "Owner" means each Holder (as defined in the Agreement) who, on the
     applicable Distribution Date, is entitled under the terms of the
     applicable Class A Certificates to payment under the Policy.

          "Preference Amount" means any amount previously distributed to an
     Owner on the Class A Certificates that is recoverable and sought to be
     recovered as a voidable preference by a trustee in bankruptcy pursuant
     to the United States Bankruptcy Code (11 U.S.C.), as amended from time
     to time in accordance with a final nonappealable order of a court having
     competent jurisdiction.

     Capitalized terms used in the Policy and not otherwise defined in the
Policy shall have the respective meanings set forth in the Agreement as of
the date of execution of the Policy, without giving effect to any subsequent
amendment or modification to the Agreement unless such amendment or
modification has been approved in writing by the Certificate Insurer.

     Any notice under the Policy or service of process on the Fiscal Agent
may be made at the address listed below for the Fiscal Agent or such other
address as the Certificate Insurer shall specify to the Trustee in writing.

     The notice address of the Fiscal Agent is
_________________________________ Attention: ________________, or such other
address as the Fiscal Agent shall specify to the Trustee in writing.

     The Policy is being issued under and pursuant to, and shall be construed
under, the laws of the State of New York, without giving effect to the
conflict of laws principles thereof.

     The insurance provided by the Policy is not covered by the
Property/Casualty Insurance Security Fund specified in Article 76 of the New
York Insurance Law.

     The Policy is not cancelable for any reason.  The premium on the Policy
is not refundable for any reason including payment, or provision being made
for payment, prior to the maturity of the Class A Certificates.

OVERCOLLATERALIZATION

     The credit enhancement provisions of the Trust result in a limited
acceleration of the Class A Certificates of a Certificate Group relative to
the amortization of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group in the early
months of the transaction.  The accelerated amortization is achieved by the
application of Distributable Excess Spread relating to a Loan Group to
principal distributions on the Class A Certificates of the related
Certificate Group.  This acceleration feature creates, with respect to each
Certificate Group, overcollateralization (i.e., the excess of the aggregate
outstanding Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group
over the related Aggregate Class A Principal Balance).  Once the required
level of overcollateralization is reached for a Certificate Group, and
subject to the provisions described in the next paragraph, the acceleration
feature for such Certificate Group will cease, until necessary to maintain
the required level of overcollateralization for such Certificate Group.

     The Agreement provides that, subject to certain floors, caps and
triggers, the required level of overcollateralization with respect to a
Certificate Group may increase or decrease over time.  Any decrease in the
required level of overcollateralization for a Loan Group will occur only at
the sole discretion of the Certificate Insurer.  Any such decrease will have
the effect of reducing the amortization of the Class A Certificates of the
related Certificate Group below what it otherwise would have been.

CROSSCOLLATERALIZATION

     Excess Spread with respect to a Loan Group will be available to cover
certain shortfalls with respect to the Offered Certificates relating to the
other Loan Group as described above under the caption "--Priority of
Distributions".

(PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

     On the Closing Date, $___________ (the "Pre-Funded Amount") will be
deposited in an account (the "Pre-Funding Account"), which account shall be
in the name of and maintained by the Trustee and shall be part of the Trust
Fund and will be used to acquire Subsequent Mortgage Loans.  During the
period beginning on the Closing Date and terminating on _____________, 19__
(the "Funding Period"), the Pre-Funded Amount will be reduced by the amount
thereof used to purchase Subsequent Mortgage Loans in accordance with the
Agreement.  Any Pre-Funded Amount remaining at the end of the Funding Period
will be distributed to holders of the classes of Certificates entitled to
receive principal on the Distribution Date in ______________, 19__ in
reduction of the related Certificate Principal Balances (thus resulting in a
partial principal prepayment of the related Certificates on such date). 

     Amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account will be invested in
Permitted Investments.  All interest and any other investment earnings on
amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account will be deposited in the
Capitalized Interest Account.  The Pre-Funding Account shall not be an asset
of the REMIC.  All reinvestment earnings on the Pre-Funding Account shall be
owned by, and be taxable to, the Seller.

CAPITALIZED INTEREST ACCOUNT

     On the Closing Date there will be deposited in an account (the
"Capitalized Interest Account") maintained with and in the name of the
Trustee on behalf of the Trust Fund a portion of the proceeds of the sale of
the Certificates.  The amount deposited therein will be used by the Trustee
on the Distribution Dates in __________________ 19__, _____________ 19__ and
______________, 19__ to cover shortfalls in interest on the Certificates that
may arise as a result of the utilization of the Pre-Funding Account for the
purchase by the Trust Fund of Subsequent Mortgage Loans after the Closing
Date.  Any amounts remaining in the Capitalized Interest Account at the end
of the Funding Period which are not needed to cover shortfalls on the
Distribution Date in ___________ 19__ are required to be paid directly to
Provident.)  The Capitalized Interest Account shall not be an asset of the
REMIC.  All reinvestment earnings on the Capitalized Interest Account shall
be owned by, and be taxable to, the Seller.)

REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS

     Concurrently with each distribution to the Certificateholders, the
Trustee will forward to each Certificateholder a statement (based solely on
information received from the Master Servicer) setting forth among other
items with respect to each Distribution Date:

          (i)    the aggregate amount of the distribution to each Class of
     Certificateholders on such Distribution Date;

          (ii)   the amount of distribution set forth in paragraph (i) above
     in respect of interest and the amount thereof in respect of any Class
     Interest Carryover Shortfall, and the amount of any Class Interest
     Carryover Shortfall remaining;

          (iii)   the amount of distribution set forth in paragraph (i) above
     in respect of principal and the amount thereof in respect of the Class A
     Principal Carryover Shortfall, and any remaining Class A Principal
     Carryover Shortfall;

          (iv)  the amount of Excess Spread for each Loan Group and the
     amount applied as to a distribution on the Certificates;

          (v)    the Guaranteed Principal Amount with respect to each
     Certificate Group, if any, for such Distribution Date;

          (vi)   the amount paid under the Policy for such Distribution Date
     in respect of the Class Interest Distribution to each Class of
     Certificates;

          (vii)   the Master Servicing Fee;

          (viii)  the Pool Principal Balance, the Loan Group 1 Principal
     Balance and the Loan Group 2 Principal Balance, in each case as of the
     close of business on the last day of the preceding Due Period;

          (ix) the Aggregate Class A Principal Balance of each Certificate
     Group after giving effect to payments allocated to principal above;

          (x)  the amount of overcollateralization relating to each Loan
     Group as of the close of business on the Distribution Date, after giving
     effect to distributions of principal on such Distribution Date;

          (xi) the number and aggregate Principal Balances of the Mortgage
     Loans as to which the minimum monthly payment is delinquent for 30-59
     days, 60-89 days and 90 or more days, respectively, as of the end of the
     preceding Due Period;

          (xii)     the book value of any real estate which is acquired by
     the Trust through foreclosure or grant of deed in lieu of foreclosure;

          (xiii)    the aggregate amount of prepayments received on the
     Mortgage Loans during the previous Due Period and specifying such amount
     for each Loan Group; and

          (xiv)     the weighted average Loan Rate on the Mortgage Loans and
     specifying such weighted average Loan Rate for each Loan Group as of the
     first day of the month prior to the Distribution Date.

     In the case of information furnished pursuant to clauses (ii) and (iii)
above, the amounts shall be expressed as a dollar amount per Certificate with
a $1,000 denomination.

     Within 60 days after the end of each calendar year, the Trustee will
forward to each Person, if requested in writing by such Person, who was a
Certificateholder during the prior calendar year a statement containing the
information set forth in clauses (ii) and (iii) above aggregated for such
calendar year.

LAST SCHEDULED DISTRIBUTION DATE

     The last scheduled Distribution Date for each Class of Offered
Certificates is as follows: Class A-1 Certificates,              ; Class A-2
Certificates,              ; Class A-3 Certificates,              ; Class A-4
Certificates,              ; Class A-5 Certificates,              ; and Class
A-6 Certificates,              .  It is expected that the actual last
Distribution Date for each Class of Offered Certificates will occur
significantly earlier than such scheduled Distribution Dates.  See
"PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS".

     Such last scheduled Distribution Dates are based on a 0% Prepayment
Assumption with no Distributable Excess Spread used to make accelerated
payments of principal to the holders of the related Offered Certificates and
the assumptions set forth above under "PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS--
Weighted Average Lives"; provided that the last scheduled Distribution Dates
                         --------
for the Class A-5 Certificates and the Class A-6 Certificates have been
calculated assuming that the Mortgage Loan in the related Loan Group having
the latest maturity date allowed by the Agreement amortizes according to its
terms, plus one year.

COLLECTION AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES ON MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Master Servicer will make reasonable efforts to collect all payments
called for under the Mortgage Loans and will, consistent with the Agreement,
follow such collection procedures as it follows from time to time with
respect to the loans in its servicing portfolio comparable to the Mortgage
Loans.  Consistent with the above, the Master Servicer may in its discretion
waive any late payment charge or any assumption or other fee or charge that
may be collected in the ordinary course of servicing the Mortgage Loans.

     With respect to the Mortgage Loans, the Maser Servicer may arrange with
a borrower a schedule for the payment of interest due and unpaid for a
period, provided that any such arrangement is consistent with the Master
Servicer's policies with respect to the mortgage loans it owns or services.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     The Master Servicer will cause to be maintained fire and hazard
insurance with extended coverage customary in the area where the Mortgaged
Property is located, in an amount which is at least equal to the least of (i)
the outstanding Principal Balance on the Mortgage Loan and any related senior
lien(s), (ii) the full insurable 

value of the premises securing the Mortgage Loan and (iii) the minimum amount
required to compensate for damage or loss on a replacement cost basis in each
case in an amount not less than such amount as is necessary to avoid the
application of any co-insurance clause contained in the related hazard
insurance policy.  Generally, if the Mortgaged Property is in an area
identified in the Federal Register by the Flood Emergency Management Agency
as FLOOD ZONE "A", such flood insurance has been made available and the
Master Servicer determines that such insurance is necessary in accordance
with accepted mortgage servicing practices of prudent lending institutions,
the Master Servicer will cause to be purchased a flood insurance policy with
a generally acceptable insurance carrier, in an amount representing coverage
not less than the least of (a) the outstanding Principal Balance of the
Mortgage Loan, (b) the full insurable value of the Mortgaged Property, or (c)
the maximum amount of insurance available under the National Flood Insurance
Act of 1968, as amended.  The Master Servicer will also maintain on REO
Property, to the extent such insurance is available, fire and hazard
insurance in the applicable amounts described above, liability insurance and,
to the extent required and available under the National Flood Insurance Act
of 1968, as amended, and the Master Servicer determines that such insurance
is necessary in accordance with accepted mortgage servicing practices of
prudent lending institutions, flood insurance in an amount equal to that
required above.  Any amounts collected by the Master Servicer under any such
policies (other than amounts to be applied to the restoration or repair of
the Mortgaged Property, or to be released to the Mortgagor in accordance with
customary mortgage servicing procedures) will be deposited in the Collection
Account, subject to retention by the Master Servicer to the extent such
amounts constitute servicing compensation or to withdrawal pursuant to the
Agreement.

     In the event that the Master Servicer obtains and maintains a blanket
policy as provided in the Agreement insuring against fire and hazards of
extended coverage on all of the Mortgage Loans, then, to the extent such
policy names the Master Servicer as loss payee and provides coverage in an
amount equal to the aggregate unpaid principal balance of the Mortgage Loans
without coinsurance, and otherwise complies with the requirements of the
first paragraph of this subsection, the Master Servicer will be deemed
conclusively to have satisfied its obligations with respect to fire and
hazard insurance coverage.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Master Servicer will foreclose upon or otherwise comparably convert
to ownership Mortgaged Properties securing such of the Mortgage Loans as come
into default when, in accordance with applicable servicing procedures under
the Agreement, no satisfactory arrangements can be made for the collection of
delinquent payments.  In connection with such foreclosure or other
conversion, the Master Servicer will follow such practices as it deems
necessary or advisable and as are in keeping with its general mortgage
servicing activities, provided that the Master Servicer will not be required
to expend its own funds in connection with foreclosure or other conversion,
correction of default on a related senior mortgage loan or restoration of any
property unless, in its sole judgment, such foreclosure, correction or
restoration will increase Net Liquidation Proceeds.  The Master Servicer will
be reimbursed out of Liquidation Proceeds for advances of its own funds as
liquidation expenses before any Net Liquidation Proceeds are distributed to
Certificateholders.

SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     With respect to each Due Period, the Master Servicer will receive from
interest payments in respect of the Mortgage Loans a portion of such interest
payments as a monthly Master Servicing Fee in the amount equal to 0.50% per
annum (the "Master Servicing Fee Rate") on the Principal Balance of each
Mortgage Loan as of the first day of each such Due Period.  All assumption
fees, late payment charges and other fees and charges, to the extent
collected from borrowers, will be retained by the Master Servicer as
additional servicing compensation.

     The Master Servicer's right to reimbursement for unreimbursed Servicing
Advances is limited to late collections on the related Mortgage Loan,
including Liquidation Proceeds, Insurance Proceeds and such other amounts as
may be collected by the Master Servicer from the related Mortgagor or
otherwise relating to the Mortgage Loan in respect of which such unreimbursed
amounts are owed.  The Master Servicer's right to reimbursement for
unreimbursed Monthly Advances shall be limited to late collections of
interest on any Mortgage Loan and to liquidation proceeds and insurance
proceeds on the related Mortgage Loan.  The Master Servicer's right to such
reimbursements is prior to the rights of Certificateholders.  However, if any
Servicing Advance or Monthly Advance is determined by the Master Servicer to
be nonrecoverable from such sources, the amount of such nonrecoverable
advances may be reimbursed to the Master Servicer from other amounts on
deposit in the Collection Account.

     Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls will not be covered by the Policy,
although Prepayment Interest Shortfalls, after application of the Master
Servicing Fee, will be so covered.  The Master Servicer is not obligated to
offset any of the Master Servicing Fee against, or to provide any other funds
to cover, any shortfalls in interest collections on the Mortgage Loans that
are attributable to the application of the Civil Relief Act ("Civil Relief
Act Interest Shortfalls").  See "RISK FACTORS--Payments on the Mortgage
Loans" in this Prospectus Supplement.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

     The Agreement provides for delivery on or before the last day of the
fifth month following the end of the Master Servicer's fiscal year, beginning
in 1997, to the Trustee, Provident, the Certificate Insurer and the Rating
Agencies of an annual statement signed by an officer of the Master Servicer
to the effect that the Master Servicer has fulfilled its material obligations
under the Agreement throughout the preceding fiscal year, except as specified
in such statement.

     On or before the last day of the fifth month following the end of the
Master Servicer's fiscal year, beginning in ____, the Master Servicer will
furnish a report prepared by a firm of nationally recognized independent
public accountants (who may also render other services to the Master Servicer
or Provident) to the Trustee, Provident, the Certificate Insurer and the
Rating Agencies to the effect that such firm has examined certain documents
and the records relating to servicing of the Mortgage Loans under the Uniform
Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers and such firm's conclusion
with respect thereto.

     The Master Servicer's fiscal year is the calendar year.

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER

     The Agreement provides that the Master Servicer may not resign from its
obligations and duties thereunder, except in connection with a permitted
transfer of servicing, unless (i) such duties and obligations are no longer
permissible under applicable law as evidenced by an opinion of counsel
delivered to the Certificate Insurer or (ii) upon the satisfaction of the
following conditions: (a) the Master Servicer has proposed a successor master
servicer to the Trustee in writing and such proposed successor master
servicer is reasonably acceptable to the Trustee; (b) the Rating Agencies
have confirmed to the Trustee that the appointment of such proposed successor
master servicer as the Master Servicer will not result in the reduction or
withdrawal of the then current rating of the Certificates; and (c) such
proposed successor master servicer is reasonably acceptable to the
Certificate Insurer.  No such resignation will become effective until the
Trustee or a successor master servicer has assumed the Master Servicer's
obligations and duties under the Agreement.

     The Master Servicer may perform any of its duties and obligations under
the Agreement through one or more subservicers or delegates, which may be
affiliates of the Master Servicer.  Notwithstanding any such arrangement, the
Master Servicer will remain liable and obligated to the Trustee and the
Certificateholders for the Master Servicer's duties and obligations under the
Agreement, without any diminution of such duties and obligations and as if
the Master Servicer itself were performing such duties and obligations.

     The Master Servicer may agree to changes in the terms of a Mortgage
Loan, provided, however, that such changes (i) will not cause the Trust to
fail to qualify as a REMIC and do not adversely affect the interests of the
Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer, (ii) are consistent with
prudent business practices and (iii) do not change the Loan Rate of such
Mortgage Loan or extend the maturity date of such Mortgage Loan in excess of
one year.  Any changes to the terms of a Mortgage Loan that would cause the
Trust to fail to qualify as a REMIC, however, may be agreed to by the Master
Servicer, provided that the Master Servicer has determined such changes are
necessary to avoid a prepayment of such Mortgage Loan, such changes are in
accordance with prudent business practices and the Master Servicer purchases
such Mortgage Loan in accordance with the terms of the Agreement.

     The Agreement provides that the Master Servicer will indemnify the Trust
and the Trustee from and against any loss, liability, expense, damage or
injury suffered or sustained as a result of the Master Servicer's actions or
omissions in connection with the servicing and administration of the Mortgage
Loans which are not in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement.  The
Agreement provides that neither Provident nor the Master Servicer nor their
directors, officers, employees or agents will be under any other liability to
the Trust, the Trustee, the Certificateholders or any other person for any
action taken or for refraining from taking any action pursuant to the
Agreement.  However, neither Provident nor the Master Servicer will be
protected against any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of
willful misconduct, bad faith or gross negligence of Provident or the Master
Servicer, as the case may be, in the performance of its duties under the
Agreement or by reason of reckless disregard of its obligations thereunder. 
In addition, the Agreement provides that the Master Servicer will not be
under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which
is not incidental to its servicing responsibilities under the Agreement.  The
Master Servicer may, in its sole discretion, undertake any such legal action
which it may deem necessary or desirable with respect to the Agreement and
the rights and duties of the parties thereto and the interest of the
Certificateholders thereunder.

     Any corporation into which the Master Servicer may be merged or
consolidated, or any corporation resulting from any merger, conversion or
consolidation to which the Master Servicer shall be a party, or any
corporation succeeding to the business of the Master Servicer shall be the
successor of the Master Servicer under the Agreement, without the execution
or filing of any paper or any further act on the part of any of the parties
to the Agreement, anything in the Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     "Events of Default" will consist of: (i) (A) any failure of the Master
Servicer to make any required Monthly Advance or (B) any other failure of the
Master Servicer to deposit in the Collection Account or Distribution Account
any deposit required to be made under the Agreement, which failure continues
unremedied for two Business Days after the giving of written notice of such
failure to the Master Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and
the Trustee by the Certificate Insurer or any Certificateholder; (ii) any
failure by the Master Servicer duly to observe or perform in any material
respect any other of its covenants or agreements in the Agreement which, in
each case, materially and adversely affects the interests of the
Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer and continues unremedied for 60
days after the giving of written notice of such failure to the Master
Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and the Trustee by the
Certificate Insurer or any Certificateholder; (iii) any failure by the Master
Servicer to make any required Servicing Advance, which failure continues
unremedied for a period of 30 days after the giving of written notice of such
failure to the Master Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and
the Trustee by the Certificate Insurer or any Certificateholder; or (iv)
certain events of insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and
liabilities or similar proceedings relating to the Master Servicer and
certain actions by the Master Servicer indicating insolvency, reorganization
or inability to pay its obligations (an "Insolvency Event").


     Upon the occurrence and continuation beyond the applicable grace period
of the event described in clause (i) (A) above, if any Monthly Advance is not
made by 4:00 P.M., New York City time, on the second Business Day following
written notice to the Master Servicer of such event, the Trustee will make
such Monthly Advance and either the Trustee or a successor master servicer
will immediately assume the duties of the Master Servicer.

     Upon removal or resignation of the Master Servicer, the Trustee will be
the successor master servicer (the "Successor Master Servicer").  The
Trustee, as Successor Master Servicer, will be obligated to make Monthly
Advances and Servicing Advances and certain other advances unless it
determines reasonably and in good faith that such advances would not be
recoverable.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, a delay in or failure of performance
referred to under clause (i) above for a period of ten Business Days or
referred to under clause (ii) above for a period of 30 Business Days, shall
not constitute an Event of Default if such delay or failure could not be
prevented by the exercise of reasonable diligence by the Master Servicer and
such delay or failure was caused by an act of God or other similar
occurrence.  Upon the occurrence of any such event the Master Servicer shall
not be relieved from using its best efforts to perform its obligations in a
timely manner in accordance with the terms of the Agreement and the Master
Servicer shall provide the Trustee, the Certificate Insurer and the
Certificateholders prompt notice of such failure or delay by it, together
with a description of its efforts to so perform its obligations.

RIGHTS UPON AN EVENT OF DEFAULT

     So long as an Event of Default remains unremedied, either the Trustee,
Certificateholders holding Certificates evidencing at least 51% of the
Percentage Interests in the Trust, with the consent of the Certificate
Insurer, or the Certificate Insurer may terminate all of the rights and
obligations of the Master Servicer under the Agreement and in and to the
Mortgage Loans, whereupon the Trustee will succeed to all the
responsibilities, duties and liabilities of the Master Servicer under the
Agreement and will be entitled to similar compensation arrangements.  In the
event that the Trustee would be obligated to succeed to all the
responsibilities, duties and liabilities of the Master Servicer but is
unwilling or unable so to act, it may appoint, or petition a court of
competent jurisdiction for the appointment of, a housing and home finance
institution or other mortgage loan or home equity loan servicer with all
licenses and permits required to perform its obligations under the Agreement
and having a net worth of at least $50,000,000 and acceptable to the
Certificate Insurer to act as successor to the Master Servicer under the
Agreement.  Pending such appointment, the Trustee will be obligated to act in
such capacity unless prohibited by law.  Such successor will be entitled to
receive the same compensation that the Master Servicer would otherwise have
received (or such lesser compensation as the Trustee and such successor may
agree).  A receiver or conservator for the Master Servicer may be empowered
to prevent the termination and replacement of the Master Servicer if the only
Event of Default that has occurred is an Insolvency Event.

AMENDMENT

     The Agreement may be amended from time to time by the Seller, the Master
Servicer, and the Trustee and with the consent of the Certificate Insurer,
but without the consent of the Certificateholders, to cure any ambiguity, to
correct or supplement any provisions therein which may be inconsistent with
any other provisions of the Agreement, to add to the duties of the Seller or
the Master Servicer to comply with any requirements imposed by the Internal
Revenue Code or any regulation thereunder, or to add or amend any provisions
of the Agreement as required by the Rating Agencies in order to maintain or
improve any rating of the Offered Certificates (it being understood that,
after obtaining the ratings in effect on the Closing Date, neither the
Seller, the Trustee, the Certificate Insurer nor the Master Servicer is
obligated to obtain, maintain, or improve any such rating) or to add any
other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under the
Agreement which shall not be inconsistent with the provisions of the
Agreement; provided that such action will not, as evidenced by an 
           ________
opinion of counsel, materially and adversely affect the interests of 
any Certificateholder or the Certificate Insurer; provided, further, 
                                                  ________  _______
that any such amendment will not be deemed to materially and adversely 
affect the Certificateholders and no such opinion will be required to be 
delivered if the person requesting such amendment obtains a letter from the 
Rating Agencies stating that such amendment would not result in a downgrading 
of the then current rating of the Offered Certificates.  The Agreement may 
also be amended from time to time by the Seller, the Master Servicer, and the 
Trustee, with the consent of Certificateholders evidencing at least 51% of 
the Percentage Interests of each Class affected thereby and the Certificate 
Insurer for the purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner 
or eliminating any of the provisions of the Agreement or of modifying in any 
manner the rights of the Certificateholders, provided that no such amendment 
                                             ________
will (i) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay the timing of, 
collections of payments on the Certificates or distributions or payments 
under the Policy which are required to be made on any Certificate without the 
consent of the Certificateholder or (ii) reduce the aforesaid percentage 
required to consent to any such amendment, without the consent of the holders
of all Offered Certificates then outstanding.


TERMINATION; PURCHASE OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Trust will terminate on the Distribution Date following the later of
(A) payment in full of all amounts owing to the Certificate Insurer unless
the Certificate Insurer shall otherwise consent and (B) the earliest of (i)
the Distribution Date on which the Aggregate Class A Principal Balance has
been reduced to zero, (ii) the final payment or other liquidation of the last
Mortgage Loan in the Trust, (iii) the optional purchase by the Master
Servicer of the Mortgage Loans, as described below and (iv) the Distribution
Date in (       ) on which date the Policy will be available to pay the
outstanding Aggregate Class A Principal Balance of the Class A Certificates.

     Subject to provisions in the Agreement concerning adopting a plan of
complete liquidation, the Master Servicer may, at its option, terminate the
Agreement on any date on which the Pool Principal Balance is less than 5% of
the sum of the Cut-Off Date Pool Principal Balance by purchasing, on the next
succeeding Distribution Date, all of the outstanding Mortgage Loans at a
price equal to the sum of the outstanding Pool Principal Balance (subject to
reduction as provided in the Agreement if the purchase price is based in part
on the appraised value of any REO Property included in the Trust and such
appraised value is less than the Principal Balance of the related Mortgage
Loan) and accrued and unpaid interest thereon at the weighted average of the
Loan Rates through the end of the Due Period preceding the final Distribution
Date together with all amounts due and owing to the Certificate Insurer.

     Any such purchase shall be accomplished by deposit into the Distribution
Account of the purchase price specified above.



THE TRUSTEE

     ________________________________________, has been named Trustee
pursuant to the Agreement.

     The Trustee may have normal banking relationships with Provident and the
Master Servicer.

     The Trustee may resign at any time, in which event Provident will be
obligated to appoint a successor Trustee, as approved by the Certificate
Insurer.  Provident may also remove the Trustee if the Trustee ceases to be
eligible to continue as such under the Agreement or if the Trustee becomes
insolvent.  Upon becoming aware of such circumstances, Provident will be
obligated to appoint a successor Trustee, as approved by the Certificate
Insurer.  Any resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a
successor Trustee will not become effective until acceptance of the
appointment by the successor Trustee.

     No holder of a Certificate will have any right under the Agreement to
institute any proceeding with respect to the Agreement unless such holder
previously has given to the Trustee written notice of default and unless
Certificateholders holding Certificates evidencing at least 51% of the
Percentage Interests in the Trust have made written requests upon the Trustee
to institute such proceeding in its own name as Trustee thereunder and have
offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity and the Trustee for 60 days has
neglected or refused to institute any such proceeding.  The Trustee will be
under no obligation to exercise any of the trusts or powers vested in it by
the Agreement or to make any investigation of matters arising thereunder or
to institute, conduct or defend any litigation thereunder or in relation
thereto at the request, order or direction of any of the Certificateholders,
unless such Certificateholders have offered to the Trustee reasonable
security or indemnity against the cost, expenses and liabilities which may be
incurred therein or thereby.


                               USE OF PROCEEDS

     The net proceeds to be received from the sale of the Certificates will
be applied by Provident towards general corporate purposes.


                       FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     An election will be made to treat the Trust as a "real estate mortgage
investment conduit" ("REMIC") for federal income tax purposes under the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code").  In the opinion of
Tax Counsel, the Class A Certificates will be designated as "regular
interests" in the REMIC and the Class R Certificates will be designated as
the sole class of residual interests in the REMIC.  See "FEDERAL INCOME TAX
CONSEQUENCES--Taxation of the REMIC and its Holders" in the Prospectus.

     The Offered Certificates generally will be treated as debt instruments
issued by the REMIC for Federal income tax purposes.  Income on such
Certificates must be reported under an accrual method of accounting.

     The Offered Certificates may, depending on their issue price, be issued
with original issue discount ("OID") for federal income tax purposes. 
Holders of such Certificates issued with OID will be required to include OID
in income as it accrues under a constant yield method, in advance of the
receipt of cash attributable to such income.  The OID Regulations do not
contain provisions specifically interpreting Code Section 1272(a)(6) which
applies to prepayable securities such as the Offered Certificates.  Until the
Treasury issues guidance to the contrary, the Trustee intends to base its OID
computation on Code Section 1272(a)(6) and the OID Regulations as described
in the Prospectus.  However, because no regulatory guidance currently exists
under Code Section 1272(a)(6), there can be no assurance that such
methodology represents the correct manner of calculating OID.

     The yield used to calculate accruals of OID with respect to the Offered
Certificates with OID will be the original yield to maturity of such
Certificates, determined by assuming that the Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 1
will prepay in accordance with    % of the Prepayment Assumption and that the
Mortgage Loans in Loan Group 2 will prepay in accordance with    % of the
Prepayment Assumption.  No representation is made as to the actual rate at
which the Mortgage Loans will prepay.

     Prepayments on mortgage loans are commonly measured relative to a
prepayment standard or model.  The Prepayment Assumption model used in this
Prospectus is based on a Constant Prepayment Rate ("CPR").  CPR represents a
constant rate of prepayment on the Mortgage Loans each month relative to the
aggregate outstanding principal balance of the Mortgage Loans.  CPR does not
purport to be either an historical description of the prepayment experience
of any pool of mortgage loans or a prediction of the anticipated rate of
prepayment of any pool of mortgage loans, including the Mortgage Loans, and
there is no assurance that the Mortgage Loans will prepay at the specified
CPR.  Provident does not make any representation about the appropriateness of
the CPR model.

     In the opinion of Tax Counsel, the Offered Certificates will be treated
as regular interests in a REMIC under section 860G of the Code.  Accordingly,
the Offered Certificates will be treated as (i) assets described in section
7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code, and (ii) "real estate assets" within the meaning
of section 856(c)(5) of the Code, in each case to the extent described in the
Prospectus.  Interest on the Offered Certificates will be treated as interest
on obligations secured by mortgages on real property within the meaning of
section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code to the same extent that the Offered
Certificates are treated as real estate assets.  See "Federal Income Tax
Consequences" in the Prospectus.


BACKUP WITHHOLDING

     Certain Certificate Owners may be subject to backup withholding at the
rate of 31% with respect to interest paid on the Offered Certificates if the
Certificate Owners, upon issuance, fail to supply the Trustee or their broker
with their taxpayer identification number, furnish an incorrect taxpayer
identification number, fails to report interest, dividends, or other
"reportable payments" (as defined in the Code) properly, or, under certain
circumstances, fails to provide the Trustee or their broker with a certified
statement, under penalty of perjury, that they are not subject to backup
withholding.

     The Trustee will be required to report annually to the IRS, and to each
Offered Certificateholder of record, the amount of interest paid (and OID
accrued, if any) on the Offered Certificates (and the amount of interest
withheld for Federal income taxes, if any) for each calendar year, except as
to exempt holders (generally, holders that are corporations, certain
tax-exempt organizations or nonresident aliens who provide certification as
to their status as nonresidents).  As long as the only "Class A
Certificateholder" of record is Cede, as nominee for DTC, Certificate Owners
and the IRS will receive tax and other information including the amount of
interest paid on such Certificates owned from Participants and Indirect
Participants rather than from the Trustee.  (The Trustee, however, will
respond to requests for necessary information to enable Participants,
Indirect Participants and certain other persons to complete their reports.) 
Each non-exempt Certificate Owner will be required to provide, under penalty
of perjury, a certificate on IRS Form W-9 containing his or her name,
address, correct Federal taxpayer identification number and a statement that
he or she is not subject to backup withholding.  Should a nonexempt
Certificate Owner fail to provide the required certification, the
Participants or Indirect Participants (or the Paying Agent) will be required
to withhold 31% of the interest (and principal) otherwise payable to the
holder, and remit the withheld amount to the IRS as a credit against the
holder's Federal income tax liability.

     Such amounts will be deemed distributed to the affected Certificate
owner for all purposes of the Certificates, the Agreement and the Policy.


FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES TO FOREIGN INVESTORS

     The following information describes the United States federal income tax
treatment of holders that are not United States persons ("Foreign
Investors").  The term "Foreign Investor" means any person other than (i) a
citizen or resident of the United States, (ii) a corporation, partnership or
other entity organized in or under the laws of the United States or any state
or political subdivision thereof, (iii) an estate the income of which is
includible in gross income for United States federal income tax purposes,
regardless of its source, or (iv) a trust if a court within the United States
is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust
and one or more United States trustees have authority to control all
substantial decisions of the trust.

     The Code and Treasury regulations generally subject interest paid to a
Foreign Investor to a withholding tax at a rate of 30% (unless such rate were
changed by an applicable treaty).  The withholding tax, however, is
eliminated with respect to certain "portfolio debt investments" issued to
Foreign Investors.  Portfolio debt investments include debt instruments
issued in registered form for which the United States payor receives a
statement that the beneficial owner of the instrument is a Foreign Investor. 
The Offered Certificates will be issued in registered form, therefore if the
information required by the Code is furnished (as described below) and no
other exceptions to the withholding tax exemption are applicable, no
withholding tax will apply to the Offered Certificates.

     For the Offered Certificates to constitute portfolio debt investments
exempt from the United States withholding tax, the withholding agent must
receive from the Certificate Owner an executed IRS Form W-8 signed under
penalty of perjury by the Certificate Owner stating that the Certificate
Owner is a Foreign Investor and providing such Certificate Owner's name and
address.  The statement must be received by the withholding agent in the
calendar year in which the interest payment is made, or in either of the two
preceding calendar years.

     A Certificate Owner that is a nonresident alien or foreign corporation
will not be subject to United States federal income tax on gain realized on
the sale, exchange, or redemption of such Offered Certificate, provided that
(i) such gain is not effectively connected with a trade or business carried
on by the Certificate Owner in the United States, (ii) in the case of a
Certificate Owner that is an individual, such Certificate Owner is not
present in the United States for 183 days or more during the taxable year in
which such sale, exchange or redemption occurs and (iii) in the case of gain
representing accrued interest, the conditions described in the immediately
preceding paragraph are satisfied.


                                 STATE TAXES

     Provident makes no representations regarding the tax consequences of
purchase, ownership or disposition of the Offered Certificates under the tax
laws of any state.  Investors considering an investment in the Certificates
should consult their own tax advisors regarding such tax consequences.

     All investors should consult their own tax advisors regarding the
Federal, state, local or foreign income tax consequences of the purchase,
ownership and disposition of the Certificates.


                             ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     Any Plan fiduciary which proposes to cause a Plan to acquire any of the
Offered Certificates should consult with its counsel with respect to the
potential consequences under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
1974, as amended ("ERISA"), and the Code, of the Plans acquisition and
ownership of such Certificates.  See "ERISA CONSIDERATIONS" in the
Prospectus.

     The U.S. Department of Labor has granted to _________________________
(____________) Prohibited Transaction Exemption _____ (the "Exemption") which
exempts from the application of the prohibited transaction rules transactions
relating to (1) the acquisition, sale and holding by Plans of certain
certificates representing an undivided interest in certain asset-backed
pass-through trusts, with respect to which _____________ or any of its
affiliates is the sole underwriter or the manager or co-manager of the
underwriting syndicate; and (2) the servicing, operation and management of
such asset-backed pass-through trusts, provided that the general conditions
and certain other conditions set forth in the Exemption are satisfied.  The
Exemption will apply to the acquisition, holding and resale of the Class A
Certificates by a Plan, provided that certain conditions (certain of which
are described below) are met.

     Among the conditions which must be satisfied for the Exemption to apply
are the following:

          (1)  The acquisition of the Class A Certificates by a Plan is on
     terms (including the price for such Certificates) that are at least as
     favorable to the investing Plan as they would be in an arm's-length
     transaction with an unrelated party;

          (2)  The rights and interests evidenced by the Class A Certificates
     acquired by the Plan are not subordinated to the rights and interests
     evidenced by other certificates of the Trust;

          (3)  The Class A Certificates acquired by the Plan have received a
     rating at the time of such acquisition that is in one of the three
     highest generic rating categories from either S&P, Moody's, or Duff &
     Phelps Credit Rating Co.;

          (4)  The sum of all payments made to and retained by the
     Underwriter in connection with the distribution of the Class A
     Certificates represents not more than reasonable compensation for
     underwriting such Certificates; the sum of all payments made to and
     retained by the Seller pursuant to the sale of the Mortgage Loans to the
     Trust represents not more than the fair market value of such Mortgage
     Loans; the sum of all payments made to and retained by the Master
     Servicer represent not more than reasonable compensation for the Master
     Servicer's services under the Agreement and reimbursement of the Master
     Servicer's reasonable expenses in connection therewith;

          (5)  The Trustee is not an affiliate of any Underwriter, the
     Seller, the Master Servicer, the Certificate Insurer, any borrower whose
     obligations under one or more Mortgage Loans constitute more than 5% of
     the aggregate unamortized principal balance of the assets in the Trust,
     or any of their respective affiliates (the "Restricted Group"); and

          (6)  The Plan investing in the Class A Certificates is an
     "accredited investor" as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of
     the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933,
     as amended.

     The Underwriter believes that the Exemption will apply to the
acquisition and holding of the Class A Certificates by Plans and that all
conditions of the Exemption other than those within the control of the
investors will be met.  Any Plan fiduciary considering whether to purchase
any Class A Certificates on behalf of a Plan should consult with its counsel
regarding the applicability of the fiduciary responsibility and prohibited
transaction provisions of ERISA and the Code to such investment.  Among other
things, before purchasing any Class A Certificates, a fiduciary of a Plan
subject to the fiduciary responsibility provisions of ERISA or an employee
benefit plan subject to the prohibited transaction provisions of the Code
should make its own determination as to the availability of the exemptive
relief provided in the Exemption, and also consider the availability of any
other prohibited transaction exemptions.


                       LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     The Offered Certificates will constitute "mortgage related securities" for
purposes of the Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of 1984 ("SMMEA")
so long as they are rated in one of the two highest rating categories by at
least one nationally recognized statistical rating organization and, as such,
are legal investments for certain entities to the extent provided in SMMEA.

     Institutions whose investment activities are subject to review by
federal or state regulatory authorities should consult with their counsel or
the applicable authorities to determine whether an investment in the Offered
Certificates complies with applicable guidelines, policy statements or
restrictions.  See "LEGAL INVESTMENT" in the Prospectus.


                                 UNDERWRITING

     Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the underwriting
agreement, dated ____________________ (the "Underwriting Agreement"), between
Provident and ______________________ (the "Underwriter"), Provident has
agreed to sell to the Underwriter and the Underwriter has agreed to purchase
from Provident the Class A Certificates.

     Distributions of the Offered Certificates will be made from time to time
in negotiated transactions or otherwise at varying prices to be determined at
the time of sale.  Proceeds to Provident from the sale of the Offered
Certificates will be approximately $            , plus accrued interest,
before deducting expenses payable by Provident, estimated to be $        in
the aggregate.  In connection with the purchase and sale of the Offered
Certificates, the Underwriter may be deemed to have received compensation
from Provident in the form of underwriting discounts.

     Provident has been advised by the Underwriter that it presently intends
to make a market in the Offered Certificates; however, it is not obligated to
do so, any market-making may be discontinued at any time, and there can be no
assurance that an active public market for the Offered Certificates will
develop.

     The Underwriting Agreement provides that Provident will indemnify the
Underwriter against certain civil liabilities, including liabilities under
the Act.


                                   EXPERTS

                                 (__________)




                                LEGAL MATTERS

     Certain legal matters with respect to the Class A Certificates will be
passed upon for Provident by Brown & Wood LLP, New York, New York, and
Keating, Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L. Cincinnati, Ohio, and for the Underwriter
by ____________________.


                                   RATINGS

     It is a condition to the issuance of the Class A Certificates that they
receive ratings of "AAA" by _______ and "Aaa" by ______.

     A securities rating addresses the likelihood of the receipt by Class A
Certificateholders of distributions on the Mortgage Loans.  The rating takes
into consideration the characteristics of the Mortgage Loans and the
structural, legal and tax aspects associated with the Class A Certificates. 
The ratings on the Class A Certificates do not, however, constitute
statements regarding the likelihood or frequency of prepayments on the
Mortgage Loans or the possibility that Class A Certificateholders might
realize a lower than anticipated yield.


     The ratings assigned to the Class A Certificates will depend primarily
upon the creditworthiness of the Certificate Insurer.  Any reduction in a
rating assigned to the claims-paying ability of the Certificate Insurer below
the ratings initially assigned to the Class A Certificates may result in a
reduction of one or more of the ratings assigned to the Class A Certificates.

     A securities rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold
securities and may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the
assigning rating organization.  Each securities rating should be evaluated
independently of similar ratings on different securities.


                            INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS

TERMS                                                                   PAGE


Aggregate Class A Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-39
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Amount Available  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-47
Assignment Event  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Available Funds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
Balloon Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-14
Beneficial owner  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
BIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Book-Entry Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Capitalized Interest Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-54
Cede  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
CEDEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
CEDEL Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Certificate Insurer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-2, S-10
Certificate Owners  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-40
Certificate Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-4, S-6, S-48
Certificate Register  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
Certificate Registrar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
Certificateholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39, S-40
Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Chemical  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Citibank  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Civil Relief Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Civil Relief Act Interest Shortfalls  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-57
Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Class A Certificateholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-61
Class A Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Class A Monthly Principal Distributable Amount  . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-49
Class A Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-39
Class A Principal Carryover Shortfall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-49
Class A Principal Distribution  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-49
Class A-1 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Class A-2 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Class A-3 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Class A-4 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Class A-5 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Class A-6 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Class A-6 Interest Carryover  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Class Interest Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-49
Class Monthly Interest Distributable Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7, S-49
Class R Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Closing Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Code  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-60
Collection Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Compensating Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15
Cooperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
CPR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36, S-61
Cut-Off Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Cut-Off Date Loan Group 1 Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-21
Cut-Off Date Loan Group 2 Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-26
Cut-Off Date Pool Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-21
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Defective Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Definitive Certificate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Determination Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11
Distributable Excess Spread . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-8, S-49
Distribution Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-2, S-7
DTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-5, S-40
Due Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-50
Eligible Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Eligible Substitute Mortgage Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
ERISA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13, S-63
Euroclear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Euroclear Operator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
Euroclear Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-41
European Depositaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6, S-40
Events of Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-58
Excess Spread . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-50
Exemption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-63
Financial Intermediary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
Fiscal Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-51
Foreign Investors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-62
Funding Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-53
GAAP  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-16
Group 1 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-4, S-39
Group 2 Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-4, S-39
Guaranteed Principal Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10
Insolvency Event  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-58
Insurer Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-50
Interest Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-7
LIBOR Rate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-48
Liquidated Mortgage Loan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-9, S-50
Loan Group  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, S-39
Loan Group 1  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, S-39
Loan Group 1 Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Loan Group 2  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, S-39
Loan Group 2 Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Loan Group Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Loan Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4
Loan-to-Value Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4, S-23, S-30
Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, S-3, S-6
Master Servicing Fee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11
Master Servicing Fee Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-11, S-56
Monthly Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12, S-46
Mortgage File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-15, S-43
Mortgage Loan Schedule  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Mortgage Pool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Mortgaged Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Net Funds Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-6
Nonrecoverable Advance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
Offered Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-4, S-39
OID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-61
Original Aggregate Class A Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-4
Percentage Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-39
Plan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-13
Policy  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-2, S-3, S-39
Pool Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Pre-Funded Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-53
Pre-Funding Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-10, S-53
Prepayment Assumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36
Prepayment Interest Shortfall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Principal Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-3
Provident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Purchase Price  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-43
Relevant Depositary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
REMIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-2, S-12, S-60
Residual Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Restricted Group  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-63
Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-40
SAIF  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
SAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-16
Seller  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, S-3, S-6
Servicing Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-46
STIFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-45
Subsequent Transfer Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-26
Subservicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-17
Substitution Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-44
Successor Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-58
Tax Counsel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-12
Terms and Conditions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-42
Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3
Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, S-3, S-11, S-51
Underwriter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-64
Underwriting Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-64
Weighted average life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  S-36



                                   ANNEX I

GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES

     Except in certain limited circumstances, the globally offered Provident
Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 199___ (the "Global Securities")
will be available only in book-entry form.  Investors in the Global
Securities may hold such Global Securities through any of DTC, CEDEL or
Euroclear.  The Global Securities will be tradeable as home market
instruments in both the European and U.S. domestic markets.  Initial
settlement and all secondary trades will settle in same-day funds.

     Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
through CEDEL and Euroclear will be conducted in the ordinary way in
accordance with their normal rules and operating procedures and in accordance
with conventional eurobond practice (i.e., seven calendar day settlement).

     Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
through DTC will be conducted according to the rules and procedures
applicable to U.S. corporate debt obligations and prior Mortgage Pass-Through
Certificates issues.

     Secondary cross-market trading between CEDEL or Euroclear and DTC
Participants holding Certificates will be effected on a
delivery-against-payment basis through the respective Depositaries of CEDEL
and Euroclear (in such capacity) and as DTC Participants.

     Non-U.S. holders (as described below) of Global Securities will be
subject to U.S. withholding taxes unless such holders meet certain
requirements and deliver appropriate U.S. tax documents to the securities
clearing organizations or their participants.

INITIAL SETTLEMENT

     All Global Securities will be held in book-entry form by DTC in the name
of Cede & Co. as nominee of DTC.  Investors' interests in the Global
Securities will be represented through financial institutions acting on their
behalf as direct and indirect Participants in DTC.  As a result, CEDEL and
Euroclear will hold positions on behalf of their participants through their
respective Depositaries, which in turn will hold such positions in accounts
as DTC Participants.

     Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through DTC will
follow the settlement practices applicable to prior Mortgage Pass-Through
Certificates issues.  Investor securities custody accounts will be credited
with their holdings against payment in same-day funds on the settlement date.

     Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through CEDEL or
Euroclear accounts will follow the settlement procedures applicable to
conventional eurobonds, except that there will be no temporary global
security and no "lock-up" or restricted period.  Global Securities will be
credited to the securities custody accounts on the settlement date against
payment in same-day funds.

SECONDARY MARKET TRADING

     Since the purchaser determines the place of delivery, it is important to
establish at the time of the trade where both the purchaser's and seller's
accounts are located to ensure that settlement can be made on the desired
value date.

     Trading between DTC Participants.  Secondary market trading between DTC
Participants will be settled using the procedures applicable to prior
Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates issues in same-day funds.

     Trading between CEDEL and/or Euroclear Participants.  Secondary market
trading between CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants will be settled
using the procedures applicable to conventional eurobonds in same-day funds.

     Trading between DTC seller and CEDEL or Euroclear purchaser.  When
Global Securities are to be transferred from the account of a DTC Participant
to the account of a CEDEL Participant or a Euroclear Participant, the
purchaser will send instructions to CEDEL or Euroclear through a CEDEL
Participant or Euroclear Participant at least one business day prior to
settlement.  CEDEL or Euroclear will instruct the respective Depositary, as
the case may be, to receive the Global Securities against payment.  Payment
will include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and including the
last coupon payment date to and excluding the settlement date, on the basis
of either the actual number of days in such accrual period and a year assumed
to consist of 360 days or a 360-day year of 12 30-day months as applicable to
the related class of Global Securities.  For transactions settling on the
31st of the month, payment will include interest accrued to and excluding the
first day of the following month.  Payment will then be made by the
respective Depositary of the DTC Participant's account against delivery of
the Global Securities.  After settlement has been completed, the Global
Securities will be credited to the respective clearing system and by the
clearing system, in accordance with its usual procedures, to the CEDEL
Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account.  The securities credit will
appear the next day (European time) and the cash debt will be back-valued to,
and the interest on the Global Securities will accrue from, the value date
(which would be the preceding day when settlement occurred in New York).  If
settlement is not completed on the intended value date (i.e., the trade
fails), the CEDEL or Euroclear cash debt will be valued instead as of the
actual settlement date.

     CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will need to make
available to the respective clearing systems the funds necessary to process
same-day funds settlement.  The most direct means of doing so is to
preposition funds for settlement, either from cash on hand or existing lines
of credit, as they would for any settlement occurring within CEDEL or
Euroclear.  Under this approach, they may take on credit exposure to CEDEL or
Euroclear until the Global Securities are credited to their accounts one day
later.

     As an alternative, if CEDEL or Euroclear has extended a line of credit
to them, CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants can elect not to
preposition funds and allow that credit line to be drawn upon the finance
settlement.  Under this procedure, CEDEL Participants or Euroclear
Participants purchasing Global Securities would incur overdraft charges for
one day, assuming they cleared the overdraft when the Global Securities were
credited to their accounts.  However, interest on the Global Securities would
accrue from the value date.  Therefore, in many cases the investment income
on the Global Securities earned during that one-day period may substantially
reduce or offset the amount of such overdraft charges, although this result
will depend on each CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear Participant's particular
cost of funds.

     Since the settlement is taking place during New York business hours, DTC
Participants can employ their usual procedures for sending Global Securities
to the respective European Depositary for the benefit of CEDEL Participants
or Euroclear Participants.  The sale proceeds will be available to the DTC
seller on the settlement date.  Thus, to the DTC Participants a cross-market
transaction will settle no differently than a trade between two DTC
Participants.

     Trading between CEDEL or Euroclear Seller and DTC Purchaser.  Due to
time zone differences in their favor, CEDEL Participants and Euroclear
Participants may employ their customary procedures for transactions in which
Global Securities are to be transferred by the respective clearing system,
through the respective Depositary, to a DTC Participant.  The seller will
send instructions to CEDEL or Euroclear through a CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear Participant at least one business day prior to settlement.  In
these cases CEDEL or Euroclear will instruct the respective Depositary, as
appropriate, to deliver the Global Securities to the DTC Participant's
account against payment.  Payment will include interest accrued on the Global
Securities from and including the last coupon payment to and excluding the
settlement date on the basis of either the actual number of days in such
accrual period and a year assumed to consist of 360 days or a 360-day year of
12 30-day months as applicable to the related class of Global Securities. 
For transactions settling on the 31st of the month, payment will include
interest accrued to and excluding the first day of the following month.  The
payment will then be reflected in the account of the CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear Participant the following day, and receipt of the cash proceeds in
the CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account would be
back-valued to the value date (which would be the preceding day, when
settlement occurred in New York).  Should the CEDEL Participant or Euroclear
Participant have a line of credit with its respective clearing system and
elect to be in debt in anticipation of receipt of the sale proceeds in its
account, the back-valuation will extinguish any overdraft incurred over that
one-day period.  If settlement is not completed on the intended value date
(i.e., the trade fails), receipt of the cash proceeds in the CEDEL
Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account would instead be valued as
of the actual settlement date.

     Finally, day traders that use CEDEL or Euroclear and that purchase
Global Securities from DTC Participants for delivery to CEDEL Participants or
Euroclear Participants should note that these trades would automatically fail
on the sale side unless affirmative action were taken. At least three
techniques should be readily available to eliminate this potential problem:

     (a)  borrowing through CEDEL or Euroclear for one day (until the
purchase side of the day trade is reflected in their CEDEL or Euroclear
accounts) in accordance with the clearing system's customary procedures;

     (b)  borrowing the Global Securities in the U.S. from a DTC Participant
no later than one day prior to settlement, which would give the Global
Securities sufficient time to be reflected in their CEDEL or Euroclear
account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or

     (c)  staggering the value dates for the buy and sell sides of the trade
so that the value date for the purchase from the DTC Participant is at least
one day prior to the value date for the sale to the CEDEL Participant or
Euroclear Participant.

CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS

     A beneficial owner of Global Securities holding securities through CEDEL
or Euroclear (or through DTC if the holder has an address outside the U.S.)
will be subject to the 30% U.S. withholding tax that generally applies to
payments of interest (including original issue discount) on registered debt
issued by U.S. Persons, unless (i) each clearing system, bank or other
financial institution that holds customers' securities in the ordinary course
of its trade or business in the chain of intermediaries between such
beneficial owner and the U.S. entity required to withhold tax complies with
applicable certification requirements and (ii) such beneficial owner takes
one of the following steps to obtain an exemption or reduced tax rate:

     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons (Form W-8).  Beneficial owners of Global
Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption from the
withholding tax by filing a signed Form W-8 (Certificate of Foreign Status). 
If the information shown on Form W-8 changes, a new Form W-8 must be filed
within 30 days of such change.

     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons with effectively connected income (Form
4224).  A non-U.S. Person, including a non-U.S. corporation or bank with a
U.S. branch, for which the interest income is effectively connected with its
conduct of a trade or business in the United States, can obtain an exemption
from the withholding tax by filing Form 4224 (Exemption from Withholding of
Tax on Income Effectively Connected with the Conduct of a Trade or Business
in the United States).

     Exemption or reduced rate for non-U.S. Persons resident in treaty
countries (Form 1001).  Non-U.S. Persons that are Certificate Owners residing
in a country that has a tax treaty with the United States can obtain an
exemption or reduced tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by filing Form
1001 (Ownership, Exemption or Reduced Rate Certificate).  If the treaty
provides only for a reduced rate, withholding tax will be imposed at that
rate unless the filer alternatively files Form W-8.  Form 1001 may be filed
by the Certificate Owners or his agent.

     Exemption for U.S. Persons (Form W-9).  U.S. Persons can obtain a
complete exemption from the withholding tax by filing Form W-9 (Payer's
Request for Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).

     U.S. Federal Income Tax Reporting Procedure.  The Certificate Owner of a
Global Security or, in the case of a Form 1001 or a Form 4224 filer, his
agent, files by submitting the appropriate form to the person through whom it
holds (the clearing agency, in the case of persons holding directly on the
books of the clearing agency).  Form W-8 and Form 1001 are effective for
three calendar years and Form 4224 is effective for one calendar year.

     The term "U.S. Person" means (i) a citizen or resident of the United
States, (ii) a corporation or partnership organized in or under the laws of
the United States or any political subdivision thereof, (iii) an estate the
income of which is includible in gross income for United States tax purposes,
regardless of its source, or (iv) a trust if a court within the United States
is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust
and one or more United States trustees have authority to control all
substantial decisions of the trust.  This summary does not deal with all
aspects of U.S. Federal income tax withholding that may be relevant to
foreign holders of the Global Securities.  Investors are advised to consult
their own tax advisors for specific tax advice concerning their holding and
disposing of the Global Securities.


    No dealer, salesman or other     
person has been authorized to give      
any information or to make any          
representation not contained in         
this Prospectus Supplement or the       
Prospectus and, if given or made,       
such information or representation      
must not be relied upon as having       
been authorized by Provident or         
the Underwriter. This Prospectus
Supplement and the Prospectus do
not constitute an offer of any         
securities other than those to         
which they relate or an offer to       
sell, or a solicitation of an           
offer to buy, to any person in any      
jurisdiction where such an offer        
or solicitation would be unlawful.      
Neither the delivery of this                PROVIDENT MORTGAGE PASS-THROUGH
Prospectus Supplement and the                             TRUST 199___  
Prospectus nor any sale made            
hereunder shall, under any                               $            
circumstances, create any                      
implication that the information               $         CLASS A-1    %  
contained herein is correct as of                       CERTIFICATES
any time subsequent to their                   $         CLASS A-2    %      
respective dates.                                       CERTIFICATES
                                               $         CLASS A-3     %
        --------------------                            CERTIFICATES
                                               $         CLASS A-4     %
           TABLE OF CONTENTS                            CERTIFICATES
                                               $         CLASS A-5     %  
                              PAGE                      CERTIFICATES
                              ----             $         CLASS A-6     %  
                                                        VARIABLE RATE 
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT                                    CERTIFICATES
Incorporation of Certain Documents
by  Reference . . . . . . . .   S-2
Summary . . . . . . . . . . .   S-3                                
Risk Factors  . . . . . . . .  S-15                 MORTGAGE PASS-THROUGH
The Certificate Insurer . . .  S-18                      CERTIFICATES
The Provident Bank. . . . . .  S-18
Description of the Mortgage
Loans. . . . . . . . . . . .   S-21
Prepayment and Yield
Considerations  . . . . . . .  S-28                      SERIES 199___
Description of the                             
Certificates . . . . . . . .   S-32
Description of the Purchase                          THE PROVIDENT BANK
Agreement . . . . . . . . . .  S-50                     AS SELLER AND
Use of Proceeds . . . . . . .  S-51                    MASTER SERVICER
Federal Income Tax 
Consequences . . . . . . . .   S-52                        
State Taxes . . . . . . . . .  S-54                      
ERISA Considerations  . . . .  S-54
Legal Investment 
Considerations . . . . . . .   S-55
Underwriting  . . . . . . . .  S-55
Experts . . . . . . . . . . .  S-56            ______________________________
Legal Matters . . . . . . . .  S-56   
Ratings . . . . . . . . . . .  S-56                PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
Index of Defined Terms  . . .  S-57            ______________________________
Annex I . . . . . . . . . . .  S-60

PROSPECTUS
Prospectus Supplement . . . . .   2
Available Information . . . . .   2
Reports to Holders  . . . . . .   2
Summary of Terms  . . . . . . .   3
Risk Factors  . . . . . . . . .  11                    (UNDERWRITER)
Description of the Securities .  14
The Trust Funds . . . . . . . .  17
Enhancement . . . . . . . . . .  22
Servicing of Loans  . . . . . .  24
The Agreements  . . . . . . . .  30
Certain Legal Aspects of Loans   38
The Provident Bank  . . . . . .  46
Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . .  46
Federal Income Tax Consequences  47
State Tax Considerations  . . .  64
ERISA Considerations  . . . . .  65
Legal Investment  . . . . . . .  67
Plan of Distribution  . . . . .  67
Legal Matters . . . . . . . . .  67
Experts . . . . . . . . . . . .  67
Additional Information  . . . .  67
Glossary of Terms . . . . . . .  68











   Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment.  A
registration statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission.  These securities may not be sold nor may
offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the registration statement
becomes effective.  This prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or
the solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these
securities in any State in which such offer, solicitation or sale would be
unlawful prior to registration or qualification under the securities laws of
any such State.

                 SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED MAY 15, 1997
    

PROSPECTUS

                           ASSET BACKED SECURITIES
                             (ISSUABLE IN SERIES)

     This Prospectus relates  to the  issuance of  Asset Backed  Certificates
(the "Certificates") and  Asset Backed Notes (the "Notes"  and, together with
the Certificates, the "Securities"), which may be issued from time to time in
one  or more  series  (each,  a "Series")  by  a Trust  Fund  created by  The
Provident  Bank ("Provident") on  terms determined  at the  time of  sale and
described  in this  Prospectus and  the related  Prospectus Supplement.   The
Securities of a Series will consist of Certificates which evidence beneficial
ownership of  a trust  established by Provident  (each, a "Trust  Fund"), and
Notes secured  by the assets of  a Trust Fund.   As specified in  the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Trust Fund for a Series of Securities will include
certain assets (the "Trust Fund Assets") which will consist  of the following
types of  single family  mortgage loans (the  "Loans"):   (i) mortgage  loans
secured by first and/or subordinate  liens on one- to four-family residential
properties (the "Mortgage Loans") and  (ii) closed-end loans (the "Closed-End
Loans") and/or revolving  home equity loans or certain  balances thereof (the
"Revolving Credit Line Loans", together  with the Closed-End Loans, the "Home
Equity Loans")  secured by first or subordinate  liens on one- to four-family
residential properties.   The  Trust Fund  Assets  will be  originated or  be
acquired by Provident and conveyed by Provident to the related Trust Fund.  A
Trust Fund also may include  insurance policies, surety bonds, cash accounts,
reinvestment income, guaranties or letters  of credit to the extent described
in the related Prospectus  Supplement.  See "Index of Defined  Terms" on Page
85  of  this Prospectus  for  the  location  of the  definitions  of  certain
capitalized terms.

     Each Series of Securities will be issued  in one or more classes.   Each
class  of Certificates of  a Series will  evidence beneficial  ownership of a
specified percentage (which may be 0%) or portion of future interest payments
and a specified percentage (which may  be 0%) or portion of future  principal
payments on the related  Trust Fund Assets.  Each class of  Notes of a Series
will  be secured by the related Trust Fund  Assets or, if so specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, a portion thereof.  A Series of Securities may
include one or more  classes that are  senior in right of  payment to one  or
more  other classes  of Securities of  such Series.   One or  more classes of
Securities of a Series may be entitled to receive distributions of principal,
interest  or any combination  thereof prior to  one or more  other classes of
Securities of such Series on or after  the occurrence of specified events, in
each case as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Distributions  to Securityholders will be made monthly, quarterly, semi-
annually or at such other intervals and on the dates specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.   Distributions on the Securities of a  Series will be
made from the related  Trust Fund Assets or proceeds thereof  pledged for the
benefit  of the  Securityholders  as  specified  in  the  related  Prospectus
Supplement.

     The  related  Prospectus  Supplement  will  describe  any  insurance  or
guarantee   provided  with  respect  to  the  related  Series  of  Securities
including, without  limitation, any  insurance or  guarantee provided by  the
Department of Housing and Urban  Development, the United States Department of
Veterans'  Affairs or any private insurer or guarantor.  The only obligations
of Provident  with respect to a Series of  Securities will be to make certain
representations  and warranties  to the  Trustee  for the  related Series  of
Securities.  The  principal obligations of the  Master Servicer named in  the
related  Prospectus  Supplement  with  respect  to  the  related  Series   of
Securities will be limited to obligations pursuant to certain representations
and warranties  and to its  contractual servicing obligations,  including any
obligation it may have  to advance delinquent payments  on the related  Trust
Fund Assets.

     The  yield on each class of Securities of  a Series will be affected by,
among other things, the rate of payments of principal (including prepayments)
on the related Trust Fund  Assets and the timing of receipt  of such payments
as  described under "Risk  Factors--Prepayment and Yield  Considerations" and
"Yield and  Prepayment Considerations" herein  and in the  related Prospectus
Supplement.   A Trust  Fund may  be subject  to early  termination under  the
circumstances   described   under  "The   Agreements--Termination;   Optional
Termination" herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, one or more elections
may be made  to treat a Trust Fund  or specified portions thereof  as a "real
estate   mortgage  investment  conduit"  ("REMIC")  for  federal  income  tax
purposes.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences."

FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH AN INVESTMENT IN THE
    SECURITIES, SEE THE INFORMATION UNDER "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE 12.

  THE CERTIFICATES OF A GIVEN SERIES WILL REPRESENT BENEFICIAL INTERESTS IN,
 AND THE NOTES OF A  GIVEN SERIES WILL REPRESENT OBLIGATIONS OF, THE RELATED
    TRUST FUND ONLY AND WILL NOT REPRESENT INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF
                       PROVIDENT, THE MASTER SERVICER,
       OR ANY AFFILIATES THEREOF, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT DESCRIBED IN THE
  RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.  THE SECURITIES AND THE LOANS WILL NOT BE 
    INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY THE FEDERAL INSURANCE DEPOSIT CORPORATION OR 
      ANY GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY OR INSTRUMENTALITY OR BY PROVIDENT OR ANY 
     OTHER PERSON OR ENTITY, EXCEPT IN EACH CASE TO THE EXTENT DESCRIBED 
                    IN THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.

 THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
     EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE 
       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES 
         COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS 
           PROSPECTUS OR THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT. ANY
           REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

     Prior to issuance there will have  been no market for the Securities  of
any  Series and there  can be  no assurance that  a secondary market  for any
Securities will develop,  or if  it does  develop, that it  will continue  or
provide Securityholders with a  sufficient level of liquidity of  investment.
This Prospectus  may not  be used to  consummate sales  of Securities  of any
Series  unless  accompanied  by  a  Prospectus  Supplement.   Offers  of  the
Securities  may  be made  through one  or  more different  methods, including
offerings  through underwriters,  as more  fully  described under  "Method of
Distribution" herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.


________________, 1997

     UNTIL 90 DAYS AFTER THE DATE OF EACH PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT, ALL DEALERS
EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN THE SECURITIES COVERED BY SUCH PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN THE DISTRIBUTION THEREOF, MAY BE
REQUIRED TO DELIVER SUCH PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THIS PROSPECTUS.  THIS IS
IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS AND
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR
UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.


             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR CURRENT REPORT ON FORM 8-K

     The Prospectus Supplement or Current Report on Form 8-K relating to the
Securities of each Series to be offered hereunder will, among other things,
set forth with respect to such Securities, as appropriate: (i) the aggregate
principal amount, interest rate and authorized denominations of each class of
such Series of Securities; (ii) information as to the assets comprising the
Trust Fund, including the general characteristics of the related Trust Fund
Assets included therein and, if applicable, the insurance policies, surety
bonds, guaranties, letters of credit or other instruments or agreements
included in the Trust Fund or otherwise, and the amount and source of any
reserve account or other cash account; (iii) the circumstances, if any, under
which the Trust Fund may be subject to early termination; (iv) the
circumstances, if any, under which the Notes of such Series are subject to
redemption; (v) the method used to calculate the amount of principal to be
distributed or paid with respect to each class of Securities; (vi) the order
of application of distributions or payments to each of the classes within
such Series, whether sequential, pro rata, or otherwise; (vii) the
Distribution Dates with respect to such Series; (viii) additional information
with respect to the method of distribution of such Securities; (ix) whether
one or more REMIC elections will be made with respect to the Trust Fund and,
if so, the designation of the regular interests and the residual interests;
(x) the aggregate original percentage ownership interest in the Trust Fund to
be evidenced by each class of Certificates; (xi) the stated maturity of each
class of Notes of such Series; (xii) information as to the nature and extent
of subordination with respect to any class of Securities that is subordinate
in right of payment to any other class; and (xiii) information as to the
Master Servicer and the Trustee.


                            AVAILABLE INFORMATION

     Provident has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
"Commission") a Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended, with respect to the Securities.  This Prospectus, which forms a part
of the Registration Statement, and the Prospectus Supplement relating to each
Series of Securities contain descriptions of the material terms of the
documents referred to herein and therein, but do not contain all of the
information set forth in the Registration Statement pursuant to the Rules and
Regulations of the Commission.  For further information, reference is made to
such Registration Statement and the exhibits thereto.  Such Registration
Statement and exhibits can be inspected and copied at prescribed rates at the
public reference facilities maintained by the Commission at its Public
Reference Section, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, and at its
Regional Offices located as follows:  Midwest Regional Office, 500 West
Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661; and Northeast Regional
Office, Seven World Trade Center, Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048.  The
Commission also maintains a Web site at http://www.sec.gov from which such
Registration Statement and exhibits may be obtained.

     No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representation other than those contained in this Prospectus and any
Prospectus Supplement with respect hereto and, if given or made, such
information or representations must not be relied upon.  This Prospectus and
any Prospectus Supplement with respect hereto do not constitute an offer to
sell or a solicitation of an offer to buy any securities other than the
Securities offered hereby and thereby nor an offer of the Securities to any
person in any state or other jurisdiction in which such offer would be
unlawful.  The delivery of this Prospectus at any time does not imply that
information herein is correct as of any time subsequent to its date.


               INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

     All documents subsequently filed by or on behalf of the Trust Fund
referred to in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement with the Commission
pursuant to Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act
of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), after the date of this Prospectus
and prior to the termination of any offering of the Securities issued by such
Trust Fund shall be deemed to be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus
and to be a part of this Prospectus from the date of the filing of such
documents.  Any statement contained in a document incorporated or deemed to
be incorporated by reference herein shall be deemed to be modified or
superseded for all purposes of this Prospectus to the extent that a statement
contained herein (or in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement) or in any
other subsequently filed document which also is or is deemed to be
incorporated by reference modifies or replaces such statement.  Any such
statement so modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so
modified or superseded, to constitute a part of this Prospectus.  Neither
Provident nor the Master Servicer for any Series intends to file with the
Commission periodic reports with respect to the related Trust Fund following
completion of the reporting period required by Rule 15d-1 or Regulation 15D
under the Exchange Act.

     The Trustee or such other entity specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement on behalf of any Trust Fund will provide without charge to each
person to whom this Prospectus is delivered, on the written or oral request
of such person, a copy of any or all of the documents referred to above that
have been or may be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus (not
including exhibits to the information that is incorporated by reference
unless such exhibits are specifically incorporated by reference into the
information that this Prospectus incorporates).  Such requests should be
directed to the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee or the address of such
other entity specified in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement.  Included
in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement is the name, address, telephone
number, and, if available, facsimile number of the office or contact person
at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee or such other entity.


                          REPORTS TO SECURITYHOLDERS

     Periodic and annual reports concerning the related Trust Fund for a
Series of Securities will be forwarded to Securityholders.  However, such
reports will neither be examined nor reported on by an independent public
accountant.  See "Description of the Securities--Reports to Securityholders".

                               SUMMARY OF TERMS

     This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the detailed
information appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and in the related
Prospectus Supplement with respect to the Series of Securities offered
thereby and to the related Agreement (as such term is defined below) which
will be prepared in connection with each Series of Securities.  Unless
otherwise specified, capitalized terms used and not defined in this Summary
of Terms have the meanings given to them in this Prospectus and in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  See "Index of Defined Terms" on Page 85 of
this Prospectus for the location of the definitions of certain capitalized
terms.

Title of 
Securities      Asset Backed Certificates (the "Certificates") and
                Asset Backed Notes (the "Notes" and, together with
                the Certificates, the "Securities"), which are
                issuable in Series.


Provident      The Provident Bank ("Provident"), an Ohio banking corporation
               in its capacity as transferor of the Loans to the Trust Fund.

Trustee        The trustee(s) (the "Trustee") for each Series of Securities
               will be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  See
               "The Agreements" herein for a description of the Trustee's
               rights and obligations.

Master 
Servicer       The entity or entities named as Master Servicer (the
               "Master Servicer") in the related Prospectus
               Supplement, which may be Provident or an affiliate
               thereof.  See "The Agreements--Certain Matters
               Regarding the Master Servicer and Provident".

Trust Fund 
Assets         Assets of the Trust Fund for a Series of Securities
               will include certain assets (the "Trust Fund
               Assets") which will consist of the Loans, together
               with payments in respect of such Trust Fund Assets,
               as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
               At the time of issuance of the Securities of the
               Series, Provident will assign the Loans comprising
               the related Trust Fund to the Trustee, without
               recourse.  The Loans will be collected in a pool
               (each, a "Pool") as of the first day of the month of
               the issuance of the related Series of Securities or
               such other date specified in the related Prospectus
               Supplement (the "Cut-Off Date").  Trust Fund Assets
               also may include insurance policies, surety bonds,
               cash accounts, reinvestment income, guaranties or
               letters of credit to the extent described in the
               related Prospectus Supplement.  See "Credit
               Enhancement".  In addition, if the related
               Prospectus Supplement so provides, the related Trust
               Fund Assets will include the funds on deposit in an
               account (a "Pre-Funding Account") which will be used
               to purchase additional Loans during the period
               specified in such Prospectus Supplement.  See "The
               Agreements--Pre-Funding Account".

Loans          The Loans will consist of (i) mortgage loans secured by first
               and/or subordinate liens on one- to four-family residential
               properties (each, a "Mortgage Loan") and (ii) closed-end loans
               (the "Closed-End Loans") and/or revolving home equity loans or
               certain balances thereof (the "Revolving Credit Line Loans",
               together with the Closed-End Loans, the "Home Equity Loans"). 
               All Loans will have been originated or purchased by Provident,
               either directly or through an affiliate.

               As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Home 
               Equity Loans will be secured by mortgages or deeds of trust
               or other similar security instruments creating a lien on a 
               Mortgaged Property, which may be subordinated to one or more 
               senior liens on the Mortgaged Property, as described in the 
               related Prospectus Supplement.

Description 
of the 
Securities     Each Security will represent a beneficial ownership
               interest in, or be secured by the assets of, a Trust
               Fund created by Provident pursuant to an Agreement
               among Provident, the Master Servicer and the Trustee
               for the related Series.  The Securities of any
               Series may be issued in one or more classes as
               specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  A
               Series of Securities may include one or more classes
               of senior Securities (collectively, the "Senior
               Securities") and one or more classes of subordinate
               Securities (collectively, the "Subordinated
               Securities").  Certain Series or classes of
               Securities may be covered by insurance policies or
               other forms of credit enhancement, in each case as
               described under "Credit Enhancement" herein and in
               the related Prospectus Supplement.

               One or more classes of Securities of each Series (i) may be
               entitled to receive distributions allocable only to principal,
               only to interest or to any combination thereof; (ii) may be 
               entitled to receive distributions only of prepayments of 
               principal throughout the lives of the Securities or during 
               specified periods; (iii) may be subordinated in the right to 
               receive distributions of scheduled payments of principal, 
               prepayments of principal, interest or any combination 
               thereof to one or more other classes of Securities of
               such Series throughout the lives of the Securities or during
               specified periods; (iv) may be entitled to receive such
               distributions only after the occurrence of events specified in
               the related Prospectus Supplement; (v) may be entitled to 
               receive distributions in accordance with a schedule or formula 
               or on the basis of collections from designated portions of the 
               related Trust Fund Assets; (vi) as to Securities entitled to 
               distributions allocable to interest, may be entitled to receive 
               interest at a fixed rate or a rate that is subject to change 
               from time to time; and (vii) as to Securities entitled to 
               distributions allocable to interest, may be entitled to 
               distributions allocable to interest only after the occurrence 
               of events specified in the related Prospectus Supplement and 
               may accrue interest until such events occur, in each case as 
               specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The timing 
               and amounts of such distributions may vary among classes or 
               over time, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

Distributions 
on the
Securities     Distributions on the Securities entitled thereto
               will be made monthly, quarterly, semi-annually or at
               such other intervals and on the dates specified in
               the related Prospectus Supplement (each, a
               "Distribution Date") out of the payments received in
               respect of the assets of the related Trust Fund or
               other assets pledged for the benefit of the
               Securities as described under "Credit Enhancement"
               herein to the extent specified in the related
               Prospectus Supplement.  The amount allocable to
               payments of principal and interest on any
               Distribution Date will be determined as specified in
               the related Prospectus Supplement.  The Prospectus
               Supplement for a Series of Securities will describe
               the method for allocating distributions among
               Securities of different classes as well as the
               method for allocating distributions among Securities
               for any particular class.  

               The aggregate original principal balance of the Securities will
               not exceed the aggregate distributions allocable to principal 
               that such Securities will be entitled to receive.  If specified 
               in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Securities will have 
               an aggregate original principal balance equal to the aggregate 
               unpaid principal balance of the Trust Fund Assets as of the 
               related Cut-Off Date and will bear interest in the aggregate 
               at a rate equal to the interest rate borne by the underlying 
               Loans (the "Loan Rate") net of the aggregate servicing fees 
               and any other amounts specified in the related Prospectus 
               Supplement or at such other interest rate as may be specified
               in such Prospectus Supplement.  

               The rate at which interest will be passed through or paid to
               Securityholders (each, a "Pass-Through Rate") entitled thereto
               may be a fixed rate or a rate that is subject to change from 
               time to time from the time and for the periods, in each case,
               as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Any such
               in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Any such 
               rate may be calculated on a loan-by-loan or weighted average 
               basis or a notional amount in each case as described in the
               related Prospectus Supplement.

Credit 
Enhancement    The Trust Fund Assets or the Securities of one or
may have the
               benefit of one or more types of credit enhancement
               as described in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
               The protection against losses afforded by any such
               credit support may be limited.  The type,
               characteristics and amount of credit enhancement
               will be determined based on the characteristics of
               the Loans comprising the Trust Fund Assets and other
               factors and will be established on the basis of
               requirements of each Rating Agency rating the
               Securities of such Series.  See "Credit
               Enhancement."

               If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the coverage
               provided by one or more of the forms of credit enhancement
               described in this Prospectus may apply concurrently to two or
               more separate Trust Funds.  If applicable, the related 
               Prospectus Supplement will identify the Trust Funds to which 
               such credit enhancement relates and the manner of determining
               the amount of coverage provided to such Trust Funds thereby 
               and of the application of such coverage to the identified 
               Trust Funds.  

A. Subordination         A Series of Securities may consist of one or more
                         classes of Senior  Securities and one or more
                         classes of Subordinated Securities.  The rights of
                         the holders of the Subordinated Securities of a
                         Series to receive distributions with respect to the
                         related Trust Fund Assets will be subordinated to
                         such rights of the holders of the Senior Securities
                         of the same Series to the extent described in the
                         related Prospectus Supplement.  This subordination
                         is intended to enhance the likelihood of regular
                         receipt by holders of Senior Securities of such
                         Series of the full amount of monthly payments of
                         principal and interest due them.  The protection
                         afforded to the holders of Senior Securities of a
                         Series by means of the subordination feature will be
                         accomplished by (i) the preferential right of such
                         holders to receive, prior to any distribution being
                         made in respect of the related Subordinated
                         Securities, the amounts of interest and/or principal
                         due them on each Distribution Date out of the funds
                         available for distribution on such date in the
                         related Security Account and, to the extent
                         described in the related Prospectus Supplement, by
                         the right of such holders to receive future
                         distributions on the related Trust Fund 

                         Assets that would otherwise have been payable to 
                         the holders of Subordinated Securities; (ii) reducing 
                         the ownership interest (if applicable) of the related
                         Subordinated Securities; or (iii) a combination of 
                         clauses (i) and (ii) above.  If so specified in the
                         related Prospectus Supplement, subordination may 
                         apply only in the event of certain types of losses 
                         not covered by other forms of credit support, such 
                         as hazard losses not covered by standard hazard 
                         insurance policies or losses due to the bankruptcy 
                         or fraud of the borrower.  The related Prospectus 
                         Supplement will set forth information concerning, 
                         among other things, the amount of subordination 
                         of a class or classes of Subordinated Securities in a
                         Series, the circumstances in which such subordination
                         will be applicable, and the manner, if any, in which 
                         the amount of subordination will decrease over time.

B. Reserve Account       One or more reserve accounts or other cash accounts
                         (each, a "Reserve Account") may be established and
                         maintained for each Series of Securities.  The
                         related Prospectus Supplement will specify whether
                         or not such Reserve Accounts will be included in the
                         corpus of the Trust Fund for such Series and will
                         also specify the manner of funding such Reserve
                         Accounts and the conditions under which the amounts
                         in any such Reserve Accounts will be used to make
                         distributions to holders of Securities of a
                         particular class or released from such Reserve
                         Accounts.

C. Letter of Credit      If so specified in the related Prospectus
                         Supplement, credit support for a Series may be
                         provided by one or more letters of credit.  A letter
                         of credit may provide limited protection against
                         certain losses in addition to or in lieu of other
                         credit support, such as losses resulting from
                         delinquent payments on the Loans in the related
                         Trust Fund, losses from risks not covered by
                         standard hazard insurance policies, losses due to
                         bankruptcy of a borrower and application of certain
                         provisions of the federal Bankruptcy Code, and
                         losses due to denial of insurance coverage due to
                         misrepresentations made in connection with the
                         origination or sale of a Loan.  The issuer of the
                         letter of credit (the "L/C Bank") will be obligated
                         to honor demands with respect to such letter of
                         credit, to the extent of the amount available
                         thereunder to provide funds under the circumstances
                         and subject to such conditions as are specified in
                         the related Prospectus Supplement.  The liability of
                         the L/C Bank under its letter of credit will be
                         reduced by the amount of unreimbursed payments
                         thereunder.

                         The maximum liability of a L/C Bank under its letter 
                         of credit will be an amount equal to a percentage 
                         specified in the related Prospectus Supplement of 
                         the initial aggregate outstanding principal balance 
                         of the Loans in the related Trust Fund or one or
                         more Classes of Securities of the related Series.  
                         The maximum amount available at any time to be 
                         paid under a letter of credit will be determined 
                         in the manner specified therein and in the
                         related Prospectus Supplement.

D. Insurance Policies; 
   Surety Bonds and 
   Guarantees            If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                         credit support for a Series may be provided by an
                         insurance policy and/or a surety bond issued by one or
                         more insurance companies or sureties.  Such certificate
                         guarantee insurance or surety bond will guarantee 
                         timely distributions of interest and/or full 
                         distributions of principal on the basis of a 
                         schedule of principal distributions set forth in 
                         or determined in the manner specified in the 
                         related Prospectus Supplement.  If specified in 
                         the related Prospectus Supplement, 
                         one or more bankruptcy bonds, special hazard 
                         insurance policies, other insurance or third-party
                         guarantees may be used to provide coverage for the 
                         risks of default or types of losses set forth in 
                         such Prospectus Supplement.

E. Over-
Collateralization        If so provided in the Prospectus
                         Supplement for a Series of Securities, a
                         portion of the interest payment on each
                         Loan may be applied as an additional
                         distribution in respect of principal to
                         reduce the principal balance of a certain
                         class or classes of such Series of
                         Securities and, thus, accelerate the rate
                         of payment of principal on such class or
                         classes of such Series of Securities.

F. Mortgage Pool
   Insurance Policy      A mortgage pool insurance policy or policies may be
                         obtained and maintained for Loans relating to any
                         Series of Securities, which shall be limited in
                         scope and shall cover defaults on the related Loans
                         in an initial amount equal to a specified percentage
                         of the aggregate principal balance of all Loans
                         included in the Pool as of the related Cut-Off Date.


G. Cross-
Collateralization        If specified in the related Prospectus
                         Supplement, separate classes of a Series
                         of Securities may evidence the beneficial
                         ownership of, or be secured by, separate
                         groups of assets included in a Trust Fund. 
                         In such case, credit support may be
                         provided by a cross-collateralization
                         feature which requires that distributions
                         be made to Securities evidencing a
                         beneficial ownership interest in, or
                         secured by, one or more asset groups prior
                         to distributions to Subordinated
                         Securities evidencing a beneficial
                         ownership interest in, or secured by,
                         other asset groups within the same Trust
                         Fund.  See "Credit Enhancement--Cross-
                         Collateralization."

Advances       The Master Servicer and, if applicable, each mortgage
               servicing institution that services a Loan in a Pool on behalf
               of the Master Servicer (each, a "Sub-Servicer") may be
               obligated to advance amounts (each, an "Advance")
               corresponding to delinquent interest and/or principal payments
               on such Loan until the date, as specified in the related
               Prospectus Supplement, on which the related Property is sold
               at a foreclosure sale or the related Loan is otherwise
               liquidated.  Any obligation to make Advances may be subject to
               limitations as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
               If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Advances
               may be drawn from a cash account available for such purpose as
               described in such Prospectus Supplement.  Advances will be
               reimbursable to the extent described under "Description of the
               Securities--Advances" herein and in the related Prospectus
               Supplement.

               In the event the Master Servicer or Sub-Servicer fails to make a
               required Advance, the Trustee may be obligated to advance such
               amounts otherwise required to be advanced by the Master Servicer
               or Sub-Servicer.  See "Description of the Securities--Advances." 

Optional 
Termination    The Master Servicer or the party specified in
               the related Prospectus Supplement, including
               the holder of the residual interest in a REMIC,
               may have the option to effect early retirement
               of a Series of Securities through the purchase
               of the Trust Fund Assets.  The Master Servicer
               will deposit the proceeds of any such purchase
               in the Security Account for each Trust Fund as described 
               under "The Agreements--Payments on Loans; Deposit to 
               Security Account."  Any such purchase of Trust
               Fund Assets and property acquired in respect of Trust Fund 
               Assets evidenced by a Series of Securities will be made at 
               the option of the Master Servicer, such other person or, 
               if applicable, such holder of the REMIC residual interest, at 
               a price specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The 
               exercise of such right will effect early retirement of the 
               Securities of that Series, but the right of the Master 
               Servicer, such other person or, if applicable,
               such holder of the REMIC residual interest, to so purchase is
               subject to the principal balance of the related Trust Fund 
               Assets being less than the percentage specified in the related 
               Prospectus Supplement of the aggregate principal balance of 
               the Trust Fund Assets at the Cut-Off Date for the Series.  The 
               foregoing is subject to the provision that if a REMIC election 
               is made with respect to a Trust Fund, any such purchase will 
               be made only in connection with a "qualified liquidation" of 
               the REMIC within the meaning of Section 860F(g)(4) of the 
               Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"). 

Legal Investment         The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of
                         Securities will specify which, if any, of the
                         classes of Securities offered thereby constitute
                         "mortgage related securities" for purposes of the
                         Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of 1984
                         ("SMMEA").  Classes of Securities that qualify as
                         "mortgage related securities" will be legal
                         investments for certain types of institutional
                         investors to the extent provided in SMMEA, subject,
                         in any case, to any other regulations which may
                         govern investments by such institutional investors. 
                         Institutions whose investment activities are subject
                         to review by federal or state authorities should
                         consult with their counsel or the applicable
                         authorities to determine whether an investment in a
                         particular class of Securities (whether or not such
                         class constitutes a "mortgage related security")
                         complies with applicable guidelines, policy
                         statements or restrictions.  See "Legal Investment."

Federal Income Tax
  Consequences      The federal income tax consequences to Securityholders
                    will vary depending on whether one or more elections are
                    made to treat the Trust Fund or specified portions
                    thereof as a REMIC under the provisions of the Code.  The
                    Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities will
                    specify whether such an election will be made.

                    If a REMIC election is made, Securities representing 
                    regular interests in a REMIC will generally be taxable to 
                    holders in the same manner as evidences of indebtedness 
                    issued by the REMIC.   Stated interest on such regular 
                    interests will be taxable as ordinary income and taken 
                    into account using the accrual method of accounting, 
                    regardless of the holder's normal accounting method. 

                    If no REMIC election is made, interest (other than 
                    original issue discount ("OID")) on Securities that 
                    are characterized as indebtedness for federal income 
                    tax purposes will be includible in income by holders 
                    thereof in accordance with their usual method of 
                    accounting.

                    Certain classes of Securities may be issued with OID.  A
                    Securityholder should be aware that the Code and the 
                    Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder do not 
                    adequately address certain issues relevant to prepayable
                    securities, such as the Securities.

                    Securityholders that will be required to report income 
                    with respect to the related Securities under the accrual 
                    method of accounting will do so without giving effect 
                    to delays and reductions in distributions attributable 
                    to a default or delinquency on the Loans, except possibly
                    to the extent that it can be established
                    that such amounts are uncollectible.  As a result, 
                    the amount of income (including OID) reported by a 
                    Securityholder in any period could significantly exceed 
                    the amount of cash distributed to such Securityholder 
                    in that period.

                    In the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, if a REMIC election is 
                    made with respect to a Series of Securities, then the 
                    arrangement by which such Securities are issued will be 
                    treated as a REMIC as long as all of the provisions of 
                    the applicable Agreement are complied with and the 
                    statutory and regulatory requirements are satisfied. 
                    Securities will be designated as "regular interests" 
                    or "residual interests" in a REMIC.  A REMIC will 
                    not be subject to entity-level tax.  Rather, the 
                    taxable income or net loss of a REMIC will be
                    taken into account by the holders of residual interests.  
                    Such holders will report their proportionate share of 
                    the taxable income of the REMIC whether or not they 
                    receive cash distributions from the REMIC attributable 
                    to such income.  The portion of the REMIC taxable income 
                    consisting of "excess inclusions" may not be offset
                    against other deductions or losses of the holder, 
                    including the net operating losses.

                    In the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, if a REMIC or a 
                    partnership election is not made with respect to a 
                    Series of Securities, then the arrangement by which 
                    such Securities are issued will be classified as a 
                    grantor trust under Subpart E, Part I of Subchapter
                    J of the Code and not as an association taxable as a 
                    corporation. If so provided in the Prospectus Supplement 
                    for a Series, there will be no separation of the principal 
                    and interest payments on the Loans.  In such circumstances,
                    the Securityholder will be considered to have purchased a 
                    pro rata undivided interest in each of the Loans.  In 
                    other cases, sale of the Securities will produce
                    a separation in the ownership of all or a portion of the
                    principal payments from all or a portion of the interest 
                    payments on the Loans.

                    In the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, if a partnership 
                    election is made, the Trust Fund will not be treated as 
                    an association or a publicly traded partnership taxable 
                    as a corporation as long as all of the provisions of 
                    the applicable Agreement are complied with and
                    the statutory and regulatory requirements are 
                    satisfied.  If Notes are issued by such Trust Fund, 
                    such Notes will be treated as indebtedness for federal 
                    income tax purposes.  The holders of the Certificates 
                    issued by such Trust Fund, if any, will agree to treat
                    the Certificates as equity interests in a partnership.

                    The Securities will be treated as assets described in 
                    Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code and as real estate 
                    assets described in Section 856(c) of the Code.

                    Generally, gain or loss will be recognized on a sale of 
                    Securities in the amount equal to the difference between 
                    the amount realized and the seller's tax basis in the 
                    Securities sold.

                    The material federal income tax consequences for 
                    investors associated with the purchase, ownership 
                    and disposition of the Securities are set forth herein 
                    under "Federal Income Tax Consequences".  The material
                    federal income tax consequences for investors associated 
                    with the purchase, ownership and disposition of 
                    Securities of any particular Series will be set forth 
                    under the heading "Federal Income Tax Consequences" 
                    in the related Prospectus Supplement.  See "Federal
                    Income Tax Consequences".

ERISA 
Considerations      A fiduciary of any employee benefit plan or
                    other retirement plan or arrangement subject to
                    the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
                    1974, as amended ("ERISA"), or the Code should
                    carefully review with its legal advisors
                    whether the purchase or holding of Securities
                    could give rise to a transaction prohibited or
                    not otherwise permissible under ERISA or the
                    Code.  See "ERISA Considerations".  Certain
                    classes of Securities may not be transferred
                    unless the Trustee is furnished with a letter
                    of representation or an opinion of counsel to
                    the effect that such transfer will not result
                    in a violation of the prohibited transaction
                    provisions of ERISA and the Code and will not
                    subject the Trustee, Provident or the Master
                    Servicer to additional obligations.  See
                    "Description of the Securities--General" and
                    " ERISA Considerations".

Risk Factors        For a discussion of certain risks associated with an
                    investment in the Securities, see "Risk Factors" on Page
                    12 herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.

                                 RISK FACTORS

     Investors should consider the following factors in connection with the
purchase of the Securities.

LIMITED LIQUIDITY

     There will be no market for the Securities of any Series prior to the
issuance thereof, and there can be no assurance that a secondary market will
develop or, if it does develop, that it will provide Securityholders with
liquidity of investment or will continue for the life of the Securities of
such Series.

LIMITED SOURCE OF PAYMENTS--NO RECOURSE TO PROVIDENT OR MASTER SERVICER

     As further described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Securities of a Series will be payable solely from the Trust Fund for such
Series and will not have any claim against or security interest in any trust
fund for any other Series.  There will be no recourse to Provident or any
other person for any failure to receive distributions on the Securities. 
Further, at the times set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain
Trust Fund Assets and/or any balance remaining in the Security Account
immediately after making all payments due on the Securities of such Series,
after making adequate provision for future payments on certain classes of
Securities and after making any other payments specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, may be promptly released or remitted to Provident, the
Master Servicer, any credit enhancement provider or any other person entitled
thereto and will no longer be available for making payments to
Securityholders.  Consequently, holders of Securities of each Series must
rely solely upon payments with respect to the Trust Fund Assets and the other
assets constituting the Trust Fund for a Series of Securities, including, if
applicable, any amounts available pursuant to any credit enhancement for such
Series, for the payment of principal of and interest on the Securities of
such Series.

     The Securities will not represent an interest in or obligation of
Provident, the Master Servicer or any of their respective affiliates.  The
only obligation, if any, of Provident with respect to the Trust Fund Assets
or the Securities of any Series will be pursuant to certain representations
and warranties and certain document delivery requirements.

     Provident may be required to repurchase or substitute for any Loan with
respect to which such representations and warranties or document delivery
requirements are breached.  There is no assurance, however, that Provident
will have the financial ability to effect such repurchase or substitution.

CREDIT ENHANCEMENT AND POSSIBLE LIMITATIONS ON EFFECTIVENESS

     Although credit enhancement is intended to reduce the risk of delinquent
payments or losses to holders of Securities entitled to the benefit thereof,
the amount of such credit enhancement will be limited, as set forth in the
related Prospectus Supplement, and may be subject to periodic reduction in
accordance with a schedule or formula or otherwise decline, and could be
depleted under certain circumstances prior to the payment in full of the
related Series of Securities, and as a result Securityholders of the related
Series may suffer losses.  Moreover, such credit enhancement may not cover
all potential losses or risks.  For example, credit enhancement may or may
not cover fraud or negligence by a loan originator or other parties.  In
addition, the Trustee will generally be permitted to reduce, terminate or
substitute all or a portion of the credit enhancement for any Series of
Securities, provided the applicable Rating Agency indicates that the then-
current rating of the Securities of such Series will not be adversely
affected.  See "Credit Enhancement".

PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS

     The timing of principal payments of the Securities of a Series will be
affected by a number of factors, including the following: (i) the extent of
prepayments (including for this purpose prepayments resulting from
refinancing or liquidations of the Loans due to defaults, casualties,
condemnations and repurchases by Provident or the Master Servicer) of the
Loans comprising the Trust Fund, which prepayments may be influenced by a 
variety of factors including general economic conditions, prevailing interest
rate levels, the availability of alternative financing and homeowner
mobility, (ii) the manner of allocating principal and/or payments among the
classes of Securities of a Series as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, (iii) the exercise by the party entitled thereto of any right of
optional termination and (iv) the rate and timing of payment defaults and
losses incurred with respect to the Trust Fund Assets.  The repurchase of
Loans by Provident or the Seller may result from repurchases of Trust Fund
Assets due to material breaches of Provident's or the Seller's representa-
tions and warranties, as applicable.  The yields to maturity and weighted
average lives of the Securities will be affected primarily by the rate and
timing of prepayment of the Loans comprising the Trust Fund Assets.  In
addition, the yields to maturity and weighted average lives of the Securities
will be affected by the distribution of amounts remaining in any Pre-Funding
Account following the end of the related Funding Period.  Any reinvestment
risks resulting from a faster or slower incidence of prepayment of Loans held
by a Trust Fund will be borne entirely by the holders of one or more classes
of the related Series of Securities.  See "Yield and Prepayment
Considerations" and "The Agreements--Pre-Funding Account."

     Interest payable on the Securities of a Series on a Distribution Date
will include all interest accrued during the period specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  In the event interest accrues over a period ending
two or more days prior to a Distribution Date, the effective yield to
Securityholders will be reduced from the yield that would otherwise be
obtainable if interest payable on the Securities were to accrue through the
day immediately preceding each Distribution Date, and the effective yield (at
par) to Securityholders will be less than the indicated coupon rate.  See
"Description of the Securities--Distributions on Securities--Distributions of
Interest".

BALLOON PAYMENTS AND INCREASED RISK OF DEFAULT

     Certain of the Loans as of the related Cut-Off Date may not be fully
amortizing over their terms to maturity and, thus, will require substantial
principal payments (i.e., balloon payments) at their stated maturity.  Loans
with balloon payments involve a greater degree of risk because the ability of
a borrower to make a balloon payment typically will depend upon its ability
either to timely refinance the loan or to timely sell the related Property. 
The ability of a borrower to accomplish either of these goals will be
affected by a number of factors, including the level of available mortgage
rates at the time of sale or refinancing, the borrower's equity in the
related Property, the financial condition of the borrower and tax laws. 
Losses on such Loans that are not otherwise covered by the credit enhancement
described in the applicable Prospectus Supplement will be borne by the
holders of one or more classes of Securities of the related Series.

NATURE OF MORTGAGES

     Change in Property Values and Possible Increase in Losses.  There are
several factors that could adversely affect the value of Properties such that
the outstanding balance of the related Loans, together with any senior
financing on the Properties, if applicable, would equal or exceed the value
of the Properties.  Among the factors that could adversely affect the value
of the Properties are an overall decline in the residential real estate
market in the areas in which the Properties are located or a decline in the
general condition of the Properties as a result of failure of borrowers to
maintain adequately the Properties or of natural disasters that are not
necessarily covered by insurance, such as earthquakes and floods.  In the
case of Home Equity Loans, such decline could extinguish the value of the
interest of a junior mortgagee in the Property before having any effect on
the interest of the related senior mortgagee.  If such a decline occurs, the
actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses on all Loans could be
higher than those currently experienced in the mortgage lending industry in
general.  Losses on such Loans that are not otherwise covered by the credit
enhancement described in the applicable Prospectus Supplement will be borne
by the holder of one or more classes of Securities of the related Series.

     Delays Due to Liquidation.  Even assuming that the Properties provide
adequate security for the Loans, substantial delays could be encountered in
connection with the liquidation of defaulted Loans and corresponding delays
in the receipt of related proceeds by Securityholders could occur.  An action
to foreclose on a Property securing a Loan is regulated by state statutes and
rules and is subject to many of the delays and expenses of 

other lawsuits if defenses or counterclaims are interposed, sometimes
requiring several years to complete.  Furthermore, in some states an action
to obtain a deficiency judgment is not permitted following a nonjudicial sale
of a Property.  In the event of a default by a borrower, these restrictions,
among other things, may impede the ability of the Master Servicer to
foreclose on or sell the Property or to obtain liquidation proceeds
sufficient to repay all amounts due on the related Loan.  In addition, the
Master Servicer will be entitled to deduct from related liquidation proceeds
all expenses reasonably incurred in attempting to recover amounts due on
defaulted Loans and not yet repaid, including payments to senior lienholders,
legal fees and costs of legal action, real estate taxes and maintenance and
preservation expenses.

     Disproportionate Effect of Liquidation Expenses.  Liquidation expenses
with respect to defaulted Loans do not vary directly with the outstanding
principal balance of the Loan at the time of default.  Therefore, assuming
that a servicer took the same steps in realizing upon a defaulted Loan having
a small remaining principal balance as it would in the case of a defaulted
Loan having a large remaining principal balance, the amount realized after
expenses of liquidation would be smaller as a percentage of the outstanding
principal balance of the small Loan than would be the case with the defaulted
Loan having a large remaining principal balance.    

     Home Equity Loans; Junior Liens and Effect on Recoveries.  Since the
mortgages and deeds of trust securing the Home Equity Loans will be primarily
junior liens subordinate to the rights of the mortgagee under the related
senior mortgage(s) or deed(s) of trust, the proceeds from any liquidation,
insurance or condemnation proceeds will be available to satisfy the
outstanding balance of such junior lien only to the extent that the claims of
such senior mortgagees have been satisfied in full, including any related
foreclosure costs.  In addition, a junior mortgagee may not foreclose on the
property securing a junior mortgage unless it forecloses subject to any
senior mortgage, in which case it must either pay the entire amount due on
any senior mortgage to the related senior mortgagee at or prior to the
foreclosure sale or undertake the obligation to make payments on any such
senior mortgage in the event the mortgagor is in default thereunder.  The
Trust Fund will not have any source of funds to satisfy any senior mortgages
or make payments due to any senior mortgagees and may therefore be prevented
from foreclosing on the related property.    

     Consumer Protection Laws.  Applicable state laws generally regulate
interest rates and other charges, require certain disclosures, and require
licensing of certain originators and servicers of Loans.  In addition, most
states have other laws, public policy and general principles of equity
relating to the protection of consumers, unfair and deceptive practices and
practices which may apply to the origination, servicing and collection of the
Loans.  Depending on the provisions of the applicable law and the specific
facts and circumstances involved, violations of these laws, policies and
principles may limit the ability of the Master Servicer to collect all or
part of the principal of or interest on the Loans, may entitle the borrower
to a refund of amounts previously paid and, in addition, could subject the
Master Servicer to damages and administrative sanctions.  See "Certain Legal
Aspects of the Loans".

ENVIRONMENTAL RISKS TO TRUST FUND

     Real property pledged as security to a lender may be subject to certain
environmental risks.  Under the laws of certain states, contamination of a
property may give rise to a lien on the property to assure the costs of
cleanup.  In several states, such a lien has priority over the lien of an
existing mortgage against such property.  In addition, under the laws of some
states and under the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response,
Compensation and Liability Act of 1980 ("CERCLA"), a lender may be liable, as
an "owner" or "operator", for costs of addressing releases or threatened
releases of hazardous substances that require remedy at a property, if agents
or employees of the lender have become sufficiently involved in the
operations of the borrower, regardless of whether the environmental damage or
threat was caused by a prior owner.  Such costs could result in a loss to the
holders of one or more classes of Securities of the related Series.  A lender
also risks such liability on foreclosure of the related property.  See
"Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans--Environmental Risks".


CERTAIN OTHER LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS

     Consumer Protection Laws.  The Loans may also be subject to federal
laws, including:

          (i)  the Federal Truth in Lending Act and Regulation Z promulgated
     thereunder, which require certain disclosures to the borrowers regarding
     the terms of the Loans;

          (ii) the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and Regulation B promulgated
     thereunder, which prohibit discrimination on the basis of age, race,
     color, sex, religion, marital status, national origin, receipt of public
     assistance or the exercise of any right under the Consumer Credit
     Protection Act, in the extension of credit;

          (iii)     the Fair Credit Reporting Act, which regulates the use
     and reporting of information related to the borrower's credit
     experience; and

          (iv) for Loans that were originated or closed after November 7,
     1989, the Home Equity Loan Consumer Protection Act of 1988, which
     requires additional application disclosures, limits changes that may be
     made to the Loan documents without the borrower's consent and restricts
     a lender's ability to declare a default or to suspend or reduce a
     borrower's credit limit to certain enumerated events.

     The Riegle Act.  Certain Mortgage Loans may be subject to the Riegle
Community Development and Regulatory Improvement Act of 1994 (the "Riegle
Act") which incorporates the Home Ownership and Equity Protection Act of
1994.  These provisions impose additional disclosure and other requirements
on creditors with respect to non-purchase money mortgage loans with high
interest rates or high up-front fees and charges.  The provisions of the
Riegle Act apply on a mandatory basis to all Mortgage Loans originated on or
after October 1, 1995.  These provisions can impose specific statutory
liabilities upon creditors who fail to comply with their provisions and may
affect the enforceability of the related Loans.  In addition, any assignee of
the creditor would generally be subject to all claims and defenses that the
consumer could assert against the creditor, including, without limitation,
the right to rescind the Mortgage Loan.

RATING OF THE SECURITIES

     It will be a condition to the issuance of a class of Securities offered
hereby that they be rated in one of the four highest rating categories by the
Rating Agency identified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Any such
rating would be based on, among other things, the adequacy of the value of
the related Trust Fund Assets and any credit enhancement with respect to such
class and will represent such Rating Agency's assessment solely of the
likelihood that holders of such class of Securities will receive payments to
which such Securityholders are entitled under the related Agreement.  Such
rating will not constitute an assessment of the likelihood that principal
prepayments on the related Loans will be made, the degree to which the rate
of such prepayments might differ from that originally anticipated or the
likelihood of early optional termination of the Series of Securities.  Such
rating shall not be deemed a recommendation to purchase, hold or sell
Securities, inasmuch as it does not address market price or suitability for a
particular investor.  Such rating will not address the possibility that
prepayment at higher or lower rates than anticipated by an investor may cause
such investor to experience a lower than anticipated yield or that an
investor purchasing a Security at a significant premium might fail to recoup
its initial investment under certain prepayment scenarios.

     There is also no assurance that any such rating will remain in effect
for any given period of time or that it may not be lowered or withdrawn
entirely by the Rating Agency in the future if in its judgment circumstances
in the future so warrant.  In addition to being lowered or withdrawn due to
any erosion in the adequacy of the value of the Trust Fund Assets or any
credit enhancement with respect to a Series of Securities, such rating might
also be lowered or withdrawn because of, among other reasons, an adverse
change in the financial or other condition of a credit enhancement provider
or a change in the rating of such credit enhancement provider's long term
debt.

     The amount, type and nature of credit enhancement, if any, established
with respect to a class of Securities will be determined on the basis of
criteria established by each Rating Agency rating classes of such Series. 
Such criteria are sometimes based upon an actuarial analysis of the behavior
of similar loans in a larger group.  Such analysis is often the basis upon
which each Rating Agency determines the amount of credit enhancement required
with respect to each such class.  There can be no assurance that the
historical data supporting any such actuarial analysis will accurately
reflect future experience nor any assurance that the data derived from a
large pool of similar loans accurately predicts the delinquency, foreclosure
or loss experience of any particular pool of Loans.  No assurance can be
given that the values of any Properties have remained or will remain at their
levels on the respective dates of origination of the related Loans.  If the
residential real estate markets should experience an overall decline in
property values such that the outstanding principal balances of the Loans in
a particular Trust Fund and any other financing on the related Properties
become equal to or greater than the value of the Properties, the rates of
delinquencies, foreclosures and losses could be higher than those now
generally experienced in the mortgage lending industry.  In addition, adverse
economic conditions (which may or may not affect real property values) may
affect the timely payment by mortgagors of scheduled payments of principal
and interest on the Loans and, accordingly, the rates of delinquencies,
foreclosures and losses with respect to any Trust Fund.  To the extent that
such losses are not covered by credit enhancement, such losses will be borne,
at least in part, by the holders of one or more classes of Securities of the
related Series.  See "Rating".

BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION AND REDUCTION OF LIQUIDITY OF SECURITIES

     If issued in book-entry form, such registration may reduce the liquidity
of the Securities in the secondary trading market since investors may be
unwilling to purchase Securities for which they cannot obtain physical
certificates.  Since transactions in Book-Entry Securities can be effected
only through the Depository Trust Company ("DTC"), participating
organizations, Financial Intermediaries and certain banks, the ability of a
Securityholder to pledge a Book-Entry Security to persons or entities that do
not participate in the DTC system may be limited due to lack of a physical
certificate representing such Securities.  Security Owners will not be
recognized as Securityholders as such term is used in the related Agreement,
and Security Owners will be permitted to exercise the rights of
Securityholders only indirectly through DTC and its Participants.

     In addition, Securityholders may experience some delay in their receipt
of distributions of interest and principal on Book-Entry Securities since
distributions are required to be forwarded by the Trustee to DTC and DTC will
then be required to credit such distributions to the accounts of Depository
participants which thereafter will be required to credit them to the accounts
of Securityholders either directly or indirectly through Financial
Intermediaries.  See "Description of the Securities--Book-Entry Registration
of Securities".

PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNTS AND POSSIBLE PREPAYMENT RISK

     If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, on the related
Closing Date Provident will deposit cash in an amount (the "Pre-Funded
Amount") specified in such Prospectus Supplement into an account (the "Pre-
Funding Account").  In no event shall the Pre-Funded Amount exceed 50% of the
initial aggregate principal amount of the Certificates and/or Notes of the
related Series of Securities.  The Pre-Funded Amount will be used to purchase
Loans ("Subsequent Loans") in a period from the related Closing Date to a
date not more than one year after such Closing Date (such period, the
"Funding Period") from Provident.  The Pre-Funding Account will be maintained
with the Trustee for the related Series of Securities and is designed solely
to hold funds to be applied by such Trustee during the Funding Period to pay
to Provident the purchase price for Subsequent Loans.  Monies on deposit in
the Pre-Funding Account will not be available to cover losses on or in
respect of the related Loans.  To the extent that the entire Pre-Funded
Amount has not been applied to the purchase of Subsequent Loans by the end of
the related Funding Period, any amounts remaining in the Pre-Funding Account
will be distributed as a prepayment of principal to the holders of the
related Securities on the Distribution Date immediately following the end of
the Funding Period, in the amounts and pursuant to the priorities set forth
in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Any reinvestment risk resulting from
such prepayment will be borne entirely by the holders of one or more classes
of the related Series of Securities.


BANKRUPTCY AND INSOLVENCY RISKS

     Provident and the Trust Fund will treat the transfer of Loans from
Provident to the Trust Fund as a sale for accounting purposes.  However, in
the event of the insolvency of Provident, it is possible that a receiver or
conservator (or similar official) for Provident, may attempt to
recharacterize the sale of the Loans as a borrowing by Provident, secured by
a pledge of the Loans.  Certain provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Act may permit the FDIC to avoid such security interest.  This position, if
argued before and/or accepted by a court, could prevent timely payments of
amounts due on the Securities and result in a reduction of payments due on
the Securities.  Provident will, however, mark its records to indicate that
the Trust Fund Assets relating to each Series have been sold to a Trust Fund.

     In the event of a bankruptcy or insolvency of the Master Servicer, the
bankruptcy trustee or receiver may have the power to prevent the Trustee or
the Securityholders from appointing a successor Master Servicer.  The time
period during which cash collections may be commingled with the Master
Servicer's own funds prior to each Distribution Date will be specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  In the event of the insolvency of the Master
Servicer and if such cash collections are commingled with the Master
Servicer's own funds for at least ten days, the Trust Fund will likely not
have a perfected interest in such collections since such collections would
not have been deposited in a segregated account within ten days after the
collection thereof, and the inclusion thereof in the bankruptcy estate of the
Master Servicer may result in delays in payment and failure to pay amounts
due on the Securities of the related Series.

     In addition, federal and state statutory provisions, including the
federal bankruptcy laws and state laws affording relief to debtors, may
interfere with or affect the ability of the secured mortgage lender to
realize upon its security.  For example, in a proceeding under the federal
Bankruptcy Code, a lender may not foreclose on a mortgaged property without
the permission of the bankruptcy court.  The rehabilitation plan proposed by
the debtor may provide, if the mortgaged property is not the debtor's
principal residence and the court determines that the value of the mortgaged
property is less than the principal balance of the mortgage loan, for the
reduction of the secured indebtedness to the value of the mortgaged property
as of the date of the commencement of the bankruptcy, rendering the lender a
general unsecured creditor for the difference, and also may reduce the
monthly payments due under such mortgage loan, change the rate of interest
and alter the mortgage loan repayment schedule.  The effect of any such
proceedings under the federal Bankruptcy Code, including but not limited to
any automatic stay, could result in delays in receiving payments on the Loans
underlying a Series of Securities and possible reductions in the aggregate
amount of such payments.

VALUE OF TRUST FUND ASSETS

     There is no assurance that the market value of the Trust Fund Assets or
any other assets relating to a Series of Securities described under "Credit
Enhancement" herein will at any time be equal to or greater than the
principal amount of the Securities of such Series then outstanding, plus
accrued interest thereon.  Moreover, upon an event of default under the
Agreement for a Series of Securities and a sale of the related Trust Fund
Assets or upon a sale of the assets of a Trust Fund for a Series of
Securities, the Trustee, the Master Servicer, the credit enhancer, if any,
and any other service provider specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
generally will be entitled to receive the proceeds of any such sale to the
extent of unpaid fees and other amounts owing to such persons under the
related Agreement prior to distributions to Securityholders.  Upon any such
sale, the proceeds thereof may be insufficient to pay in full the principal
of and interest on the Securities of such Series.


                                THE TRUST FUND

GENERAL

     The Securities of each Series will represent interests in the assets of
the related Trust Fund, and the Notes of each Series will be secured by the
pledge of the assets of the related Trust Fund.  The Trust Fund for 
each Series will be held by the Trustee for the benefit of the related
Securityholders.  Each Trust Fund will consist of certain assets (the "Trust
Fund Assets") consisting of a pool (each, a "Pool") comprised of Loans as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, together with payments in
respect of such Loans, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
The Pool will be created on the first day of the month of the issuance of the
related Series of Securities or such other date specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement (the "Cut-Off Date").  The Securities will be entitled
to payment from the assets of the related Trust Fund or other assets pledged
for the benefit of the Securityholders as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement and will not be entitled to payments in respect of the assets of
any other trust fund established by Provident. 

     Each Loan will have been originated or acquired by Provident in
accordance with the underwriting criteria specified below under "Loan
Program--Underwriting Standards" or as otherwise described in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  See "Loan Program--Underwriting Standards".  The
Trust Fund Assets will be conveyed without recourse by Provident to the
related Trust Fund.

     Provident will assign the Trust Fund Assets to the Trustee named in the
related Prospectus Supplement for the benefit of the holders of the
Securities of the related Series.  The Master Servicer named in the related
Prospectus Supplement will service the Trust Fund Assets, either directly or
through Sub-Servicers, pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement among
Provident, the Master Servicer and the Trustee with respect to a Series
consisting of Certificates, or a master servicing agreement (each, a "Master
Servicing Agreement") between the Trustee and the Master Servicer with
respect to a Series consisting of Certificates and Notes, and will receive a
fee for such services.  See "Loan Program" and "The Agreements".  With
respect to Loans serviced by the Master Servicer through a Sub-Servicer, the
Master Servicer will remain liable for its servicing obligations under the
related Agreement as if the Master Servicer alone were servicing such Loans.

     As used herein, "Agreement" means, with respect to a Series consisting
of Certificates, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and with respect to a
Series consisting of Certificates and Notes, the Trust Agreement, the
Indenture and the Master Servicing Agreement, as the context requires.

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund
relating to a Series of Securities may be a business trust formed under the
laws of the state specified in the related Prospectus Supplement pursuant to
a trust agreement (each, a "Trust Agreement") between Provident and the
trustee of such Trust Fund.

     With respect to each Trust Fund, prior to the initial offering of the
related Series of Securities, the Trust Fund will have no assets or
liabilities.  No Trust Fund is expected to engage in any activities other
than acquiring, managing and holding the related Trust Fund Assets and other
assets contemplated herein specified and in the related Prospectus Supplement
and the proceeds thereof, issuing Securities and making payments and
distributions thereon and certain related activities.  No Trust Fund is
expected to have any source of capital other than its assets and any related
credit enhancement.

     The only obligations of Provident with respect to a Series of Securities
will be to make certain representations and warranties to the Trustee for
such Series of Securities.  With respect to any breach of a representation or
warranty which materially and adversely affects the interests of a
Securityholder, Provident will be obligated to cure such breach or repurchase
or substitute for the affected Loan or Loans.  See "The Agreements--
Assignment of the Trust Fund Assets".  The obligations of the Master Servicer
with respect to the Loans will consist principally of its contractual
servicing obligations under the related Agreement (including its obligation
to enforce the obligations of the Sub-Servicers or Provident, or both, as
more fully described herein under "Loan Program--Representations by 
Provident; Repurchases" and "The Agreements--Sub-Servicing" and  
"--Assignment of the Trust Fund Assets") and its obligation, if any, to make 
certain cash advances in the event of delinquencies in payments on or with 
respect to the Loans in the amounts described herein under "Description of 
the Securities--Advances".  The obligations of the Master Servicer to make 
advances may be subject to limitations to the extent provided herein and in 
the related Prospectus Supplement.

     The following is a brief description of the assets expected to be
included in the Trust Funds.  If specific information respecting Trust Fund
Assets is not known at the time the related Series of Securities initially is
offered, more general information of the nature described below will be
provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, and specific information will
be set forth in a report on Form 8-K to be filed with the Securities and
Exchange Commission within fifteen days after the initial issuance of such
Securities (the "Detailed Description").  In no event, however, will more
than 5% (by principal balance at the Cut-Off Date) of the Mortgage Pool
deviate from the characteristics of the Loans set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  A copy of the Agreement with respect to each Series
of Securities will be available for inspection at the corporate trust office
of the Trustee specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  A schedule of
the Loans relating to such Series will be attached to the Agreement delivered
to the Trustee upon delivery of the Securities.

THE LOANS

     General.  Loans will consist of Mortgage Loans and Home Equity Loans. 
As more fully described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Loans will
be "conventional" loans.

     The Loans in a Pool will have monthly payments due on the first day of
each month or on such other day of the month specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  The payment terms of the Loans to be included in a
Trust Fund will be described in the related Prospectus Supplement and may
include any of the following features (or combination thereof), all as
described below or in the related Prospectus Supplement:

          (a)  Interest may be payable at a fixed rate, a rate adjustable
     from time to time in relation to an index (which will be specified in
     the related Prospectus Supplement), a rate that is fixed for a period of
     time or under certain circumstances and is followed by an adjustable
     rate, a rate that otherwise varies from time to time, or a rate that is
     convertible from an adjustable rate to a fixed rate.  Changes to an
     adjustable rate may be subject to periodic limitations, maximum rates,
     minimum rates or a combination of such limitations.  Accrued interest
     may be deferred and added to the principal of a Loan for such periods
     and under such circumstances as may be specified in the related
     Prospectus Supplement.  Loans may provide for the payment of interest at
     a rate lower than the specified interest rate borne by such Loan (the
     "Loan Rate") for a period of time or for the life of the Loan, and the
     amount of any difference may be contributed from funds supplied by the
     seller of the Property or another source.

          (b)  Principal may be payable on a level debt service basis to
     fully amortize the Loan over its term, may be calculated on the basis of
     an assumed amortization schedule that is significantly longer than the
     original term to maturity or on an interest rate that is different from
     the Loan Rate or may not be amortized during all or a portion of the
     original term.  Payment of all or a substantial portion of the principal
     may be due on maturity ("balloon payment").  Principal may include
     interest that has been deferred and added to the principal balance of
     the Loan.

          (c)  Monthly payments of principal and interest may be fixed for
     the life of the Loan, may increase over a specified period of time or
     may change from period to period.  Loans may include limits on periodic
     increases or decreases in the amount of monthly payments and may include
     maximum or minimum amounts of monthly payments.

          (d)  Prepayments of principal may be subject to a prepayment fee,
     which may be fixed for the life of the Loan or may decline over time,
     and may be prohibited for the life of the Loan or for certain periods
     ("Lockout Periods").  Certain Loans may permit prepayments after
     expiration of the 

     applicable Lockout Period and may require the payment of a prepayment
     fee in connection with any such subsequent prepayment.  Other Loans may
     permit prepayments without payment of a fee unless the prepayment occurs
     during specified time periods.  The Loans may include "due-on-sale"
     clauses which permit the mortgagee to demand payment of the entire Loan
     in connection with the sale or certain transfers of the related
     Property.  Other Loans may be assumable by persons meeting the then
     applicable standards set forth in the Agreement.

     A Trust Fund may contain certain Loans ("Buydown Loans") that include
provisions whereby a third party partially subsidizes the monthly payments of
the borrowers on such Loans during the early years of such Loans, the
difference to be made up from a fund (a "Buydown Fund") contributed by such
third party at the time of origination of the Loan.  A Buydown Fund will be
in an amount equal either to the discounted value or full aggregate amount of
future payment subsidies.  The underlying assumption of buydown plans is that
the income of the borrower will increase during the buydown period as a
result of normal increases in compensation and inflation, so that the
borrower will be able to meet the full loan payments at the end of the
buydown period.  To the extent that this assumption as to increased income is
not fulfilled, the possibility of defaults on Buydown Loans is increased. 
The related Prospectus Supplement will contain information with respect to
any Buydown Loan concerning limitations on the interest rate paid by the
borrower initially, on annual increases in the interest rate and on the
length of the buydown period.

     The real property which secures repayment of the Loans is referred to as
the "Mortgaged Properties".  The Loans will be secured by mortgages or deeds
of trust or other similar security instruments creating a lien on a Mortgaged
Property.  In the case of Home Equity Loans, such liens generally will be
subordinated to one or more senior liens on the related Mortgaged Properties
as described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The Mortgaged Properties
are referred to herein as the "Properties".  The Properties relating to Loans
will consist of detached or semi-detached one- to four-family dwelling units,
townhouses, rowhouses, individual condominium units, individual units in
planned unit developments, manufactured homes and certain other dwelling
units ("Single Family Properties").  Such Properties may include vacation and
second homes, investment properties, and dwellings situated on leasehold
estates.  In the case of leasehold interests, the term of the leasehold will
exceed the scheduled maturity of the Loan by at least five years, unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The Properties may
be located in any one of the fifty states, the District of Columbia, Guam,
Puerto Rico or any other territory of the United States.

     Loans with certain Loan-to-Value Ratios and/or certain principal
balances may be covered wholly or partially by primary mortgage guaranty
insurance policies (each, a "Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy").  The
existence, extent and duration of any such coverage will be described in the
applicable Prospectus Supplement.

     The aggregate principal balance of Loans secured by Properties that are
owner-occupied may be disclosed in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The
basis for a representation that a given percentage of the Loans is secured by
Single Family Properties that are owner-occupied will be either (i) the
making of a representation by the borrower at origination of the Loan either
that the underlying Property will be used by the borrower for a period of at
least six months every year or that the borrower intends to use the Property
as a primary residence or (ii) a finding that the address of the underlying
Property is the borrower's mailing address.  

     Home Equity Loans.  As more fully described in the related Prospectus
Supplement, interest on each Revolving Credit Line Loan, excluding
introduction rates offered from time to time during promotional periods, is
computed and payable monthly on the average daily outstanding principal
balance of such Loan.  Principal amounts on a Revolving Credit Line Loan may
be drawn down (up to a maximum amount as set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement) or repaid under each Revolving Credit Line Loan from time to
time, but may be subject to a minimum periodic payment.  As specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the Trust Fund may include any amounts
borrowed under a Revolving Credit Line Loan after the Cut-Off Date.  The full
amount of a Closed-End Loan is advanced at the inception of the Loan and
generally is repayable in equal (or substantially equal) installments of an
amount to fully amortize such Loan at its stated maturity or is a Balloon
Loan.  As more fully described in the related Prospectus Supplement, interest
on each Closed-End Loan is calculated on the basis of the outstanding 
principal balance of such Loan multiplied by the Loan Rate thereon and further 
multiplied by either a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of 
days in the period elapsed since the preceding payment of interest was made 
and the denominator of which is the number of days in the annual period for 
which interest accrues on such Loan, or a fraction which is 30 over 360.  
Except to the extent provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the 
original terms to stated maturity of Closed-End Loans generally will not 
exceed 360 months.  Under certain circumstances, under either a Revolving 
Credit Line Loan or a Closed-End Loan, a borrower may choose an interest 
only payment option and is obligated to pay only the amount of interest 
which accrues on the Loan during the billing cycle.  An interest only 
payment option may be available for a specified period before the borrower 
must begin paying at least the minimum monthly payment of a specified 
percentage of the average outstanding balance of the Loan.

     Additional Information.  Each Prospectus Supplement will contain
information, as of the date of such Prospectus Supplement and to the extent
then specifically known to Provident, with respect to the Loans contained in
the related Pool, including (i) the aggregate outstanding principal balance
and the average outstanding principal balance of the Loans as of the
applicable Cut-Off Date, (ii) the type of property securing the Loan (e.g.,
single family residences, individual units in condominium apartment
buildings, two- to four-family dwelling units, other real property or Home
Improvements), (iii) the original terms to maturity of the Loans, (iv) the
largest principal balance and the smallest principal balance of any of the
Loans, (v) the earliest origination date and latest maturity date of any of
the Loans, (vi) the Loan-to-Value Ratios or Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios, as
applicable, of the Loans, (vii) the Loan Rates or annual percentage rates
("APR") or range of Loan Rates or APR's borne by the Loans, (viii) the
maximum and minimum per annum Loan Rates, and (ix) the geographical location
of the Loans.  If specific information respecting the Loans is not known to
Provident at the time the related Securities are initially offered, more
general information of the nature described above will be provided in the
related Prospectus Supplement, and specific information will be set forth in
the Detailed Description.

     Generally, the "Loan-to-Value Ratio" of a Loan at any given time is the
fraction, expressed as a percentage, the numerator of which is the original
principal balance of the related Loan and the denominator of which is the
Collateral Value of the related Property.  Generally, the "Combined Loan-to-
Value Ratio" of a Loan at any given time is the ratio, expressed as a
percentage, of (i) the sum of (a) the original principal balance of the Loan
(or, in the case of a Revolving Credit Line Loan, the maximum amount thereof
available) and (b) the outstanding principal balance at the date of
origination of the Loan of any senior mortgage loan(s) or, in the case of any
open-ended senior mortgage loan, the maximum available line of credit with
respect to such mortgage loan, regardless of any lesser amount actually
outstanding at the date of origination of the Loan, to (ii) the Collateral 
Value of the related Property.  The "Collateral Value" of the Property, other
than with respect to certain Loans the proceeds of which were used to
refinance an existing mortgage loan (each, a "Refinance Loan"), is the lesser
of (a) the appraised value determined in an appraisal obtained at origination
of such Loan and (b) the sales price for such Property.  In the case of
Refinance Loans, the "Collateral Value" of the related Property is the
appraised value thereof determined in an appraisal obtained at the time of
refinancing.

     No assurance can be given that values of the Properties have remained or
will remain at their levels on the dates of origination of the related Loans. 
If the residential real estate market should experience an overall decline in
property values such that the sum of the outstanding principal balances of
the Loans and any primary or secondary financing on the Properties, as
applicable, in a particular Pool become equal to or greater than the value of
the Properties, the actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses
could be higher than those now generally experienced in the mortgage lending
industry.  In addition, adverse economic conditions and other factors (which
may or may not affect real property values) may affect the timely payment by
borrowers of scheduled payments of principal and interest on the Loans and,
accordingly, the actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses with
respect to any Pool.  To the extent that such losses are not covered by
subordination provisions or alternative arrangements, such losses will be
borne, at least in part, by the holders of the Securities of the related
Series.


SUBSTITUTION OF TRUST FUND ASSETS

     Substitution of Trust Fund Assets will be permitted in the event of
breaches of representations and warranties with respect to any original Trust
Fund Asset or in the event the documentation with respect to any Trust Fund
Asset is determined by the Trustee to be incomplete.  The period during which
such substitution will be permitted generally will be indicated in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  


                               USE OF PROCEEDS

     The net proceeds to be received by Provident from the sale of the Trust
Fund Assets by Provident to Trust Funds will be applied by Provident to the
purchase of additional trust fund assets or will be used by Provident for
general corporate purposes.  Provident expects to sell Securities in Series
issued by the related Trust Fund from time to time, but the timing and amount
of offerings of Securities will depend on a number of factors, including the
volume of Trust Fund Assets originated or acquired by Provident and sold to
the Trust Fund, prevailing interest rates, availability of funds and general
market conditions.


                              THE PROVIDENT BANK

     Provident, an Ohio banking corporation, is the principal banking
subsidiary of Provident Bancorp, Inc., a Cincinnati-based bank holding
company registered under the Bank Holding Company Act.  Provident Bancorp,
Inc. operates throughout Ohio, Northern Kentucky, Southeastern Indiana and
Florida.  The principal executive offices of Provident are located at One
East Fourth Street, Cincinnati, Ohio 45202 (Telephone: (513) 579-2000).

     Neither Provident nor any of Provident's affiliates will insure or
guarantee distributions on the Securities of any Series.


                                 LOAN PROGRAM

     The Loans will have been originated or purchased by Provident, either
directly or through affiliates.  The Loans so originated or acquired by
Provident will have been originated in accordance with the underwriting
criteria specified below under "Underwriting Standards" and as further
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

UNDERWRITING STANDARDS

     Underwriting standards are applied by or on behalf of a lender to
evaluate the borrower's credit standing and repayment ability, and the value
and adequacy of the related Property as collateral.  In general, a
prospective borrower applying for a Loan is required to fill out a detailed
application designed to provide to the underwriting officer pertinent credit
information, including the principal balance and payment history with respect
to any senior mortgage, if any, which will be verified by Provident.  As part
of the description of the borrower's financial condition, the borrower
generally is required to provide a current list of assets and liabilities and
a statement of income and expenses, as well as an authorization to apply for
a credit report which summarizes the borrower's credit history with local
merchants and lenders and any record of bankruptcy.  In most cases, an
employment verification is obtained from an independent source (typically the
borrower's employer) which verification reports, among other things, the
length of employment with that organization and the borrower's current
salary.  If a prospective borrower is self-employed, the borrower may be
required to submit copies of signed tax returns.  The borrower may also be
required to authorize verification of deposits at financial institutions
where the borrower has demand or savings accounts.

     In determining the adequacy of the property to be used as collateral, an
appraisal will generally be made of each property considered for financing. 
The appraiser is generally required to inspect the property, issue a report
on its condition and, if applicable, verify construction has been completed. 
The appraisal is based on the market value of comparable homes, the estimated
rental income (if considered applicable by the appraiser) and the cost of
replacing the property.  The value of the property being financed, as
indicated by the appraisal, must be such that it currently supports, and is
anticipated to support in the future, the outstanding loan balance.

     The maximum loan amount will vary depending upon a borrower's credit
grade and loan program but will not generally exceed $750,000.  Variations in
maximum loan amount limits will be permitted based on compensating factors. 
Compensating factors may generally include, to the extent specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, low loan-to-value ratio, low debt-to-income
ratio, stable employment, favorable credit history and the nature of the
underlying first mortgage loan, if applicable.

     Provident's underwriting standards generally permit loans with loan-to-
value ratios at origination of up to 100% depending on the loan program, type
and use of the property, creditworthiness of the borrower and debt-to-income
ratio.  

     After obtaining all applicable employment, credit and property
information, Provident will use a debt-to-income ratio to assist in
determining whether the prospective borrower has sufficient monthly income
available to support the payments of principal and interest on the Mortgage
Loan in addition to other monthly credit obligations.  The "debt-to-income
ratio" is the ratio of the borrower's total monthly obligations (which
includes principal and interest on each mortgage, tax assessments, other
loans, charge accounts and all other scheduled indebtedness) to the
borrower's gross monthly income.  The maximum monthly debt-to-income ratio
will vary depending upon a borrower's credit grade and loan program but will
not generally exceed 60%.  Variations in the monthly debt-to-income ratio
limit will be permitted based on compensating factors to the extent specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a portion of the
Loans in a Trust Fund may have been originated under a limited documentation
program.  Under a limited documentation program, more emphasis is placed on
the value and adequacy on the property as collateral and other assets of the
borrower than on credit underwriting.  Under a limited documentation program,
certain credit underwriting documentation concerning income or income
verification and/or employment verification is waived.

     In the case of a Loan secured by a leasehold interest in real property,
the title to which is held by a third party lessor, Provident will represent
and warrant, among other things, that the remaining term of the lease and any
sublease is at least five years longer than the remaining term on the Loan.

     Certain of the types of Loans that may be included in a Trust Fund are
recently developed and may involve additional uncertainties not present in
traditional types of loans.  For example, certain of such Loans may provide
for escalating or variable payments by the borrower.  These types of Loans
are underwritten on the basis of a judgment that the borrowers have the
ability to make the monthly payments required initially.  In some instances,
a borrower's income may not be sufficient to permit continued Loan payments
as such payments increase.  These types of Loans may also be underwritten
primarily upon the basis of Loan-to-Value Ratios or other favorable credit
factors.

QUALIFICATIONS OF PROVIDENT

     Provident will be required to satisfy the following qualifications. 
Provident is, and each entity from which it acquires Loans must be, an
institution experienced in originating and servicing loans of the type
contained in the related Pool in accordance with accepted practices and
prudent guidelines, and must maintain satisfactory facilities to originate
and service those loans.  Provident is a seller/servicer approved by the
Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA") and the Federal Home Loan
Mortgage Corporation ("FHLMC").  Provident is a mortgagee approved by the
Federal Housing Authority and is an institution the deposit accounts in which
are insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC").


REPRESENTATIONS BY PROVIDENT; REPURCHASES

     Provident will have made representations and warranties in respect of
the Loans sold by Provident to the Trust Fund and evidenced by all, or a
part, of a Series of Securities.  Such representations and warranties may
include, among other things: (i) that title insurance (or in the case of
Properties located in areas where such policies are generally not available,
an attorney's certificate of title) and any required hazard insurance policy
were effective at origination of each Loan and that each policy (or
certificate of title as applicable) remained in effect on the date of
purchase of the Loan from Provident; (ii) that Provident had good title to
each such Loan and such Loan was subject to no offsets, defenses,
counterclaims or rights of rescission except to the extent that any buydown
agreement may forgive certain indebtedness of a borrower; (iii) that each
Loan constituted a valid lien on, or a perfected security interest with
respect to, the Property (subject only to permissible liens disclosed, if
applicable, title insurance exceptions, if applicable, and certain other
exceptions described in the Agreement), (iv) the Property is undamaged by
waste, fire, earthquake, earth movement, windstorm, flood, tornado or other
casualty, so as to affect adversely the value of the Property; (v) that there
were no delinquent tax or assessment liens against the Property; (vi) that no
required payment on a Loan was delinquent more than the number of days
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement; and (vii) that each Loan was
made in compliance with, and is enforceable under, all applicable state and
federal laws and regulations in all material respects.

     The Master Servicer or the Trustee will promptly notify Provident of any
breach of any representation or warranty made by it in respect of a Loan
which materially and adversely affects the interests of the Securityholders
in such Loan.  If Provident cannot cure such breach within the number of days
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement following notice from the
Master Servicer or the Trustee, as the case may be, then Provident will be
obligated either (i) to repurchase such Loan from the Trust Fund at a price
(the "Purchase Price") equal to 100% of the unpaid principal balance thereof
as of the date of the repurchase plus unpaid accrued interest thereon to the
first day of the month following the month of repurchase at the Loan Rate
(less any Advances or amount payable as related servicing compensation if
Provident is the Master Servicer) or (ii) substitute for such Loan a
replacement loan that satisfies the criteria specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  If a REMIC election is to be made with respect to a
Trust Fund, the Master Servicer or a holder of the related residual
certificate generally will be obligated to pay any prohibited transaction tax
which may arise in connection with any such repurchase or substitution and
the Trustee must have received a satisfactory opinion of counsel that such
repurchase or substitution will not cause the Trust Fund to lose its status
as a REMIC or otherwise subject the Trust Fund to a prohibited transaction
tax.  This repurchase or substitution obligation will constitute the sole
remedy available to holders of Securities or the Trustee for a breach of
representation by Provident.

     Neither the Trustee nor the Master Servicer (unless the Master Servicer
is Provident) will be obligated to purchase or substitute a Loan if Provident
defaults on its obligation to do so, and no assurance can be given that
Provident will carry out its respective repurchase or substitution
obligations with respect to Loans.


                        DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES

     Each Series of Certificates will be issued pursuant to separate
agreements (each, a "Pooling and Servicing Agreement" or a "Trust Agreement")
among Provident, the Master Servicer and the Trustee.  A form of Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and Trust Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part.  Each Series of
Notes will be issued pursuant to an indenture (the "Indenture") between the
related Trust Fund and the entity named in the related Prospectus Supplement
as trustee (the "Trustee") with respect to such Series, and the related Loans
will be serviced by the Master Servicer pursuant to a Master Servicing
Agreement.  A form of Indenture and Master Servicing Agreement has been filed
as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a
part.  

     A Series of Securities may consist of both Notes and Certificates.  Each
Agreement, dated as of the related Cut-Off Date, will be among Provident, the
Master Servicer and the Trustee for the benefit of the holders of the 
Securities of such Series.  The provisions of each Agreement will vary 
depending upon the nature of the Securities to be issued thereunder
and the nature of the related Trust Fund.  The following are descriptions of
the material provisions which may appear in each Agreement.  The descriptions
are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety by reference to, all of
the provisions of the Agreement for each Series of Securities and the
applicable Prospectus Supplement.  Provident will provide a copy of the
Agreement (without exhibits) relating to any Series of Securities without
charge upon written request of a holder of record of a Security of such
Series addressed to The Provident Bank, One East Fourth Street, Cincinnati,
Ohio 45202, Attention: Secretary.

GENERAL

     As described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Securities of
each Series will be issued in book-entry or fully registered form, in the
authorized denominations specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
will, in the case of Certificates, evidence specified beneficial ownership
interests in, and in the case of Notes, be secured by, the assets of the
related Trust Fund created pursuant to each Agreement and will not be
entitled to payments in respect of the assets included in any other Trust
Fund established by Provident.  Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Securities will not represent obligations of
Provident or any affiliate of Provident.  Certain of the Loans may be
guaranteed or insured as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
Each Trust Fund will consist of, to the extent provided in the related
Agreement, (i) the Trust Fund Assets, as from time to time are subject to the
related Agreement (exclusive of any amounts specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement ("Retained Interest")), including all payments of
interest and principal received with respect to the Loans after the Cut-Off
Date (to the extent not applied in computing the principal balance of such
Loans as of the Cut-Off Date (the "Cut-Off Date Principal Balance")); (ii)
such assets as from time to time are required to be deposited in the related
Security Account, as described below under "The Agreements--Payments on
Loans; Deposits to Security Account"; (iii) property which secured a Loan and
which is acquired on behalf of the Securityholders by foreclosure or deed in
lieu of foreclosure and (iv) any insurance policies or other forms of credit
enhancement required to be maintained pursuant to the related Agreement.  If
so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund may also
include one or more of the following:  reinvestment income on payments
received on the Trust Fund Assets, a Reserve Account, a mortgage pool
insurance policy, a special hazard insurance policy, a bankruptcy bond, one
or more letters of credit, a surety bond, guaranties or similar instruments.

     Each Series of Securities will be issued in one or more classes.  Each
class of Certificates of a Series will evidence beneficial ownership of a
specified percentage (which may be 0%) or portion of future interest payments
and a specified percentage (which may be 0%) or portion of future principal
payments on, and each class of Notes of a Series will be secured by, the
related Trust Fund Assets.  A Series of Securities may include one or more
classes that are senior in right to payment to one or more other classes of
Securities of such Series.  Certain Series or classes of Securities may be
covered by insurance policies, surety bonds or other forms of credit
enhancement, in each case as described under "Credit Enhancement" herein and
in the related Prospectus Supplement.  One or more classes of Securities of a
Series may be entitled to receive distributions of principal, interest or any
combination thereof.  Distributions on one or more classes of a Series of
Securities may be made prior to one or more other classes, after the
occurrence of specified events, in accordance with a schedule or formula or
on the basis of collections from designated portions of the related Trust
Fund Assets, in each case as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
The timing and amounts of such distributions may vary among classes or over
time as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Distributions of principal and interest (or, where applicable, of
principal only or interest only) on the related Securities will be made by
the Trustee on each Distribution Date (i.e., monthly, quarterly, semi-
annually or at such other intervals and on the dates as are specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement) in proportion to the percentages specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  Distributions will be made to the persons
in whose names the Securities are registered at the close of business on the
dates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (each, a "Record Date"). 
Distributions will be made in the manner specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement to the persons entitled thereto at the address appearing in the
register maintained for 
Securityholders (the "Security Register"); provided, however, that the
                                           -------   --------
final distribution in retirement of the Securities will be made only upon 
presentation and surrender of the Securities at the office or agency of the 
Trustee or other person specified in the notice to Securityholders of such 
final distribution.

     The Securities will be freely transferable and exchangeable at the
Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee as set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  No service charge will be made for any registration of exchange
or transfer of Securities of any Series, but the Trustee may require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any related tax or other governmental charge.

     As to each Series, an election may be made to treat the related Trust
Fund or designated portions thereof as a "real estate mortgage investment
conduit" or "REMIC" as defined in the Code.  The related Prospectus Supple-
ment will specify whether a REMIC election is to be made.  Alternatively, the
Agreement for a Series of Securities may provide that a REMIC election may be
made at the discretion of Provident or the Master Servicer and may only be
made if certain conditions are satisfied.  As to any such Series, the terms
and provisions applicable to the making of a REMIC election will be set forth
in the related Prospectus Supplement.  If such an election is made with
respect to a Series of Securities, one of the classes will be designated as
evidencing the sole class of "residual interests" in the related REMIC, as
defined in the Code.  All other classes of Securities in such a Series will
constitute "regular interests" in the related REMIC, as defined in the Code. 
As to each Series of Securities with respect to which a REMIC election is to
be made, the Master Servicer, the Trustee or a holder of the related residual
certificate will be obligated to take all actions required in order to comply
with applicable laws and regulations.

DISTRIBUTIONS ON SECURITIES

     General.  In general, the method of determining the amount of
distributions on a particular Series of Securities will depend on the type of
credit support, if any, that is used with respect to such Series.  See
"Credit Enhancement".  Set forth below are descriptions of various methods
that may be used to determine the amount of distributions on the Securities
of a particular Series.  The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of
Securities will describe the method to be used in determining the amount of
distributions on the Securities of such Series.

     Distributions allocable to principal and interest on the Securities will
be made by the Trustee out of, and only to the extent of, funds in the
related Security Account, including any funds transferred from any Reserve
Account.  As between Securities of different classes and as between
distributions of principal (and, if applicable, between distributions of
Principal Prepayments, as defined below, and scheduled payments of principal)
and interest, distributions made on any Distribution Date will be applied as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The Prospectus Supplement
will also describe the method for allocating distributions among Securities
of a particular class.

     Available Funds.  All distributions on the Securities of each Series on
each Distribution Date will be made from the Available Funds described below,
in accordance with the terms described in the related Prospectus Supplement
and specified in the Agreement.  "Available Funds" for each Distribution Date
will generally equal the amount on deposit in the related Security Account on
such Distribution Date (net of related fees and expenses payable by the
related Trust Fund) other than amounts to be held therein for distribution on
future Distribution Dates.

     Distributions of Interest.  Interest will accrue on the aggregate
principal balance of the Securities (or, in the case of Securities entitled
only to distributions allocable to interest, the aggregate notional amount)
of each class of Securities (the "Class Security Balance") entitled to
interest from the date, at the Pass-Through Rate or interest rate, as
applicable (which in either case may be a fixed rate or rate adjustable as
specified in such Prospectus Supplement), and for the periods specified in
such Prospectus Supplement.  To the extent funds are available therefor,
interest accrued during each such specified period on each class of
Securities entitled to interest (other than a class of Securities that
provides for interest that accrues, but is not currently payable, referred to
hereafter as "Accrual Securities") will be distributable on the Distribution
Dates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement until the aggregate
Class Security Balance of the Securities of such class has been distributed
in full or, in the case of Securities entitled only to distributions
allocable to interest, until the aggregate notional amount of such Securities 
is reduced to zero or for the period of time designated in the related 
Prospectus Supplement.  The original Class Security Balance of each Security 
will equal the aggregate distributions allocable to principal to which such 
Security is entitled.  Distributions allocable to interest on each Security 
that is not entitled to distributions allocable to principal will be 
calculated based on the notional amount of such Security.  The notional 
amount of a Security will not evidence an interest in or entitlement to 
distributions allocable to principal but will be used solely for convenience 
in expressing the calculation of interest and for certain other purposes.

     Interest payable on the Securities of a Series on a Distribution Date
will include all interest accrued during the period specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  In the event interest accrues over a period ending
two or more days prior to a Distribution Date, the effective yield to
Securityholders will be reduced from the yield that would otherwise be
obtainable if interest payable on the Security were to accrue through the day
immediately preceding such Distribution Date, and the effective yield (at
par) to Securityholders will be less than the indicated coupon rate.

     With respect to any class of Accrual Securities, if specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, any interest that has accrued but is not paid
on a given Distribution Date will be added to the aggregate Class Security
Balance of such class of Securities on that Distribution Date.  Distributions
of interest on any class of Accrual Securities will commence only after the
occurrence of the events specified in such Prospectus Supplement.  Prior to
such time, the beneficial ownership interest in the Trust Fund or the
principal balance, as applicable, of such class of Accrued Securities, as
reflected in the aggregate Class Security Balance of such class of Accrual
Securities, will increase on each Distribution Date by the amount of interest
that accrued on such class of Accrual Securities during the preceding
interest accrual period but that was not required to be distributed to such
class on such Distribution Date.  Any such class of Accrual Securities will
thereafter accrue interest on its outstanding Class Security Balance as so
adjusted.

     Distributions of Principal.  The related Prospectus Supplement will
specify the method by which the amount of principal to be distributed on the
Securities on each Distribution Date will be calculated and the manner in
which such amount will be allocated among the classes of Securities entitled
to distributions of principal.  The aggregate Class Security Balance of any
class of Securities entitled to distributions of principal generally will be
the aggregate original Class Security Balance of such class of Securities
specified in such Prospectus Supplement, reduced by all distributions
reported to the holders of such Securities as allocable to principal and, (i)
in the case of Accrual Securities, as described in the related Prospectus
Supplement, increased by interest accrued but not then distributable on such
Accrual Securities and (ii) in the case of adjustable rate Securities,
subject to the effect of negative amortization, if applicable.  

     If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, one or more classes
of Securities will be entitled to receive all or a disproportionate
percentage of the payments of principal which are received from borrowers in
advance of their scheduled due dates and are not accompanied by amounts
representing scheduled interest due after the month of such payments
("Principal Prepayments") in the percentages and under the circumstances or
for the periods specified in such Prospectus Supplement.  Any such allocation
of Principal Prepayments to such class or classes of Securities will have the
effect of accelerating the amortization of such Securities while increasing
the interests evidenced by one or more other classes of Securities in the
Trust Fund.  Increasing the interests of the other classes of Securities
relative to that of certain Securities is intended to preserve the
availability of the subordination provided by such other Securities.  See
"Credit Enhancement--Subordination".

     Unscheduled Distributions.  If specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Securities will be subject to receipt of distributions before
the next scheduled Distribution Date under the circumstances and in the
manner described below and in such Prospectus Supplement.  If applicable, the
Trustee will be required to make such unscheduled distributions on the day
and in the amount specified in the related Prospectus Supplement if, due to
substantial payments of principal (including Principal Prepayments) on the
Trust Fund Assets, the Trustee or the Master Servicer determines that the
funds available or anticipated to be available from the Security Account and,
if applicable, any Reserve Account, may be insufficient to make required
distributions on the Securities on such Distribution Date.  Unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the amount of any such 
unscheduled distribution that is allocable to principal will not exceed 
the amount that would otherwise have been required to be
distributed as principal on the Securities on the next Distribution Date. 
Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
unscheduled distributions will include interest at the applicable
Pass-Through Rate (if any) or interest rate (if any) on the amount of the
unscheduled distribution allocable to principal for the period and to the
date specified in such Prospectus Supplement.

ADVANCES

     To the extent provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master
Servicer will be required to advance on or before each Distribution Date
(from its own funds, funds advanced by Sub-Servicers or funds held in the
Security Account for future distributions to the holders of Securities of the
related Series) an amount equal to the aggregate of payments of interest
and/or principal that were delinquent on the related Determination Date (as
such term is defined in the related Prospectus Supplement) and were not
advanced by any Sub-Servicer, subject to the Master Servicer's determination
that such advances may be recoverable out of late payments by borrowers,
Liquidation Proceeds, Insurance Proceeds or otherwise.

     In making Advances, the Master Servicer will endeavor to maintain a
regular flow of scheduled interest and principal payments to Securityholders,
rather than to guarantee or insure against losses.  If Advances are made by
the Master Servicer from cash being held for future distribution to
Securityholders, the Master Servicer will replace such funds on or before any
future Distribution Date to the extent that funds in the applicable Security
Account on such Distribution Date would be less than the amount required to
be available for distributions to Securityholders on such date.  Any Master
Servicer funds advanced will be reimbursable to the Master Servicer out of
recoveries on the specific Loans with respect to which such Advances were
made (e.g., late payments made by the related borrower, any related Insurance
Proceeds, Liquidation Proceeds or proceeds of any Loan purchased by Provident
or a Sub-Servicer pursuant to the related Agreement).  Advances by the Master
Servicer (and any advances by a Sub-Servicer) also will be reimbursable to
the Master Servicer (or Sub-Servicer) from cash otherwise distributable to
Securityholders (including the holders of Senior Securities) to the extent
that the Master Servicer determines that any such Advances previously made
are not ultimately recoverable as described above.  To the extent provided in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer also will be obligated
to make Advances, to the extent recoverable out of Insurance Proceeds,
Liquidation Proceeds or otherwise, in respect of certain taxes and insurance
premiums not paid by borrowers on a timely basis.  Funds so advanced are
reimbursable to the Master Servicer to the extent permitted by the related
Agreement.  The obligations of the Master Servicer to make advances may be
supported by a cash advance reserve fund, a surety bond or other arrangement
of the type described herein under "Credit Enhancement", in each case as
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     In the event the Master Servicer or a Sub-Servicer fails to make a
required Advance, the Trustee will be obligated to make such Advance in its
capacity as successor servicer if it is acting in such capacity.  If the
Trustee makes such an Advance, it will be entitled to be reimbursed for such
Advance to the same extent and degree as the Master Servicer or a
Sub-Servicer is entitled to be reimbursed for Advances.  See "Description of
the Securities--Distributions on Securities".

REPORTS TO SECURITYHOLDERS

     Prior to or concurrently with each distribution on a Distribution Date,
the Master Servicer or the Trustee will furnish to each Securityholder of
record of the related Series a statement setting forth, to the extent
applicable to such Series of Securities, among other things:

          (i)  the amount of such distribution allocable to principal,
     separately identifying the aggregate amount of any Principal Prepayments
     and, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
     applicable prepayment penalties included therein;

          (ii) the amount of such distribution allocable to interest;

          (iii)     the amount of any Advance;

          (iv) the aggregate amount (a) otherwise allocable to the
     Subordinated Securityholders on such Distribution Date, and (b)
     withdrawn from the Reserve Account, if any, that is included in the
     amounts distributed to the Senior Securityholders;

          (v)  the outstanding principal balance or notional amount of each
     class of the related Series of Securities after giving effect to the
     distribution of principal on such Distribution Date;

          (vi) the percentage of principal payments on the Loans (excluding
     prepayments), if any, which each such class will be entitled to receive
     on the following Distribution Date;

          (vii)     the percentage of Principal Prepayments on the Loans, if
     any, which each such class will be entitled to receive on the following
     Distribution Date;

          (viii)    the related amount of the servicing compensation retained
     or withdrawn from the Security Account by the Master Servicer, and the
     amount of additional servicing compensation received by the Master
     Servicer attributable to penalties, fees, excess Liquidation Proceeds
     and other similar charges and items;

          (ix) the number and aggregate principal balances of Loans as to
     which the minimum monthly payment is delinquent 30-59 days, 60-89 days
     and 90 or more days, respectively, as of the close of business on the
     last day of the calendar month preceding such Distribution Date;

          (x)  the book value of any real estate acquired through foreclosure
     or grant of a deed in lieu of foreclosure;

          (xi) the Pass-Through Rate or interest rate, as applicable, if
     adjusted from the date of the last statement, of any such class expected
     to be applicable to the next distribution to such class;

          (xii)     if applicable, the amount remaining in any Reserve
     Account at the close of business on the Distribution Date;

          (xiii)    the Pass-Through Rate or interest rate, as applicable, as
     of the day prior to the immediately preceding Distribution Date; and

          (xiv)     any amounts remaining under letters of credit, Pool
     policies or other forms of credit enhancement.

     Where applicable, any amount set forth above may be expressed as a
dollar amount per single Security of the relevant class having the Percentage
Interest specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The report to
Securityholders for any Series of Securities may include additional or other
information of a similar nature to that specified above.

     In addition, within a reasonable period of time after the end of each
calendar year, the Master Servicer or the Trustee will mail to each
Securityholder of record at any time during such calendar year a report (a)
as to the aggregate of amounts reported pursuant to (i) and (ii) above for
such calendar year or, in the event such person was a Securityholder of
record only during a portion of such calendar year, for the applicable
portion of such year and (b) such other customary information as may be
deemed necessary or desirable for Securityholders to prepare their tax
returns.

CATEGORIES OF CLASSES OF SECURITIES

     The Securities of any Series may be comprised of one or more classes. 
Such classes, in general, fall into different categories.  The following
chart identifies and generally defines certain of the more typical 
categories.  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities may
identify the classes which comprise such Series by reference to the following
categories:

CATEGORIES OF CLASSES              DEFINITION

               PRINCIPAL TYPES

Accretion Directed       A class that receives principal payments from the
                         accreted interest from specified classes of Accrual
                         Securities.  An Accretion Directed class also may
                         receive principal payments from principal paid on
                         the underlying Trust Fund Assets for the related
                         Series.

Component Securities          A class consisting of "Components."  The
                              Components of a class of Component Securities
                              may have different principal and/or interest
                              payment characteristics but together constitute
                              a single class.  Each Component of a class of
                              Component Securities may be identified as
                              falling into one or more of the categories in
                              this chart.

Notional Amount
  Securities        A class having no principal balance and bearing interest
                    on the related notional amount.  The notional amount is
                    used for purposes of the determination of interest
                    distributions.

Planned Principal Class
  (also sometimes
  referred to as "PACs")      A class that is designed to receive principal
                              payments using a predetermined principal
                              balance schedule derived by assuming two
                              constant prepayment rates for the underlying
                              Trust Fund Assets.  These two rates are the
                              endpoints for the "structuring range" for the
                              Planned Principal Class.  The Planned Principal
                              Classes in any Series of Securities may be
                              subdivided into different categories (e.g.,
                              Primary Planned Principal Classes, Secondary
                              Planned Principal Classes and so forth) having
                              different effective structuring ranges and
                              different principal payment priorities.  The
                              structuring range for the Secondary Planned
                              Principal Class of a Series of Securities will
                              be narrower than that for the Primary Planned
                              Principal Class of such Series.

Scheduled Principal Class          A class that is designed to receive
                                   principal payments using a predetermined
                                   principal balance schedule but is not
                                   designated as a Planned Principal Class or
                                   Targeted Principal Class.  In many cases,
                                   the schedule is derived by assuming two
                                   constant prepayment rates for the
                                   underlying Trust Fund Assets.  These two
                                   rates are the endpoints for the
                                   "structuring range" for the Scheduled
                                   Principal Class.

Sequential Pay      Classes that receive principal payments in a prescribed
                    sequence, that do not have predetermined principal 
                    balance schedules and that under all circumstances 
                    receive payments of principal continuously from the first 
                    Distribution Date on which they receive principal until 
                    they are retired.  A single class that receives principal 
                    payments before or after all other classes in the same 
                    Series of Securities may be identified as a Sequential Pay
                    class.

Strip          A class that receives a constant proportion, or "strip," of
               the principal payments on the underlying Trust Fund Assets.

Support Class (also
  sometimes referred to
  as "Companion Classes")          A class that receives principal payments
                                   on any Distribution Date only if scheduled
                                   payments have been made on specified
                                   Planned Principal Classes, Targeted
                                   Principal Classes and/or Scheduled
                                   Principal Classes.

Targeted Principal Class
  (also sometimes
  referred to as "TACs")      A class that is designed to receive principal
                              payments using a predetermined principal
                              balance schedule derived by assuming a single
                              constant prepayment rate for the underlying
                              Trust Fund Assets.

               INTEREST TYPES

Fixed Rate          A class with an interest rate that is fixed throughout
                    the life of the class.

Floating Rate       A class with an interest rate that resets periodically
                    based upon a designated index and that varies directly
                    with changes in such index.

Inverse Floating 
Rate                A class with an interest rate that resets
                    periodically based upon a designated index and
                    that varies inversely with changes in such
                    index.

Variable Rate       A class with an interest rate that resets periodically
                    and is calculated by reference to the rate or rates of
                    interest applicable to specified assets or instruments
                    (e.g., the Loan Rates borne by the underlying Loans).

Interest Only       A class that receives some or all of the interest
                    payments made on the underlying Trust Fund Assets and
                    little or no principal.  Interest Only Classes have
                    either a nominal principal balance or a notional amount. 
                    A nominal principal balance represents actual principal
                    that will be paid on the class.  It is referred to as
                    nominal since it is extremely small compared to other
                    classes.  A notional amount is the amount used as a 
                    reference to calculate the amount of interest due on  
                    an Interest Only Class that is not entitled to any 
                    distributions in respect of principal.

Principal Only      A class that does not bear interest and is entitled to
                    receive only distributions in respect of principal.

Partial Accrual     A class that accretes a portion of the amount of
                    accrued interest thereon, which amount will be added
                    to the principal balance of such class on each
                    applicable Distribution Date, with the remainder of
                    such accrued interest to be distributed currently as
                    interest on such class.  Such accretion may continue
                    until a specified event has occurred or until such
                    Partial Accrual Class is retired.

Accrual             A class that accretes the amount of accrued interest 
                    otherwise distributable on such class, which amount will 
                    be added as principal to the principal balance of such 
                    class on each applicable Distribution Date.  Such 
                    accretion may continue until some specified event has 
                    occurred or until such Accrual Class is retired.

BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION OF SECURITIES

     As described in the related Prospectus Supplement, if not issued in
fully registered form, each class of Securities will be registered as
book-entry certificates (the "Book-Entry Securities").  Persons acquiring
beneficial ownership interests in the Securities ("Security Owners") will
hold their Securities through DTC in the United States, or Cedel Bank,
soci t  anonyme ("CEDEL"), or the Euroclear System ("Euroclear") in Europe,
if they are participants of such systems, or indirectly through organizations
which are participants in such systems.  The Book-Entry Securities will be
issued in one or more certificates which equal the aggregate principal
balance of the Securities and will initially be registered in the name of
Cede & Co., the nominee of DTC.  CEDEL and Euroclear will hold omnibus
positions on behalf of their participants through customers' securities
accounts in CEDEL's and Euroclear's names on the books of their respective
depositaries which in turn will hold such positions in customers' securities
accounts in the depositaries' names on the books of DTC.  Citibank, N.A.,
will act as depositary for CEDEL and The Chase Manhattan Bank will act as
depositary for Euroclear (in such capacities, individually the "Relevant
Depositary" and collectively the "European Depositaries").  Except as
described below, no person acquiring a Book-Entry Security (each, a
"beneficial owner") will be entitled to receive a physical certificate
representing such Security (a "Definitive Security").  Unless and until
Definitive Securities are issued, it is anticipated that the only
"Securityholder" of the Securities will be Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC. 
Security Owners are only permitted to exercise their rights indirectly
through Participants and DTC.

     The beneficial owner's ownership of a Book-Entry Security will be
recorded on the records of the brokerage firm, bank, thrift institution or
other financial intermediary (each, a "Financial Intermediary") that
maintains the beneficial owner's account for such purpose.  In turn, the
Financial Intermediary's ownership of such Book-Entry Security will be
recorded on the records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as agent
for the Financial Intermediary, whose interest will in turn be recorded on
the records of DTC, if the beneficial owner's Financial Intermediary is not a
DTC participant, and on the records of CEDEL or Euroclear, as appropriate).

     Security Owners will receive all distributions of principal of, and
interest on, the Securities from the Trustee through DTC and DTC
participants.  While the Securities are outstanding (except under the
circumstances described below), under the rules, regulations and procedures
creating and affecting DTC and its operations (the "Rules"), DTC is required
to make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose behalf it acts with
respect to the Securities and is required to receive and transmit
distributions of principal of, and interest on, the Securities.  Participants
and indirect participants with whom Security Owners have accounts with
respect to Securities are similarly required to make book-entry transfers and
receive and transmit such distributions on behalf of their respective
Security Owners.  Accordingly, although Security Owners will not possess
certificates, the Rules provide a mechanism by which Security Owners will
receive distributions and will be able to transfer their interest.

     Security Owners will not receive or be entitled to receive certificates
representing their respective interests in the Securities, except under the
limited circumstances described below.  Unless and until Definitive
Securities are issued, Security Owners who are not Participants may transfer
ownership of Securities only through Participants and indirect participants
by instructing such Participants and indirect participants to transfer
Securities, by book-entry transfer, through DTC for the account of the
purchasers of such Securities, which account is maintained with their
respective Participants.  Under the Rules and in accordance with DTC's normal
procedures, transfers of ownership of Securities will be executed through DTC
and the accounts of the respective Participants at DTC will be debited and
credited.  Similarly, the Participants and indirect participants will make
debits or credits, as the case may be, on their records on behalf of the
selling and purchasing Security Owners.

     Because of time zone differences, credits of securities received in
CEDEL or Euroclear as a result of a transaction with a Participant will be
made during subsequent securities settlement processing and dated the
business day following the DTC settlement date.  Such credits or any
transactions in such securities settled during such processing will be
reported to the relevant Euroclear or CEDEL Participants on such business
day.  Cash received in CEDEL or Euroclear as a result of sales of securities
by or through a CEDEL Participant (as defined herein) or Euroclear
Participant (as defined herein) to a DTC Participant will be received with
value on the DTC settlement date but will be available in the relevant CEDEL
or Euroclear cash account only as of the business day following settlement
with DTC.  

     Transfers between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC rules. 
Transfers between CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

     Cross-market transfers between persons holding directly or indirectly
through DTC, on the one hand, and directly or indirectly through CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC
in accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing system by the Relevant Depositary; however, such cross-market
transactions will require delivery of instructions to the relevant European
international clearing system by the counterparty in such system in
accordance with its rules and procedures and within its established deadlines
(European time).  The relevant European international clearing system will,
if the transaction meets its settlement requirements, deliver instructions to
the Relevant Depositary to take action to effect final settlement on its
behalf by delivering or receiving securities in DTC, and making or receiving
payment in accordance with normal procedures for same day funds settlement
applicable to DTC.  CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants may not
deliver instructions directly to the European Depositaries.

     CEDEL is incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg as a professional
depository.  CEDEL holds securities for its participating organizations
("CEDEL Participants") and facilitates the clearance and settlement of
securities transactions between CEDEL Participants through electronic
book-entry changes in accounts of CEDEL Participants, thereby eliminating the
need for physical movement of certificates.  Transactions may be settled in
CEDEL in any of 28 currencies, including United States dollars.  CEDEL
provides to its CEDEL Participants, among other things, services for
safekeeping, administration, clearance and settlement of internationally
traded securities and securities lending and borrowing.  CEDEL interfaces
with domestic markets in several countries.  As a professional depository, 
CEDEL is subject to regulation by the Luxembourg Monetary Institute.  
CEDEL participants are recognized financial institutions around the 
world, including underwriters, securities brokers and dealers, banks, 
trust companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations.  
Indirect access to CEDEL is also available to others, such as banks, 
brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a 
custodial relationship with a CEDEL Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     Euroclear was created in 1968 to hold securities for its participants
("Euroclear Participants") and to clear and settle transactions between
Euroclear Participants through simultaneous electronic book-entry delivery
against payment, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of
certificates and any risk from lack of simultaneous transfers of securities
and cash.  Transactions may be settled in any of 32 currencies, including
United States dollars.  Euroclear includes various other services, including
securities lending and borrowing and interfaces with domestic markets in
several countries generally similar to the arrangements for cross-market
transfers with DTC described above.  Euroclear is operated by the Brussels,
Belgium office of Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York ("Morgan" and in
such capacity, the "Euroclear Operator"), under contract with Euroclear
Clearance Systems S.C., a Belgian cooperative corporation (the "Belgian
Cooperative").  All operations are conducted by Morgan, and all Euroclear
securities clearance accounts and Euroclear cash accounts are accounts with
the Euroclear Operator, not the Belgian Cooperative.  The Belgian Cooperative
establishes policy for Euroclear on behalf of Euroclear Participants. 
Euroclear Participants include banks (including central banks), securities
brokers and dealers and other professional financial intermediaries. 
Indirect access to Euroclear is also available to other firms that clear
through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Euroclear Participant,
either directly or indirectly.

     Morgan is the Belgian branch of a New York banking corporation which is
a member bank of the Federal Reserve System.  As such, it is regulated and
examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System and the New
York State Banking Department, as well as the Belgian Banking Commission.

     Securities clearance accounts and cash accounts with Morgan are governed
by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear and the related
Operating Procedures of the Euroclear System and applicable Belgian law
(collectively, the "Terms and Conditions").  The Terms and Conditions govern
transfers of securities and cash within Euroclear, withdrawals of securities
and cash from Euroclear, and receipts of payments with respect to securities
in Euroclear.  All securities in Euroclear are held on a fungible basis
without attribution of specific certificates to specific securities clearance
accounts.  The Euroclear Operator acts under the Terms and Conditions only on
behalf of Euroclear Participants, and has no record of or relationship with
persons holding through Euroclear Participants.

     Under a book-entry format, beneficial owners of the Book-Entry
Securities may experience some delay in their receipt of payments, since such
payments will be forwarded by the Trustee to Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC. 
Distributions with respect to Securities held through CEDEL or Euroclear will
be credited to the cash accounts of CEDEL Participants or Euroclear
Participants in accordance with the relevant system's rules and procedures,
to the extent received by the Relevant Depositary.  Such distributions will
be subject to tax reporting in accordance with relevant United States tax
laws and regulations.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences -Tax Treatment of
Foreign Investors" and "--Tax Consequences to Holders of the Notes--Backup
Withholding" herein.  Because DTC can only act on behalf of Financial
Intermediaries, the ability of a beneficial owner to pledge Book-Entry
Securities to persons or entities that do not participate in the Depository
system may be limited due to the lack of physical certificates for such
Book-Entry Securities.  In addition, issuance of the Book-Entry Securities in
book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such Securities in the secondary
market since certain potential investors may be unwilling to purchase
Securities for which they cannot obtain physical certificates.

     Monthly and annual reports on the Trust will be provided to Cede & Co.,
as nominee of DTC, and may be made available by Cede & Co. to beneficial
owners upon request, in accordance with the rules, regulations and procedures
creating and affecting the Depository, and to the Financial Intermediaries to
whose DTC accounts the Book-Entry Securities of such beneficial owners are
credited.

     DTC has advised the Trustee that, unless and until Definitive Securities
are issued, DTC will take any action permitted to be taken by the holders of
the Book-Entry Securities under the applicable Agreement only at the
direction of one or more Financial Intermediaries to whose DTC accounts the
Book-Entry Securities are credited, to the extent that such actions are taken
on behalf of Financial Intermediaries whose holdings include such Book-Entry
Securities.  CEDEL or the Euroclear Operator, as the case may be, will take
any other action permitted to be taken by a Securityholder under the
Agreement on behalf of a CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant only in
accordance with its relevant rules and procedures and subject to the ability
of the Relevant Depositary to effect such actions on its behalf through DTC. 
DTC may take actions, at the direction of the related Participants, with
respect to some Securities which conflict with actions taken with respect to
other Securities.

     Upon the occurrence of any of the events described in the immediately
preceding paragraph, the Trustee will be required to notify all beneficial
owners of the occurrence of such event and the availability through DTC of
Definitive Securities.  Upon surrender by DTC of the global certificate or
certificates representing the Book-Entry Securities and instructions for
re-registration, the Trustee will issue Definitive Securities, and thereafter
the Trustee will recognize the holders of such Definitive Securities as
Securityholders under the applicable Agreement.

     Although DTC, CEDEL and Euroclear have agreed to the foregoing
procedures in order to facilitate transfers of Securities among participants
of DTC, CEDEL and Euroclear, they are under no obligation to perform or
continue to perform such procedures and such procedures may be discontinued
at any time.

     None of the Master Servicer, Provident or the Trustee will have any
responsibility for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made on
account of beneficial ownership interests of the Book-Entry Securities held
by Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC, or for maintaining, supervising or
reviewing any records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.


                              CREDIT ENHANCEMENT

GENERAL

     Credit enhancement may be provided with respect to one or more classes
of a Series of Securities or with respect to the related Trust Fund Assets. 
Credit enhancement may be in the form of a limited financial guaranty policy
issued by an entity named in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
subordination of one or more classes of the Securities of such Series, the
establishment of one or more Reserve Accounts, the use of a cross-collateral-
ization feature, use of a mortgage pool insurance policy, bankruptcy bond,
special hazard insurance policy, surety bond, letter of credit, guaranteed
investment contract, overcollateralization, or another method of credit
enhancement contemplated herein and described in the related Prospectus
Supplement, or any combination of the foregoing.  Unless otherwise specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement, credit enhancement will not provide
protection against all risks of loss and will not guarantee repayment of the
entire principal balance of the Securities and interest thereon.  If losses
occur which exceed the amount covered by credit enhancement or which are not
covered by the credit enhancement, Securityholders will bear their allocable
share of any deficiencies.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the coverage provided
by one or more of the forms of credit enhancement described in this
Prospectus may apply concurrently to two or more separate Trust Funds.  If
applicable, the related Prospectus Supplement will identify the Trust Funds
to which such credit enhancement relates and the manner of determining the
amount of coverage provided to such Trust Funds thereby and of the
application of such coverage to the identified Trust Funds.


SUBORDINATION

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, protection
afforded to holders of one or more classes of Securities of a Series by means
of the subordination feature may be accomplished by the preferential right of
holders of one or more other classes of such Series (the "Senior Securities")
to distributions in respect of scheduled principal, Principal Prepayments,
interest or any combination thereof that otherwise would have been payable to
holders of Subordinated Securities under the circumstances and to the extent
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Protection may also be
afforded to the holders of Senior Securities of a Series by: (i) reducing the
ownership interest (if applicable) of the related Subordinated Securities;
(ii) a combination of the immediately preceding sentence and clause (i)
above; or (iii) as otherwise described in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, delays in receipt of
scheduled payments on the Loans and losses on defaulted Loans may be borne
first by the various classes of Subordinated Securities and thereafter by the
various classes of Senior Securities, in each case under the circumstances
and subject to the limitations specified in such Prospectus Supplement.  The
aggregate distributions in respect of delinquent payments on the Loans over
the lives of the Securities or at any time, the aggregate losses in respect
of defaulted Loans which must be borne by the Subordinated Securities by
virtue of subordination and the amount of the distributions otherwise
distributable to the Subordinated Securityholders that will be distributable
to Senior Securityholders on any Distribution Date may be limited as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  If aggregate distributions
in respect of delinquent payments on the Loans or aggregate losses in respect
of such Loans were to exceed an amount specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, Senior Securityholders would experience losses on their
Securities.

     In addition to or in lieu of the foregoing, if so specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, all or any portion of distributions otherwise
payable to Subordinated Securityholders on any Distribution Date may instead
be deposited into one or more Reserve Accounts established with the Trustee
or distributed to Senior Securityholders.  Such deposits may be made on each
Distribution Date, for specified periods or until the balance in the Reserve
Account has reached a specified amount and, following payments from the
Reserve Account to Senior Securityholders or otherwise, thereafter to the
extent necessary to restore the balance in the Reserve Account to required
levels, in each case as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
Amounts on deposit in the Reserve Account may be released to the holders of
certain classes of Securities at the times and under the circumstances
specified in such Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, various classes of
Senior Securities and Subordinated Securities may themselves be subordinate
in their right to receive certain distributions to other classes of Senior
and Subordinated Securities, respectively, through a cross-collateralization
mechanism or otherwise.  As between classes of Senior Securities and as
between classes of Subordinated Securities, distributions may be allocated
among such classes (i) in the order of their scheduled final Distribution
Dates, (ii) in accordance with a schedule or formula, (iii) in relation to
the occurrence of events, or (iv) otherwise, in each case as specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  As between classes of Subordinated
Securities, payments to holders of Senior Securities on account of
delinquencies or losses and payments to any Reserve Account will be allocated
as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.


LETTER OF CREDIT

     The letter of credit, if any, with respect to a Series of Securities
will be issued by the bank or financial institution specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement (the "L/C Bank").  Under the letter of credit, the L/C
Bank will be obligated to honor drawings thereunder in an aggregate fixed
dollar amount, net of unreimbursed payments thereunder, equal to the
percentage specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (i) of the
aggregate principal balance of the Loans on the related Cut-Off Date or (ii)
of one or more Classes of Securities.  If so specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the letter of credit may permit drawings in the event
of losses not covered by insurance policies or other credit support, such as
losses arising from damage not covered by standard hazard insurance policies,
losses resulting from the bankruptcy of a borrower and the application of
certain provisions of the federal Bankruptcy Code, or losses resulting from
denial of insurance coverage due to misrepresentations in connection with the
origination of a Loan.  The amount available under the letter of credit will,
in all cases, be reduced to the extent of the unreimbursed payments
thereunder.  The obligations of the L/C Bank under the letter of credit for 
each Series of Securities will expire at the earlier of the date specified 
in the related Prospectus Supplement or the termination of the Trust Fund.  
See "The Agreements--Termination: Optional Termination."  A copy of the 
letter of credit for a Series, if any, will be filed with the Commission as 
an exhibit to a Current Report on Form 8-K to be filed within 15 days of 
issuance of the Securities of the related Series.

INSURANCE POLICIES, SURETY BONDS AND GUARANTIES

     If so provided in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities,
deficiencies in amounts otherwise payable on such Securities or certain
classes thereof will be covered by insurance policies and/or surety bonds
provided by one or more insurance companies or sureties.  Such instruments
may cover, with respect to one or more classes of Securities of the related
Series, timely distributions of interest and/or full distributions of
principal on the basis of a schedule of principal distributions set forth in
or determined in the manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. 
In addition, if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund
may also include bankruptcy bonds, special hazard insurance policies, other
insurance or guaranties for the purpose of (i)  maintaining timely payments
or providing additional protection against losses on the assets included in
such Trust Fund, (ii) paying administrative expenses or (iii) establishing a
minimum reinvestment rate on the payments made in respect of such assets or
principal payment rate on such assets.  Such arrangements may include
agreements under which Securityholders are entitled to receive amounts
deposited in various accounts held by the Trustee upon the terms specified in
such Prospectus Supplement.  A copy of any such instrument for a Series will
be filed with the Commission as an exhibit to a Current Report on Form 8-K to
be filed with the Commission within 15 days of issuance of the Securities of
the related Series.

OVER-COLLATERALIZATION

     If so provided in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities,
a portion of the interest payment on each Loan may be applied as an
additional distribution in respect of principal to reduce the principal
balance of a certain class or classes of Securities and, thus, accelerate the
rate of payment of principal on such class or classes of Securities relative
to the principal balance of the Loans in the related Trust Fund.

RESERVE ACCOUNTS

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, credit support with
respect to a Series of Securities will be provided by the establishment and
maintenance with the Trustee for such Series of Securities, in trust, of one
or more Reserve Accounts for such Series.  The related Prospectus Supplement
will specify whether or not any such Reserve Accounts will be included in the
Trust Fund for such Series.

     The Reserve Account for a Series will be funded (i) by the deposit
therein of cash, United States Treasury securities, instruments evidencing
ownership of principal or interest payments thereon, letters of credit,
demand notes, certificates of deposit or a combination thereof in the
aggregate amount specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, (ii) by the
deposit therein from time to time of certain amounts, as specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement to which the Subordinated Securityholders, if
any, would otherwise be entitled or (iii) in such other manner as may be
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Any amounts on deposit in the Reserve Account and the proceeds of any
other instrument upon maturity will be held in cash or will be invested in
"Permitted Investments" which may include (i) direct obligations of, or
obligations fully guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest
by, the United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof, provided that
                                                                --------
such obligations are backed by the full faith and credit of
the United States; (ii) repurchase agreements on obligations specified in
clause (i) maturing not more than three months from the date of acquisition
thereof, provided that the short-term unsecured debt obligations
         --------
of the party agreeing to repurchase such obligations are at the time
rated by each Rating Agency in its highest short-term rating category; (iii)
certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers' acceptances (which, if
Moody's is a Rating Agency, shall each have an original maturity of not more
than 90 days and, in the case of bankers' acceptances, shall in no event have
an original maturity of more than 365 days) of any U.S. depository
institution or trust company incorporated under the laws of the United States
or any state thereof and subject to supervision and examination by federal 
and/or state banking authorities, provided that the unsecured short-term debt 
                                  --------
obligations of such depository institution or trust company at the date of 
acquisition thereof have been rated by each Rating Agency in its highest 
unsecured short-term debt rating category; (iv) commercial paper (having 
original maturities of not more than 90 days) of any corporation incorporated 
under the laws of the United States or any state thereof which on the date of 
acquisition has been rated by the Rating Agencies in their highest short-term 
rating categories; (v) short-term investment funds ("STIFS") sponsored by any 
trust company or bank incorporated under the laws of the United States or 
any state thereof which on the date of acquisition has been rated by the 
Rating Agencies in their respective highest rating category of long-term 
unsecured debt; (vi) interests in any money market fund which at the 
date of acquisition of the interests in such fund and throughout 
the time as the interest is held in such fund has the rating specified 
in the related Prospectus Supplement by each Rating Agency; and (vii) 
other obligations or securities that are acceptable to each Rating
Agency as a Permitted Investment hereunder and will not result in a reduction
in the then current rating of the Securities, as evidenced by a letter to
such effect from such Rating Agency and with respect to which the Master
Servicer has received confirmation that, for tax purposes, the investment
complies with the last clause of this definition; provided that no instrument
                                                  --------
described hereunder shall evidence either the right to receive (a) only 
interest with respect to the obligations underlying such instrument 
or (b) both principal and interest payments derived from obligations 
underlying such instrument and the interest and principal payments with 
respect to such instrument provided a yield to maturity at par greater 
                          --------
than 120% of the yield to maturity at par of the underlying obligations; 
and provided, further, that no instrument described hereunder may be 
    --------  -------
purchased at a price greater than par if such instrument may be prepaid or 
called at a price less than its purchase price prior to its stated 
maturity.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, 
any instrument deposited therein will name the Trustee, in its capacity as 
trustee for the holders of the Securities, as beneficiary and will be 
issued by an entity acceptable to each Rating Agency that rates the 
Securities of the related Series.  Additional information with respect to 
such instruments deposited in the Reserve Accounts will be set forth in 
the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Any amounts so deposited and payments on instruments so deposited will
be available for withdrawal from the Reserve Account for distribution to the
holders of Securities of the related Series for the purposes, in the manner
and at the times specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

POOL INSURANCE POLICIES

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a separate pool
insurance policy ("Pool Insurance Policy") will be obtained for the Pool and
issued by the insurer (the "Pool Insurer") named in such Prospectus
Supplement.  Each Pool Insurance Policy will, subject to the limitations
described below, cover loss by reason of default in payment on Loans in the
Pool in an amount equal to a percentage specified in such Prospectus
Supplement of the aggregate principal balance of such Loans on the Cut-Off
Date which are not covered as to their entire outstanding principal balances
by Primary Mortgage Insurance Policies.  As more fully described below, the
Master Servicer will present claims thereunder to the Pool Insurer on behalf
of itself, the Trustee and the holders of the Securities of the related
Series.  The Pool Insurance Policies, however, are not blanket policies
against loss, since claims thereunder may only be made respecting particular
defaulted Loans and only upon satisfaction of certain conditions precedent
described below.  The Pool Insurance Policies generally will not cover losses
due to a failure to pay or denial of a claim under a Primary Mortgage
Insurance Policy.

     The Pool Insurance Policies generally will provide that no claims may be
validly presented unless (i) any required Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy
is in effect for the defaulted Loan and a claim thereunder has been submitted
and settled; (ii) hazard insurance on the related Property has been kept in
force and real estate taxes and other protection and preservation expenses
have been paid; (iii) if there has been physical loss or damage to the
Property, it has been restored to its physical condition (reasonable wear and
tear excepted) at the time of issuance of the policy; and (iv) the insured
has acquired good and merchantable title to the Property free and clear of
liens except certain permitted encumbrances.  Upon satisfaction of these
conditions, the Pool Insurer will have the option either (a) to purchase the
property securing the defaulted Loan at a price equal to the principal
balance thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest at the Loan Rate to the date
of such purchase and certain expenses incurred by the Master Servicer on
behalf of the Trustee and Securityholders, or (b) to pay the amount by which
the sum of the principal balance of the defaulted Loan plus accrued and
unpaid interest at the Loan Rate to the date of payment of the claim and 
the aforementioned expenses exceeds the proceeds received from an 
approved sale of the Property, in either case net of certain amounts paid 
or assumed to have been paid under the related Primary Mortgage Insurance 
Policy.  If any Property securing a defaulted Loan is damaged and proceeds, 
if any, from the related hazard insurance policy or the applicable special 
hazard insurance policy are insufficient to restore the damaged Property to 
a condition sufficient to permit recovery under the Pool Insurance Policy, 
the Master Servicer will not be required to expend its own funds to 
restore the damaged Property unless it determines that (i) such restoration 
will increase the proceeds to Securityholders on liquidation of the Loan 
after reimbursement of the Master Servicer for its expenses and (ii) such 
expenses will be recoverable by it through proceeds of the sale of the 
Property or proceeds of the related Pool Insurance Policy or any related 
Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy.

     The Pool Insurance Policies generally will not insure (and many Primary
Mortgage Insurance Policies do not insure) against loss sustained by reason
of a default arising from, among other things, (i) fraud or negligence in the
origination or servicing of a Loan, including misrepresentation by the
borrower, the originator or persons involved in the origination thereof, or
(ii) failure to construct a Property in accordance with plans and
specifications.  A failure of coverage attributable to one of the foregoing
events might result in a breach of Provident's representations described
above, and, in such events might give rise to an obligation on the part of
Provident to repurchase the defaulted Loan if the breach cannot be cured by
Provident.  No Pool Insurance Policy will cover (and many Primary Mortgage
Insurance Policies do not cover) a claim in respect of a defaulted Loan
occurring when the servicer of such Loan, at the time of default or
thereafter, was not approved by the applicable insurer.

     The original amount of coverage under each Pool Insurance Policy
generally will be reduced over the life of the related Securities by the
aggregate dollar amount of claims paid less the aggregate of the net amounts
realized by the Pool Insurer upon disposition of all foreclosed properties. 
The amount of claims paid will include certain expenses incurred by the
Master Servicer as well as accrued interest on delinquent Loans to the date
of payment of the claim or such other date set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  Accordingly, if aggregate net claims paid under any
Pool Insurance Policy reach the original policy limit, coverage under that
Pool Insurance Policy will be exhausted and any further losses will be borne
by the related Securityholders.

CROSS-COLLATERALIZATION

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the beneficial
ownership of separate groups of assets included in a Trust Fund may be
evidenced by separate classes of the related Series of Securities.  In such
case, credit support may be provided by a cross-collateralization feature
which requires that distributions be made to Securities evidencing a
beneficial ownership interest in, or secured by, one or more asset groups
within the same Trust Fund prior to distributions to Subordinated Securities
evidencing a beneficial ownership interest in, or secured by, one or more
other asset groups within such Trust Fund.  Cross-collateralization may be
provided by (i) the allocation of certain excess amounts generated by one or
more asset groups to one or more other asset groups within the same Trust
Fund or (ii) the allocation of losses with respect to one or more asset
groups to one or more other asset groups within the same Trust Fund.  The
Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities which includes a
cross-collateralization feature will describe the manner and conditions for
applying such cross-collateralization feature.


                     YIELD AND PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     The yields to maturity and weighted average lives of the Securities will
be affected primarily by the amount and timing of principal payments received
on or in respect of the Trust Fund Assets included in the related Trust Fund. 
The original terms to maturity of the Loans in a given Pool will vary
depending upon the type of Loans included therein.  Each Prospectus
Supplement will contain information with respect to the type and maturities
of the Loans in the related Pool.  The related Prospectus Supplement will
specify the circumstances, if any, under which the related Loans will be
subject to prepayment penalties.  The prepayment experience on the Loans in a
Pool will affect the weighted average life of the related Series of
Securities.

     The rate of prepayment on the Loans cannot be predicted.  Home equity
loans and home improvement contracts have been originated in significant
volume only during the past few years and Provident is not aware of any
publicly available studies or statistics on the rate of prepayment of such
loans.  Generally, home equity loans and home improvement contracts are not
viewed by borrowers as permanent financing.  Accordingly, such Loans may
experience a higher rate of prepayment than traditional first mortgage loans. 
On the other hand, because home equity loans such as the Revolving Credit
Line Loans generally are not fully amortizing, the absence of voluntary
borrower prepayments could cause rates of principal payments lower than, or
similar to, those of traditional fully-amortizing first mortgage loans.  The
prepayment experience of the related Trust Fund may be affected by a wide
variety of factors, including general economic conditions, prevailing
interest rate levels, the availability of alternative financing, homeowner
mobility and the frequency and amount of any future draws on any Revolving
Credit Line Loans.  Other factors that might be expected to affect the
prepayment rate of a pool of home equity mortgage loans or home improvement
contracts include the amounts of, and interest rates on, the underlying
senior mortgage loans, and the use of first mortgage loans as long-term
financing for home purchase and subordinate mortgage loans as shorter-term
financing for a variety of purposes, including home improvement, education
expenses and purchases of consumer durables such as automobiles. 
Accordingly, such Loans may experience a higher rate of prepayment than
traditional fixed-rate mortgage loans.  In addition, any future limitations
on the right of borrowers to deduct interest payments on home equity loans
for federal income tax purposes may further increase the rate of prepayments
of the Loans.  The enforcement of a "due-on-sale" provision (as described
below) will have the same effect as a prepayment of the related Loan.  See
"Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses".  

     The yield to an investor who purchases Securities in the secondary
market at a price other than par will vary from the anticipated yield if the
rate of prepayment on the Loans is actually different than the rate
anticipated by such investor at the time such Securities were purchased.

     Collections on Home Equity Loans may vary because, among other things,
borrowers may (i) make payments during any month as low as the minimum
monthly payment for such month or, during the interest-only period for
certain Revolving Credit Line Loans and, in more limited circumstances,
Closed-End Loans, with respect to which an interest-only payment option has
been selected, the interest and the fees and charges for such month or (ii)
make payments as high as the entire outstanding principal balance plus
accrued interest and the fees and charges thereon.  In addition, collections
on the Loans may vary due to seasonal purchasing and the payment habits of
borrowers.

     As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain of the
conventional Loans will contain "due-on-sale" provisions permitting the
mortgagee to accelerate the maturity of the Loan upon sale or certain
transfers by the borrower of the related Property.  Thus, the rate of
prepayments on such Loans may be lower than that of conventional Loans
bearing comparable interest rates.  The Master Servicer generally will
enforce any due-on-sale or due-on-encumbrance clause to the extent it has
knowledge of the conveyance or further encumbrance or the proposed conveyance
or proposed further encumbrance of the Property and reasonably believes that
it is entitled to do so under applicable law.  See "The Agreements--
Collection Procedures" and "Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans" for a
description of certain provisions of each Agreement and certain legal
developments that may affect the prepayment experience on the Loans.

     The rate of prepayments with respect to conventional mortgage loans has
fluctuated significantly in recent years.  In general, if prevailing rates
fall significantly below the Loan Rates borne by the Loans, such Loans are
more likely to be subject to higher prepayment rates than if prevailing
interest rates remain at or above such Loan Rates.  Conversely, if prevailing
interest rates rise appreciably above the Loan Rates borne by the Loans, such
Loans are more likely to experience a lower prepayment rate than if
prevailing rates remain at or below such Loan Rates.  However, there can be
no assurance that such will be the case.

     When a full prepayment is made on a Loan, the borrower is charged
interest on the principal amount of the Loan so prepaid only for the number
of days in the month actually elapsed up to the date of the prepayment,
rather than for a full month.  The effect of prepayments in full will be to
reduce the amount of interest passed through or paid in the following month
to holders of Securities because interest on the principal amount of any 
Loan so prepaid will generally be paid only to the date of prepayment. 
Partial prepayments in a given month may be applied to the outstanding
principal balances of the Loans so prepaid on the first day of the month of
receipt or the month following receipt.  In the latter case, partial
prepayments will not reduce the amount of interest passed through or paid in
such month.  Generally, neither full nor partial prepayments will be passed
through or paid until the month following receipt.

     Even assuming that the Properties provide adequate security for the
Loans, substantial delays could be encountered in connection with the
liquidation of defaulted Loans and corresponding delays in the receipt of
related proceeds by Securityholders could occur.  An action to foreclose on a
Property securing a Loan is regulated by state statutes and rules and is
subject to many of the delays and expenses of other lawsuits if defenses or
counterclaims are interposed, sometimes requiring several years to complete. 
Furthermore, in some states an action to obtain a deficiency judgment is not
permitted following a nonjudicial sale of a property.  In the event of a
default by a borrower, these restrictions, among other things, may impede the
ability of the Master Servicer to foreclose on or sell the Property or to
obtain liquidation proceeds sufficient to repay all amounts due on the
related Loan.  In addition, the Master Servicer will be entitled to deduct
from related liquidation proceeds all expenses reasonably incurred in
attempting to recover amounts due on defaulted Loans and not yet repaid,
including payments to senior lienholders, legal fees and costs of legal
action, real estate taxes and maintenance and preservation expenses.

     Liquidation expenses with respect to defaulted mortgage loans do not
vary directly with the outstanding principal balance of the loan at the time
of default.  Therefore, assuming that a servicer took the same steps in
realizing upon a defaulted mortgage loan having a small remaining principal
balance as it would in the case of a defaulted mortgage loan having a large
remaining principal balance, the amount realized after expenses of
liquidation would be smaller as a percentage of the remaining principal
balance of the small mortgage loan than would be the case with the defaulted
mortgage loan having a large remaining principal balance.

     Applicable state laws generally regulate interest rates and other
charges, require certain disclosures, and require licensing of certain
originators and servicers of Loans.  In addition, most have other laws,
public policy and general principles of equity relating to the protection of
consumers, unfair and deceptive practices and practices which may apply to
originating, servicing and collecting Loans.  Depending on the provisions of
the applicable law and the specific facts and circumstances involved,
violations of these laws, policies and principles may limit the ability of
the Master Servicer to collect all or part of the principal of or interest on
the Loans, may entitle the borrower to a refund of amounts previously paid
and, in addition, could subject the Master Servicer to damages and
administrative sanctions.

     If the rate at which interest is passed through or paid to the holders
of Securities of a Series is calculated on a Loan-by-Loan basis,
disproportionate principal prepayments among Loans with different Loan Rates
will affect the yield on such Securities.  In most cases, the effective yield
to Securityholders will be lower than the yield otherwise produced by the
applicable Pass-Through Rate or interest rate and purchase price, because
while interest will accrue on each Loan from the first day of the month
(unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement), the
distribution of such interest will not be made earlier than the month
following the month of accrual.

     Under certain circumstances, the Master Servicer, the holders of the
residual interests in a REMIC or any person specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement may have the option to purchase the assets of a Trust
Fund and thereby affect earlier retirement of the related Series of
Securities.  See "The Agreements--Termination; Optional Termination".

     The relative contribution of the various factors affecting prepayment
may vary from time to time.  There can be no assurance as to the rate of
payment of principal of the Trust Fund Assets at any time or over the lives
of the Securities.

     The Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities will
discuss in greater detail the effect of the rate and timing of principal
payments (including prepayments), delinquencies and losses on the yield,
weighted average lives and maturities of such Securities.


                                THE AGREEMENTS

     Set forth below is a description of the material provisions of each
Agreement which are not described elsewhere in this Prospectus.  The
description is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by reference to, the
provisions of each Agreement.  Where particular provisions or terms used in
the Agreements are referred to, such provisions or terms are as specified in
the Agreements.

ASSIGNMENT OF THE TRUST FUND ASSETS

     Assignment of the Loans.  At the time of issuance of the Securities of a
Series, Provident will assign the Loans comprising the related Trust Fund to
the Trustee, without recourse, together with all principal and interest
received by or on behalf of Provident on or with respect to such Loans after
the Cut-Off Date, other than principal and interest due on or before the Cut-
Off Date and other than any Retained Interest specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  The Trustee will, concurrently with such assignment,
deliver such Securities to Provident in exchange for the Loans.  Each Loan
will be identified in a schedule appearing as an exhibit to the related
Agreement.  Such schedule will include information as to the outstanding
principal balance of each Loan after application of payments due on or before
the Cut-Off Date, as well as information regarding the Loan Rate or APR, the
maturity of the Loan, the Loan-to-Value Ratios or Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratios, as applicable, at origination and certain other information.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Agreement will require that, within the time period specified therein,
Provident will also deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee (or to
the custodian hereinafter referred to) as to each Mortgage Loan or Home
Equity Loan, among other things, (i) the mortgage note or contract endorsed
without recourse in blank or to the order of the Trustee, (ii) the mortgage,
deed of trust or similar instrument (a "Mortgage") with evidence of recording
indicated thereon (except for any Mortgage not returned from the public
recording office, in which case Provident will deliver or cause to be
delivered a copy of such Mortgage together with a certificate that the
original of such Mortgage was delivered to such recording office), (iii) an
assignment of the Mortgage to the Trustee, which assignment will be in
recordable form in the case of a Mortgage assignment, and (iv) such other
security documents, including those relating to any senior interests in the
Property, as may be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement or the
related Agreement.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, Provident will not promptly cause the assignments of the
Mortgages to be recorded in the appropriate public office for real property
records.  If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, some or all of
the Loan documents may not be delivered to the Trustee until after the
occurrence of certain events specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     The Trustee (or the custodian hereinafter referred to) will review such
Loan documents within the time period specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement after receipt thereof, and the Trustee will hold such documents in
trust for the benefit of the related Securityholders.  Unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,  if any such document is
found to be missing or defective in any material respect, the Trustee (or
such custodian) will notify the Master Servicer and Provident.  If Provident
cannot cure the omission or defect within the time period specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement after receipt of such notice, Provident will be
obligated to either (i) purchase the related Loan from the Trust Fund at the
Purchase Price or (ii) if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
remove such Loan from the Trust Fund and substitute in its place one or more
other Loans that meets certain requirements set forth therein.  There can be
no assurance that Provident will fulfill this purchase or substitution
obligation.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
this obligation to cure, purchase or substitute constitutes the sole remedy
available to the Securityholders or the Trustee for omission of, or a
material defect in, a constituent document.

     The Trustee will be authorized to appoint a custodian pursuant to a
custodial agreement to maintain possession of and, if applicable, to review
the documents relating to the Loans as agent of the Trustee.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions, with respect to a Trust Fund
for which a REMIC election is to be made, no purchase or substitution of a
Loan will be made if such purchase or substitution would result in a
prohibited transaction tax under the Code.

     No Recourse to Provident or Master Servicer.  As described above under
"--Assignment of the Loans," Provident will assign the Loans comprising the
related Trust Fund to the Trustee, without recourse.  However, Provident will
be obligated to repurchase or substitute for any Loan as to which certain
representations and warranties are breached or for failure to deliver certain
documents relating to the Loans as described herein under "Assignment of the
Loans" and "Loan Program--Representations by Provident; Repurchases."  These
obligations to purchase or substitute constitute the sole remedy available to
the Securityholders or the Trustee for a breach of any such representation or
warranty or failure to deliver a constituent document.

PAYMENTS ON LOANS; DEPOSITS TO SECURITY ACCOUNT

     The Master Servicer will establish and maintain or cause to be
established and maintained with respect to the related Trust Fund a separate
account or accounts for the collection of payments on the related Trust Fund
Assets in the Trust Fund (the "Security Account") which, unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, must be either (i) maintained
with a depository institution whose short-term debt obligations and long-term
debt obligations at the time of any deposit therein and throughout the time
the interest is maintained are rated as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement by the Rating Agencies, and the deposits in such account or
accounts are fully insured by either the Bank Insurance Fund (the "BIF") or
the Savings Association Insurance Fund ("SAIF") (as successor to the Federal
Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation) and which is any of (a) a federal
savings and loan association duly organized, validly existing and in good
standing under the applicable banking laws of any state, (b) an institution
duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the applicable
banking laws of any state, (c) a national banking association duly organized,
validly existing and in good standing under the federal banking laws or (d) a
principal subsidiary of a bank holding company, (ii) a segregated trust
account maintained with the corporate trust department of a federal or state
chartered depository or trust company, having capital and surplus of not less
than $50,000,000, acting in its fiduciary capacity, or (iii) an account
otherwise acceptable to each Rating Agency as evidenced by a letter from each
Rating Agency to the Trustee, without reduction or withdrawal of the then
current ratings of the Securities.  The collateral eligible to secure amounts
in the Security Account is limited to Permitted Investments.  A Security
Account may be maintained as an interest bearing account or the funds held
therein may be invested pending each succeeding Distribution Date in
Permitted Investments.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Master Servicer or its designee will be entitled to receive
any such interest or other income earned on funds in the Security Account as
additional compensation and will be obligated to deposit in the Security
Account the amount of any loss immediately as realized.  The Security Account
may be maintained with the Master Servicer or with a depository institution
that is an affiliate of the Master Servicer, provided it meets the standards
set forth above.

     The Master Servicer will deposit or cause to be deposited in the
Security Account for each Trust Fund, to the extent applicable and unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the following
payments and collections received or advances made by or on behalf of it
subsequent to the Cut-Off Date (other than certain payments due on or before
the Cut-Off Date and exclusive of any amounts representing Retained
Interest):

          (i)  all payments on account of principal, including Principal
     Prepayments and, if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
     applicable prepayment penalties, on the Loans;

          (ii) all payments on account of interest on the Loans, net of
     applicable servicing compensation;

          (iii)     all proceeds (net of unreimbursed payments of property
     taxes, insurance premiums and similar items ("Insured Expenses")
     incurred, and unreimbursed Advances made, by the Master Servicer, if
     any) of the hazard insurance policies and any Primary Mortgage Insurance
     Policies, to the extent such proceeds are not applied to the restoration 
     of the property or released to the Mortgagor in accordance with the 
     Master Servicer's normal servicing procedures (collectively, "Insurance 
     Proceeds") and all other cash amounts (net of unreimbursed expenses 
     incurred in connection with liquidation or foreclosure ("Liquidation 
     Expenses") and unreimbursed Advances made, by the Master Servicer, if 
     any) received and retained in connection with the liquidation of 
     defaulted Loans, by foreclosure or otherwise ("Liquidation Proceeds"), 
     together with any net proceeds received on a monthly basis with respect 
     to any properties acquired on behalf of the Securityholders by 
     foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure;

          (iv) all proceeds of any Loan or property in respect thereof
     purchased by Provident as described under "Loan Program--Representations
     by Provident; Repurchases" or "--Assignment of Trust Fund Assets" above
     and all proceeds of any Loan repurchased as described under "--
     Termination; Optional Termination" below;

          (v)  all payments required to be deposited in the Security Account
     with respect to any deductible clause in any blanket insurance policy
     described under "--Hazard Insurance" below;

          (vi) any amount required to be deposited by the Master Servicer in
     connection with losses realized on investments for the benefit of the
     Master Servicer of funds held in the Security Account and, to the extent
     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any payments required to
     be made by the Master Servicer in connection with prepayment interest
     shortfalls; and

          (vii)     all other amounts required to be deposited in the
     Security Account pursuant to the Agreement.

     The Master Servicer may from time to time direct the institution that
maintains the Security Account to withdraw funds from the Security Account
for the following purposes:

          (i)  to pay to the Master Servicer the servicing fees described in
     the related Prospectus Supplement, the master servicing fees (subject to
     reduction) and, as additional servicing compensation, earnings on or
     investment income with respect to funds in the Security Account credited
     thereto;

          (ii) to reimburse the Master Servicer for Advances, such right of
     reimbursement with respect to any Loan being limited to amounts received
     that represent late recoveries of payments of principal and/or interest
     on such Loan (or Insurance Proceeds or Liquidation Proceeds with respect
     thereto) with respect to which such Advance was made;

          (iii)     to reimburse the Master Servicer for any Advances
     previously made which the Master Servicer has determined to be
     nonrecoverable;

          (iv) to reimburse the Master Servicer from Insurance Proceeds for
     expenses incurred by the Master Servicer and covered by the related
     insurance policies;

          (v)  to reimburse the Master Servicer for unpaid master servicing
     fees and unreimbursed out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred by the
     Master Servicer in the performance of its servicing obligations, such
     right of reimbursement being limited to amounts received representing
     late recoveries of the payments for which such advances were made;

          (vi) to pay to the Master Servicer, with respect to each Loan or
     property acquired in respect thereof that has been purchased by the
     Master Servicer pursuant to the Agreement, all amounts received thereon
     and not taken into account in determining the principal balance of such
     repurchased Loan;

          (vii)     to reimburse the Master Servicer or Provident for
     expenses incurred and reimbursable pursuant to the Agreement;

          (viii)    to withdraw any amount deposited in the Security Account
     and not required to be deposited therein; and

          (ix) to clear and terminate the Security Account upon termination
     of the Agreement.

     In addition, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, on or prior to the business day immediately preceding each
Distribution Date, the Master Servicer shall withdraw from the Security
Account the amount of Available Funds, to the extent on deposit, for deposit
in an account maintained by the Trustee for the related Series of Securities.

     The applicable Agreement may require the Master Servicer to establish
and maintain one or more escrow accounts into which Mortgagors deposit
amounts sufficient to pay taxes, assessments, hazard insurance premiums or
comparable items.  Withdrawals from the escrow accounts maintained for
Mortgagors may be made to effect timely payment of taxes, assessments and
hazard insurance premiums or comparable items, to reimburse the Master
Servicer out of related assessments for maintaining hazard insurance, to
refund to Mortgagors amounts determined to be overages, to remit to
Mortgagors, if required, interest earned, if any, on balances in any of the
escrow accounts, to repair or otherwise protect the Property and to clear and
terminate any of the escrow accounts.  The Master Servicer will be solely
responsible for administration of the escrow accounts and will be expected to
make advances to such account when a deficiency exists therein.

PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

     If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer
will establish and maintain a Pre-Funding Account, in the name of the related
Trustee on behalf of the related Securityholders, into which Provident will
deposit cash in an amount equal to the Pre-Funded Amount on the related
Closing Date.  The Pre-Funding Account will be maintained with the Trustee
for the related Series of Securities and is designed solely to hold funds to
be applied by such Trustee during the Funding Period to pay to Provident the
purchase price for Subsequent Loans.  Monies on deposit in the Pre-Funding
Account will not be available to cover losses on or in respect of the related
Loans.  The Pre-Funded Amount will not exceed 50% of the initial aggregate
principal amount of the Securities of the related Series.  The Pre-Funded
Amount will be used by the related Trustee to purchase Subsequent Loans from
Provident from time to time during the Funding Period.  The Funding Period,
if any, for a Trust Fund will begin on the related Closing Date and will end
on the date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, which in no event
will be later than the date that is one year after the related Closing Date. 
Monies on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account may be invested in Permitted
Investments under the circumstances and in the manner described in the
related Agreement.  Earnings on investment of funds in the Pre-Funding
Account will be deposited into the related Security Account or such other
trust account as is specified in the related Prospectus Supplement and losses
will be charged against the funds on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account.  Any
amounts remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the Funding Period
will be distributed to the related Securityholders in the manner and priority
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, as a prepayment of principal
of the related Securities.

     In addition, if so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, on the
related Closing Date Provident will deposit in an account (the "Capitalized
Interest Account") cash in such amount as is necessary to cover shortfalls in
interest on the related Series of Securities that may arise as a result of
utilization of the Pre-Funding Account as described above.  The Capitalized
Interest Account shall be maintained with the Trustee for the related Series
of Securities and is designed solely to cover the above-mentioned interest
shortfalls.  Monies on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account will not
be available to cover losses on or in respect of the related Loans.  To the
extent that the entire amount on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account
has not been applied to cover shortfalls in interest on the related Series of
Securities by the end of the Funding Period, any amounts remaining in the
Capitalized Interest Account will be paid to Provident.

SUB-SERVICING

     The Master Servicer may enter into an agreement (a "Sub-Servicing
Agreement") with any servicing entity which will act as the Sub-Servicer for
the related Loans, which Sub-Servicing Agreement will not contain any terms
inconsistent with the related Agreement.  Notwithstanding any such
subservicing arrangement, unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Master Servicer will remain liable for its servicing duties
and obligations under the Master Servicing Agreement as if the Master
Servicer alone were servicing the Loans.


COLLECTION PROCEDURES

     The Master Servicer, directly or through one or more Sub-Servicers, will
make reasonable efforts to collect all payments called for under the Loans
and will, consistent with each Agreement and any Pool Insurance Policy,
Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy, bankruptcy bond or alternative
arrangements, follow such collection procedures as are customary with respect
to loans that are comparable to the Loans.  Consistent with the above, the
Master Servicer may, in its discretion, (i) waive any assumption fee, late
payment or other charge in connection with a Loan and (ii) to the extent not
inconsistent with the coverage of such Loan by a Pool Insurance Policy,
Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy, bankruptcy bond or alternative
arrangements, if applicable, arrange with a borrower a schedule for the
liquidation of delinquencies consistent with the Master Servicer's policies
with respect to the mortgage loans it owns and services for others.  To the
extent the Master Servicer is obligated to make or cause to be made Advances,
such obligation will remain during any period of such an arrangement.

     In any case in which property securing a Loan has been, or is about to
be, conveyed by the mortgagor or obligor, the Master Servicer will, to the
extent it has knowledge of such conveyance or proposed conveyance, exercise
or cause to be exercised its rights to accelerate the maturity of such Loan
under any due-on-sale clause applicable thereto, but only if the exercise of
such rights is permitted by applicable law.  If these conditions are not met
or if the Master Servicer reasonably believes it is unable under applicable
law to enforce such due-on-sale clause, the Master Servicer will enter into
or cause to be entered into an assumption and modification agreement with the
person to whom such property has been or is about to be conveyed, pursuant to
which such person becomes liable for repayment of the Loan and, to the extent
permitted by applicable law, the mortgagor remains liable thereon.  Any fee
collected by or on behalf of the Master Servicer for entering into an
assumption agreement will be retained by or on behalf of the Master Servicer
as additional servicing compensation.  See "Certain Legal Aspects of the
Loans--Due-on-Sale Clauses".  In connection with any such assumption, the
terms of the related Loan may not be changed.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Master Servicer will require the mortgagor or obligor on each Loan to
maintain a hazard insurance policy providing for no less than the coverage of
the standard form of fire insurance policy with extended coverage customary
for the type of Property in the state in which such Property is located. 
Such coverage will be in an amount that is at least equal to the lesser of
(i) the maximum insurable value of the improvements securing such Loan from
time to time, (ii) the combined principal balance owing on such Loan and any
mortgage loan senior to such Loan and (iii) the minimum amount required to
compensate for damage or loss on a replacement cost basis.  All amounts
collected by the Master Servicer under any hazard policy (except for amounts
to be applied to the restoration or repair of the Property or released to the
mortgagor or obligor in accordance with the Master Servicer's normal
servicing procedures) will be deposited in the related Security Account. In
the event that the Master Servicer maintains a blanket policy insuring
against hazard losses on all the Loans comprising part of a Trust Fund, it
will conclusively be deemed to have satisfied its obligation relating to the
maintenance of hazard insurance.  Such blanket policy may contain a
deductible clause, in which case the Master Servicer will be required to
deposit from its own funds into the related Security Account the amounts
which would have been deposited therein but for such clause.

     In general, the standard form of fire and extended coverage policy
covers physical damage to or destruction of the improvements securing a Loan
by fire, lightning, explosion, smoke, windstorm and hail, riot, strike and
civil commotion, subject to the conditions and exclusions particularized in
each policy.  Although the policies relating to the Loans may have been
underwritten by different insurers under different state laws in accordance
with different applicable forms and therefore may not contain identical terms
and conditions, the basic terms thereof are dictated by respective state
laws, and most such policies typically do not cover any physical damage
resulting from the following:  war, revolution, governmental actions, floods
and other water-related causes, earth movement (including earthquakes,
landslides and mud flows), nuclear reactions, wet or dry rot, vermin,
rodents, insects or domestic animals, theft and, in certain cases, vandalism. 
The foregoing list is merely indicative of certain kinds of uninsured risks
and is not intended to be all inclusive.  If the Property securing a Loan is
located in a federally designated special flood area at the time of
origination, the Master Servicer will require the mortgagor or obligor to
obtain and maintain flood insurance.

     The hazard insurance policies covering properties securing the Loans
typically contain a clause which in effect requires the insured at all time
to carry insurance of a specified percentage (generally 80% to 90%) of the
full replacement value of the insured property in order to recover the full
amount of any partial loss.  If the insured's coverage falls below this
specified percentage, then the insurer's liability in the event of partial
loss will not exceed the larger of (i) the actual cash value (generally
defined as replacement cost at the time and place of loss, less physical
depreciation) of the improvements damaged or destroyed or (ii) such
proportion of the loss as the amount of insurance carried bears to the
specified percentage of the full replacement cost of such improvements. 
Since the amount of hazard insurance the Master Servicer may cause to be
maintained on the improvements securing the Loans declines as the principal
balances owing thereon decrease, and since improved real estate generally has
appreciated in value over time in the past, the effect of this requirement in
the event of partial loss may be that hazard insurance proceeds will be
insufficient to restore fully the damaged property.  If specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, a special hazard insurance policy will be
obtained to insure against certain of the uninsured risks described above. 
See "Credit Enhancement."

     If the Property securing a defaulted Loan is damaged and proceeds, if
any, from the related hazard insurance policy are insufficient to restore the
damaged Property, the Master Servicer is not required to expend its own funds
to restore the damaged Property unless it determines (i) that such
restoration will increase the proceeds to Securityholders on liquidation of
the Loan after reimbursement of the Master Servicer for its expenses and (ii)
that such expenses will be recoverable by it from related Insurance Proceeds
or Liquidation Proceeds.

     If recovery on a defaulted Loan under any related Insurance Policy is
not available, or if the defaulted Loan is not covered by an Insurance
Policy, the Master Servicer will be obligated to follow or cause to be
followed such normal practices and procedures as it deems necessary or
advisable to realize upon the defaulted Loan.  If the proceeds of any
liquidation of the Property securing the defaulted Loan are less than the
principal balance of such Loan plus interest accrued thereon that is payable
to Securityholders, the Trust Fund will realize a loss in the amount of such
difference plus the aggregate of expenses incurred by the Master Servicer in
connection with such proceedings which are reimbursable under the Agreement. 
In the unlikely event that any such proceedings result in a total recovery
which is, after reimbursement to the Master Servicer of its expenses, in
excess of the principal balance of such Loan plus interest accrued thereon
that is payable to Securityholders, the Master Servicer will be entitled to
withdraw or retain from the Security Account amounts representing its normal
servicing compensation with respect to such Loan and, unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, amounts representing the
balance of such excess, exclusive of any amount required by law to be
forwarded to the related borrower, as additional servicing compensation.

     If the Master Servicer or its designee recovers Insurance Proceeds
which, when added to any related Liquidation Proceeds and after deduction of
certain expenses reimbursable to the Master Servicer, exceed the principal
balance of such Loan plus interest accrued thereon that is payable to
Securityholders, the Master Servicer will be entitled to withdraw or retain
from the Security Account amounts representing its normal servicing
compensation with respect to such Loan.  In the event that the Master
Servicer has expended its own funds to restore the damaged Property and such
funds have not been reimbursed under the related hazard insurance policy, it
will be entitled to withdraw from the Security Account out of related
Liquidation Proceeds or Insurance Proceeds an amount equal to such 
expenses incurred by it, in which event the Trust Fund may realize a loss 
up to the amount so charged. Since Insurance Proceeds cannot exceed 
deficiency claims and certain expenses incurred by the Master Servicer, 
no such payment or recovery will result in a recovery to the Trust Fund 
which exceeds the principal balance of the defaulted Loan together with 
accrued interest thereon.  See "Credit Enhancement".

     The proceeds from any liquidation of a Loan will be applied in the
following order of priority:  first, to reimburse the Master Servicer for any
unreimbursed expenses incurred by it to restore the related Property and any
unreimbursed servicing compensation payable to the Master Servicer with
respect to such Loan; second, to reimburse the Master Servicer for any
unreimbursed Advances with respect to such Loan; third, to accrued and unpaid
interest (to the extent no Advance has been made for such amount) on such
Loan; and fourth, as a recovery of principal of such Loan.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED LOANS

     Primary Mortgage Insurance Policies.  If so specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer will maintain or cause to be
maintained, as the case may be, in full force and effect, a Primary Mortgage
Insurance Policy with regard to each Loan for which such coverage is
required.  Primary Mortgage Insurance Policies reimburse certain losses
sustained by reason of defaults in payments by borrowers.  The Master
Servicer will not cancel or refuse to renew any such Primary Mortgage
Insurance Policy in effect at the time of the initial issuance of a Series of
Securities that is required to be kept in force under the applicable
Agreement unless the replacement Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy for such
cancelled or nonrenewed policy is maintained with an insurer whose claims-
paying ability is sufficient to maintain the current rating of the classes of
Securities of such Series that have been rated.

SERVICING AND OTHER COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     The principal servicing compensation to be paid to the Master Servicer
in respect of its master servicing activities for each Series of Securities
will be equal to the percentage per annum described in the related Prospectus
Supplement (which may vary under certain circumstances) of the outstanding
principal balance of each Loan, and such compensation will be retained by it
from collections of interest on such Loan in the related Trust Fund (the
"Master Servicing Fee").  As compensation for its servicing duties, a Sub-
Servicer, if any, will be entitled to a monthly servicing fee as described in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  In addition, the Master Servicer or Sub-
Servicer will retain all prepayment charges, assumption fees and late payment
charges, to the extent collected from borrowers, and any benefit that may
accrue as a result of the investment of funds in the applicable Security
Account (unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement).

     The Master Servicer will pay or cause to be paid certain ongoing
expenses associated with each Trust Fund and incurred by it in connection
with its responsibilities under the related Agreement, including, without
limitation, and if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, payment
of any fee or other amount payable in respect of any credit enhancement
arrangements, payment of the fees and disbursements of  the Trustee, any
custodian appointed by the Trustee, the certificate registrar and any paying
agent, and payment of expenses incurred in enforcing the obligations of Sub-
Servicers.  The Master Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement of expenses
incurred in enforcing the obligations of Sub-Servicers under certain limited
circumstances.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

     Each Agreement will provide that on or before a specified date in each
year, a firm of independent public accountants will furnish a statement to
the Trustee to the effect that, on the basis of the examination by such firm
conducted substantially in compliance with the Uniform Single Attestation
Program for Mortgage Bankers or the Audit Program for Mortgages serviced for
FHLMC, the servicing by or on behalf of the Master Servicer of the Trust Fund
Assets pursuant to the Agreement was conducted in compliance therewith except
for any significant exceptions or errors in records that, in the opinion of
the firm, the Audit Program for Mortgages serviced for FHLMC, or the Uniform 
Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers, it is required to report.  
In rendering its statement such firm may rely, as to matters relating 
to the direct servicing of Loans by Sub-Servicers, upon comparable statements 
for examinations conducted substantially in compliance with the Uniform 
Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers or the Audit Program 
for Mortgages serviced for FHLMC (rendered within one year of such 
statement) of firms of independent public accountants with respect to 
the related Sub-Servicer.

     Each Agreement will also provide for delivery to the Trustee, on or
before a specified date in each year, of an annual statement signed by two
officers of the Master Servicer to the effect that the Master Servicer has
fulfilled its obligations under the Agreement throughout the preceding year.

     Copies of the annual accountants' statement and the statement of
officers of the Master Servicer may be obtained by Securityholders of the
related Series without charge upon written request to the Master Servicer at
the address set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER AND PROVIDENT

     The Master Servicer under each Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Master
Servicing Agreement, as applicable, will be named in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  Any of Provident, an affiliate of Provident or another entity
may serve as Master Servicer.

     Each Agreement will provide that the Master Servicer may not resign from
its obligations and duties under the Agreement except upon (a) appointment of
a successor servicer and receipt by the Trustee of a letter from the Rating
Agency that such resignation and appointment will not result in a downgrade
of the Securities and (b) a determination that its duties thereunder are no
longer permissible under applicable law.  The Master Servicer may, however,
be removed from its obligations and duties as set forth in the Agreement. No
such resignation will become effective until the Trustee or a successor
servicer has assumed the Master Servicer's obligations and duties under the
Agreement.

     Each Agreement will further provide that neither the Master Servicer,
Provident nor any director, officer, employee, or agent of the Master
Servicer or Provident will be under any liability to the related Trust Fund
or Securityholders for any action taken or for refraining from the taking of
any action in good faith pursuant to the Agreement, or for errors in
judgment; provided, however, that neither the Master Servicer,
                    --------  -------
Provident nor any such person will be protected against any liability which
would otherwise be imposed by reason of wilful misfeasance, bad faith or
gross negligence in the performance of duties thereunder or by reason of
reckless disregard of obligations and duties thereunder.  Each Agreement will
further provide that the Master Servicer, Provident and any director,
officer, employee or agent of the Master Servicer or Provident will be
entitled to indemnification by the related Trust Fund and will be held
harmless against any loss, liability or expense incurred in connection with
any legal action relating to the Agreement or the Securities, other than any
loss, liability or expense related to any specific Loan or Loans (except any
such loss, liability or expense otherwise reimbursable pursuant to the Agree-
ment) and any loss, liability or expense incurred by reason of willful
misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of duties
thereunder or by reason of reckless disregard of obligations and duties
thereunder.  In addition, each Agreement will provide that neither the Master
Servicer nor Provident will be under any obligation to appear in, prosecute
or defend any legal action which is not incidental to its respective
responsibilities under the Agreement and which in its opinion may involve it
in any expense or liability.  The Master Servicer or Provident may, however,
in its discretion undertake any such action which it may deem necessary or
desirable with respect to the Agreement and the rights and duties of the
parties thereto and the interests of the Securityholders thereunder.  In such
event, the legal expenses and costs of such action and any liability
resulting therefrom will be expenses, costs and liabilities of the Trust
Fund, and the Master Servicer or Provident, as the case may be, will be
entitled to be reimbursed therefor out of funds otherwise distributable to
Securityholders.

     Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
person into which the Master Servicer may be merged or consolidated, or any
person resulting from any merger or consolidation to which the Master
Servicer is a party, or any person succeeding to the business of the Master
Servicer, will be the 

successor of the Master Servicer under each Agreement, provided that such
person is qualified to sell mortgage loans to, and service mortgage loans on
behalf of, FNMA or FHLMC and further provided that such merger, consolidation
or succession does not adversely affect the then current rating or ratings of
the class or classes of Securities of such Series that have been rated.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT; RIGHTS UPON EVENT OF DEFAULT

     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Master Servicing Agreement.  Except as
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Events of Default
under each Agreement will consist of (i) any failure by the Master Servicer
to make any required deposit pursuant to the related Agreement (other than an
Advance) which continues unremedied for five days after the giving of written
notice of such failure to the Master Servicer by the Trustee, or to the
Master Servicer and the Trustee by a holder of the Securities of the related
Series; (ii) any failure by the Master Servicer to make an Advance as
required under the Agreement; (iii) any failure by the Master Servicer duly
to observe or perform in any material respect any of its other covenants or
agreements in the Agreement which continues unremedied for thirty days after
the giving of written notice of such failure to the Master Servicer by the
Trustee, or to the Master Servicer and the Trustee by a holder of the
Securities of the related Series; and (iv) certain events of insolvency,
readjustments of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar
proceedings and certain actions by or on behalf of the Master Servicer
indicating its insolvency, reorganization or inability to pay its
obligations.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Agreement will
permit the Trustee to sell the Trust Fund Assets in the event that payments
in respect thereto are insufficient to make payments required in the
Agreement.  The Trust Fund Assets will be sold only under the circumstances
and in the manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, so long
as an Event of Default under an Agreement remains unremedied, the Trustee may
(and at the direction of holders of Securities evidencing not less than 51%
of the aggregate Percentage Interests and under such other circumstances as
may be specified in such Agreement, the Trustee shall) terminate all of the
rights and obligations of the Master Servicer under the Agreement relating to
such Trust Fund and in and to the related Trust Fund Assets, whereupon the
Trustee will succeed to all of the responsibilities, duties and liabilities
of the Master Servicer under the Agreement, including, if specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the obligation to make Advances, and will be
entitled to similar compensation arrangements; provided, however, that if the
                                               --------  -------
Event of Default results from the Master Servicer's failure to make an 
Advance, the Trustee shall terminate the Master Servicer.  In the event 
that the Trustee is unwilling or unable so to act, it may appoint, or 
petition a court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of, a 
mortgage loan servicing institution with a net worth of a least $50,000,000 
to act as successor to the Master Servicer under the Agreement.  Pending 
such appointment, the Trustee is obligated to act in such capacity.  
The Trustee and any such successor may agree upon the servicing compensation 
to be paid, which in no event may be greater than the compensation payable 
to the Master Servicer under the Agreement.

     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, no
Securityholder, solely by virtue of such holder's status as a Securityholder,
will have any right under any Agreement to institute any proceeding with
respect to such Agreement, unless such holder previously has given to the
Trustee written notice of default and unless the holders of Securities of any
class of such Series evidencing not less than 25% of the aggregate Percentage
Interests constituting such class have made written request upon the Trustee
to institute such proceeding in its own name as Trustee thereunder and have
offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity, and the Trustee for 60 days has
neglected or refused to institute any such proceeding.

     Indenture.  Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, Events of Default under the Indenture for each Series of Notes
include:  (i) a default in the payment of any principal of or interest on any
Note of such Series which continues unremedied for five days after written
notice of such default is given as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement; (ii) failure to perform in any material respect any other
covenant of Provident or the Trust Fund in the Indenture which continues for
a period of thirty days after notice thereof is given in accordance with the 
procedures described in the related Prospectus Supplement; (iii) certain 
events of bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or liquidation of Provident 
or the Trust Fund; or (iv) any other Event of Default provided with respect 
to Notes of that Series including but not limited to certain defaults on the 
part of the issuer, if any, of a credit enhancement instrument supporting 
such Notes.

     If an Event of Default with respect to the Notes of any Series at the
time outstanding occurs and is continuing, either the Trustee or the holders
of a majority of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such
Series may declare the principal amount (or, if the Notes of that Series have
an interest rate of 0%, such portion of the principal amount as may be
specified in the terms of that Series, as provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement) of all the Notes of such Series to be due and payable
immediately.  Such declaration may, under certain circumstances, be rescinded
and annulled by the holders of more than 50% of the Percentage Interests of
the Notes of such Series.

     If, following an Event of Default with respect to any Series of Notes,
the Notes of such Series have been declared to be due and payable, the
Trustee may, in its discretion, notwithstanding such acceleration, elect to
maintain possession of the collateral securing the Notes of such Series and
to continue to apply distributions on such collateral as if there had been no
declaration of acceleration if such collateral continues to provide
sufficient funds for the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes of
such Series as they would have become due if there had not been such a
declaration.  In addition, the Trustee may not sell or otherwise liquidate
the collateral securing the Notes of a Series following an Event of Default,
other than a default in the payment of any principal or interest on any Note
of such Series which continues unremedied for five days after written notice
of such default is given as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
unless (a) the holders of 100% of the Percentage Interests of the Notes of
such Series consent to such sale, (b) the proceeds of such sale or
liquidation are sufficient to pay in full the principal of and accrued
interest, due and unpaid, on the outstanding Notes of such Series at the date
of such sale or (c) the Trustee determines that such collateral would not be
sufficient on an ongoing basis to make all payments on such Notes as such
payments would have become due if such Notes had not been declared due and
payable, and the Trustee obtains the consent of the holders of 662/3% of the
Percentage Interests of the Notes of such Series.

     In the event that the Trustee liquidates the collateral in connection
with an Event of Default involving a default in the payment of principal of
or interest on the Notes of a Series which continues unremedied for five days
after written notice of such default is given as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Indenture provides that the Trustee will have a
prior lien on the proceeds of any such liquidation for unpaid fees and
expenses.  As a result, upon the occurrence of such an Event of Default, the
amount available for distribution to the Noteholders would be less than would
otherwise be the case.  However, the Trustee may not institute a proceeding
for the enforcement of its lien except in connection with a proceeding for
the enforcement of the lien of the Indenture for the benefit of the
Noteholders after the occurrence of such an Event of Default.

     Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in
the event the principal of the Notes of a Series is declared due and payable
as described above, the holders of any such Notes issued at a discount from
par may be entitled to receive no more than an amount equal to the unpaid
principal amount thereof less the amount of such discount which is
unamortized.

     Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in case an Event of Default shall occur and be continuing with
respect to a Series of Notes, the Trustee shall be under no obligation to
exercise any of the rights or powers under the Indenture at the request or
direction of any of the holders of Notes of such Series unless such holders
offered to the Trustee security or indemnity satisfactory to it against the
costs, expenses and liabilities which might be incurred by it in complying
with such request or direction.  Subject to such provisions for
indemnification and certain limitations contained in the Indenture, the
holders of a majority of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes
of such Series shall have the right to direct the time, method and place of
conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or
exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee with respect to the
Notes of such Series, and the holders of a majority of the then aggregate
outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series may, in certain cases, waive
any default with respect thereto, except a default in the payment of
principal or interest or a default in respect of a covenant 
or provision of the Indenture that cannot be modified without the waiver or
consent of all the holders of the outstanding Notes of such Series affected
thereby.

AMENDMENT

     Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, each
Agreement may be amended by Provident, the Master Servicer and the Trustee,
without the consent of any of the Securityholders, (i) to cure any ambiguity;
(ii) to correct or supplement any provision therein which may be defective or
inconsistent with any other provision therein; or (iii) to make any other
revisions with respect to matters or questions arising under the Agreement
which are not inconsistent with the provisions thereof, provided that such
action will not adversely affect in any material respect the interests of any
Securityholder.  An amendment will be deemed not to adversely affect in any
material respect the interests of the Securityholders if the person
requesting such amendment obtains a letter from each Rating Agency requested
to rate the class or classes of Securities of such Series stating that such
amendment will not result in the downgrading or withdrawal of the respective
ratings then assigned to such Securities.  In addition, to the extent
provided in the related Agreement, an Agreement may be amended without the
consent of any of the Securityholders to change the manner in which the
Security Account is maintained, provided that any such change does not
adversely affect the then current rating on the class or classes of
Securities of such Series that have been rated.  In addition, if a REMIC
election is made with respect to a Trust Fund, the related Agreement may be
amended to modify, eliminate or add to any of its provisions to such extent
as may be necessary to maintain the qualification of the related Trust Fund
as a REMIC, provided that the Trustee has received an opinion of counsel to
the effect that such action is necessary or helpful to maintain such
qualification. Each Agreement may also be amended by Provident, the Master
Servicer and the Trustee with consent of holders of Securities of such Series
evidencing not less than 51% of the aggregate Percentage Interests of each
class affected thereby for the purpose of adding any provisions to or
changing in an manner or eliminating any of the provisions of the Agreement
or of modifying in any manner the rights of the holders of the related
Securities; provided, however, that no such amendment may (i)
            --------  -------
reduce in any manner the amount of or delay the timing of, payments received
on Loans which are required to be distributed on any Security without the
consent of the holder of such Security, or (ii) reduce the aforesaid
percentage of Securities of any class the holders of which are required to
consent to any such amendment without the consent of the holders of all
Securities of such class covered by such Agreement then outstanding.  If a
REMIC election is made with respect to a Trust Fund, the Trustee will not be
entitled to consent to an amendment to the related Agreement without having
first received an opinion of counsel to the effect that such amendment will
not cause such Trust Fund to fail to qualify as a REMIC.

TERMINATION; OPTIONAL TERMINATION

     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Trust Agreement.  Unless otherwise
specified in the related Agreement, the obligations created by each Pooling
and Servicing Agreement and Trust Agreement for each Series of Securities
will terminate upon the payment to the related Securityholders of all amounts
held in the Security Account by the Master Servicer and required to be paid
to them pursuant to such Agreement following the later of (i) the final
payment of or other liquidation of the last of the Trust Fund Assets subject
thereto or the disposition of all property acquired upon foreclosure of any
such Trust Fund Assets remaining in the Trust Fund and (ii) the purchase by
the Master Servicer or, if REMIC treatment has been elected and if specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement, by the holder of the residual interest
in the REMIC or any other party specified to have such right (see "Federal
Income Tax Consequences" below), from the related Trust Fund of all of the
remaining Trust Fund Assets and all property acquired in respect of such
Trust Fund Assets.

     Unless otherwise specified by the related Prospectus Supplement, any
such purchase of Trust Fund Assets and property acquired in respect of Trust
Fund Assets evidenced by a Series of Securities will be made at the option of
the Master Servicer, such other person or, if applicable, such holder of the
REMIC residual interest, at a price specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  The exercise of such right will affect early retirement of the
Securities of that Series, but the right of the Master Servicer, such other
person or, if applicable, such holder of the REMIC residual interest, to so
purchase is subject to the principal balance of the related Trust Fund Assets
being less than the percentage specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
of the aggregate principal balance of the Trust Fund Assets at the Cut-Off 
Date for the Series.  The foregoing is subject to the provision that if a 
REMIC election is made with respect to a Trust Fund, any repurchase pursuant
to clause (ii) above will be made only in connection with a "qualified
liquidation" of the REMIC within the meaning of Section 860F(g)(4) of the
Code.

     Indenture.  The Indenture will be discharged with respect to a Series of
Notes (except with respect to certain continuing rights specified in the
Indenture) upon the delivery to the Trustee for cancellation of all the Notes
of such Series or, with certain limitations, upon deposit with the Trustee of
funds sufficient for the payment in full of all of the Notes of such Series.

     In addition to such discharge with certain limitations, the Indenture
will provide that, if so specified with respect to the Notes of any Series,
the related Trust Fund will be discharged from any and all obligations in
respect of the Notes of such Series (except for certain obligations relating
to temporary Notes and exchange of Notes, to register the transfer of or
exchange Notes of such Series, to replace stolen, lost or mutilated Notes of
such Series, to maintain paying agencies and to hold monies for payment in
trust) upon the deposit with the Trustee, in trust, of money and/or direct
obligations of or obligations guaranteed by the United States of America
which through the payment of interest and principal in respect thereof in
accordance with their terms will provide money in an amount sufficient to pay
the principal of and each installment of interest on the Notes of such Series
on the last scheduled Distribution Date for such Notes and any installment of
interest on such Notes in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the
Notes of such Series.  In the event of any such defeasance and discharge of
Notes of such Series, holders of Notes of such Series would be able to look
only to such money and/or direct obligations for payment of principal and
interest, if any, on their Notes until maturity.

THE TRUSTEE

     The Trustee under each Agreement will be named in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement.  The commercial bank or trust company serving as
Trustee may have normal banking relationships with Provident, the Master
Servicer and any of their respective affiliates.


                      CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS

     The following discussion contains summaries, which are general in
nature, of certain legal matters relating to the Loans.  Because such legal
aspects are governed primarily by applicable state law (which laws may differ
substantially), the descriptions do not, except as expressly provided below,
reflect the laws of any particular state, nor do they encompass the laws of
all states in which the security for the Loans is situated.  The descriptions
are qualified in their entirety by reference to the applicable federal laws
and the appropriate laws of the states in which Loans may be originated.

GENERAL

     The Loans for a Series may be secured by deeds of trust, mortgages,
security deeds or deeds to secure debt, depending upon the prevailing
practice in the state in which the property subject to the loan is located. 
Deeds of trust are used almost exclusively in California instead of
mortgages.  A mortgage creates a lien upon the real property encumbered by
the mortgage, which lien is generally not prior to the lien for real estate
taxes and assessments.  Priority between mortgages depends on their terms and
generally on the order of recording with a state or county office.  There are
two parties to a mortgage, the mortgagor, who is the borrower and owner of
the mortgaged property, and the mortgagee, who is the lender.  Under the
mortgage instrument, the mortgagor delivers to the mortgagee a note or bond
and the mortgage.  Although a deed of trust is similar to a mortgage, a deed
of trust formally has three parties, the borrower-property owner called the
trustor (similar to a mortgagor), a lender (similar to a mortgagee) called
the beneficiary, and a third-party grantee called the trustee.  Under a deed
of trust, the borrower grants the property, irrevocably until the debt is
paid, in trust, generally with a power of sale, to the trustee to secure
payment of the obligation.  A security deed and a deed to secure debt are
special types of deeds which indicate on their face that they are granted to
secure an underlying debt.  

By executing a security deed or deed to secure debt, the grantor conveys
title to, as opposed to merely creating a lien upon, the subject property to
the grantee until such time as the underlying debt is repaid.  The trustee's
authority under a deed of trust, the mortgagee's authority under a mortgage
and the grantee's authority under a security deed or deed to secure debt are
governed by law and, with respect to some deeds of trust, the directions of
the beneficiary.

FORECLOSURE/REPOSSESSION

     Deed of Trust.  Foreclosure of a deed of trust is generally accomplished
by a non-judicial sale under a specific provision in the deed of trust which
authorizes the trustee to sell the property at public auction upon any
default by the borrower under the terms of the note or deed of trust.  In
certain states, such foreclosure also may be accomplished by judicial action
in the manner provided for foreclosure of mortgages.  In addition to any
notice requirements contained in a deed of trust, in some states (such as
California), the trustee must record a notice of default and send a copy to
the borrower-trustor, to any person who has recorded a request for a copy of
any notice of default and notice of sale, to any successor in interest to the
borrower-trustor, to the beneficiary of any junior deed of trust and to
certain other persons.  In some states (including California), the borrower-
trustor has the right to reinstate the loan at any time following default
until shortly before the trustee's sale.  In general, the borrower, or any
other person having a junior encumbrance on the real estate, may, during a
statutorily prescribed reinstatement period, cure a monetary default by
paying the entire amount in arrears plus other designated costs and expenses
incurred in enforcing the obligation.  Generally, state law controls the
amount of foreclosure expenses and costs, including attorney's fees, which
may be recovered by a lender.  After the reinstatement period has expired
without the default having been cured, the borrower or junior lienholder no
longer has the right to reinstate the loan and must pay the loan in full to
prevent the scheduled foreclosure sale.  If the deed of trust is not
reinstated within any applicable cure period, a notice of sale must be posted
in a public place and, in most states (including California), published for a
specific period of time in one or more newspapers.  In addition, some state
laws require that a copy of the notice of sale be posted on the property and
sent to all parties having an interest of record in the real property.  In
California, the entire process from recording a notice of default to a non-
judicial sale usually takes four to five months.

     Mortgages.  Foreclosure of a mortgage is generally accomplished by
judicial action.  The action is initiated by the service of legal pleadings
upon all parties having an interest in the real property.  Delays in
completion of the foreclosure may occasionally result from difficulties in
locating necessary parties.  Judicial foreclosure proceedings are often not
contested by any of the parties.  When the mortgagee's right to foreclosure
is contested, the legal proceedings necessary to resolve the issue can be
time consuming.  After the completion of a judicial foreclosure proceeding,
the court generally issues a judgment of foreclosure and appoints a referee
or other court officer to conduct the sale of the property.  In some states,
mortgages may also be foreclosed by advertisement, pursuant to a power of
sale provided in the mortgage.

     Although foreclosure sales are typically public sales, frequently no
third party purchaser bids in excess of the lender's lien because of the
difficulty of determining the exact status of title to the property, the
possible deterioration of the property during the foreclosure proceedings and
a requirement that the purchaser pay for the property in cash or by cashier's
check.  Thus the foreclosing lender often purchases the property from the
trustee or referee for an amount equal to the principal amount outstanding
under the loan, accrued and unpaid interest and the expenses of foreclosure
in which event the mortgagor's debt will be extinguished or the lender may
purchase for a lesser amount in order to preserve its right against a
borrower to seek a deficiency judgment in states where such judgment is
available.  Thereafter, subject to the right of the borrower in some states
to remain in possession during the redemption period, the lender will assume
the burden of ownership, including obtaining hazard insurance and making such
repairs at its own expense as are necessary to render the property suitable
for sale.  The lender will commonly obtain the services of a real estate
broker and pay the broker's commission in connection with the sale of the
property.  Depending upon market conditions, the ultimate proceeds of the
sale of the property may not equal the lender's investment in the property. 
Any loss may be reduced by the receipt of any mortgage guaranty insurance
proceeds.

     Courts have imposed general equitable principles upon foreclosure, which
are generally designed to mitigate the legal consequences to the borrower of
the borrower's defaults under the loan documents.  Some courts have been
faced with the issue of whether federal or state constitutional provisions
reflecting due process concerns for fair notice require that borrowers under
deeds of trust receive notice longer than that prescribed by statute. For the
most part, these cases have upheld the notice provisions as being reasonable
or have found that the sale by a trustee under a deed of trust does not
involve sufficient state action to afford constitutional protection to the
borrower.

     When the beneficiary under a junior mortgage or deed of trust cures the
default and reinstates or redeems by paying the full amount of the senior
mortgage or deed of trust, the amount paid by the beneficiary so to cure or
redeem becomes a part of the indebtedness secured by the junior mortgage or
deed of trust.  See "Junior Mortgages; Rights of Senior Mortgagees" below.

ENVIRONMENTAL RISKS

     Real property pledged as security to a lender may be subject to
unforeseen environmental risks.  Under the laws of certain states,
contamination of a property may give rise to a lien on the property to assure
the payment of the costs of clean-up.  In several states such a lien has
priority over the lien of an existing mortgage against such property.  In
addition, under CERCLA, the United States Environmental Protection Agency
("EPA") may impose a lien on property where EPA has incurred clean-up costs. 
However, a CERCLA lien is subordinate to pre-existing, perfected security
interests.

     Under the laws of some states and under CERCLA, it is conceivable that a
secured lender may be held liable as an "owner" or "operator" for the costs
of addressing releases or threatened releases of hazardous substances at a
property, even though the environmental damage or threat was caused by a
prior or current owner or operator.  CERCLA imposes liability for such costs
on any and all "responsible parties," including owners or operators.  How-
ever, CERCLA excludes from the definition of "owner or operator" a secured
creditor who holds indicia of ownership primarily to protect its security
interest but without "participating in the management" of the Property (the
"Secured Creditor Exclusion").  Thus, if a lender's activities begin to
encroach on the actual management of a contaminated facility or property, the
lender may incur liability as an "owner or operator" under CERCLA. Similarly,
if a lender forecloses and takes title to a contaminated facility or
property, the lender may incur CERCLA liability in various circumstances,
including, but not limited to, when it holds the facility or property as an
investment (including leasing the facility or property to third party) or
fails to market the property in a timely fashion.

     Whether actions taken by a lender would constitute participation in the
management of a mortgaged property or the business of a borrower so as to
render the secured creditor exemption unavailable to a lender has been a
matter of judicial interpretation of the statutory language, and court
decisions have been inconsistent.  In 1990, the Court of Appeals for the
Eleventh Circuit suggested that the mere capacity of the lender to influence
a borrower's decisions regarding disposal of hazardous substances was
sufficient participation in the management of the borrower's business to deny
the protection of the Secured Creditor Exclusion to the lender.

     This ambiguity appears to have been resolved by the enactment of the
Asset Conservation, Lender Liability and Deposit Insurance Protection Act of
1996, which was signed into law by President Clinton on September 30, 1996. 
The new legislation provides that in order to be deemed to have participated
in the management of a mortgaged property, a lender must actually participate
in the operational affairs of the property or the borrower.  The legislation
also provides that participation in the management of the property does not
include "merely having the capacity to influence, or unexercised right to
control" operations.  Rather, a lender will lose the protection of the
Secured Creditor Exclusion only if it exercises decision-making control over
the borrower's environmental compliance and hazardous substance handling and
disposal practices, or assumes day-to-day management of all operational
functions of the mortgaged property.    If a lender is or becomes liable, it
can bring an action for contribution against any other "responsible parties,"
including a previous owner or operator, who created the environmental hazard,
but those persons or entities may be bankrupt or otherwise judgment proof. 
The costs associated with environmental cleanup may be substantial.  It 
is conceivable that such costs arising from the circumstances set forth above
would result in a loss to Securityholders.

     CERCLA does not apply to petroleum products, and the Secured Creditor
Exclusion does not govern liability for cleanup costs under federal laws
other than CERCLA, in particular Subtitle I of the federal Resource
Conservation and Recovery Act ("RCRA"), which regulates underground petroleum
storage tanks (except heating oil tanks).  The EPA has adopted a lender
liability rule for underground storage tanks under Subtitle I of RCRA.  Under
such rule, a holder of a security interest in an underground storage tank or
real property containing an underground storage tank is not considered an
operator of the underground storage tank as long as petroleum is not added
to, stored in or dispensed from the tank.  In addition, under the Asset
Conservation, Lender Liability and Deposit Insurance Protection Act of 1996,
the protections accorded to lenders under CERCLA are also accorded to the
holders of security interests in underground storage tanks.  Liability for
cleanup of petroleum contamination may, however, be governed by state law,
which may not provide for any specific protection for secured creditors.

     Except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, at
the time the Loans were originated, no environmental assessments or very
limited environmental assessments of the Properties were conducted.

RIGHTS OF REDEMPTION

     In some states, after sale pursuant to a deed of trust or foreclosure of
a mortgage, the borrower and foreclosed junior lienors are given a statutory
period in which to redeem the property from the foreclosure sale.  In certain
other states (including California), this right of redemption applies only to
sales following judicial foreclosure and not to sales pursuant to a non-
judicial power of sale.  In most states where the right of redemption is
available, statutory redemption may occur upon payment of the foreclosure
purchase price, accrued interest and taxes.  In other states, redemption may
be authorized if the former borrower pays only a portion of the sums due. 
The effect of a statutory right of redemption is to diminish the ability of
the lender to sell the foreclosed property.  The exercise of a right of
redemption would defeat the title of any purchaser from the lender subsequent
to foreclosure or sale under a deed of trust.  Consequently, the practical
effect of the redemption right is to force the lender to retain the property
and pay the expenses of ownership until the redemption period has run.  In
some states, there is no right to redeem property after a trustee's sale
under a deed of trust.

ANTI-DEFICIENCY LEGISLATION; BANKRUPTCY LAWS; TAX LIENS

     Certain states have imposed statutory and judicial restrictions that
limit the remedies of a beneficiary under a deed of trust or a mortgagee
under a mortgage.  In some states, including California, statutes and case
law limit the right of the beneficiary or mortgagee to obtain a deficiency
judgment against borrowers financing the purchase of their residence or
following sale under a deed of trust or certain other foreclosure
proceedings.  A deficiency judgment is a personal judgment against the
borrower equal in most cases to the difference between the amount due to the
lender and the fair market value of the real property at the time of the
foreclosure sale.  As a result of these prohibitions, it is anticipated that
in most instances the Master Servicer will utilize the non-judicial
foreclosure remedy and will not seek deficiency judgments against defaulting
borrowers.  

     Some state statutes require the beneficiary or mortgagee to exhaust the
security afforded under a deed of trust or mortgage by foreclosure in an
attempt to satisfy the full debt before bringing a personal action against
the borrower.  In certain other states, the lender has the option of bringing
a personal action against the borrower on the debt without first exhausting
such security; however, in some of these states, the lender, following
judgment on such personal action, may be deemed to have elected a remedy and
may be precluded from exercising remedies with respect to the security. 
Consequently, the practical effect of the election requirement, when
applicable, is that lenders will usually proceed first against the security
rather than bringing a personal action against the borrower.  In some states,
exceptions to the anti-deficiency statutes are provided for in certain
instances where the value of the lender's security has been impaired by acts
or omissions of the borrower, for example, in the event of waste of the 
property.  Finally, other statutory provisions limit any deficiency 
judgment against the former borrower following a foreclosure sale to 
the excess of the outstanding debt over the fair market value of the 
property at the time of the public sale.  The purpose of these statutes 
is generally to prevent a beneficiary or a mortgagee from obtaining a 
large deficiency judgment against the former borrower as a result of 
low or no bids at the foreclosure sale.  

     In addition to anti-deficiency and related legislation, numerous other
federal and state statutory provisions, including the federal bankruptcy laws
and state laws affording relief to debtors, may interfere with or affect the
ability of the secured mortgage lender to realize upon its security.  For
example, in a proceeding under the federal Bankruptcy Code, a lender may not
foreclose on a mortgaged property without the permission of the bankruptcy
court.  The rehabilitation plan proposed by the debtor may provide, if the
mortgaged property is not the debtor's principal residence and the court
determines that the value of the mortgaged property is less than the
principal balance of the mortgage loan, for the reduction of the secured
indebtedness to the value of the mortgaged property as of the date of the
commencement of the bankruptcy, rendering the lender a general unsecured
creditor for the difference, and also may reduce the monthly payments due
under such mortgage loan, change the rate of interest and alter the mortgage
loan repayment schedule.  The effect of any such proceedings under the
federal Bankruptcy Code, including but not limited to any automatic stay,
could result in delays in receiving payments on the Loans underlying a Series
of Securities and possible reductions in the aggregate amount of such
payments.

     The federal tax laws provide priority to certain tax liens over the lien
of a mortgage or secured party.  


DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES

     Each conventional Loan generally will contain a due-on-sale clause which
will generally provide that if the mortgagor or obligor sells, transfers or
conveys the Property, the Loan or contract may be accelerated by the
mortgagee or secured party.  Court decisions and legislative actions have
placed substantial restrictions on the right of lenders to enforce such
clauses in many states.  For instance, the California Supreme Court in August
1978 held that due-on-sale clauses were generally unenforceable.  However,
the Garn-St Germain Depository Institutions Act of 1982 (the "Garn-St Germain
Act"), subject to certain exceptions, preempts state constitutional,
statutory and case law prohibiting the enforcement of due-on-sale clauses. 
As a result, due-on-sale clauses are generally enforceable except in those
states whose legislatures exercised their authority to regulate the
enforceability of such clauses  with respect to mortgage loans that were (i)
originated or assumed during the "window period" under the Garn-St Germain
Act which ended in all cases not later than October 15, 1982, and (ii)
originated by lenders other than national banks, federal savings institutions
and federal credit unions.  FHLMC has taken the position in its published
mortgage servicing standards that, out of a total of eleven "window period
states," five states (Arizona, Michigan, Minnesota, New Mexico and Utah) have
enacted statutes extending, on various terms and for varying periods, the
prohibition on enforcement of due-on-sale clauses with respect to certain
categories of "window period loans".  Also, the Garn-St Germain Act does
"encourage" lenders to permit assumption of loans at the original rate of
interest or at some other rate less than the average of the original rate and
the market rate.

     As to loans secured by an owner-occupied residence, the Garn-St Germain
Act sets forth nine specific instances in which a mortgagee covered by the
Act may not exercise its rights under a due-on-sale clause, notwithstanding
the fact that a transfer of the property may have occurred.  The inability to
enforce a due-on-sale clause may result in transfer of the related Property
to an uncreditworthy person, which could increase the likelihood of default
or may result in a mortgage bearing an interest rate below the current market
rate being assumed by a new home buyer, which may affect the average life of
the Loans and the number of Loans which may extend to maturity.

     In addition, under federal bankruptcy law, due-on-sale clauses may not
be enforceable in bankruptcy proceedings and may, under certain
circumstances, be eliminated in any modified mortgage resulting from such
bankruptcy proceeding.


ENFORCEABILITY OF PREPAYMENT AND LATE PAYMENT FEES

     Forms of notes, mortgages and deeds of trust used by lenders may contain
provisions obligating the borrower to pay a late charge if payments are not
timely made, and in some circumstances may provide for prepayment fees or
penalties if the obligation is paid prior to maturity.  In certain states,
there are or may be specific limitations upon the late charges which a lender
may collect from a borrower for delinquent payments.  Certain states also
limit the amounts that a lender may collect from a borrower as an additional
charge if the loan is prepaid.  Under certain state laws, prepayment charges
may not be imposed after a certain period of time following the origination
of mortgage loans with respect to prepayments on loans secured by liens
encumbering owner-occupied residential properties.  Since many of the
Properties will be owner-occupied, it is anticipated that prepayment charges
may not be imposed with respect to many of the Loans.  The absence of such a
restraint on prepayment, particularly with respect to fixed rate Loans having
higher Loan Rates, may increase the likelihood of refinancing or other early
retirement of such Loans or contracts.  Late charges and prepayment fees are
typically retained by servicers as additional servicing compensation.

APPLICABILITY OF USURY LAWS


     Title V of the Depository Institutions Deregulation and Monetary Control
Act of 1980 ("Title V") provides that state usury limitations shall not apply
to certain types of residential first mortgage loans originated by certain
lenders after March 31, 1980.  The Office of Thrift Supervision, as successor
to the Federal Home Loan Bank Board, is authorized to issue rules and
regulations and to publish interpretations governing implementation of Title
V.  Title V authorized the states to reimpose interest rate limits by
adopting, before April 1, 1983, a law or constitutional provision which
expressly rejects application of the federal law.  Fifteen states adopted
such a law prior to the April 1, 1983 deadline.  In addition, even where
Title V was not so rejected, any state is authorized by the law to adopt a
provision limiting discount points or other charges on mortgage loans covered
by Title V.  Certain states have taken action to reimpose interest rate
limits and/or to limit discount points or other charges.

SOLDIERS' AND SAILORS' CIVIL RELIEF ACT

     Generally, under the terms of the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief
Act of 1940, as amended (the "Relief Act"), a borrower who enters military
service after the origination of such borrower's Loan (including a borrower
who is a member of the National Guard or is in reserve status at the time of
the origination of the Loan and is later called to active duty) may not be
charged interest above an annual rate of 6% during the period of such
borrower's active duty status, unless a court orders otherwise upon
application of the lender.  It is possible that such interest rate limitation
could have an effect, for an indeterminate period of time, on the ability of
the Master Servicer to collect full amounts of interest on certain of the
Loans.  Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
shortfall in interest collections resulting from the application of the
Relief Act could result in losses to Securityholders.  The Relief Act also
imposes limitations which would impair the ability of the Master Servicer to
foreclose on an affected Loan during the borrower's period of active duty
status.  Moreover, the Relief Act permits the extension of a Loan's maturity
and the re-adjustment of its payment schedule beyond the completion of
military service.  Thus, in the event that such a Loan goes into default,
there may be delays and losses occasioned by the inability to realize upon
the Property in a timely fashion.

JUNIOR MORTGAGES; RIGHTS OF SENIOR MORTGAGEES

     To the extent that the Loans comprising the Trust Fund for a Series are
secured by mortgages which are junior to other mortgages held by other
lenders or institutional investors, the rights of the Trust Fund (and
therefore the Securityholders) as mortgagee under any such junior mortgage
are subordinate to those of any mortgagee under any senior mortgage.  The
senior mortgagee has the right to receive hazard insurance and condemnation
proceeds and to cause the property securing the Loan to be sold upon default
of the mortgagor, thereby extinguishing the junior mortgagee's lien unless
the junior mortgagee asserts its subordinate interest in the property in
foreclosure litigation and, possibly, satisfies the defaulted senior
mortgage.  A junior mortgagee may satisfy a defaulted senior loan in full
and, in some states, may cure a default and bring the senior loan 
current, in either event adding the amounts expended to the balance due on
the junior loan.  In most states, absent a provision in the mortgage or deed
of trust, no notice of default is required to be given to a junior mortgagee.

     The standard form of the mortgage used by most institutional lenders
confers on the mortgagee the right both to receive all proceeds collected
under any hazard insurance policy and all awards made in connection with
condemnation proceedings, and to apply such proceeds and awards to any
indebtedness secured by the mortgage, in such order as the mortgagee may
determine.  Thus, in the event improvements on the property are damaged or
destroyed by fire or other casualty, or in the event the property is taken by
condemnation, the mortgagee or beneficiary under a senior mortgage will have
the prior right to collect any insurance proceeds payable under a hazard
insurance policy and any award of damages in connection with the condemnation
and to apply the same to the indebtedness secured by the senior mortgage. 
Proceeds in excess of the amount of senior mortgage indebtedness, in most
cases, may be applied to the indebtedness of a junior mortgage.

     Another provision sometimes found in the form of the mortgage or deed of
trust used by institutional lenders obligates the mortgagor to pay before
delinquency all taxes and assessments on the property and, when due, all
encumbrances, charges and liens on the property which appear prior to the
mortgage or deed of trust, to provide and maintain fire insurance on the
property, to maintain and repair the property and not to commit or permit any
waste thereof, and to appear in and defend any action or proceeding
purporting to affect the property or the rights of the mortgagee under the
mortgage.  Upon a failure of the mortgagor to perform any of these
obligations, the mortgagee is given the right under certain mortgages to
perform the obligation itself, at its election, with the mortgagor
reimbursing the mortgagee for any sums expended by the mortgagee on behalf of
the mortgagor.  All sums so expended by the mortgagee become part of the
indebtedness secured by the mortgage.

     The form of credit line trust deed or mortgage generally used by most
institutional lenders which make Revolving Credit Line Loans typically
contains a "future advance" clause, which provides, in essence, that
additional amounts advanced to or on behalf of the borrower by the
beneficiary or lender are to be secured by the deed of trust or mortgage. 
Any amounts so advanced after the Cut-Off Date with respect to any Mortgage
will not be included in the Trust Fund.  The priority of the lien securing
any advance made under the clause may depend in most states on whether the
deed of trust or mortgage is called and recorded as a credit line deed of
trust or mortgage.  If the beneficiary or lender advances additional amounts,
the advance is entitled to receive the same priority as amounts initially
advanced under the trust deed or mortgage, notwithstanding the fact that
there may be junior trust deeds or mortgages and other liens which intervene
between the date of recording of the trust deed or mortgage and the date of
the future advance, and notwithstanding that the beneficiary or lender had
actual knowledge of such intervening junior trust deeds or mortgages and
other liens at the time of the advance.  In most states, the trust deed or
mortgage lien securing mortgage loans of the type which includes home equity
credit lines applies retroactively to the date of the original recording of
the trust deed or mortgage, provided that the total amount of advances under
the home equity credit line does not exceed the maximum specified principal
amount of the recorded trust deed or mortgage and except as to advances made
after receipt by the lender of a written notice of lien from a judgment lien
creditor of the trustor.

CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS

     Numerous federal and state consumer protection laws impose substantive
requirements upon mortgage lenders in connection with originating, servicing
and enforcing loans secured by Single Family Properties.  These laws include
the federal Truth-in-Lending Act and Regulation Z promulgated thereunder,
Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act and Regulation B promulgated
thereunder, Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Fair Credit Billing Act, Fair
Credit Reporting Act and related statutes and regulations.  In particular,
Regulation Z requires certain disclosures to borrowers regarding terms of the
Loans; the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and Regulation B promulgated
thereunder prohibit discrimination in the extension of credit on the basis of
age, race, color, sex, religion, marital status, national origin, receipt of
public assistance or the exercise of any right under the Consumer Credit
Protection Act; and the Fair Credit Reporting Act regulates the use and
reporting of information related to the borrower's credit experience. 
Certain provisions of these laws impose specific statutory liabilities upon
lenders who fail to comply therewith.  In addition, violations of such laws
may limit the ability of Provident to collect all or part of the principal of
or interest on the Loans and could subject Provident and in some cases its
assignees to damages and administrative enforcement.


                       FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

GENERAL

     The following is a summary of the anticipated material federal income
tax consequences of the purchase, ownership, and disposition of the
Securities and is based on advice of Brown & Wood LLP, special counsel to
Provident.  The summary is based upon the provisions of the Code, the
regulations promulgated thereunder, including, where applicable, proposed
regulations, and the judicial and administrative rulings and decisions now in
effect, all of which are subject to change or possible differing
interpretations.  The statutory provisions, regulations, and interpretations
on which this interpretation is based are subject to change, and such a
change could apply retroactively.

     The summary does not purport to deal with all aspects of federal income
taxation that may affect particular investors in light of their individual
circumstances, nor with certain types of investors subject to special
treatment under the federal income tax laws.  This summary focuses primarily
upon investors who will hold Securities as "capital assets" (generally,
property held for investment) within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code,
but much of the discussion is applicable to other investors as well. 
Prospective investors are advised to consult their own tax advisers
concerning the federal, state, local and any other tax consequences to them
of the purchase, ownership and disposition of the Securities.

     The federal income tax consequences to Holders will vary depending on
whether (i) the Securities of a Series are classified as indebtedness; (ii)
an election is made to treat the Trust Fund relating to a particular Series
of Securities as a REMIC under the Code; (iii) the Securities represent an
ownership interest in some or all of the assets included in the Trust Fund
for a Series; or (iv) an election is made to treat the Trust Fund relating to
a particular Series of Certificates as a partnership.  The Prospectus
Supplement for each Series of Securities will specify how the Securities will
be treated for federal income tax purposes and will discuss whether a REMIC
election, if any, will be made with respect to such Series.  Prior to
issuance of each Series of Securities, Provident shall file with the
Commission a Form 8-K on behalf of the related Trust Fund containing an
opinion of Brown & Wood LLP with respect to the validity of the information
set forth under "Federal Income Tax Consequences" herein and in the related
Prospectus Supplement.

TAXATION OF DEBT SECURITIES

     Status as Real Property Loans.  Except to the extent otherwise provided
in the related Prospectus Supplement, Brown & Wood LLP will have advised
Provident that:  (i) Securities held by a domestic building and loan
association will constitute "loans... secured by an interest in real
property" within the meaning of Code section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v); and (ii)
Securities held by a real estate investment trust will constitute "real
estate assets" within the meaning of Code section 856(c)(5)(A) and interest
on such Securities will be considered "interest on obligations secured by
mortgages on real property or on interests in real property" within the
meaning of Code section 856(c)(3)(B).

     The Small Business Job Protection Act of 1996, as part of the repeal of
the bad debt reserve method for thrift institutions, repealed the application
of Code section 593(d) to any taxable year beginning after December 31, 1995.

     Interest and Acquisition Discount.  Securities representing regular
interests in a REMIC ("Regular Interest Securities") are generally taxable to
Holders in the same manner as evidences of indebtedness issued by the REMIC. 
Stated interest on the Regular Interest Securities will be taxable as
ordinary income and taken into account using the accrual method of
accounting, regardless of the Holder's normal accounting method.  Interest
(other than original issue discount) on Securities (other than Regular
Interest Securities) that are characterized as 
indebtedness for federal income tax purposes will be includible in income by
Holders thereof in accordance with their usual methods of accounting. 
Securities characterized as debt for federal income tax purposes and Regular
Interest Securities will be referred to hereinafter collectively as "Debt
Securities."

     Debt Securities that are Compound Interest Securities will, and certain
of the other Debt Securities may, be issued with "original issue discount"
("OID").  The following discussion is based in part on the rules governing
OID which are set forth in Sections 1271-1275 of the Code and the Treasury
regulations issued thereunder on February 2, 1994 (the "OID Regulations").  A
Holder should be aware, however, that the OID Regulations do not adequately
address certain issues relevant to prepayable securities, such as the Debt
Securities.

     In general, OID, if any, will equal the difference between the stated
redemption price at maturity of a Debt Security and its issue price.  A
Holder of a Debt Security must include such OID in gross income as ordinary
interest income as it accrues under a method taking into account an economic
accrual of the discount.  In general, OID must be included in income in
advance of the receipt of the cash representing that income.  The amount of
OID on a Debt Security will be considered to be zero if it is less than a de
minimis amount determined under the Code.

     The issue price of a Debt Security is the first price at which a
substantial amount of Debt Securities of that class are sold to the public
(excluding bond houses, brokers, underwriters or wholesalers).  If less than
a substantial amount of a particular class of Debt Securities is sold for
cash on or prior to the related Closing Date, the issue price for such class
will be treated as the fair market value of such class on such Closing Date. 
The issue price of a Debt Security also includes the amount paid by an
initial Debt Security Holder for accrued interest that relates to a period
prior to the issue date of the Debt Security.  The stated redemption price at
maturity of a Debt Security includes the original principal amount of the
Debt Security, but generally will not include distributions of interest if
such distributions constitute "qualified stated interest."

     Under the OID Regulations, qualified stated interest generally means
interest payable at a single fixed rate or qualified variable rate (as
described below) provided that such interest payments are unconditionally
payable at intervals of one year or less during the entire term of the Debt
Security.  The OID Regulations state that interest payments are
unconditionally payable only if a late payment or nonpayment is expected to
be penalized or reasonable remedies exist to compel payment.  Certain Debt
Securities may provide for default remedies in the event of late payment or
nonpayment of interest.  The interest on such Debt Securities will be
unconditionally payable and constitute qualified stated interest, not OID. 
However, absent clarification of the OID Regulations, where Debt Securities
do not provide for default remedies, the interest payments will be included
in the Debt Security's stated redemption price at maturity and taxed as OID. 
Interest is payable at a single fixed rate only if the rate appropriately
takes into account the length of the interval between payments. 
Distributions of interest on Debt Securities with respect to which deferred
interest will accrue, will not constitute qualified stated interest payments,
in which case the stated redemption price at maturity of such Debt Securities
includes all distributions of interest as well as principal thereon.  Where
the interval between the issue date and the first Distribution Date on a Debt
Security is either longer or shorter than the interval between subsequent
Distribution Dates, all or part of the interest foregone, in the case of the
longer interval, and all of the additional interest, in the case of the
shorter interval, will be included in the stated redemption price at maturity
and tested under the de minimis rule described below.  In the case of a Debt
Security with a long first period which has non-de minimis OID, all stated
interest in excess of interest payable at the effective interest rate for the
long first period will be included in the stated redemption price at maturity
and the Debt Security will generally have OID.  Holders of Debt Securities
should consult their own tax advisors to determine the issue price and stated
redemption price at maturity of a Debt Security.

     Under the de minimis rule, OID on a Debt Security will be considered to
be zero if such OID is less than 0.25% of the stated redemption price at
maturity of the Debt Security multiplied by the weighted average maturity of
the Debt Security.  For this purpose, the weighted average maturity of the
Debt Security is computed as the sum of the amounts determined by multiplying
the number of full years (i.e., rounding down partial years) from the issue
date until each distribution in reduction of stated redemption price at
maturity is scheduled to be made by a fraction, the numerator of which is the 
amount of each distribution included in the stated redemption price at 
maturity of the Debt Security and the denominator of which is the stated 
redemption price at maturity of the Debt Security.  Holders generally must 
report de minimis OID pro rata as principal payments are received, and such 
income will be capital gain if the Debt Security is held as a capital 
asset.  However, accrual method Holders may elect to accrue all de minimis 
OID as well as market discount under a constant interest method.

     Debt Securities may provide for interest based on a qualified variable
rate.  Under the OID Regulations, interest is treated as payable at a
qualified variable rate and not as contingent interest if, generally, (i)
such interest is unconditionally payable at least annually, (ii) the issue
price of the debt instrument does not exceed the total noncontingent
principal payments and (iii) interest is based on a "qualified floating
rate," an "objective rate," or a combination of "qualified floating rates"
that do not operate in a manner that significantly accelerates or defers
interest payments on such Debt Security.  In the case of Compound Interest
Securities, certain Interest Weighted Securities (as defined herein under "--
Interest Weighted Securities"), and certain of the other Debt Securities,
none of the payments under the instrument will be considered qualified stated
interest, and thus the aggregate amount of all payments will be included in
the stated redemption price.

     The Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS") recently issued final
regulations (the "Contingent Regulations") governing the calculation of OID
on instruments having contingent interest payments.  The Contingent
Regulations specifically do not apply for purposes of calculating OID on debt
instruments subject to Code Section 1272(a)(6), such as the Debt Security. 
Additionally, the OID Regulations do not contain provisions specifically
interpreting Code Section 1272(a)(6).  Until the Treasury issues guidance to
the contrary, the Trustee intends to base its computation on Code Section
1272(a)(6) and the OID Regulations as described in this Prospectus.  However,
because no regulatory guidance currently exists under Code Section
1272(a)(6), there can be no assurance that such methodology represents the
correct manner of calculating OID.

     The Holder of a Debt Security issued with OID must include in gross
income, for all days during its taxable year on which it holds such Debt
Security, the sum of the "daily portions" of such OID.  The amount of OID
includible in income by a Holder will be computed by allocating to each day
during a taxable year a pro rata portion of the OID that accrued during the
relevant accrual period.  In the case of a Debt Security that is not a
Regular Interest Security and the principal payments on which are not subject
to acceleration resulting from prepayments on the Loans, the amount of OID
includible in income of a Holder for an accrual period (generally the period
over which interest accrues on the debt instrument) will equal the product of
the yield to maturity of the Debt Security and the adjusted issue price of
the Debt Security, reduced by any payments of qualified stated interest.  The
adjusted issue price is the sum of its issue price plus prior accruals or
OID, reduced by the total payments made with respect to such Debt Security in
all prior periods, other than qualified stated interest payments.

     The amount of OID to be included in income by a Holder of a debt
instrument, such as certain Classes of the Debt Securities, that is subject
to acceleration due to prepayments on other debt obligations securing such
instruments (a "Pay-Through Security"), is computed by taking into account
the anticipated rate of prepayments assumed in pricing the debt instrument
(the "Prepayment Assumption").  The amount of OID that will accrue during an
accrual period on a Pay-Through Security is the excess (if any) of the sum of
(a) the present value of all payments remaining to be made on the Pay-Through
Security as of the close of the accrual period and (b) the payments during
the accrual period of amounts included in the stated redemption price of the
Pay-Through Security, over the adjusted issue price of the Pay-Through
Security at the beginning of the accrual period.  The present value of the
remaining payments is to be determined on the basis of three factors:  (i)
the original yield to maturity of the Pay-Through Security (determined on the
basis of compounding at the end of each accrual period and properly adjusted
for the length of the accrual period), (ii) events which have occurred before
the end of the accrual period and (iii) the assumption that the remaining
payments will be made in accordance with the original Prepayment Assumption. 
The effect of this method is to increase the portions of OID required to be
included in income by a Holder to take into account prepayments with respect
to the Loans at a rate that exceeds the Prepayment Assumption, and to
decrease (but not below zero for any period) the portions of OID required to
be included in income by a Holder of a Pay-Through Security to take into
account prepayments with respect to the Loans at a rate that is slower than 
the Prepayment Assumption.  Although OID will be reported to Holders of 
Pay-Through Securities based on the Prepayment Assumption, no representation 
is made to Holders that Loans will be prepaid at that rate or at any other 
rate.

     Provident may adjust the accrual of OID on a Class of Regular Interest
Securities (or other regular interests in a REMIC) in a manner that it
believes to be appropriate to take account of realized losses on the Loans,
although the OID Regulations do not provide for such adjustments.  If the IRS
were to require that OID be accrued without such adjustments, the rate of
accrual of OID for a Class of Regular Interest Securities could increase.

     Certain classes of Regular Interest Securities may represent more than
one class of REMIC regular interests.  Unless otherwise provided in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee intends, based on the OID
Regulations, to calculate OID on such Securities as if, solely for the
purposes of computing OID, the separate regular interests were a single debt
instrument.

     A subsequent Holder of a Debt Security will also be required to include
OID in gross income, but such a Holder who purchases such Debt Security for
an amount that exceeds its adjusted issue price will be entitled (as will an
initial Holder who pays more than a Debt Security's issue price) to offset
such OID by comparable economic accruals of portions of such excess.

     Effects of Defaults and Delinquencies.  Holders will be required to
report income with respect to the related Securities under an accrual method
without giving effect to delays and reductions in distributions attributable
to a default or delinquency on the Loans, except possibly to the extent that
it can be established that such amounts are uncollectible.  As a result, the
amount of income (including OID) reported by a Holder of such a Security in
any period could significantly exceed the amount of cash distributed to such
Holder in that period.  The Holder will eventually be allowed a loss (or will
be allowed to report a lesser amount of income) to the extent that the
aggregate amount of distributions on the Securities is deducted as a result
of a Loan default.  However, the timing and character of such losses or
reductions in income are uncertain and, accordingly, Holders of Securities
should consult their own tax advisors on this point.

     Interest Weighted Securities.  It is not clear how income should be
accrued with respect to Regular Interest Securities or Stripped Securities
(as defined under "--Tax Status as a Grantor Trust; General" herein) the
payments on which consist solely or primarily of a specified portion of the
interest payments on qualified mortgages held by the REMIC or on Loans
underlying Pass-Through Securities ("Interest Weighted Securities").  The
Issuer intends to take the position that all of the income derived from an
Interest Weighted Security should be treated as OID and that the amount and
rate of accrual of such OID should be calculated by treating the Interest
Weighted Security as a Compound Interest Security.  However, in the case of
Interest Weighted Securities that are entitled to some payments of principal
and that are Regular Interest Securities, the IRS could assert that income
derived from an Interest Weighted Security should be calculated as if the
Security were a security purchased at a premium equal to the excess of the
price paid by such Holder for such Security over its stated principal amount,
if any.  Under this approach, a Holder would be entitled to amortize such
premium only if it has in effect an election under Section 171 of the Code
with respect to all taxable debt instruments held by such Holder, as
described below.  Alternatively, the IRS could assert that an Interest
Weighted Security should be taxable under the rules governing bonds issued
with contingent payments.  Such treatment may be more likely in the case of
Interest Weighted Securities that are Stripped Securities as described below. 
See "--Tax Status as a Grantor Trust; Discount or Premium on Pass-Through
Securities."

     Variable Rate Debt Securities.  In the case of Debt Securities bearing
interest at a rate that varies directly, according to a fixed formula, with
an objective index, it appears that (i) the yield to maturity of such Debt
Securities and (ii) in the case of Pay-Through Securities, the present value
of all payments remaining to be made on such Debt Securities, should be
calculated as if the interest index remained at its value as of the issue
date of such Securities.  Because the proper method of adjusting accruals of
OID on a variable rate Debt Security is uncertain, Holders of variable rate
Debt Securities should consult their own tax advisers regarding the
appropriate treatment of such Securities for federal income tax purposes.

     Market Discount.  A purchaser of a Security may be subject to the market
discount rules of Sections 1276-1278 of the Code.  A Holder that acquires a
Debt Security with more than a prescribed de minimis amount of "market
discount" (generally, the excess of the principal amount of the Debt Security
over the purchaser's purchase price) will be required to include accrued
market discount in income as ordinary income in each month, but limited to an
amount not exceeding the principal payments on the Debt Security received in
that month and, if the Securities are sold, the gain realized.  Such market
discount would accrue in a manner to be provided in Treasury regulations but,
until such regulations are issued, such market discount would in general
accrue either (i) on the basis of a constant yield (in the case of a
Pay-Through Security, taking into account a prepayment assumption) or (ii) in
the ratio of (a) in the case of Securities (or in the case of a Pass-Through
Security (as defined herein under "--Tax Status as a Grantor Trust"), as set
forth below, the Loans underlying such Security) not originally issued with
OID, stated interest payable in the relevant period to total stated interest
remaining to be paid at the beginning of the period or (b) in the case of
Securities (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below,
the Loans underlying such Security) originally issued at a discount, OID in
the relevant period to total OID remaining to be paid.

     Section 1277 of the Code provides that, regardless of the origination
date of the Debt Security (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, the
Loans), the excess of interest paid or accrued to purchase or carry a
Security (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below, the
underlying Loans) with market discount over interest received on such
Security is allowed as a current deduction only to the extent such excess is
greater than the market discount that accrued during the taxable year in
which such interest expense was incurred.  In general, the deferred portion
of any interest expense will be deductible when such market discount is
included in income, including upon the sale, disposition, or repayment of the
Security (or in the case of a Pass-Through Security, an underlying Loan).  A
Holder may elect to include market discount in income currently as it
accrues, on all market discount obligations acquired by such Holder during
the taxable year such election is made and thereafter, in which case the
interest deferral rule will not apply.

     Premium.  A Holder who purchases a Debt Security (other than an Interest
Weighted Security to the extent described above) at a cost greater than its
stated redemption price at maturity, generally will be considered to have
purchased the Security at a premium, which it may elect to amortize as an
offset to interest income on such Security (and not as a separate deduction
item) on a constant yield method.  Although no regulations addressing the
computation of premium accrual on securities similar to the Securities have
been issued, the legislative history of the 1986 Act indicates that premium
is to be accrued in the same manner as market discount.  Accordingly, it
appears that the accrual of premium on a Class of Pay-Through Securities will
be calculated using the Prepayment Assumption used in pricing such Class.  If
a Holder makes an election to amortize premium on a Debt Security, such
election will apply to all taxable debt instruments (including all REMIC
regular interests and all pass-through certificates representing ownership
interests in a trust holding debt obligations) held by the Holder at the
beginning of the taxable year in which the election is made, and to all
taxable debt instruments acquired thereafter by such Holder, and will be
irrevocable without the consent of the IRS.  Purchasers who pay a premium for
the Securities should consult their tax advisers regarding the election to
amortize premium and the method to be employed.

     On June 27, 1996, the IRS issued proposed regulations (the "Amortizable
Bond Premium Regulations") dealing with amortizable bond premium.  These
regulations specifically do not apply to prepayable debt instruments subject
to Code Section 1272(a)(6) such as the Securities.  Absent further guidance
from the IRS, the Trustee intends to account for amortizable bond premium in
the manner described above.  Prospective purchasers of the Securities should
consult their tax advisors regarding the possible application of the
Amortizable Bond Premium Regulations.

     Election to Treat All Interest as Original Issue Discount.  The OID
Regulations permit a Holder of a Debt Security to elect to accrue all
interest, discount (including de minimis market or original issue discount)
and premium income as interest, based on a constant yield method for Debt
Securities acquired on or after April 4, 1994.  If such an election were to
be made with respect to a Debt Security with market discount, the Holder of
the Debt Security would be deemed to have made an election to include in
income currently market discount 

with respect to all other debt instruments having market discount that such
Holder of the Debt Security acquires during the year of the election or
thereafter.  Similarly, a Holder of a Debt Security that makes this election
for a Debt Security that is acquired at a premium will be deemed to have made
an election to amortize bond premium with respect to all debt instruments
having amortizable bond premium that such Holder owns or acquires.  The
election to accrue interest, discount and premium on a constant yield method
with respect to a Debt Security is irrevocable.

TAXATION OF THE REMIC AND ITS HOLDERS

     General.  In the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, special counsel to
Provident, if a REMIC election is made with respect to a Series of
Securities, then the arrangement by which the Securities of that Series are
issued will be treated as a REMIC as long as all of the provisions of the
applicable Agreement are complied with and the statutory and regulatory
requirements are satisfied.  Securities will be designated as "Regular
Interests" or "Residual Interests" in a REMIC, as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.

     Except to the extent specified otherwise in a Prospectus Supplement, if
a REMIC election is made with respect to a Series of Securities, (i)
Securities held by a domestic building and loan association will constitute
"a regular or a residual interest in a REMIC" within the meaning of Code
Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(xi) (assuming that at least 95% of the REMIC's assets
consist of cash, government securities, "loans secured by an interest in real
property," and other types of assets described in Code Section
7701(a)(19)(C)); and (ii) Securities held by a real estate investment trust
will constitute "real estate assets" within the meaning of Code Section
856(c)(6)(B), and income with respect to the Securities will be considered
"interest on obligations secured by mortgages on real property or on
interests in real property" within the meaning of Code Section 856(c)(3)(B)
(assuming, for both purposes, that at least 95% of the REMIC's assets are
qualifying assets).  If less than 95% of the REMIC's assets consist of assets
described in (i) or (ii) above, then a Security will qualify for the tax
treatment described in (i), (ii) or (iii) in the proportion that such REMIC
assets are qualifying assets.

     The Small Business Job Protection Act of 1996, as part of the repeal of
the bad debt reserve method for thrift institutions, repealed the application
of Code Section 593(d) to any taxable year beginning after December 31, 1995.

REMIC EXPENSES; SINGLE CLASS REMICS

     As a general rule, all of the expenses of a REMIC will be taken into
account by Holders of the Residual Interest Securities.  In the case of a
"single class REMIC," however, the expenses will be allocated, under Treasury
regulations, among the Holders of the Regular Interest Securities and the
Holders of the Residual Interest Securities (as defined herein) on a daily
basis in proportion to the relative amounts of income accruing to each Holder
on that day.  In the case of a Holder of a Regular Interest Security who is
an individual or a "pass-through interest holder" (including certain
pass-through entities, but not including real estate investment trusts), such
expenses will be deductible only to the extent that such expenses, plus other
"miscellaneous itemized deductions" of the Holder, exceed 2% of such Holder's
adjusted gross income.  In addition, for taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1990, the amount of itemized deductions otherwise allowable for
the taxable year for an individual whose adjusted gross income exceeds the
applicable amount (which amount will be adjusted for inflation for taxable
years beginning after 1990) will be reduced by the lesser of (i) 3% of the
excess of adjusted gross income over the applicable amount or (ii) 80% of the
amount of itemized deductions otherwise allowable for such taxable year.  The
reduction or disallowance of this deduction may have a significant impact on
the yield of the Regular Interest Security to such a Holder.  In general
terms, a single class REMIC is one that either (i) would qualify under
existing Treasury regulations as a grantor trust if it were not a REMIC
(treating all interests as ownership interests, even if they would be
classified as debt for federal income tax purposes) or (ii) is similar to
such a trust and which is structured with the principal purpose of avoiding
the single class REMIC rules.  Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the expenses of the REMIC will be allocated to Holders
of the related Residual Interest Securities.



TAXATION OF THE REMIC

     General.  Although a REMIC is a separate entity for federal income tax
purposes, a REMIC is not generally subject to entity-level tax.  Rather, the
taxable income or net loss of a REMIC is taken into account by the Holders of
Residual Interests.  As described above, the Regular Interests are generally
taxable as debt of the REMIC.

     Calculation of REMIC Income.  The taxable income or net loss of a REMIC
is determined under an accrual method of accounting and in the same manner as
in the case of an individual, with certain adjustments.  In general, the
taxable income or net loss will be the difference between (i) the gross
income produced by the REMIC's assets, including stated interest and any OID
or market discount on Loans and other assets, and (ii) deductions, including
stated interest and OID accrued on Regular Interest Securities, amortization
of any premium with respect to Loans, and servicing fees and other expenses
of the REMIC.  A Holder of a Residual Interest Security that is an individual
or a "pass-through interest holder" (including certain pass-through entities,
but not including real estate investment trusts) will be unable to deduct
servicing fees payable on the Loans or other administrative expenses of the
REMIC for a given taxable year, to the extent that such expenses, when
aggregated with such Holder's other miscellaneous itemized deductions for
that year, do not exceed two percent of such Holder's adjusted gross income.

     For purposes of computing its taxable income or net loss, the REMIC
should have an initial aggregate tax basis in its assets equal to the
aggregate fair market value of the Regular Interests and the Residual
Interests on the Startup Day (generally, the day that the interests are
issued).  That aggregate basis will be allocated among the assets of the
REMIC in proportion to their respective fair market values.

     The OID provisions of the Code apply to loans of individuals originated
on or after March 2, 1984, and the market discount provisions apply to loans
originated after July 18, 1984.  Subject to possible application of the de
minimis rules, the method of accrual by the REMIC of OID income on such Loans
will be equivalent to the method under which Holders of Pay-Through
Securities accrue OID (i.e., under the constant yield method taking into
account the Prepayment Assumption).  The REMIC will deduct OID on the Regular
Interest Securities in the same manner that the Holders of the Regular
Interest Securities include such discount in income, but without regard to
the de minimis rules.  See "Taxation of Debt Securities" above.  However, a
REMIC that acquires Loans at a market discount must include such market
discount in income currently, as it accrues, on a constant interest basis.

     To the extent that the REMIC's basis allocable to Loans that it holds
exceeds their principal amounts, the resulting premium, if attributable to
mortgages originated after September 27, 1985, will be amortized over the
life of the Loans (taking into account the Prepayment Assumption) on a
constant yield method.  Although the law is somewhat unclear regarding
recovery of premium attributable to Loans originated on or before such date,
it is possible that such premium may be recovered in proportion to payments
of Loan principal.

     Prohibited Transactions and Contributions Tax.  The REMIC will be
subject to a 100% tax on any net income derived from a "prohibited
transaction." For this purpose, net income will be calculated without taking
into account any losses from prohibited transactions or any deductions
attributable to any prohibited transaction that resulted in a loss.  In
general, prohibited transactions include:  (i) subject to limited exceptions,
the sale or other disposition of any qualified mortgage transferred to the
REMIC; (ii) subject to limited exceptions, the sale or other disposition of a
cash flow investment; (iii) the receipt of any income from assets not
permitted to be held by the REMIC pursuant to the Code; or (iv) the receipt
of any fees or other compensation for services rendered by the REMIC.  It is
anticipated that a REMIC will not engage in any prohibited transactions in
which it would recognize a material amount of net income.  In addition,
subject to a number of exceptions, a tax is imposed at the rate of 100% on
amounts contributed to a REMIC after the close of the three-month period
beginning on the Startup Day.  The Holders of Residual Interest Securities
will generally be responsible for the payment of any such taxes imposed on
the REMIC.  To the extent not paid by such Holders or otherwise, however,
such taxes will be paid out of the Trust Fund and will be allocated pro rata
to all outstanding classes of Securities of such REMIC.


TAXATION OF HOLDERS OF RESIDUAL INTEREST SECURITIES

     The Holder of a Security representing a Residual Interest (a "Residual
Interest Security") will take into account the "daily portion" of the taxable
income or net loss of the REMIC for each day during the taxable year in which
such Holder held the Residual Interest Security.  The daily portion is
determined by allocating to each day in any calendar quarter its ratable
portion of the taxable income or net loss of the REMIC for such quarter, and
by allocating that amount among the Holders (on such day) of the Residual
Interest Securities in proportion to their respective holdings on such day.

     The Holder of a Residual Interest Security must report its proportionate
share of the taxable income of the REMIC whether or not it receives cash
distributions from the REMIC attributable to such income or loss.  The
reporting of taxable income without corresponding distributions could occur,
for example, in certain REMIC issues in which the Loans held by the REMIC
were issued or acquired at a discount, since mortgage prepayments cause
recognition of discount income, while the corresponding portion of the
prepayment could be used in whole or in part to make principal payments on
Regular Interests issued without any discount or at an insubstantial discount
(if this occurs, it is likely that cash distributions will exceed taxable
income in later years).  Taxable income may also be greater in earlier years
of certain REMIC issues as a result of the fact that interest expense
deductions, as a percentage of outstanding principal on Regular Interest
Securities, will typically increase over time as lower yielding Securities
are paid, whereas interest income with respect to Loans will generally remain
constant over time as a percentage of Loan principal.

     In any event, because the Holder of a Residual Interest is taxed on the
net income of the REMIC, the taxable income derived from a Residual Interest
Security in a given taxable year will not be equal to the taxable income
associated with investment in a corporate bond or stripped instrument having
similar cash flow characteristics and pretax yield.  Therefore, the after-tax
yield on the Residual Interest Security may be less than that of such a bond
or instrument.

     Limitation on Losses.  The amount of the REMIC's net loss that a Holder
may take into account currently is limited to the Holder's adjusted basis at
the end of the calendar quarter in which such loss arises.  A Holder's basis
in a Residual Interest Security will initially equal such Holder's purchase
price, and will subsequently be increased by the amount of the REMIC's
taxable income allocated to the Holder, and decreased (but not below zero) by
the amount of distributions made and the amount of the REMIC's net loss
allocated to the Holder.  Any disallowed loss may be carried forward
indefinitely, but may be used only to offset income of the REMIC generated by
the same REMIC.  The ability of Holders of Residual Interest Securities to
deduct net losses may be subject to additional limitations under the Code, as
to which such Holders should consult their tax advisers.

     Distributions.  Distributions on a Residual Interest Security (whether
at their scheduled times or as a result of prepayments) will generally not
result in any additional taxable income or loss to a Holder of a Residual
Interest Security.  If the amount of such payment exceeds a Holder's adjusted
basis in the Residual Interest Security, however, the Holder will recognize
gain (treated as gain from the sale of the Residual Interest Security) to the
extent of such excess.

     Sale or Exchange.  A Holder of a Residual Interest Security will
recognize gain or loss on the sale or exchange of a Residual Interest
Security equal to the difference, if any, between the amount realized and
such Holder's adjusted basis in the Residual Interest Security at the time of
such sale or exchange.  Except to the extent provided in regulations, which
have not yet been issued, any loss upon disposition of a Residual Interest
Security will be disallowed if the selling Holder acquires any residual
interest in a REMIC or similar mortgage pool within six months before or
after such disposition.

     Excess Inclusions.  The portion of the REMIC taxable income of a Holder
of a Residual Interest Security consisting of "excess inclusion" income may
not be offset by other deductions or losses, including net operating losses,
on such Holder's federal income tax return.  Further, if the Holder of a
Residual Interest Security is an organization subject to the tax on unrelated 
business income imposed by Code Section 511, such holder's excess inclusion 
income will be treated as unrelated business taxable income of such Holder.  
In addition, under Treasury regulations yet to be issued, if a real estate 
investment trust, a regulated investment company, a common trust fund, 
or certain cooperatives were to own a Residual Interest Security, a portion 
of dividends (or other distributions) paid by the real estate investment 
trust (or other entity) would be treated as excess inclusion income.  If 
a Residual Security is owned by a foreign person, excess inclusion income 
is subject to tax at a rate of 30% which may not be reduced by treaty, 
is not eligible for treatment as "portfolio interest" and is subject 
to certain additional limitations.  See "Tax Treatment of Foreign 
Investors."  The Small Business Job Protection Act of 1996 has eliminated 
the special rule permitting Section 593 institutions ("thrift institutions") 
to use net operating losses and other allowable deductions to offset their 
excess inclusion income from REMIC residual certificates that have 
"significant value" within the meaning of the REMIC Regulations, effective 
for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1995, except with respect 
to residual certificates continuously held by a thrift institution 
since November 1, 1995.

     In addition, the Small Business Job Protection Act of 1996 provides
three rules for determining the effect of excess inclusions on the
alternative minimum taxable income of a residual Holder.  First, alternative
minimum taxable income for such residual Holder is determined without regard
to the special rule that taxable income cannot be less than excess
inclusions.  Second, a residual Holder's alternative minimum taxable income
for a tax year cannot be less than excess inclusions for the year.  Third,
the amount of any alternative minimum tax net operating loss deductions must
be computed without regard to any excess inclusions.  These rules are
effective for tax years beginning after December 31, 1986, unless a residual
Holder elects to have such rules apply only to tax years beginning after
August 20, 1996.

     The excess inclusion portion of a REMIC's income is generally equal to
the excess, if any, of REMIC taxable income for the quarterly period
allocable to a Residual Interest Security, over the daily accruals for such
quarterly period of (i) 120% of the long-term applicable federal rate on the
Startup Day multiplied by (ii) the adjusted issue price of such Residual
Interest Security at the beginning of such quarterly period.  The adjusted
issue price of a Residual Interest at the beginning of each calendar quarter
will equal its issue price (calculated in a manner analogous to the
determination of the issue price of a Regular Interest), increased by the
aggregate of the daily accruals for prior calendar quarters, and decreased
(but not below zero) by the amount of loss allocated to a Holder and the
amount of distributions made on the Residual Interest Security before the
beginning of the quarter.  The long-term federal rate, which is announced
monthly by the Treasury Department, is an interest rate that is based on the
average market yield of outstanding marketable obligations of the United
States government having remaining maturities in excess of nine years.

     Under the REMIC Regulations, in certain circumstances, transfers of
Residual Securities may be disregarded.  See "--Restrictions on Ownership and
Transfer of Residual Interest Securities" and "--Tax Treatment of Foreign
Investors" below.


     Restrictions on Ownership and Transfer of Residual Interest Securities. 
As a condition to qualification as a REMIC, reasonable arrangements must be
made to prevent the ownership of a Residual Interest by any "Disqualified
Organization."  Disqualified Organizations include the United States, any
State or political subdivision thereof, any foreign government, any
international organization, or any agency or instrumentality of any of the
foregoing, a rural electric or telephone cooperative described in Section
1381(a)(2)(C) of the Code, or any entity exempt from the tax imposed by
Sections 1-1399 of the Code, if such entity is not subject to tax on its
unrelated business income.  Accordingly, the applicable Pooling and Servicing
Agreement will prohibit Disqualified Organizations from owning a Residual
Interest Security.  In addition, no transfer of a Residual Interest Security
will be permitted unless the proposed transferee shall have furnished to the
Trustee an affidavit representing and warranting that it is neither a
Disqualified Organization nor an agent or nominee acting on behalf of a
Disqualified Organization.

     If a Residual Interest Security is transferred to a Disqualified
Organization (in violation of the restrictions set forth above), a
substantial tax will be imposed on the transferor of such Residual Interest
Security at the time of the transfer.  In addition, if a Disqualified
Organization holds an interest in a pass-

through entity (including, among others, a partnership, trust, real estate
investment trust, regulated investment company, or any person holding as
nominee), that owns a Residual Interest Security, the pass-through entity
will be required to pay an annual tax on its allocable share of the excess
inclusion income of the REMIC.

     Under the REMIC Regulations, if a Residual Interest Security is a
"noneconomic residual interest," as described below, a transfer of a Residual
Interest Security to a United States person will be disregarded for all
Federal tax purposes unless no significant purpose of the transfer was to
impede the assessment or collection of tax.  A Residual Interest Security is
a "noneconomic residual interest" unless at the time of the transfer (i) the
present value of the expected future distributions on the Residual Interest
Security at least equals the product of the present value of the anticipated
excess inclusions and the highest rate of tax for the year in which the
transfer occurs, and (ii) the transferor reasonably expects that the
transferee will receive distributions from the REMIC at or after the time at
which the taxes accrue on the anticipated excess inclusions in an amount
sufficient to satisfy the accrued taxes.  If a transfer of a Residual
Interest is disregarded, the transferor would be liable for any Federal
income tax imposed upon taxable income derived by the transferee from the
REMIC.  The REMIC Regulations provide no guidance as to how to determine if a
significant purpose of a transfer is to impede the assessment or collection
of tax.  A similar type of limitation exists with respect to certain
transfers of Residual Interests by foreign persons to United States persons. 
See "--Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors."

     Mark to Market Rules.  Prospective purchasers of a Residual Interest
Security should be aware that the IRS recently finalized regulations (the
"Mark-to-Market Regulations") which provide that a Residual Interest Security
acquired after January 3, 1995 cannot be marked-to-market.  The Mark-to-
Market Regulations replace the temporary regulations which allowed a Residual
Interest Security to be marked-to-market provided that it was not a negative
value Residual Interest and did not have the same economic effect as a
negative value Residual Interest.  Prospective purchasers of a Residual
Interest Security should consult their tax advisors regarding the possible
application of the Mark-to-Market Regulations.

ADMINISTRATIVE MATTERS

     The REMIC's books must be maintained on a calendar year basis and the
REMIC must file an annual federal income tax return.  The REMIC will also be
subject to the procedural and administrative rules of the Code applicable to
partnerships, including the determination of any adjustments to, among other
things, items of REMIC income, gain, loss, deduction, or credit, by the IRS
in a unified administrative proceeding.

TAX STATUS AS A GRANTOR TRUST

     General.  As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement if a REMIC
or partnership election is not made, in the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP,
special counsel to Provident, the Trust Fund relating to a Series of
Securities will be classified for federal income tax purposes as a grantor
trust under Subpart E, Part I of Subchapter J of the Code and not as an
association taxable as a corporation (the Securities of such Series, "Pass-
Through Securities").  In some Series there will be no separation of the
principal and interest payments on the Loans.  In such circumstances, a
Holder will be considered to have purchased a pro rata undivided interest in
each of the Loans.  In other cases ("Stripped Securities"), sale of the
Securities will produce a separation in the ownership of all or a portion of
the principal payments from all or a portion of the interest payments on the
Loans.

     Each Holder must report on its federal income tax return its share of
the gross income derived from the Loans (not reduced by the amount payable as
fees to the Trustee and the Servicer and similar fees (collectively, the
"Servicing Fees")), at the same time and in the same manner as such items
would have been reported under the Holder's tax accounting method had it held
its interest in the Loans directly, received directly its share of the
amounts received with respect to the Loans, and paid directly its share of
the Servicing Fees.  In the case of Pass-Through Securities other than
Stripped Securities, such income will consist of a pro rata share of all of
the income derived from all of the Loans and, in the case of Stripped
Securities, such income will consist of a pro rata share of the income
derived from each stripped bond or stripped coupon in which the Holder owns
an interest.  The holder of a Security will generally be entitled to deduct
such Servicing Fees under Section 162 or 
Section 212 of the Code to the extent that such Servicing Fees represent
"reasonable" compensation for the services rendered by the Trustee and the
Servicer (or third parties that are compensated for the performance of
services).  In the case of a noncorporate Holder, however, Servicing Fees (to
the extent not otherwise disallowed, e.g., because they exceed reasonable
compensation) will be deductible in computing such Holder's regular tax
liability only to the extent that such fees, when added to other
miscellaneous itemized deductions, exceed 2% of adjusted gross income and may
not be deductible to any extent in computing such Holder's alternative
minimum tax liability.  In addition, the amount of itemized deductions
otherwise allowable for the taxable year for an individual whose adjusted
gross income exceeds the applicable amount (which amount will be adjusted for
inflation) will be reduced by the lesser of (i) 3% of the excess of adjusted
gross income over the applicable amount or (ii) 80% of the amount of itemized
deductions otherwise allowable for such taxable year.

     Discount or Premium on Pass-Through Securities.  The Holder's purchase
price of a Pass-Through Security is to be allocated among the Loans in
proportion to their fair market values determined as of the time of purchase
of the Securities.  In the typical case, the Trustee (to the extent necessary
to fulfill its reporting obligations) will treat each Loan as having a fair
market value proportional to the share of the aggregate principal balances of
all of the Loans that it represents, since the Securities, unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, will have a relatively
uniform interest rate and other common characteristics.  To the extent that
the portion of the purchase price of a Pass-Through Security allocated to a
Loan (other than to a right to receive any accrued interest thereon and any
undistributed principal payments) is less than or greater than the portion of
the principal balance of the Loan allocable to the Security, the interest in
the Loan allocable to the Pass-Through Security will be deemed to have been
acquired at a discount or premium, respectively.

     The treatment of any discount will depend on whether the discount
represents OID or market discount.  In the case of a Loan with OID in excess
of a prescribed de minimis amount or a Stripped Security, a Holder of a
Security will be required to report as interest income in each taxable year
its share of the amount of OID that accrues during that year in the manner
described above.  OID with respect to a Loan could arise, for example, by
virtue of the financing of points by the originator of the Loan, or by virtue
of the charging of points by the originator of the Loan in an amount greater
than a statutory de minimis exception, in circumstances under which the
points are not currently deductible pursuant to applicable Code provisions. 
Any market discount or premium on a Loan will be includible in income,
generally in the manner described above, except that in the case of Pass-
Through Securities, market discount is calculated with respect to the Loans
underlying the Certificate, rather than with respect to the Security.  A
Holder that acquires an interest in a Loan originated after July 18, 1984
with more than a de minimis amount of market discount (generally, the excess
of the principal amount of the Loan over the purchaser's allocable purchase
price) will be required to include accrued market discount in income in the
manner set forth above.  See "--Taxation of Debt Securities; Market Discount"
and "--Premium" above.

     In the case of market discount on a Pass-Through Security attributable
to Loans originated on or before July 18, 1984, the Holder generally will be
required to allocate the portion of such discount that is allocable to a Loan
among the principal payments on the Loan and to include the discount
allocable to each principal payment in ordinary income at the time such
principal payment is made.  Such treatment would generally result in discount
being included in income at a slower rate than discount would be required to
be included in income using the method described in the preceding paragraph.

     Stripped Securities.  A Stripped Security may represent a right to
receive only a portion of the interest payments on the Loans, a right to
receive only principal payments on the Loans, or a right to receive certain
payments of both interest and principal.  Certain Stripped Securities ("Ratio
Strip Securities") may represent a right to receive differing percentages of
both the interest and principal on each Loan.  Pursuant to Section 1286 of
the Code, the separation of ownership of the right to receive some or all of
the interest payments on an obligation from ownership of the right to receive
some or all of the principal payments results in the creation of "stripped
bonds" with respect to principal payments and "stripped coupons" with respect
to interest payments.  Section 1286 of the Code applies the OID rules to
stripped bonds and stripped coupons.  For purposes of computing OID, a
stripped bond or a stripped coupon is treated as a debt instrument issued on
the date that such stripped interest is purchased with an issue price equal 
to its purchase price or, if more than one stripped interest is purchased, 
the ratable share of the purchase price allocable to such stripped interest.

     Servicing Fees in excess of reasonable Servicing Fees ("Excess Servicing
Fees") will be treated under the stripped bond rules.  If the Excess
Servicing Fees are less than 100 basis points (i.e., 1% interest on the Loan
principal balance) or the Securities are initially sold with a de minimis
discount (assuming no Prepayment Assumption is required), any non-de minimis
discount arising from a subsequent transfer of the Securities should be
treated as market discount.  The IRS appears to require that reasonable
Servicing Fees be calculated on a Loan-by-Loan basis, which could result in
some Loans being treated as having more than 100 basis points of interest
stripped off.

     The Code, OID Regulations and judicial decisions provide no direct
guidance as to how the interest and OID rules are to apply to Stripped
Securities and other Pass-Through Securities.  Under the method described
above for Pay-Through Securities (the "Cash Flow Bond Method"), a Prepayment
Assumption is used and periodic recalculations are made which take into
account with respect to each accrual period the effect of prepayments during
such period.  However, the 1986 Act does not, absent Treasury regulations,
appear specifically to cover instruments such as the Stripped Securities
which technically represent ownership interests in the underlying Loans,
rather than being debt instruments "secured by" those Loans.  Nevertheless,
it is believed that the Cash Flow Bond Method is a reasonable method of
reporting income for such Securities, and it is expected that OID will be
reported on that basis unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  In applying the calculation to Pass-Through Securities, the
Trustee will treat all payments to be received by a Holder with respect to
the underlying Loans as payments on a single installment obligation.  The IRS
could, however, assert that OID must be calculated separately for each Loan
underlying a Security.

     Under certain circumstances, if the Loans prepay at a rate faster than
the Prepayment Assumption, the use of the Cash Flow Bond Method may
accelerate a Holder's recognition of income.  If, however, the Loans prepay
at a rate slower than the Prepayment Assumption, in some circumstances the
use of this method may decelerate a Holder's recognition of income.

     In the case of a Stripped Security that is an Interest Weighted
Security, the Trustee intends, absent contrary authority, to report income to
Securityholders as OID, in the manner described above for Interest Weighted
Securities.

     Possible Alternative Characterizations.  The characterizations of the
Stripped Securities described above are not the only possible interpretations
of the applicable Code provisions.  Among other possibilities, the IRS could
contend that (i) in certain Series, each non-Interest Weighted Security is
composed of an unstripped undivided ownership interest in Loans and an
installment obligation consisting of stripped principal payments; (ii) the
non-Interest Weighted Securities are subject to the contingent payment
provisions of the Contingent Regulations; or (iii) each Interest Weighted
Stripped Security is composed of an unstripped undivided ownership interest
in Loans and an installment obligation consisting of stripped interest
payments.

     Given the variety of alternatives for treatment of the Stripped
Securities and the different federal income tax consequences that result from
each alternative, potential purchasers are urged to consult their own tax
advisers regarding the proper treatment of the Securities for federal income
tax purposes.

     Character as Qualifying Loans.  In the case of Stripped Securities,
there is no specific legal authority existing regarding whether the character
of the Securities, for federal income tax purposes, will be the same as the
Loans.  The IRS could take the position that the Loans' character is not
carried over to the Securities in such circumstances.  Pass-Through
Securities will be, and, although the matter is not free from doubt, Stripped
Securities should be, considered to represent "real estate assets" within the
meaning of Section 856(c)(6)(B) of the Code and "loans secured by an interest
in real property" within the meaning of Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v) of the
Code; and interest income attributable to the Securities should be considered
to represent "interest on obligations secured by mortgages on real property
or on interests in real property" within the meaning of 
Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code.  Reserves or funds underlying the
Securities may cause a proportionate reduction in the above-described
qualifying status categories of Securities.

SALE OR EXCHANGE

     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as to which
a partnership election is made, a Holder's tax basis in its Security is the
price such Holder pays for a Security, plus amounts of original issue or
market discount included in income and reduced by any payments received
(other than qualified stated interest payments) and any amortized premium. 
Gain or loss recognized on a sale, exchange, or redemption of a Security,
measured by the difference between the amount realized and the Security's
basis as so adjusted, will generally be capital gain or loss, assuming that
the Security is held as a capital asset.  In the case of a Security held by a
bank, thrift, or similar institution described in Section 582 of the Code,
however, gain or loss realized on the sale or exchange of a Regular Interest
Security will be taxable as ordinary income or loss.  In addition, gain from
the disposition of a Regular Interest Security that might otherwise be
capital gain will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the excess,
if any, of (i) the amount that would have been includible in the Holder's
income if the yield on such Regular Interest Security had equaled 110% of the
applicable federal rate as of the beginning of such Holder's holding period,
over the amount of ordinary income actually recognized by the Holder with
respect to such Regular Interest Security.  For taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1993, the maximum tax rate on ordinary income for individual
taxpayers is 39.6% and the maximum tax rate on long-term capital gains
reported after December 31, 1990 for such taxpayers is 28%.  The maximum tax
rate on both ordinary income and long-term capital gains of corporate
taxpayers is 35%.

MISCELLANEOUS TAX ASPECTS

     Backup Withholding.  Subject to the discussion below with respect to
Trust Funds as to which a partnership election is made, a Holder, other than
a Holder of a Residual Interest Security, may, under certain circumstances,
be subject to "backup withholding" at a rate of 31% with respect to
distributions or the proceeds of a sale of certificates to or through brokers
that represent interest or OID on the Securities.  This withholding generally
applies if the Holder of a Security (i) fails to furnish the Trustee with its
taxpayer identification number ("TIN"); (ii) furnishes the Trustee an
incorrect TIN; (iii) fails to report properly interest, dividends or other
"reportable payments" as defined in the Code; or (iv) under certain
circumstances, fails to provide the Trustee or such Holder's securities
broker with a certified statement, signed under penalty of perjury, that the
TIN provided is its correct number and that the Holder is not subject to
backup withholding.  Backup withholding will not apply, however, with respect
to certain payments made to Holders, including payments to certain exempt
recipients (such as exempt organizations) and to certain Nonresidents (as
defined below).  Holders should consult their tax advisers as to their
qualification for exemption from backup withholding and the procedure for
obtaining the exemption.

     The Trustee will report to the Holders and to the Servicer for each
calendar year the amount of any "reportable payments" during such year and
the amount of tax withheld, if any, with respect to payments on the
Securities.

TAX TREATMENT OF FOREIGN INVESTORS

     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as to which
a partnership election is made, under the Code, unless interest (including
OID) paid on a Security (other than a Residual Interest Security) is
considered to be "effectively connected" with a trade or business conducted
in the United States by a nonresident alien individual, foreign partnership
or foreign corporation ("Nonresidents"), such interest will normally qualify
as portfolio interest (except where (i) the recipient is a holder, directly
or by attribution, of 10% or more of the capital or profits interest in the
issuer, or (ii) the recipient is a controlled foreign corporation to which
the issuer is a related person) and will be exempt from federal income tax. 
Upon receipt of appropriate ownership statements, the issuer normally will be
relieved of obligations to withhold tax from such interest payments.  These
provisions supersede the generally applicable provisions of United States law
that would otherwise require the issuer to withhold at a 30% rate (unless
such rate were reduced or eliminated by an 
applicable tax treaty) on, among other things, interest and other fixed or
determinable, annual or periodic income paid to Nonresidents.  Holders of
Pass-Through Securities and Stripped Securities, including Ratio Strip
Securities, however, may be subject to withholding to the extent that the
Loans were originated on or before July 18, 1984.

     Interest and OID of Holders who are foreign persons are not subject to
withholding if they are effectively connected with a United States business
conducted by the Holder.  They will, however, generally be subject to the
regular United States income tax.

     Payments to Holders of Residual Interest Securities who are foreign
persons will generally be treated as interest for purposes of the 30% (or
lower treaty rate) United States withholding tax.  Holders should assume that
such income does not qualify for exemption from United States withholding tax
as "portfolio interest." It is clear that, to the extent that a payment
represents a portion of REMIC taxable income that constitutes excess
inclusion income, a Holder of a Residual Interest Security will not be
entitled to an exemption from or reduction of the 30% (or lower treaty rate)
withholding tax rule.  If the payments are subject to United States
withholding tax, they generally will be taken into account for withholding
tax purposes only when paid or distributed (or when the Residual Interest
Security is disposed of).  The Treasury has statutory authority, however, to
promulgate regulations which would require such amounts to be taken into
account at an earlier time in order to prevent the avoidance of tax.  Such
regulations could, for example, require withholding prior to the distribution
of cash in the case of Residual Interest Securities that do not have
significant value.  Under the REMIC Regulations, if a Residual Interest
Security has tax avoidance potential, a transfer of a Residual Interest
Security to a Nonresident will be disregarded for all federal tax purposes. 
A Residual Interest Security has tax avoidance potential unless, at the time
of the transfer, the transferor reasonably expects that the REMIC will
distribute to the transferee amounts that will equal at least 30% of each
excess inclusion, and that such amounts will be distributed at or after the
time at which the excess inclusions accrue and not later than the calendar
year following the calendar year of accrual.  If a Nonresident transfers a
Residual Interest Security to a United States person, and if the transfer has
the effect of allowing the transferor to avoid tax on accrued excess
inclusions, then the transfer is disregarded and the transferor continues to
be treated as the owner of the Residual Interest Security for purposes of the
withholding tax provisions of the Code.  See "--Excess Inclusions."

TAX CHARACTERIZATION OF THE TRUST FUND AS A PARTNERSHIP

     Brown & Wood LLP, special counsel to Provident, will deliver its opinion
that a Trust Fund for which a partnership election is made will not be an
association (or publicly traded partnership) taxable as a corporation for
federal income tax purposes.  This opinion will be based on the assumption
that the terms of the Trust Agreement and related documents will be complied
with, and on counsel's conclusions that (1) the Trust Fund will not have
certain characteristics necessary for a business trust to be classified as an
association taxable as a corporation and (2) the nature of the income of the
Trust Fund will exempt it from the rule that certain publicly traded
partnerships are taxable as corporations or the issuance of the Securities
has been structured as a private placement under an IRS safe harbor, so that
the Trust Fund will not be characterized as a publicly traded partnership
taxable as a corporation.

     If the Trust Fund were taxable as a corporation for federal income tax
purposes, the Trust Fund would be subject to corporate income tax on its
taxable income.  The Trust Fund's taxable income would include all its
income, possibly reduced by its interest expense on the Notes.  Any such
corporate income tax could materially reduce cash available to make payments
on the Notes and distributions on the Certificates, and Certificateholders
could be liable for any such tax that is unpaid by the Trust Fund.


TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE NOTES

     Treatment of the Notes as Indebtedness.  The Trust Fund will agree, and
the Noteholders will agree by their purchase of Notes, to treat the Notes as
debt for federal income tax purposes.  Brown & Wood LLP, special counsel to
Provident, will, except as otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, advise Provident that the Notes will be classified as debt 
for federal income tax purposes.  The discussion below assumes this 
characterization of the Notes is correct.

     OID, Indexed Securities, etc.  The discussion below assumes that all
payments on the Notes are denominated in U.S. dollars, and that the Notes are
not Indexed Securities or Strip Notes.  Moreover, the discussion assumes that
the interest formula for the Notes meets the requirements for "qualified
stated interest" under the OID Regulations, and that any OID on the Notes
(i.e., any excess of the principal amount of the Notes over their issue
price) does not exceed a de minimis amount (i.e., 0.25% of their principal
amount multiplied by the number of full years included in their term), all
within the meaning of the OID Regulations.  If these conditions are not
satisfied with respect to any given series of Notes, additional tax
considerations with respect to such Notes will be disclosed in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement.

     Interest Income on the Notes.  Based on the above assumptions, except as
discussed in the following paragraph, the Notes will not be considered issued
with OID.  The stated interest thereon will be taxable to a Noteholder as
ordinary interest income when received or accrued in accordance with such
Noteholder's method of tax accounting.  Under the OID Regulations, a Holder
of a Note issued with a de minimis amount of OID must include such OID in
income, on a pro rata basis, as principal payments are made on the Note.  It
is believed that any prepayment premium paid as a result of a mandatory
redemption will be taxable as contingent interest when it becomes fixed and
unconditionally payable.  A purchaser who buys a Note for more or less than
its principal amount will generally be subject, respectively, to the premium
amortization or market discount rules of the Code.

     A Holder of a Note that has a fixed maturity date of not more than one
year from the issue date of such Note (a "Short-Term Note") may be subject to
special rules.  An accrual basis Holder of a Short-Term Note (and certain
cash method Holders, including regulated investment companies, as set forth
in Section 1281 of the Code) generally would be required to report interest
income as interest accrues on a straight-line basis over the term of each
interest period.  Other cash basis Holders of a Short-Term Note would, in
general, be required to report interest income as interest is paid (or, if
earlier, upon the taxable disposition of the Short-Term Note).  However, a
cash basis Holder of a Short-Term Note reporting interest income as it is
paid may be required to defer a portion of any interest expense otherwise
deductible on indebtedness incurred to purchase or carry the Short-Term Note
until the taxable disposition of the Short-Term Note.  A cash basis taxpayer
may elect under Section 1281 of the Code to accrue interest income on all
nongovernment debt obligations with a term of one year or less, in which case
the taxpayer would include interest on the Short-Term Note in income as it
accrues, but would not be subject to the interest expense deferral rule
referred to in the preceding sentence.  Certain special rules apply if a
Short-Term Note is purchased for more or less than its principal amount.

     Sale or Other Disposition.  If a Noteholder sells a Note, the Holder
will recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the
amount realized on the sale and the Holder's adjusted tax basis in the Note. 
The adjusted tax basis of a Note to a particular Noteholder will equal the
Holder's cost for the Note, increased by any market discount, acquisition
discount, OID and gain previously included by such Noteholder in income with
respect to the Note and decreased by the amount of bond premium (if any)
previously amortized and by the amount of principal payments previously
received by such Noteholder with respect to such Note.  Any such gain or loss
will be capital gain or loss if the Note was held as a capital asset, except
for gain representing accrued interest and accrued market discount not
previously included in income.  Capital losses generally may be used only to
offset capital gains.

     Foreign Holders.  Interest payments made (or accrued) to a Noteholder
who is a nonresident alien, foreign corporation or other non-United States
person (a "foreign person") generally will be considered "portfolio
interest", and generally will not be subject to United States federal income
tax and withholding tax if the interest is not effectively connected with the
conduct of a trade or business within the United States by the foreign person
and the foreign person (i) is not actually or constructively a "10 percent
shareholder" of the Trust Fund or Provident (including a Holder of 10% of the
outstanding Certificates) or a "controlled foreign corporation" with respect
to which the Trust Fund or Provident is a "related person" within the meaning
of the Code and (ii) provides the Owner Trustee or other person who is 
otherwise required to withhold U.S. tax with respect to the Notes with an 
appropriate statement (on Form W-8 or a similar form), signed under penalties 
of perjury, certifying that the beneficial owner of the Note is a foreign 
person and providing the foreign person's name and address.  If a Note is 
held through a securities clearing organization or certain other financial 
institutions, the organization or institution may provide the relevant 
signed statement to the withholding agent; in that case, however, the 
signed statement must be accompanied by a Form W-8 or substitute form 
provided by the foreign person that owns the Note.  If such interest is 
not portfolio interest, then it will be subject to United States federal 
income and withholding tax at a rate of 30 percent, unless reduced or 
eliminated pursuant to an applicable tax treaty.

     Any capital gain realized on the sale, redemption, retirement or other
taxable disposition of a Note by a foreign person will be exempt from United
States federal income and withholding tax, provided that (i) such gain is not
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person and (ii) in the case of an individual foreign
person, the foreign person is not present in the United States for 183 days
or more in the taxable year.

     Backup Withholding.  Each Holder of a Note (other than an exempt Holder
such as a corporation, tax-exempt organization, qualified pension and
profit-sharing trust, individual retirement account or nonresident alien who
provides certification as to status as a nonresident) will be required to
provide, under penalties of perjury, a certificate containing the Holder's
name, address, correct federal taxpayer identification number and a statement
that the Holder is not subject to backup withholding.  Should a nonexempt
Noteholder fail to provide the required certification, the Trust Fund will be
required to withhold 31 percent of the amount otherwise payable to the
Holder, and remit the withheld amount to the IRS as a credit against the
Holder's federal income tax liability.

     Possible Alternative Treatments of the Notes.  If, contrary to the
opinion of Brown & Wood LLP special counsel to Provident, the IRS
successfully asserted that one or more of the Notes did not represent debt
for federal income tax purposes, the Notes might be treated as equity
interests in the Trust Fund.  If so treated, the Trust Fund might be taxable
as a corporation with the adverse consequences described above (and the
taxable corporation would not be able to reduce its taxable income by
deductions for interest expense on Notes recharacterized as equity). 
Alternatively, and most likely in the view of special counsel to Provident,
the Trust Fund might be treated as a publicly traded partnership that would
not be taxable as a corporation because it would meet certain qualifying
income tests.  Nonetheless, treatment of the Notes as equity interests in
such a publicly traded partnership could have adverse tax consequences to
certain Holders.  For example, income to certain tax-exempt entities
(including pension funds) would be "unrelated business taxable income",
income to foreign Holders generally would be subject to U.S. tax and U.S. tax
return filing and withholding requirements, and individual Holders might be
subject to certain limitations on their ability to deduct their share of the
Trust Fund's expenses.

TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE CERTIFICATES

     Treatment of the Trust Fund as a Partnership.  The Trust Fund and the
Master Servicer will agree, and the Certificateholders will agree by their
purchase of Certificates, to treat the Trust Fund as a partnership for
purposes of federal and state income tax, franchise tax and any other tax
measured in whole or in part by income, with the assets of the partnership
being the assets held by the Trust Fund, the partners of the partnership
being the Certificateholders, and the Notes being debt of the partnership. 
However, the proper characterization of the arrangement involving the Trust
Fund, the Certificates, the Notes, the Trust Fund and the Servicer is not
clear because there is no authority on transactions closely comparable to
that contemplated herein.

     A variety of alternative characterizations are possible.  For example,
because the Certificates have certain features characteristic of debt, the
Certificates might be considered debt of the Trust Fund.  Any such
characterization would not result in materially adverse tax consequences to
Certificateholders as compared to the consequences from treatment of the 
Certificates as equity in a partnership, described below.  The following 
discussion assumes that the Certificates represent equity interests in 
a partnership.

     Indexed Securities, etc.  The following discussion assumes that all
payments on the Certificates are denominated in U.S. dollars, none of the
Certificates are Indexed Securities or Strip Certificates, and that a Series
of Securities includes a single class of Certificates.  If these conditions
are not satisfied with respect to any given Series of Certificates,
additional tax considerations with respect to such Certificates will be
disclosed in the applicable Prospectus Supplement.

     Partnership Taxation.  As a partnership, the Trust Fund will not be
subject to federal income tax.  Rather, each Certificateholder will be
required to separately take into account such Holder's allocated share of
income, gains, losses, deductions and credits of the Trust Fund.  The Trust
Fund's income will consist primarily of interest and finance charges earned
on the Loans (including appropriate adjustments for market discount, OID and
bond premium) and any gain upon collection or disposition of Loans.  The
Trust Fund's deductions will consist primarily of interest accruing with
respect to the Notes, servicing and other fees, and losses or deductions upon
collection or disposition of Loans.

     The tax items of a partnership are allocable to the partners in
accordance with the Code, Treasury regulations and the partnership agreement
(here, the Trust Agreement and related documents).  The Trust Agreement will
provide, in general, that the Certificateholders will be allocated taxable
income of the Trust Fund for each month equal to the sum of (i) the interest
that accrues on the Certificates in accordance with their terms for such
month, including interest accruing at the Pass-Through Rate for such month
and interest on amounts previously due on the Certificates but not yet
distributed; (ii) any Trust Fund income attributable to discount on the Loans
that corresponds to any excess of the principal amount of the Certificates
over their initial issue price (iii) prepayment premium payable to the
Certificateholders for such month; and (iv) any other amounts of income
payable to the Certificateholders for such month.  Such allocation will be
reduced by any amortization by the Trust Fund of premium on Loans that
corresponds to any excess of the issue price of Certificates over their
principal amount.  All remaining taxable income of the Trust Fund will be
allocated to Provident.  Based on the economic arrangement of the parties,
this approach for allocating Trust Fund income should be permissible under
applicable Treasury regulations, although no assurance can be given that the
IRS would not require a greater amount of income to be allocated to
Certificateholders.  Moreover, even under the foregoing method of allocation,
Certificateholders may be allocated income equal to the entire Pass-Through
Rate plus the other items described above even though the Trust Fund might
not have sufficient cash to make current cash distributions of such amount. 
Thus, cash basis Holders will in effect be required to report income from the
Certificates on the accrual basis and Certificateholders may become liable
for taxes on Trust Fund income even if they have not received cash from the
Trust Fund to pay such taxes.  In addition, because tax allocations and tax
reporting will be done on a uniform basis for all Certificateholders but
Certificateholders may be purchasing Certificates at different times and at
different prices, Certificateholders may be required to report on their tax
returns taxable income that is greater or less than the amount reported to
them by the Trust Fund.

     All of the taxable income allocated to a Certificateholder that is a
pension, profit sharing or employee benefit plan or other tax-exempt entity
(including an individual retirement account) will constitute "unrelated
business taxable income" generally taxable to a Holder under the Code.

     An individual taxpayer's share of expenses of the Trust Fund (including
fees to the Servicer but not interest expense) would be miscellaneous
itemized deductions.  Such deductions might be disallowed to the individual
in whole or in part and might result in such Holder being taxed on an amount
of income that exceeds the amount of cash actually distributed to such Holder
over the life of the Trust Fund.

     The Trust Fund intends to make all tax calculations relating to income
and allocations to Certificateholders on an aggregate basis.  If the IRS were
to require that such calculations be made separately for each Loan, the Trust
Fund might be required to incur additional expense but it is believed that
there would not be a material adverse effect on Certificateholders.

     Discount and Premium.  It is believed that the Loans were not issued
with OID, and, therefore, the Trust Fund should not have OID income. 
However, the purchase price paid by the Trust Fund for the Loans may be
greater or less than the remaining principal balance of the Loans at the time
of purchase.  If so, the Loan will have been acquired at a premium or
discount, as the case may be.  (As indicated above, the Trust Fund will make
this calculation on an aggregate basis, but might be required to recompute it
on a Loan by Loan basis.)

     If the Trust Fund acquires the Loans at a market discount or premium,
the Trust Fund will elect to include any such discount in income currently as
it accrues over the life of the Loans or to offset any such premium against
interest income on the Loans.  As indicated above, a portion of such market
discount income or premium deduction may be allocated to Certificateholders.

     Section 708 Termination.  Under Section 708 of the Code, the Trust Fund
will be deemed to terminate for federal income tax purposes if 50% or more of
the capital and profits interests in the Trust Fund are sold or exchanged
within a 12-month period.  If such a termination occurs, the Trust Fund will
be considered to distribute its assets to the partners, who would then be
treated as recontributing those assets to the Trust Fund as a new
partnership.  The Trust Fund will not comply with certain technical
requirements that might apply when such a constructive termination occurs. 
As a result, the Trust Fund may be subject to certain tax penalties and may
incur additional expenses if it is required to comply with those
requirements.  Furthermore, the Trust Fund might not be able to comply due to
lack of data.

     Disposition of Certificates.  Generally, capital gain or loss will be
recognized on a sale of Certificates in an amount equal to the difference
between the amount realized and the seller's tax basis in the Certificates
sold.  A Certificateholder's tax basis in a Certificate will generally equal
the Holder's cost increased by the Holder's share of Trust Fund income
(includible in income) and decreased by any distributions received with
respect to such Certificate.  In addition, both the tax basis in the
Certificates and the amount realized on a sale of a Certificate would include
the Holder's share of the Notes and other liabilities of the Trust Fund.  A
Holder acquiring Certificates at different prices may be required to maintain
a single aggregate adjusted tax basis in such Certificates, and, upon sale or
other disposition of some of the Certificates, allocate a portion of such
aggregate tax basis to the Certificates sold (rather than maintaining a
separate tax basis in each Certificate for purposes of computing gain or loss
on a sale of that Certificate).

     Any gain on the sale of a Certificate attributable to the Holder's share
of unrecognized accrued market discount on the Loans would generally be
treated as ordinary income to the Holder and would give rise to special tax
reporting requirements.  The Trust Fund does not expect to have any other
assets that would give rise to such special reporting requirements.  Thus, to
avoid those special reporting requirements, the Trust Fund will elect to
include market discount in income as it accrues.

     If a Certificateholder is required to recognize an aggregate amount of
income (not including income attributable to disallowed itemized deductions
described above) over the life of the Certificates that exceeds the aggregate
cash distributions with respect thereto, such excess will generally give rise
to a capital loss upon the retirement of the Certificates.

     Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees.  In general, the Trust
Fund's taxable income and losses will be determined monthly and the tax items
for a particular calendar month will be apportioned among the
Certificateholders in proportion to the principal amount of Certificates
owned by them as of the close of the last day of such month.  As a result, a
Holder purchasing Certificates may be allocated tax items (which will affect
its tax liability and tax basis) attributable to periods before the actual
transaction.

     The use of such a monthly convention may not be permitted by existing
regulations.  If a monthly convention is not allowed (or only applies to
transfers of less than all of the partner's interest), taxable income or
losses of the Trust Fund might be reallocated among the Certificateholders. 
The Trust Fund's method of allocation between transferors and transferees 
may be revised to conform to a method permitted by future regulations.

     Section 754 Election.  In the event that a Certificateholder sells its
Certificates at a profit (loss), the purchasing Certificateholder will have a
higher (lower) basis in the Certificates than the selling Certificateholder
had.  The tax basis of the Trust Fund's assets will not be adjusted to
reflect that higher (or lower) basis unless the Trust Fund were to file an
election under Section 754 of the Code.  In order to avoid the administrative
complexities that would be involved in keeping accurate accounting records,
as well as potentially onerous information reporting requirements, the Trust
Fund will not make such election.  As a result, Certificateholders might be
allocated a greater or lesser amount of Trust Fund income than would be
appropriate based on their own purchase price for Certificates.

     Administrative Matters.  The Owner Trustee is required to keep or have
kept complete and accurate books of the Trust Fund.  Such books will be
maintained for financial reporting and tax purposes on an accrual basis and
the fiscal year of the Trust Fund will be the calendar year.  The Trustee
will file a partnership information return (IRS Form 1065) with the IRS for
each taxable year of the Trust Fund and will report each Certificateholder's
allocable share of items of Trust Fund income and expense to Holders and the
IRS on Schedule K-1.  The Trust Fund will provide the Schedule K-l
information to nominees that fail to provide the Trust Fund with the
information statement described below and such nominees will be required to
forward such information to the beneficial owners of the Certificates. 
Generally, Holders must file tax returns that are consistent with the
information return filed by the Trust Fund or be subject to penalties unless
the Holder notifies the IRS of all such inconsistencies.

     Under Section 6031 of the Code, any person that holds Certificates as a
nominee at any time during a calendar year is required to furnish the Trust
Fund with a statement containing certain information on the nominee, the
beneficial owners and the Certificates so held.  Such information includes
(i) the name, address and taxpayer identification number of the nominee and
(ii) as to each beneficial owner (x) the name, address and identification
number of such person, (y) whether such person is a United States person, a
tax-exempt entity or a foreign government, an international organization, or
any wholly owned agency or instrumentality of either of the foregoing, and
(z) certain information on Certificates that were held, bought or sold on
behalf of such person throughout the year.  In addition, brokers and
financial institutions that hold Certificates through a nominee are required
to furnish directly to the Trust Fund information as to themselves and their
ownership of Certificates.  A clearing agency registered under Section 17A of
the Exchange Act is not required to furnish any such information statement to
the Trust Fund.  The information referred to above for any calendar year must
be furnished to the Trust Fund on or before the following January 31. 
Nominees, brokers and financial institutions that fail to provide the Trust
Fund with the information described above may be subject to penalties.

     Provident or the Trustee will be designated as the tax matters partner
in the related Trust Agreement and, as such, will be responsible for
representing the Certificateholders in any dispute with the IRS.  The Code
provides for administrative examination of a partnership as if the
partnership were a separate and distinct taxpayer.  Generally, the statute of
limitations for partnership items does not expire before three years after
the date on which the partnership information return is filed.  Any adverse
determination following an audit of the return of the Trust Fund by the
appropriate taxing authorities could result in an adjustment of the returns
of the Certificateholders, and, under certain circumstances, a
Certificateholder may be precluded from separately litigating a proposed
adjustment to the items of the Trust Fund.  An adjustment could also result
in an audit of a Certificateholder's returns and adjustments of items not
related to the income and losses of the Trust Fund.

     Tax Consequences to Foreign Certificateholders.  It is not clear whether
the Trust Fund would be considered to be engaged in a trade or business in
the United States for purposes of federal withholding taxes with respect to
non-U.S. persons because there is no clear authority dealing with that issue
under facts substantially similar to those described herein.  Although it is
not expected that the Trust Fund would be engaged in a trade or business in
the United States for such purposes, the Trust Fund will withhold as if it
were so engaged in order to protect the Trust Fund from possible adverse
consequences of a failure to withhold.  The Trust Fund expects to withhold on
the portion of its taxable income that is allocable to foreign
Certificateholders pursuant to Section 1446 of the Code, as if such income 
were effectively connected to a U.S. trade or business, at a rate of 35% 
for foreign holders that are taxable as corporations and 39.6% for all 
other foreign holders. Subsequent adoption of Treasury regulations or the 
issuance of other administrative pronouncements may require the Trust Fund to 
change its withholding procedures.  In determining a Holder's withholding 
status, the Trust Fund may rely on IRS Form W-8, IRS Form W-9 or the Holder's
certification of nonforeign status signed under penalties of perjury.

     The term "U.S. Person" means a citizen or resident of the United States,
a corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under
the laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof, or an
estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its
source of income, or a trust if a court within the United States is able to
exercise primary supervision of the administration of the trust and one or
more United States fiduciaries have the authority to control all substantial
decisions of the trust.

     Each foreign Holder might be required to file a U.S. individual or
corporate income tax return (including, in the case of a corporation, the
branch profits tax) on its share of the Trust Fund's income.  Each foreign
Holder must obtain a taxpayer identification number from the IRS and submit
that number to the Trust Fund on Form W-8 in order to assure appropriate
crediting of the taxes withheld.  A foreign Holder generally would be
entitled to file with the IRS a claim for refund with respect to taxes
withheld by the Trust Fund taking the position that no taxes were due because
the Trust Fund was not engaged in a U.S. trade or business.  However,
interest payments made (or accrued) to a Certificateholder who is a foreign
person generally will be considered guaranteed payments to the extent such
payments are determined without regard to the income of the Trust Fund.  If
these interest payments are properly characterized as guaranteed payments,
then the interest will not be considered "portfolio interest." As a result,
Certificateholders will be subject to United States federal income tax and
withholding tax at a rate of 30 percent, unless reduced or eliminated
pursuant to an applicable treaty.  In such case, a foreign Holder would only
be entitled to claim a refund for that portion of the taxes in excess of the
taxes that should be withheld with respect to the guaranteed payments.

     Backup Withholding.  Distributions made on the Certificates and proceeds
from the sale of the Certificates will be subject to a "backup" withholding
tax of 31% if, in general, the Certificateholder fails to comply with certain
identification procedures, unless the Holder is an exempt recipient under
applicable provisions of the Code.


                           STATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS

     In addition to the federal income tax consequences described in "Federal
Income Tax Consequences," potential investors should consider the state and
local income tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership, and disposition
of the Securities.  State and local income tax law may differ substantially
from the corresponding federal law, and this discussion does not purport to
describe any aspect of the income tax laws of any state or locality. 
Therefore, potential investors should consult their own tax advisors with
respect to the various state and local tax consequences of an investment in
the Securities.


                             ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     The following describes certain considerations under ERISA and the Code,
which apply only to Securities of a Series that are not divided into
subclasses.  If Securities are divided into subclasses, the related
Prospectus Supplement will contain information concerning considerations
relating to ERISA and the Code that are applicable to such Securities.

     ERISA imposes requirements on employee benefit plans (and on certain
other retirement plans and arrangements, including individual retirement
accounts and annuities, Keogh plans and collective investment funds and
separate accounts in which such plans, accounts or arrangements are invested)
(collectively "Plans") subject to ERISA and on persons who are fiduciaries
with respect to such Plans.  Generally, ERISA applies to investments made by 
Plans.  Among other things, ERISA requires that the assets of Plans be held 
in trust and that the trustee, or other duly
authorized fiduciary, have exclusive authority and discretion to manage and
control the assets of such Plans.  ERISA also imposes certain duties on
persons who are fiduciaries of Plans.  Under ERISA, any person who exercises
any authority or control respecting the management or disposition of the
assets of a Plan is considered to be a fiduciary of such Plan (subject to
certain exceptions not here relevant).  Certain employee benefit plans, such
as governmental plans (as defined in ERISA Section 3(32)) and, if no election
has been made under Section 410(d) of the Code, church plans (as defined in
ERISA Section 3(33)), are not subject to ERISA requirements.  Accordingly,
assets of such plans may be invested in Securities without regard to the
ERISA considerations described above and below, subject to the provisions of
applicable state law.  Any such plan which is qualified and exempt from
taxation under Code Sections 401(a) and 501(a), however, is subject to the
prohibited transaction rules set forth in Code Section 503. 

     On November 13, 1986, the United States Department of Labor (the "DOL")
issued final regulations concerning the definition of what constitutes the
assets of a Plan.  (Labor Reg. Section 2510.3-101).  Under this regulation,
the underlying assets and properties of corporations, partnerships and
certain other entities in which a Plan makes an "equity" investment could be
deemed for purposes of ERISA to be assets of the investing Plan in certain
circumstances.  However, the regulation provides that, generally, the assets
of a corporation or partnership in which a Plan invests will not be deemed
for purposes of ERISA to be assets of such Plan if the equity interest
acquired by the investing Plan is a publicly-offered security.  A
publicly-offered security, as defined in the Labor Reg. Section 2510.3-101,
is a security that is widely held, freely transferable and registered under
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

     In addition to the imposition of general fiduciary standards of
investment prudence and diversification, ERISA prohibits a broad range of
transactions involving Plan assets and persons ("Parties in Interest") having
certain specified relationships to a Plan and imposes additional prohibitions
where Parties in Interest are fiduciaries with respect to such Plan.  Because
the Loans may be deemed Plan assets of each Plan that purchases Securities,
an investment in the Securities by a Plan might be a prohibited transaction
under ERISA Sections 406 and 407 and subject to an excise tax under Code
Section 4975 unless a statutory or administrative exemption applies.

     In Prohibited Transaction Exemption 83-1 ("PTE 83-1"), which amended
Prohibited Transaction Exemption 81-7, the DOL exempted from ERISA's
prohibited transaction rules certain transactions relating to the operation
of residential mortgage pool investment trusts and the purchase, sale and
holding of "mortgage pool pass-through certificates" in the initial issuance
of such certificates.  PTE 83-1 permits, subject to certain conditions,
transactions which might otherwise be prohibited between Plans and Parties in
Interest with respect to those Plans related to the origination, maintenance
and termination of mortgage pools consisting of mortgage loans secured by
first or second mortgages or deeds of trust on single-family residential
property, and the acquisition and holding of certain mortgage pool pass-
through certificates representing an interest in such mortgage pools by
Plans.  If the general conditions (discussed below) of PTE 83-1 are
satisfied, investments by a Plan in Securities that represent interests in a
Pool consisting of Loans ("Single Family Securities") will be exempt from the
prohibitions of ERISA Sections 406(a) and 407 (relating generally to
transactions with Parties in Interest who are not fiduciaries) if the Plan
purchases the Single Family Securities at no more than fair market value and
will be exempt from the prohibitions of ERISA Sections 406(b)(1) and (2)
(relating generally to transactions with fiduciaries) if, in addition, the
purchase is approved by an independent fiduciary, no sales commission is paid
to the pool sponsor, the Plan does not purchase more than 25% of all Single
Family Securities, and at least 50% of all Single Family Securities are
purchased by persons independent of the pool sponsor or pool trustee.  PTE
83-1 does not provide an exemption for transactions involving Subordinate
Securities.  Accordingly, no transfer of a Subordinate Security or a Security
which is not a Single Family Security may be made to a Plan unless specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     The discussion in this and the next succeeding paragraph applies only to
Single Family Securities.  Provident believes that, for purposes of PTE 83-1,
the term "mortgage pass-through certificate" would include: (i) Securities
issued in a Series consisting of only a single class of Securities; and (ii)
Securities issued in a Series in which there is only one class of such
Securities; provided that the Securities in the case of
            --------
clause (i), or the Securities in the case of clause (ii), evidence the
beneficial ownership of both a specified percentage of 
future interest payments (greater than 0%) and a specified percentage
(greater than 0%) of future principal payments on the Loans.  It is not clear
whether a class of Securities that evidences the beneficial ownership in a
Trust Fund divided into Loan groups, beneficial ownership of a specified
percentage of interest payments only or principal payments only, or a
notional amount of either principal or interest payments, or a class of
Securities entitled to receive payments of interest and principal on the
Loans only after payments to other classes or after the occurrence of certain
specified events would be a "mortgage pass-through certificate" for purposes
of PTE 83-1.

     PTE 83-1 sets forth three general conditions which must be satisfied for
any transaction to be eligible for exemption: (i) the maintenance of a system
of insurance or other protection for the pooled mortgage loans and property
securing such loans, and for indemnifying Securityholders against reductions
in pass-through payments due to property damage or defaults in loan payments
in an amount not less than the greater of one percent of the aggregate
principal balance of all covered pooled mortgage loans or the principal
balance of the largest covered pooled mortgage loan; (ii) the existence of a
pool trustee who is not an affiliate of the pool sponsor; and (iii) a
limitation on the amount of the payment retained by the pool sponsor,
together with other funds inuring to its benefit, to not more than adequate
consideration for selling the mortgage loans plus reasonable compensation for
services provided by the pool sponsor to the pool.  Provident believes that
the first general condition referred to above will be satisfied with respect
to the Securities in a Series issued without a subordination feature, or the
Securities only in a Series issued with a subordination feature, provided
that the subordination and Reserve Account, subordination by shifting of
interests, the pool insurance or other form of credit enhancement described
under "Credit Enhancement" herein (such subordination, pool insurance or
other form of credit enhancement being the system of insurance or other
protection referred to above) with respect to a Series of Securities is
maintained in an amount not less than the greater of one percent of the
aggregate principal balance of the Loans or the principal balance of the
largest Loan.  See "Description of the Securities" herein.  In the absence of
a ruling that the system of insurance or other protection with respect to a
Series of Securities satisfies the first general condition referred to above,
there can be no assurance that these features will be so viewed by the DOL. 
The Trustee will not be affiliated with Provident.

     Each Plan fiduciary who is responsible for making the investment
decisions whether to purchase or commit to purchase and to hold Single Family
Securities must make its own determination as to whether the first and third
general conditions, and the specific conditions described briefly in the
preceding paragraphs, of PTE 83-1 have been satisfied, or as to the
availability of any other prohibited transaction exemptions.  Each Plan
fiduciary should also determine whether, under the general fiduciary
standards of investment prudence and diversification, an investment in the
Securities is appropriate for the Plan, taking into account the overall
investment policy of the Plan and the composition of the Plan's investment
portfolio.

     The DOL has granted to certain underwriters individual administrative
exemptions (the "Underwriter Exemptions") from certain of the prohibited
transaction rules of ERISA and the related excise tax provisions of Section
4975 of the Code with respect to the initial purchase, the holding and the
subsequent resale by Plans of certificates in pass-through trusts that
consist of certain receivables, loans and other obligations that meet the
conditions and requirements of the Underwriter Exemptions.

     While each Underwriter Exemption is an individual exemption separately
granted to a specific underwriter, the terms and conditions which generally
apply to the Underwriter Exemptions are substantially the following:

          (1)  the acquisition of the certificates by a Plan is on terms
     (including the price for the certificates) that are at least as
     favorable to the Plan as they would be in an arm's-length transaction
     with an unrelated party;

          (2)  the rights and interests evidenced by the certificates
     acquired by the Plan are not subordinated to the rights and interests
     evidenced by other certificates of the trust fund;

          (3)  the certificates required by the Plan have received a rating
     at the time of such acquisition that is one of the three highest generic
     rating categories from Standard & Poor's Ratings 

     Group, a Division of The McGraw-Hill Companies ("S&P"), Moody's
     Investors Service, Inc. ("Moody's"), Duff & Phelps Credit Rating Co.
     ("DCR") or Fitch Investors Service, Inc. ("Fitch");

          (4)  the trustee must not be an affiliate of any other member of
     the Restricted Group as defined below;

          (5)  the sum of all payments made to and retained by the
     underwriters in connection with the distribution of the certificates
     represents not more than reasonable compensation for underwriting the
     certificates; the sum of all payments made to and retained by the seller
     pursuant to the assignment of the loans to the trust fund represents not
     more than the fair market value of such loans; the sum of all payments
     made to and retained by the servicer and any other servicer represents
     not more than reasonable compensation for such person's services under
     the agreement pursuant to which the loans are pooled and reimbursements
     of such person's reasonable expenses in connection therewith; and

          (6)  the Plan investing in the certificates is an "accredited
     investor" as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of the Securities
     and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

     The trust fund must also meet the following requirements:

     (i)  the corpus of the trust fund must consist solely of assets of the
type that have been included in other investment pools;

     (ii)  certificates in such other investment pools must have been rated
in one of the three highest rating categories of S&P, Moody's, Fitch or DCR
for at least one year prior to the Plan's acquisition of certificates; and

     (iii)  certificates evidencing interests in such other investment pools
must have been purchased by investors other than Plans for at least one year
prior to any Plan's acquisition of certificates.

     Moreover, the Underwriter Exemptions generally provide relief from
certain self-dealing/conflict of interest prohibited transactions that may
occur when the Plan fiduciary causes a Plan to acquire certificates in a
trust as to which the fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor on the
receivables held in the trust, provided that, among other requirements: (i)
in the case of an acquisition in connection with the initial issuance of
certificates, at least fifty percent (50%) of each class of certificates in
which Plans have invested is acquired by persons independent of the
Restricted Group (as defined below), (ii) such fiduciary (or its affiliate)
is an obligor with respect to five percent (5%) or less of the fair market
value of the obligations contained in the trust; (iii) the Plan's investment
in certificates of any class does not exceed twenty-five percent (25%) of all
of the certificates of that class outstanding at the time of the acquisition;
and (iv) immediately after the acquisition, no more than twenty-five percent
(25%) of the assets of the Plan with respect to which such person is a
fiduciary is invested in certificates representing an interest in one or more
trusts containing assets sold or serviced by the same entity.  The
Underwriter Exemptions do not apply to Plans sponsored by Provident, the
related Underwriter, the Trustee, the Master Servicer, any insurer with
respect to the Loans, any obligor with respect to Loans included in the Trust
Fund constituting more than five percent (5%) of the aggregate unamortized
principal balance of the assets in the Trust Fund, or any affiliate of such
parties (the "Restricted Group").

     The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities will indicate
the classes of Securities, if any, offered thereby as to which it is expected
that an Underwriter Exemption will apply.

     The Underwriter Exemption contains several requirements, some of which
differ from those in PTE 83-l.  The Underwriter Exemption contains an
expanded definition of "certificate" which includes an interest which
entitles the holder to pass-through payments of principal, interest and/or
other payments.  The Underwriter Exemption contains an expanded definition of
"trust" which permits the trust corpus to consist of secured consumer
receivables.  The definition of "trust", however, does not include any
investment pool unless, inter alia, (i) the investment pool consists only of
assets of the type which have been included in other 
investment pools, (ii) certificates evidencing interests in such other
investment pools have been purchased by investors other than Plans for at
least one year prior to the Plan's acquisition of certificates pursuant to
the Underwriter Exemption, and (iii) certificates in such other investment
pools have been rated in one of the three highest generic rating categories
of the four credit rating agencies noted below.  Generally, the Underwriter
Exemption holds that the acquisition of the certificates by a Plan must be on
terms (including the price for the certificates) that are at least as
favorable to the Plan as they would be in an arm's length transaction with an
unrelated party.  The Underwriter Exemption requires that the rights and
interests evidenced by the certificates not be "subordinated" to the rights
and interests evidenced by other certificates of the same trust.  The
Underwriter Exemption requires that certificates acquired by a Plan have
received a rating at the time of their acquisition that is in one of the
three highest generic rating categories of S&P, Moody's, Fitch or DCR.  The
Underwriter Exemption specifies that the pool trustee must not be an
affiliate of the pool sponsor, nor an affiliate of the Underwriter, the pool
servicer, any obligor with respect to mortgage loans included in the trust
constituting more than five percent (5%) of the aggregate unamortized
principal balance of the assets in the trust, or any affiliate of such
entities.  Finally, the Underwriter Exemption stipulates that any Plan
investing in the certificates must be an "accredited investor" as defined in
Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of the Securities and Exchange Commission
under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

     Any Plan fiduciary which proposes to cause a Plan to purchase Securities
should consult with their counsel concerning the impact of ERISA and the
Code, the applicability of PTE 83-1 and the Underwriter Exemption, and the
potential consequences in their specific circumstances, prior to making such
investment.  Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should determine whether under the
general fiduciary standards of investment prudence and diversification an
investment in the Securities is appropriate for the Plan, taking into account
the overall investment policy of the Plan and the composition of the Plan's
investment portfolio.



                               LEGAL INVESTMENT

     The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities will specify
which, if any, of the classes of Securities offered thereby constitute
"mortgage related securities" for purposes of the Secondary Mortgage Market
Enhancement Act of 1984 ("SMMEA").  Classes of Securities that qualify as
"mortgage related securities" will be legal investments for persons, trusts,
corporations, partnerships, associations, business trusts, and business
entities (including depository institutions, life insurance companies and
pension funds) created pursuant to or existing under the laws of the United
States or of any state (including the District of Columbia and Puerto Rico)
whose authorized investments are subject to state regulations to the same
extent as, under applicable law, obligations issued by or guaranteed as to
principal and interest by the United States or any such entities.  Under
SMMEA, if a state enacted legislation prior to October 4, 1991 specifically
limiting the legal investment authority of any such entities with respect to
"mortgage related securities", Securities will constitute legal investments
for entities subject to such legislation only to the extent provided therein. 
Approximately twenty-one states adopted such legislation prior to the October
4, 1991 deadline.

     SMMEA also amended the legal investment authority of federally-chartered
depository institutions as follows: federal savings and loan associations and
federal savings banks may invest in, sell or otherwise deal in Securities
without limitations as to the percentage of their assets represented thereby,
federal credit unions may invest "in mortgage related securities", and
national banks may purchase securities for their own account without regard
to the limitations generally applicable to investment securities set forth in
12 U.S.C. 24 (Seventh), subject  in each case to such regulations as the
applicable federal authority may prescribe.  In this connection, federal
credit unions should review the National Credit Union Administration ("NCUA")
Letter to Credit Unions No. 96, as modified by Letter to Credit Unions No.
108, which includes guidelines to assist federal credit unions in making
investment decisions for "mortgage related securities" and the NCUA's
regulation "Investment and Deposit Activities" (12 C.F.R. Part 703), which
sets forth certain restrictions on investments by federal credit unions in
"mortgage related securities" (in each case whether or not the class of
Securities under consideration for purchase constituted a "mortgage related
security").

     All depository institutions considering an investment in the Securities
(whether or not the class of Securities under consideration for purchase
constitutes a "mortgage related security") should review the Federal
Financial Institutions Examination Council's Supervisory Policy Statement on
the Securities Activities (to the extent adopted by their respective
regulators) (the "Policy Statement") setting forth, in relevant part, certain
securities trading and sales practices deemed unsuitable for an institution's
investment portfolio, and guidelines for (and restrictions on) investing in
mortgage derivative products, including "mortgage related securities", which
are "high-risk mortgage securities" as defined in the Policy Statement. 
According to the Policy Statement, such "high-risk mortgage securities"
include securities such as Securities not entitled to distributions allocated
to principal or interest, or Subordinated Securities.  Under the Policy
Statement, it is the responsibility of each depository institution to
determine, prior to purchase (and at stated intervals thereafter), whether a
particular mortgage derivative product is a "high-risk mortgage security",
and whether the purchase (or retention) of such a product would be consistent
with the Policy Statement.

     The foregoing does not take into consideration the applicability of
statutes, rules, regulations, orders, guidelines or agreements generally
governing investments made by a particular investor, including, but not
limited to "prudent investor" provisions which may restrict or prohibit
investment in securities which are not "interest bearing" or "income paying".

     There may be other restrictions on the ability of certain investors,
including depository institutions, either to purchase Securities or to
purchase Securities representing more than a specified percentage of the
investor's assets.  Investors should consult their own legal advisors in
determining whether and to what extent the Securities constitute legal
investments for such investors.


                            METHOD OF DISTRIBUTION

     Securities are being offered hereby in Series from time to time (each
Series evidencing or relating to a separate Trust Fund) through any of the
following methods:

          1.  By negotiated firm commitment underwriting and public
     reoffering by underwriters;

          2.  By agency placements through one or more  placement agents
     primarily with institutional investors and dealers; and

          3.  By placement directly by Provident with institutional
     investors.

     A Prospectus Supplement will be prepared for each Series which will
describe the method of offering being used for that Series and will set forth
the identity of any underwriters thereof and either the price at which such
Series is being offered, the nature and amount of any underwriting discounts
or additional compensation to such underwriters and the proceeds of the
offering to Provident, or the method by which the price at which the
underwriters will sell the Securities will be determined.  Each Prospectus
Supplement for an underwritten offering will also contain information
regarding the nature of the underwriters' obligations, any material
relationship between Provident and any underwriter and, where appropriate,
information regarding any discounts or concessions to be allowed or reallowed
to dealers or others and any arrangements to stabilize the market for the
Securities so offered.  In firm commitment underwritten offerings, the
underwriters will be obligated to purchase all of the Securities of such
Series if any such Securities are purchased.  Securities may be acquired by
the underwriters for their own accounts and may be resold from time to time
in one or more transactions, including negotiated transactions, at a fixed
public offering price or at varying prices determined at the time of sale.

     Underwriters and agents may be entitled under agreements entered into
with Provident to indemnification by Provident against certain civil
liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended, or to contribution with respect to payments which such underwriters
or agents may be required to make in respect thereof.

     If a Series is offered other than through underwriters, the Prospectus
Supplement relating thereto will contain information regarding the nature of
such offering and any agreements to be entered into between Provident and
purchasers of Securities of such Series.


                                LEGAL MATTERS

     Certain legal matters relating to the Securities of each Series will be
passed upon for Provident by Keating, Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L., Cincinnati,
Ohio.  Certain legal matters relating to certain federal income tax
consequences with respect to the Securities will be passed upon for Provident
by Brown & Wood LLP, New York, New York.


                            FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     A new Trust Fund will be formed with respect to each Series of
Securities and no Trust Fund will engage in any business activities or have
any assets or obligations prior to the issuance of the related Series of
Securities.  Accordingly, no financial statements with respect to any Trust
Fund will be included in this Prospectus or in the related Prospectus
Supplement.


                                    RATING

     It is a condition to the issuance of the Securities of each Series
offered hereby and by the Prospectus Supplement that they shall have been
rated in one of the four highest rating categories by the nationally
recognized statistical rating agency or agencies (each, a "Rating Agency")
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Any such rating would be based on, among other things, the adequacy of
the value of the Trust Fund Assets and any credit enhancement with respect to
such class and will reflect such Rating Agency's assessment solely of the
likelihood that Holders of a class of Securities will receive payments to
which such Securityholders are entitled under the related Agreement.  Such
rating will not constitute an assessment of the likelihood that principal
prepayments on the related Loans will be made, the degree to which the rate
of such prepayments might differ from that originally anticipated or the
likelihood of early optional termination of the Series of Securities.  Such
rating should not be deemed a recommendation to purchase, hold or sell
Securities, inasmuch as it does not address market price or suitability for a
particular investor.  Each security rating should be evaluated independently
of any other security rating.  Such rating will not address the possibility
that prepayment at higher or lower rates than anticipated by an investor may
cause such investor to experience a lower than anticipated yield or that an
investor purchasing a Security at a significant premium might fail to recoup
its initial investment under certain prepayment scenarios.

     There is also no assurance that any such rating will remain in effect
for any given period of time or that it may not be lowered or withdrawn
entirely by the Rating Agency in the future if in its judgment circumstances
in the future so warrant.  In addition to being lowered or withdrawn due to
any erosion in the adequacy of the value of the Trust Fund Assets or any
credit enhancement with respect to a Series, such rating might also be
lowered or withdrawn for other reasons, including, but not limited to, an
adverse change in the financial or other condition of a credit enhancement
provider or a change in the rating of such credit enhancement provider's
long-term debt.

     The amount, type and nature of credit enhancement, if any, established
with respect to a Series of Securities will be determined on the basis of
criteria established by each Rating Agency rating classes of such Series. 
Such criteria are sometimes based upon an actuarial analysis of the behavior
of mortgage loans in a larger group.  Such analysis is often the basis upon
which each Rating Agency determines the amount of credit 

enhancement required with respect to each such class.  There can be no
assurance that the historical data supporting any such actuarial analysis
will accurately reflect future experience nor any assurance that the data
derived from a large pool of mortgage loans accurately predicts the
delinquency, foreclosure or loss experience of any particular pool of Loans. 
No assurance can be given that values of any Properties have remained or will
remain at their levels on the respective dates of origination of the related
Loans.  If the residential real estate markets should experience an overall
decline in property values such that the outstanding principal balances of
the Loans in a particular Trust Fund and any secondary financing on the
related Properties become equal to or greater than the value of the
Properties, the rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses could be
higher than those now generally experienced in the mortgage lending industry. 
In additional, adverse economic conditions (which may or may not affect real
property values) may affect the timely payment by mortgagors of scheduled
payments of principal and interest on the Loans and, accordingly, the rates
of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses with respect to any Trust Fund.  To
the extent that such losses are not covered by credit enhancement, such
losses will be borne, at least in part, by the Holders of one or more classes
of the Securities of the related Series.

                            INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS

Term                                                                     Page
- ----                                                                   ----

Accrual Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
Amortizable Bond Premium Regulations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  63
APR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Available Funds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
Balloon payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Belgian Cooperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
Beneficial owner  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
BIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
Book-Entry Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Buydown Fund  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Buydown Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Capitalized Interest Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  45
Cash Flow Bond Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
CEDEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
CEDEL Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
CERCLA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Class Security Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
Closed-End Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Code  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Collateral Value  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Commission  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Companion Classes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  30
Components  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  29
Contingent Regulations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
Cut-Off Date  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 18
Cut-Off Date Principal Balance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
DCR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
Debt Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
Debt-to-income ratio  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
Definitive Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Detailed Description  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Distribution Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
DOL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
DTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
EPA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
ERISA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  11
Euroclear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Euroclear Operator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
Euroclear Participants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
European Depositaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Excess Servicing Fees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
Exchange Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
FDIC  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
FHLMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
Financial Intermediary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Fitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
FNMA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23
Foreign person  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  73
Funding Period  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
Garn-St Germain Act . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  56
Home Equity Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Indenture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Insurance Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Insured Expenses  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Interest Weighted Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  62
IRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
L/C Bank  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 36
Liquidation Expenses  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Liquidation Proceeds  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
Loan Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6, 19
Loan-to-Value Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Lockout Periods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
Mark-to-Market Regulations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  67
Master Servicer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Master Servicing Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
Master Servicing Fee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  47
Moody's . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
Morgan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  33
Mortgage  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  41
Mortgage Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Mortgage Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Mortgaged Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
NCUA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  82
Nonresidents  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  71
Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
OID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 59
OID Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
PACs  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  30
Parties in Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
Pass-Through Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Pass-Through Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
Pay-Through Security  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
Permitted Investments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  37
Plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
Policy Statement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  82
Pool  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 17
Pool Insurance Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
Pool Insurer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
Pooling and Servicing Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Pre-Funded Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
Pre-Funding Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 16
Prepayment Assumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Principal Prepayments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  27
Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Provident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
PTE 83-1  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
Purchase Price  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Rating Agency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  83
Ratio Strip Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
RCRA  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  55
Record Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
Refinance Loan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
Regular Interest Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
Relevant Depositary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Relief Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
REMIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Reserve Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Residual Interest Security  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  65
Restricted Group  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
Retained Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
Revolving Credit Line Loans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Riegle Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
S&P . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
SAIF  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
Secured Creditor Exclusion  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4
Security Account  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
Security Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
Security Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
Senior Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5, 35
Series  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Servicing Fees  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
Short-Term Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  72
Single Family Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
Single Family Securities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
SMMEA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 81
STIFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  37
Stripped Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
Sub-Servicer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Sub-Servicing Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  45
Subordinated Securities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Subsequent Loans  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
TACs  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  31
Terms and Conditions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  34
Thrift institutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  66
TIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  70
Title V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
Trust Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18, 24
Trust Fund  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Trust Fund Assets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1, 4, 17
Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4, 24
U.S. Person . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  77
Underwriter Exemptions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  79



                                   PART II

                    INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

ITEM 14.  OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION*

     The following table sets forth the estimated expenses in connection with
the issuance and  distribution of the Securities being  registered under this
Registration Statement, other than underwriting discounts and commissions:

SEC Registration Fee                    $  151,515.15
Printing and Engraving Expenses         $    125,000.00
Legal Fees and Expenses                 $    500,000.00
Trustee Fees and Expenses               $    50,000.00
Accounting Fees and Expenses            $    125,000.00
Blue Sky Fees and Expenses              $    15,000.00
Rating Agency Fees                      $    200,000.00
Miscellaneous                           $    100,000.00
                                        ---------------

Total                                   $    1,266,515.15

____________
*    All amounts  except the SEC  Registration Fee are estimates  of expenses
     incurred in connection with the issuance and distribution of a Series of
     Securities in an  aggregate principal amount assumed for  these purposes
     to be equal to $500,000,000 of Securities registered hereby.

ITEM 15.  INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.

     The Registrant's  Code of  Regulations provides  for indemnification  of
directors and officers of the  Registrant to the fullest extent  permitted by
law.  In particular, the Code of Regulations provides for indemnification for
any person who  was or is a party or is threatened  to be made a party to any
threatened, pending or  completed action, suit or proceeding,  whether civil,
criminal, administrative  or investigative, by reason of  the fact that he is
or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the Registrant, or is or was
serving at  the request  of the Registrant  as a director,  trustee, officer,
employee or agent  of another corporation, domestic or  foreign non-profit or
for profit, partnership,joint  venture, trust or other  enterprise; provided,
however, that  the Registrant shall  indemnify any such agent  (as opposed to
any director,  officer or  employee) of  the Company  to an  extent that  the
directors may, in their discretion, so determine.


ITEM 16.  EXHIBITS.

    1.1             Form of Underwriting Agreement.
    4.1             Form  of Pooling and Servicing Agreement relating to Home
                    Equity Loan Asset Backed Certificates.**
    4.2             Form of Trust Agreement.
    4.3             Form of Indenture.
    4.4             Form of Master Servicing Agreement.
    5.1             Opinion of Keating,  Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L. as to the
                    legality of the Securities.
    8.1             Opinion of Brown & Wood LLP as to certain tax matters.
   23.1             Consent  of Brown &  Wood LLP  (included  in Exhibit  8.1
                    hereof).
   23.2             Consent of Keating, Muething &  Klekamp, P.L.L. (included
                    in Exhibit 5.1).
   24.1             Power of Attorney.*
__________________________
*Previously filed.



ITEM 17.  UNDERTAKINGS.

     (a) The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes:

          (1)  To file, during  any period in which offers or sales are being
     made, a post-effective amendment to this Registration Statement;

                (i) To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of
          the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act");

               (ii) To reflect in the prospectus  any facts or events arising
          after the effective  date of  this Registration  Statement (or  the
          most recent post-effective amendment hereof) which, individually or
          in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information
          set  forth in  this Registration  Statement.   Notwithstanding  the
          foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities offered
          (if the total  dollar value of securities offered  would not exceed
          that which was registered)  and any deviation from the low  or high
          and of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the
          form  of prospectus  filed  with the  Commission  pursuant to  Rule
          424(b)  if, in  the  aggregate,  the changes  in  volume and  price
          represent no more  than 20 percent change in  the maximum aggregate
          offering price set  forth in the "Calculation of  Registration Fee"
          table in the effective Registration Statement;

              (iii) To include any  material information with respect  to the
          plan  of distribution not previously disclosed in this Registration
          Statement  or  any material  change  to  such information  in  this
          Registration Statement;

provided, however, that  paragraphs (a)(1)(i) and (a)(1)(ii) do  not apply if
the  information required  to be  included in  a post-effective  amendment by
those paragraphs is contained  in periodic reports filed with or furnished to
the Commission  by the  Registrant pursuant  to Section  13 or  15(d) of  the
Securities  Exchange Act of  1934 that are incorporated  by reference in this
Registration Statement.

          (2)  That, for the purpose of  determining any liability under  the
     Act, each  such post-effective  amendment shall  be deemed  to be  a new
     registration statement relating  to the securities offered  therein, and
     the offering of such securities at that  time shall be deemed to be  the
     initial bona fide offering thereof.

          (3)  To  remove  from  registration by  means  of  a post-effective
     amendment any of the securities  being registered which remain unsold at
     the termination of the offering.

     (b) The  undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that,  for purposes of
determining any liability under the Act, each filing of a Trust Fund's annual
report pursuant to Section 13(a) or  Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934 that is incorporated by  reference in this Registration Statement
shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities
offered therein, and  the offering of such  securities at that time  shall be
deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

     (c) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Act may
be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant
pursuant to the  foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the  Registrant has been
advised  that in the opinion  of the Securities  and Exchange Commission such
indemnification  is against  public policy  as expressed  in the Act  and is,
therefore,  unenforceable.   In the  event that  a claim  for indemnification
against  such  liabilities (other  than  the  payment  by the  Registrant  of
expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the
Registrant in the successful  defense of any  action, suit or proceeding)  is
asserted by such  director, officer or controlling person  in connection with
the securities being  registered, the Registrant will, unless  in the opinion
of its counsel  the matter has been settled by  controlling precedent, submit
to  a   court  of   appropriate  jurisdiction   the  question   whether  such
indemnification by it  is against public policy  as expressed in the  Act and
will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

     (d) The undersigned  Registrant hereby undertakes to file an application
for the purpose  of determining the eligibility  of the trustee to  act under
subsection  (a)  of Section  310  of  the  Trust  Indenture Act  of  1939  in
accordance with the rules and  regulations prescribed by the Commission under
Section 305(b)(2) of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939.

                                  SIGNATURES

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933,  as amended,
the Registrant  certifies that (i)  it reasonably believes that  the security
rating requirement of  Transaction Requirement B.5 of Form S-3 will be met by
the time  of sale  of each Series  of Securities  to which  this Registration
Statement relates and (ii) it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets
all  of the requirements  for filing  on Form  S-3 and  has duly  caused this
Amendment  to the Registration  Statement to be  signed on its  behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly  authorized, in Cincinnati, Ohio on  the 15th day
of May, 1997.

                              THE PROVIDENT BANK



                              By     /s/ Mark E. Magee        
                                  ----------------------------
                              Name:  Mark E. Magee
                              Senior Vice President

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as  amended,
this Amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following
persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

     SIGNATURES                         TITLE                        DATE
     ----------                         -----                        ----

        *                          President                 May 15,  1997
- -----------------------
Allen L. Davis                  (Principal Executive Officer) 
                                 and Director


        *                       Senior Vice President 
- -----------------------               and Chief              May 15, 1997
John R. Farrenkopf              Financial Officer (Principal
                                Accounting Officer)

        *                          Director                  May 15, 1997
- -----------------------
Jack M. Cook

        *                          Director                  May 15, 1997
- -----------------------
Thomas D. Grote, Jr.

        *                          Director                  May 15, 1997
- -----------------------
Joseph A. Steger

        *                          Director                  May 15, 1997
- -----------------------
Philip R. Myers

        *                          Director                  May 15, 1997
- -----------------------
Joseph A. Pedoto

        *                          Director                  May 15, 1997
- -----------------------
Sidney A. Peerless


*By:  /s/ Mark E. Magee    
     ----------------------
     Attorney-in-Fact
                                                                             
         

                                EXHIBIT INDEX


                                                                   SEQUENTIAL
EXHIBIT                                                              PAGE    
  NO.                         DESCRIPTION OF EXHIBIT                 NUMBER  
- -------                       ----------------------               ----------

  1.1               --   Form of Underwriting Agreement.
  4.1               --   Form of Pooling and
                         Servicing Agreement
                         relating to Home Equity
                         Loan Asset Backed
                         Certificates.
  4.2               --   Form of Trust Agreement.
  4.3               --   Form of Indenture.
  4.4               --   Form of Master Servicing Agreement.
  5.1               --   Opinion of Keating,
                         Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L.
                         as to the legality of the
                         Securities.
  8.1               --   Opinion of Brown & Wood LLP
                         as to certain tax matters.
 23.1               --   Consent of Brown & Wood LLP
                         (included in Exhibit 8.1).
 23.2               --   Consent of Keating,
                         Muething & Klekamp, P.L.L.
                         (included in Exhibit 5.1).
 24.1               --   Power of Attorney (included on page
                         II-3).*

                    
- --------------------
*Previously filed.